Read $GDBHISTSIZE instead of $HISTSIZE
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2505
2506 @item show inferior-tty
2507 @kindex show inferior-tty
2508 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @node Attach
2512 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2513 @kindex attach
2514 @cindex attach
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item attach @var{process-id}
2518 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2519 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2520 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2521 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2522 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2523
2524 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2525 executing the command.
2526 @end table
2527
2528 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2529 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2530 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2531 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2532
2533 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2534 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2535 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2536 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2537 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2538 Specify Files}.
2539
2540 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2541 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2542 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2543 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2544 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2545 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2546 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2547
2548 @table @code
2549 @kindex detach
2550 @item detach
2551 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2552 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2553 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2554 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2555 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2556 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2557 executing the command.
2558 @end table
2559
2560 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2561 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2562 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2563 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2564 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2565 Messages}).
2566
2567 @node Kill Process
2568 @section Killing the Child Process
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex kill
2572 @item kill
2573 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2577 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2578 is running.
2579
2580 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2581 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2582 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2583 outside the debugger.
2584
2585 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2586 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2587 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2588 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2589 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2590 breakpoint settings).
2591
2592 @node Inferiors and Programs
2593 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2594
2595 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2596 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2597 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2598 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2599 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2600 from multiple executables.
2601
2602 @cindex inferior
2603 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2604 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2605 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2606 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2607 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2608 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2609 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2610 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2611 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2612 threads running in it.
2613
2614 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2615 inferiors}}:
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex info inferiors
2619 @item info inferiors
2620 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2621
2622 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2623
2624 @enumerate
2625 @item
2626 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2627
2628 @item
2629 the target system's inferior identifier
2630
2631 @item
2632 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2633
2634 @end enumerate
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2638 indicates the current inferior.
2639
2640 For example,
2641 @end table
2642 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2643
2644 @smallexample
2645 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2646 Num Description Executable
2647 2 process 2307 hello
2648 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2655 @item inferior @var{infno}
2656 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2657 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2658 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2659 @end table
2660
2661
2662 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2663 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2664 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2665 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2666 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2667 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex add-inferior
2671 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2672 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2673 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2674 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2675 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2676 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2677
2678 @kindex clone-inferior
2679 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2680 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2681 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2682 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2683 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2684
2685 @smallexample
2686 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2687 Num Description Executable
2688 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2689 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2690 Added inferior 2.
2691 1 inferiors added.
2692 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2693 Num Description Executable
2694 2 <null> helloworld
2695 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2696 @end smallexample
2697
2698 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2699
2700 @kindex remove-inferiors
2701 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2702 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2703 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2704 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2705
2706 @end table
2707
2708 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2709 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2710 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2711 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2715 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2716 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2717 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2718 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2719 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2720
2721 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2723 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2724 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2725 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2726 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2727 @end table
2728
2729 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2730 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2731 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2732 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2733
2734
2735 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2736 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2737
2738 @table @code
2739 @kindex set print inferior-events
2740 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2741 @item set print inferior-events
2742 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2743 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2744 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2745 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2746 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2747 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2748
2749 @kindex show print inferior-events
2750 @item show print inferior-events
2751 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2752 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2753 @end table
2754
2755 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2756 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2757 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2758
2759
2760 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2761 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2762 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2763 info program-spaces}} command.
2764
2765 @table @code
2766 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2767 @item maint info program-spaces
2768 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2769 @value{GDBN}.
2770
2771 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2772
2773 @enumerate
2774 @item
2775 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2776
2777 @item
2778 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2779 the @code{file} command.
2780
2781 @end enumerate
2782
2783 @noindent
2784 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2785 indicates the current program space.
2786
2787 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2788 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2789 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2790
2791 @smallexample
2792 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2793 Id Executable
2794 2 goodbye
2795 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2796 * 1 hello
2797 @end smallexample
2798
2799 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2800 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2801 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2802 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2803 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2807 Id Executable
2808 * 1 vfork-test
2809 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2810 @end smallexample
2811
2812 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2813 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2814 @end table
2815
2816 @node Threads
2817 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2818
2819 @cindex threads of execution
2820 @cindex multiple threads
2821 @cindex switching threads
2822 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2823 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2824 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2825 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2826 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2827 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2828 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2829
2830 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2831 programs:
2832
2833 @itemize @bullet
2834 @item automatic notification of new threads
2835 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2836 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2837 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2838 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2839 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2840 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2841 messages on thread start and exit.
2842 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2843 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2844 isn't compatible with the program.
2845 @end itemize
2846
2847 @quotation
2848 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2849 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2850 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2851 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2852 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2853 like this:
2854
2855 @smallexample
2856 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2857 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2858 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2859 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2860 @end smallexample
2861 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2862 @c doesn't support threads"?
2863 @end quotation
2864
2865 @cindex focus of debugging
2866 @cindex current thread
2867 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2868 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2869 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2870 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2871 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2872
2873 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2874 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2875 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2876 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2877 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2878 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2879 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2880 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2881 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2882 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2883
2884 @smallexample
2885 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2886 @end smallexample
2887
2888 @noindent
2889 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2890 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2891 further qualifier.
2892
2893 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2894 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2895 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2896 @c program?
2897 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2898 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2899 @c threads ab initio?
2900
2901 @cindex thread number
2902 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2903 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2904 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2905
2906 @table @code
2907 @kindex info threads
2908 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2909 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2910 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2911 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2912 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2913
2914 @enumerate
2915 @item
2916 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2917
2918 @item
2919 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2920
2921 @item
2922 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2923 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2924 program itself.
2925
2926 @item
2927 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2928 @end enumerate
2929
2930 @noindent
2931 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2932 indicates the current thread.
2933
2934 For example,
2935 @end table
2936 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2937
2938 @smallexample
2939 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2940 Id Target Id Frame
2941 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2942 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2943 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2944 at threadtest.c:68
2945 @end smallexample
2946
2947 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2948 Solaris-specific command:
2949
2950 @table @code
2951 @item maint info sol-threads
2952 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2953 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2954 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2955 @end table
2956
2957 @table @code
2958 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2959 @item thread @var{threadno}
2960 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2961 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2962 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2963 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2964 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2965
2966 @smallexample
2967 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2968 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2969 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2970 8 printf ("hello\n");
2971 @end smallexample
2972
2973 @noindent
2974 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2975 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2976 threads.
2977
2978 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2979 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2980 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2981 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2982 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2983 information on convenience variables.
2984
2985 @kindex thread apply
2986 @cindex apply command to several threads
2987 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
2988 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2989 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2990 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2991 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2992 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2993 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply
2994 a command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
2995 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
2996 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
2997
2998
2999 @kindex thread name
3000 @cindex name a thread
3001 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3002 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3003 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3004 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3005
3006 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3007 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3008 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3009 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3010 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3011
3012 @kindex thread find
3013 @cindex search for a thread
3014 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3015 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3016 matches the supplied regular expression.
3017
3018 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3019 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3020 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3021 is the LWP id.
3022
3023 @smallexample
3024 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3025 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3026 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3027 Id Target Id Frame
3028 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3029 @end smallexample
3030
3031 @kindex set print thread-events
3032 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3033 @item set print thread-events
3034 @itemx set print thread-events on
3035 @itemx set print thread-events off
3036 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3037 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3038 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3039 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3040 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3041
3042 @kindex show print thread-events
3043 @item show print thread-events
3044 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3045 have started and exited.
3046 @end table
3047
3048 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3049 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3050 programs with multiple threads.
3051
3052 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3053 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3054
3055 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3056 @table @code
3057 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3058 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3059 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3060 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3061 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3062 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3063 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3064 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3065 macro.
3066
3067 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3068 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3069 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3070 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3071 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3072 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3073
3074 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3075 refers to the default system directories that are
3076 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3077 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3078 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3079
3080 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3081 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3082 was loaded in the inferior process.
3083
3084 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3085 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3086 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3087 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3088 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3089 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3090 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3091
3092 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3093 only on some platforms.
3094
3095 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3096 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3097 Display current libthread_db search path.
3098
3099 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3100 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3101 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3102 @item set debug libthread-db
3103 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3104 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3105 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3106 @end table
3107
3108 @node Forks
3109 @section Debugging Forks
3110
3111 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3112 @cindex multiple processes
3113 @cindex processes, multiple
3114 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3115 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3116 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3117 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3118 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3119 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3120 will cause it to terminate.
3121
3122 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3123 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3124 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3125 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3126 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3127 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3128 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3129 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3130 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3131 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3132
3133 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3134 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3135 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3136 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3137
3138 The fork debugging commands are supported in both native mode and when
3139 connected to @code{gdbserver} using @kbd{target extended-remote}.
3140
3141 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3142 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3143
3144 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3145 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3146
3147 @table @code
3148 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3149 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3150 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3151 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3152 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3153
3154 @table @code
3155 @item parent
3156 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3157 unimpeded. This is the default.
3158
3159 @item child
3160 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3161 unimpeded.
3162
3163 @end table
3164
3165 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3166 @item show follow-fork-mode
3167 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3168 @end table
3169
3170 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3171 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3172 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3173
3174 @table @code
3175 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3176 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3177 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3178 retain debugger control over them both.
3179
3180 @table @code
3181 @item on
3182 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3183 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3184 independently. This is the default.
3185
3186 @item off
3187 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3188 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3189 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3190 is held suspended.
3191
3192 @end table
3193
3194 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3195 @item show detach-on-fork
3196 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3197 @end table
3198
3199 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3200 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3201 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3202 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3203 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3204 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3205
3206 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3207 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3208 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3209 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3210 and Programs}.
3211
3212 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3213 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3214 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3215 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3216 the child process's @code{main}.
3217
3218 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3219 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3220
3221 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3222 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3223 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3224 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3225 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3226 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3227 command.
3228
3229 @table @code
3230 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3231 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3232
3233 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3234 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3235
3236 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3237
3238 @table @code
3239 @item new
3240 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3241 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3242 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3243 original inferior.
3244
3245 For example:
3246
3247 @smallexample
3248 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3249 (gdb) info inferior
3250 Id Description Executable
3251 * 1 <null> prog1
3252 (@value{GDBP}) run
3253 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3254 Program exited normally.
3255 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3256 Id Description Executable
3257 * 2 <null> prog2
3258 1 <null> prog1
3259 @end smallexample
3260
3261 @item same
3262 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3263 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3264 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3265 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3266 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3267
3268 For example:
3269
3270 @smallexample
3271 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3272 Id Description Executable
3273 * 1 <null> prog1
3274 (@value{GDBP}) run
3275 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3276 Program exited normally.
3277 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3278 Id Description Executable
3279 * 1 <null> prog2
3280 @end smallexample
3281
3282 @end table
3283 @end table
3284
3285 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3286 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3287 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3288
3289 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3290 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3291
3292 @cindex checkpoint
3293 @cindex restart
3294 @cindex bookmark
3295 @cindex snapshot of a process
3296 @cindex rewind program state
3297
3298 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3299 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3300 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3301 later.
3302
3303 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3304 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3305 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3306 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3307 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3308
3309 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3310 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3311 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3312 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3313 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3314 start again from there.
3315
3316 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3317 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3318
3319 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3320
3321 @table @code
3322 @kindex checkpoint
3323 @item checkpoint
3324 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3325 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3326 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3327
3328 @kindex info checkpoints
3329 @item info checkpoints
3330 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3331 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3332 listed:
3333
3334 @table @code
3335 @item Checkpoint ID
3336 @item Process ID
3337 @item Code Address
3338 @item Source line, or label
3339 @end table
3340
3341 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3342 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3343 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3344 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3345 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3346 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3347 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3348
3349 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3350 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3351 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3352 the debugger.
3353
3354 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3355 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3356 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3357
3358 @end table
3359
3360 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3361 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3362 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3363 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3364 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3365 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3366 previously read data can be read again.
3367
3368 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3369 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3370 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3371 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3372 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3373 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3374
3375 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3376 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3377 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3378 different execution path this time.
3379
3380 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3381 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3382 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3383 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3384 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3385 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3386 potentially pose a problem.
3387
3388 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3389
3390 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3391 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3392 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3393 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3394 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3395 next.
3396
3397 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3398 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3399 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3400 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3401 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3402
3403 @node Stopping
3404 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3405
3406 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3407 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3408 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3409
3410 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3411 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3412 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3413 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3414 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3415 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3416 explicitly request this information at any time.
3417
3418 @table @code
3419 @kindex info program
3420 @item info program
3421 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3422 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3423 @end table
3424
3425 @menu
3426 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3427 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3428 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3429 Skipping over functions and files
3430 * Signals:: Signals
3431 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3432 @end menu
3433
3434 @node Breakpoints
3435 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3436
3437 @cindex breakpoints
3438 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3439 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3440 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3441 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3442 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3443 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3444 program.
3445
3446 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3447 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3448 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3449 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3450 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3451 call).
3452
3453 @cindex watchpoints
3454 @cindex data breakpoints
3455 @cindex memory tracing
3456 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3457 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3458 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3459 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3460 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3461 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3462 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3463 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3464 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3465 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3466 same commands.
3467
3468 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3469 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3470 Automatic Display}.
3471
3472 @cindex catchpoints
3473 @cindex breakpoint on events
3474 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3475 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3476 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3477 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3478 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3479 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3480 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3481
3482 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3483 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3484 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3485 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3486 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3487 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3488 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3489 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3490 enable it again.
3491
3492 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3493 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3494 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3495 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3496 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3497 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3498 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3499
3500 @menu
3501 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3502 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3503 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3504 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3505 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3506 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3507 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3508 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3509 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3510 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3511 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3512 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3513 @end menu
3514
3515 @node Set Breaks
3516 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3517
3518 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3519 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3520 @c
3521 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3522
3523 @kindex break
3524 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3525 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3526 @cindex latest breakpoint
3527 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3528 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3529 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3530 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3531 convenience variables.
3532
3533 @table @code
3534 @item break @var{location}
3535 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3536 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3537 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3538 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3539 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3540
3541 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3542 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3543 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3544 that situation.
3545
3546 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3547 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3548 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3549
3550 @item break
3551 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3552 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3553 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3554 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3555 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3556 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3557 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3558 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3559 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3560 inside loops.
3561
3562 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3563 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3564 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3565 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3566 existed when your program stopped.
3567
3568 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3569 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3570 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3571 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3572 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3573 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3574 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3575
3576 @kindex tbreak
3577 @item tbreak @var{args}
3578 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3579 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3580 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3581 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3582
3583 @kindex hbreak
3584 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3585 @item hbreak @var{args}
3586 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3587 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3588 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3589 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3590 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3591 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3592 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3593 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3594 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3595 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3596 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3597 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3598 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3599 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3600 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3601 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3602 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3603 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3604
3605 @kindex thbreak
3606 @item thbreak @var{args}
3607 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3608 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3609 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3610 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3611 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3612 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3613 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3614 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3615
3616 @kindex rbreak
3617 @cindex regular expression
3618 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3619 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3620 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3621 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3622 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3623 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3624 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3625 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3626 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3627
3628 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3629 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3630 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3631 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3632 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3633 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3634
3635 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3636 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3637 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3638 classes.
3639
3640 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3641 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3642 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3643
3644 @smallexample
3645 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3646 @end smallexample
3647
3648 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3649 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3650 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3651 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3652 every function in a given file:
3653
3654 @smallexample
3655 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3656 @end smallexample
3657
3658 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3659 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3660
3661 @kindex info breakpoints
3662 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3663 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3664 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3665 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3666 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3667 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3668 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3669
3670 @table @emph
3671 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3672 @item Type
3673 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3674 @item Disposition
3675 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3676 @item Enabled or Disabled
3677 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3678 that are not enabled.
3679 @item Address
3680 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3681 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3682 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3683 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3684 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3685 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3686 @item What
3687 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3688 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3689 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3690 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3691 @end table
3692
3693 @noindent
3694 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3695 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3696 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3697 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3698 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3699 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3700
3701 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3702 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3703 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3704 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3705
3706 @noindent
3707 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3708 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3709 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3710 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3711 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3712
3713 @noindent
3714 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3715 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3716 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3717 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3718 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3719 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3720
3721 @noindent
3722 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3723 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3724
3725 @end table
3726
3727 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3728 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3729 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3730 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3731
3732 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3733 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3734 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3735 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3736
3737 @itemize @bullet
3738 @item
3739 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3740
3741 @item
3742 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3743 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3744
3745 @item
3746 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3747 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3748
3749 @item
3750 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3751 several places where that function is inlined.
3752 @end itemize
3753
3754 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3755 the relevant locations.
3756
3757 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3758 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3759 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3760 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3761 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3762 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3763 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3764
3765 For example:
3766
3767 @smallexample
3768 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3769 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3770 stop only if i==1
3771 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3772 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3773 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3774 @end smallexample
3775
3776 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3777 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3778 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3779 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3780 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3781 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3782 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3783 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3784 that belong to that breakpoint.
3785
3786 @cindex pending breakpoints
3787 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3788 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3789 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3790 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3791 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3792 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3793 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3794 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3795 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3796 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3797 is not yet resolved.
3798
3799 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3800 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3801 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3802 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3803 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3804 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3805
3806 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3807 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3808 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3809 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3810
3811 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3812 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3813 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3814
3815 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3816 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3817 address specification to an address:
3818
3819 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3820 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3821 @table @code
3822 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3823 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3824 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3825
3826 @item set breakpoint pending on
3827 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3828 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3829
3830 @item set breakpoint pending off
3831 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3832 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3833 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3834
3835 @item show breakpoint pending
3836 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3837 @end table
3838
3839 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3840 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3841 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3842
3843 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3844 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3845 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3846 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3847 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3848 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3849 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3850 breakpoints.
3851
3852 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3853
3854 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3855 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3856 @table @code
3857 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3858 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3859 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3860 breakpoint must be used.
3861
3862 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3863 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3864 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3865 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3866 @end table
3867
3868 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3869 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3870 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3871 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3872 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3873 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3874 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3875 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3876 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3877
3878 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3879 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3880 @table @code
3881 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3882 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3883 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3884 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3885
3886 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3887 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3888 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3889 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3890 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3891 @end table
3892
3893 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3894 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3895 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3896
3897 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3898 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3899
3900 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3901
3902 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3903 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3904 @table @code
3905 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3906 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3907 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3908 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3909 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3910
3911 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3912 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3913 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3914 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3915 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3916 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3917 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3918 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3919 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3920 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3921 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3922 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3923 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3924
3925 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3926 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3927 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3928 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3929 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3930 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3931 @end table
3932
3933
3934 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3935 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3936 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3937 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3938 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3939 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3940 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3941 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3942
3943
3944 @node Set Watchpoints
3945 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3946
3947 @cindex setting watchpoints
3948 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3949 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3950 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3951 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3952 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3953
3954 @itemize @bullet
3955 @item
3956 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3957
3958 @item
3959 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3960 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3961 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3962
3963 @item
3964 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3965 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3966 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3967 @end itemize
3968
3969 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3970 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3971 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3972 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3973 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3974 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3975 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3976 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3977 the expression changes.
3978
3979 @cindex software watchpoints
3980 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3981 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3982 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3983 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3984 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3985 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3986 culprit.)
3987
3988 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3989 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3990 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3991
3992 @table @code
3993 @kindex watch
3994 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3995 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3996 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3997 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3998 to watch the value of a single variable:
3999
4000 @smallexample
4001 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4002 @end smallexample
4003
4004 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
4005 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4006 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4007 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4008 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4009 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4010
4011 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4012 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4013 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4014 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4015 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4016 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4017 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4018 error.
4019
4020 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4021 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4022 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4023 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4024 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4025 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4026 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4027 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4028 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4029 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4030 Examples:
4031
4032 @smallexample
4033 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4034 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4035 @end smallexample
4036
4037 @kindex rwatch
4038 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4039 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4040 by the program.
4041
4042 @kindex awatch
4043 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4044 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4045 or written into by the program.
4046
4047 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4048 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4049 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4050 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4051 @end table
4052
4053 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4054 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4055 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4056 a never-changing value:
4057
4058 @smallexample
4059 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4060 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4061 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4062 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4063 @end smallexample
4064
4065 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4066 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4067 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4068 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4069 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4070 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4071
4072 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4073 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4074 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4075 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4076 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4077 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4078 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4079 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4080
4081 @table @code
4082 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4083 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4084 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4085
4086 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4087 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4088 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4089 @end table
4090
4091 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4092 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4093 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4094
4095 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4096
4097 @smallexample
4098 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4099 @end smallexample
4100
4101 @noindent
4102 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4103
4104 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4105 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4106 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4107 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4108 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4109 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4110 will print a message like this:
4111
4112 @smallexample
4113 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4114 @end smallexample
4115
4116 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4117 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4118 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4119 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4120 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4121 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4122 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4123 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4124
4125 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4126 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4127 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4128 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4129 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4130 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4131
4132 @smallexample
4133 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4134 @end smallexample
4135
4136 @noindent
4137 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4138
4139 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4140 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4141 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4142 expression with separately allocated resources.
4143
4144 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4145 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4146 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4147
4148 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4149 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4150 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4151 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4152 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4153 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4154 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4155 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4156 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4157
4158 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4159 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4160 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4161 watched expression from every thread.
4162
4163 @quotation
4164 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4165 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4166 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4167 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4168 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4169 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4170 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4171 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4172 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4173 @end quotation
4174
4175 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4176
4177 @node Set Catchpoints
4178 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4179 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4180 @cindex exception handlers
4181 @cindex event handling
4182
4183 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4184 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4185 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4186
4187 @table @code
4188 @kindex catch
4189 @item catch @var{event}
4190 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4191
4192 @table @code
4193 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4194 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4195 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4196 @kindex catch throw
4197 @kindex catch rethrow
4198 @kindex catch catch
4199 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4200 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4201
4202 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4203 regular expression will be caught.
4204
4205 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4206 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4207 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4208 exception being thrown.
4209
4210 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4211 @value{GDBN}:
4212
4213 @itemize @bullet
4214 @item
4215 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4216 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4217 supported.
4218
4219 @item
4220 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4221 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4222 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4223 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4224 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4225 built.
4226
4227 @item
4228 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4229 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4230
4231 @item
4232 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4233 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4234 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4235 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4236
4237 @item
4238 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4239 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4240 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4241 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4242 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4243 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4244 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4245 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4246 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4247
4248 @item
4249 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4250
4251 @item
4252 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4253 @end itemize
4254
4255 @item exception
4256 @kindex catch exception
4257 @cindex Ada exception catching
4258 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4259 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4260 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4261 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4262 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4263
4264 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4265 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4266 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4267 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4268 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4269 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4270 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4271 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4272
4273 @item exception unhandled
4274 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4275 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4276
4277 @item assert
4278 @kindex catch assert
4279 A failed Ada assertion.
4280
4281 @item exec
4282 @kindex catch exec
4283 @cindex break on fork/exec
4284 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4285 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4286
4287 @item syscall
4288 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4289 @kindex catch syscall
4290 @cindex break on a system call.
4291 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4292 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4293 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4294 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4295 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4296 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4297 will be caught.
4298
4299 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4300 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4301 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4302 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4303
4304 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4305 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4306 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4307 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4308
4309 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4310 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4311 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4312 available choices.
4313
4314 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4315 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4316 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4317 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4318 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4319 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4320 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4321 behind the OS upgrades).
4322
4323 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4324 arguments to it:
4325
4326 @smallexample
4327 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4328 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4329 (@value{GDBP}) r
4330 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4331
4332 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4333 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4334 (@value{GDBP}) c
4335 Continuing.
4336
4337 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4338 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4339 (@value{GDBP})
4340 @end smallexample
4341
4342 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4343
4344 @smallexample
4345 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4346 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4347 (@value{GDBP}) r
4348 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4349
4350 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4351 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4352 (@value{GDBP}) c
4353 Continuing.
4354
4355 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4356 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4357 (@value{GDBP})
4358 @end smallexample
4359
4360 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4361 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4362 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4363
4364 @smallexample
4365 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4366 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4367 (@value{GDBP}) r
4368 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4369
4370 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4371 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4372 (@value{GDBP}) c
4373 Continuing.
4374
4375 Program exited normally.
4376 (@value{GDBP})
4377 @end smallexample
4378
4379 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4380 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4381 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4382 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4383
4384 @smallexample
4385 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4386 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4387 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4388 (@value{GDBP})
4389 @end smallexample
4390
4391 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4392 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4393 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4394 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4395 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4396 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4397
4398 @smallexample
4399 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4400 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4401 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4402 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4403 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4404 (@value{GDBP})
4405 @end smallexample
4406
4407 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4408
4409 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4410 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4411
4412 @smallexample
4413 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4414 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4415 @end smallexample
4416
4417 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4418
4419 @item fork
4420 @kindex catch fork
4421 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4422 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4423
4424 @item vfork
4425 @kindex catch vfork
4426 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4427 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4428
4429 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4430 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4431 @kindex catch load
4432 @kindex catch unload
4433 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4434 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4435 matches one of the affected libraries.
4436
4437 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4438 @kindex catch signal
4439 The delivery of a signal.
4440
4441 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4442 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4443 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4444
4445 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4446 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4447 signal names.
4448
4449 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4450 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4451 will be caught.
4452
4453 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4454 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4455 catchpoint.
4456
4457 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4458 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4459 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4460 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4461 commands.
4462
4463 @end table
4464
4465 @item tcatch @var{event}
4466 @kindex tcatch
4467 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4468 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4469
4470 @end table
4471
4472 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4473
4474
4475 @node Delete Breaks
4476 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4477
4478 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4479 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4480 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4481 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4482 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4483 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4484
4485 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4486 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4487 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4488 their breakpoint numbers.
4489
4490 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4491 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4492 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4493
4494 @table @code
4495 @kindex clear
4496 @item clear
4497 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4498 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4499 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4500 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4501
4502 @item clear @var{location}
4503 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4504 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4505 most useful ones are listed below:
4506
4507 @table @code
4508 @item clear @var{function}
4509 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4510 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4511
4512 @item clear @var{linenum}
4513 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4514 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4515 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4516 @end table
4517
4518 @cindex delete breakpoints
4519 @kindex delete
4520 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4521 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4522 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4523 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4524 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4525 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4526 @end table
4527
4528 @node Disabling
4529 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4530
4531 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4532 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4533 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4534 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4535 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4536
4537 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4538 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4539 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4540 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4541 do not know which numbers to use.
4542
4543 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4544 affects all of its locations.
4545
4546 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4547 different states of enablement:
4548
4549 @itemize @bullet
4550 @item
4551 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4552 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4553 @item
4554 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4555 @item
4556 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4557 disabled.
4558 @item
4559 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4560 N times, then becomes disabled.
4561 @item
4562 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4563 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4564 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4565 @end itemize
4566
4567 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4568 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4569
4570 @table @code
4571 @kindex disable
4572 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4573 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4574 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4575 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4576 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4577 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4578 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4579
4580 @kindex enable
4581 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4582 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4583 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4584
4585 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4586 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4587 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4588
4589 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4590 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4591 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4592 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4593 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4594 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4595 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4596
4597 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4598 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4599 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4600 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4601 @end table
4602
4603 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4604 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4605 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4606 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4607 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4608 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4609 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4610 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4611 Stepping}.)
4612
4613 @node Conditions
4614 @subsection Break Conditions
4615 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4616 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4617
4618 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4619 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4620 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4621 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4622 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4623 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4624 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4625 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4626
4627 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4628 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4629 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4630 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4631 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4632
4633 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4634 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4635 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4636 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4637 one.
4638
4639 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4640 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4641 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4642 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4643 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4644 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4645 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4646 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4647 conditions for the
4648 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4649 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4650
4651 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4652 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4653 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4654 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4655 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4656 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4657
4658 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4659 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4660 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4661 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4662 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4663
4664 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4665 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4666 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4667 with the @code{condition} command.
4668
4669 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4670 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4671 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4672 catchpoint.
4673
4674 @table @code
4675 @kindex condition
4676 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4677 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4678 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4679 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4680 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4681 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4682 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4683 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4684 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4685 prints an error message:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4689 @end smallexample
4690
4691 @noindent
4692 @value{GDBN} does
4693 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4694 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4695 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4696
4697 @item condition @var{bnum}
4698 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4699 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4700 @end table
4701
4702 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4703 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4704 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4705 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4706 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4707 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4708 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4709 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4710 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4711 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4712 your program reaches it.
4713
4714 @table @code
4715 @kindex ignore
4716 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4717 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4718 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4719 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4720 takes no action.
4721
4722 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4723 a count of zero.
4724
4725 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4726 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4727 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4728 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4729
4730 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4731 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4732 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4733
4734 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4735 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4736 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4737 Variables}.
4738 @end table
4739
4740 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4741
4742
4743 @node Break Commands
4744 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4745
4746 @cindex breakpoint commands
4747 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4748 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4749 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4750 enable other breakpoints.
4751
4752 @table @code
4753 @kindex commands
4754 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4755 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4756 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4757 @itemx end
4758 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4759 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4760 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4761
4762 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4763 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4764
4765 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4766 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4767 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4768 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4769 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4770 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4771 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4772 Expressions}).
4773 @end table
4774
4775 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4776 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4777
4778 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4779 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4780 that resumes execution.
4781
4782 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4783 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4784 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4785 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4786 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4787
4788 @kindex silent
4789 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4790 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4791 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4792 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4793 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4794 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4795
4796 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4797 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4798 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4799
4800 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4801 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4802
4803 @smallexample
4804 break foo if x>0
4805 commands
4806 silent
4807 printf "x is %d\n",x
4808 cont
4809 end
4810 @end smallexample
4811
4812 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4813 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4814 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4815 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4816 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4817 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4818 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4819
4820 @smallexample
4821 break 403
4822 commands
4823 silent
4824 set x = y + 4
4825 cont
4826 end
4827 @end smallexample
4828
4829 @node Dynamic Printf
4830 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4831
4832 @cindex dynamic printf
4833 @cindex dprintf
4834 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4835 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4836 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4837 having to recompile it.
4838
4839 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4840 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4841 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4842 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4843 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4844 redirects to files and so forth.
4845
4846 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4847 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4848 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4849 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4850 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4851 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4852 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4853
4854 @table @code
4855 @kindex dprintf
4856 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4857 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4858 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4859 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4860
4861 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4862 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4863 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4864 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4865 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4866 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4867
4868 @item gdb
4869 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4870 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4871
4872 @item call
4873 @kindex dprintf-style call
4874 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4875 @code{printf}).
4876
4877 @item agent
4878 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4879 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4880 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4881 support running commands on the target.
4882
4883 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4884 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4885 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4886 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4887 command.
4888
4889 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4890 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4891 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4892 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4893 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4894 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4895
4896 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4897 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4898 you could do the following:
4899
4900 @example
4901 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4902 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4903 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4904 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4905 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4906 (gdb) info break
4907 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4908 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4909 continue
4910 (gdb)
4911 @end example
4912
4913 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4914 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4915 the variable settings.
4916
4917 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4918 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4919 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4920 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4921 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4922 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4923
4924 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4925 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4926 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4927
4928 @end table
4929
4930 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4931 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4932 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4933 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4934 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4935 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4936
4937 @node Save Breakpoints
4938 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4939
4940 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4941 breakpoints}} command.
4942
4943 @table @code
4944 @kindex save breakpoints
4945 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4946 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4947 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4948 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4949 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4950 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4951 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4952 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4953 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4954 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4955 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4956 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4957 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4958 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4959 that can no longer be recreated.
4960 @end table
4961
4962 @node Static Probe Points
4963 @subsection Static Probe Points
4964
4965 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4966 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
4967 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4968 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4969 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
4970
4971 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
4972 ELF-compatible systems:
4973
4974 @itemize @bullet
4975
4976 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4977 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
4978 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4979 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
4980 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
4981 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
4982 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4983 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
4984
4985 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
4986 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
4987 C@t{++} languages.
4988 @end itemize
4989
4990 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4991 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
4992 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
4993 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
4994 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
4995 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
4996 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
4997 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
4998 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
4999
5000 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5001 probes}, with optional arguments:
5002
5003 @table @code
5004 @kindex info probes
5005 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5006 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5007 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5008 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5009
5010 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5011 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5012 probes from all providers are listed.
5013
5014 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5015 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5016 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5017
5018 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5019 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5020 given, all object files are considered.
5021
5022 @item info probes all
5023 List the available static probes, from all types.
5024 @end table
5025
5026 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5027 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5028 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5029 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5030 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5031
5032 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5033 commands, with optional arguments:
5034
5035 @table @code
5036 @kindex enable probes
5037 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5038 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5039 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5040 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5041
5042 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5043 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5044 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5045
5046 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5047 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5048 given, all object files are considered.
5049
5050 @kindex disable probes
5051 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5052 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5053 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5054 @end table
5055
5056 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5057 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5058 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5059 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5060 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5061 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5062 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5063 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5064 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5065 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5066 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5067 at the current probe point.
5068
5069 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5070 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5071 an error message.
5072
5073
5074 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5075 @node Error in Breakpoints
5076 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5077
5078 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5079 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5080
5081 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5082 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5083 @smallexample
5084 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5085 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5086 @end smallexample
5087
5088 @noindent
5089 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5090 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5091 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5092
5093 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5094 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5095
5096 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5097 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5098 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5099
5100 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5101 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5102 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5103 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5104
5105 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5106 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5107 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5108 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5109 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5110 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5111 first in the bundle.
5112
5113 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5114 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5115 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5116 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5117 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5118 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5119 is hit.
5120
5121 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5122 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5123
5124 @smallexample
5125 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5126 @end smallexample
5127
5128 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5129 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5130 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5131 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5132 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5133 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5134 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5135 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5136
5137 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5138 adjusted breakpoints:
5139
5140 @smallexample
5141 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5142 to 0x00010410.
5143 @end smallexample
5144
5145 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5146 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5147 frequently than expected.
5148
5149 @node Continuing and Stepping
5150 @section Continuing and Stepping
5151
5152 @cindex stepping
5153 @cindex continuing
5154 @cindex resuming execution
5155 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5156 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5157 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5158 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5159 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5160 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5161 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5162 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5163 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5164 handlers}).)
5165
5166 @table @code
5167 @kindex continue
5168 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5169 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5170 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5171 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5172 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5173 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5174 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5175 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5176 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5177 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5178
5179 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5180 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5181 @code{continue} is ignored.
5182
5183 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5184 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5185 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5186 @code{continue}.
5187 @end table
5188
5189 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5190 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5191 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5192 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5193
5194 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5195 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5196 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5197 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5198 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5199 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5200
5201 @table @code
5202 @kindex step
5203 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5204 @item step
5205 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5206 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5207 abbreviated @code{s}.
5208
5209 @quotation
5210 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5211 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5212 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5213 @c distinction here.
5214 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5215 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5216 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5217 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5218 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5219 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5220 below.
5221 @end quotation
5222
5223 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5224 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5225 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5226 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5227 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5228 called within the line.
5229
5230 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5231 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5232 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5233 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5234 was any debugging information about the routine.
5235
5236 @item step @var{count}
5237 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5238 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5239 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5240
5241 @kindex next
5242 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5243 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5244 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5245 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5246 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5247 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5248 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5249 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5250
5251 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5252
5253
5254 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5255 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5256 @c
5257 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5258 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5259 @c function are executed without stopping.
5260
5261 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5262 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5263 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5264
5265 @kindex set step-mode
5266 @item set step-mode
5267 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5268 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5269 @itemx set step-mode on
5270 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5271 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5272 information rather than stepping over it.
5273
5274 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5275 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5276 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5277
5278 @item set step-mode off
5279 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5280 debug information. This is the default.
5281
5282 @item show step-mode
5283 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5284 source line debug information.
5285
5286 @kindex finish
5287 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5288 @item finish
5289 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5290 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5291 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5292
5293 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5294 ,Returning from a Function}).
5295
5296 @kindex until
5297 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5298 @cindex run until specified location
5299 @item until
5300 @itemx u
5301 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5302 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5303 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5304 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5305 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5306 than the address of the jump.
5307
5308 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5309 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5310 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5311 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5312 through the next iteration.
5313
5314 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5315 stack frame.
5316
5317 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5318 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5319 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5320 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5321 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5322
5323 @smallexample
5324 (@value{GDBP}) f
5325 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5326 206 expand_input();
5327 (@value{GDBP}) until
5328 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5329 @end smallexample
5330
5331 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5332 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5333 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5334 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5335 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5336 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5337 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5338
5339 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5340 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5341 argument.
5342
5343 @item until @var{location}
5344 @itemx u @var{location}
5345 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5346 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5347 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5348 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5349 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5350 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5351 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5352 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5353 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5354 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5355 invocations have returned.
5356
5357 @smallexample
5358 94 int factorial (int value)
5359 95 @{
5360 96 if (value > 1) @{
5361 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5362 98 @}
5363 99 return (value);
5364 100 @}
5365 @end smallexample
5366
5367
5368 @kindex advance @var{location}
5369 @item advance @var{location}
5370 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5371 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5372 @ref{Specify Location}.
5373 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5374 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5375 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5376 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5377
5378
5379 @kindex stepi
5380 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5381 @item stepi
5382 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5383 @itemx si
5384 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5385
5386 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5387 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5388 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5389 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5390
5391 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5392
5393 @need 750
5394 @kindex nexti
5395 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5396 @item nexti
5397 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5398 @itemx ni
5399 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5400 proceed until the function returns.
5401
5402 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5403
5404 @end table
5405
5406 @anchor{range stepping}
5407 @cindex range stepping
5408 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5409 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5410 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5411 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5412 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5413 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5414 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5415 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5416 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5417 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5418 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5419 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5420 if necessary:
5421
5422 @table @code
5423 @kindex set range-stepping
5424 @kindex show range-stepping
5425 @item set range-stepping
5426 @itemx show range-stepping
5427 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5428
5429 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5430 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5431 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5432 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5433 default is @code{on}.
5434
5435 @end table
5436
5437 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5438 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5439 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5440
5441 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5442 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5443 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5444
5445 For example, consider the following C function:
5446
5447 @smallexample
5448 101 int func()
5449 102 @{
5450 103 foo(boring());
5451 104 bar(boring());
5452 105 @}
5453 @end smallexample
5454
5455 @noindent
5456 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5457 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5458 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5459 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5460
5461 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5462 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5463 is called from many places.
5464
5465 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5466 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5467 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5468 @code{foo}.
5469
5470 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5471 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5472
5473 @table @code
5474 @kindex skip function
5475 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5476 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5477 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5478 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5479 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5480
5481 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5482 will be skipped.
5483
5484 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5485 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5486
5487 @kindex skip file
5488 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5489 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5490 will be skipped over when stepping.
5491
5492 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5493 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5494 @end table
5495
5496 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5497 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5498
5499 @table @code
5500 @kindex info skip
5501 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5502 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5503 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5504 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5505
5506 @table @emph
5507 @item Identifier
5508 A number identifying this skip.
5509 @item Type
5510 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5511 @item Enabled or Disabled
5512 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5513 @item Address
5514 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5515 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5516 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5517 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5518 address here.
5519 @item What
5520 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5521 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5522 where it is defined.
5523 @end table
5524
5525 @kindex skip delete
5526 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5527 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5528 skips.
5529
5530 @kindex skip enable
5531 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5532 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5533 skips.
5534
5535 @kindex skip disable
5536 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5537 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5538 skips.
5539
5540 @end table
5541
5542 @node Signals
5543 @section Signals
5544 @cindex signals
5545
5546 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5547 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5548 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5549 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5550 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5551 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5552 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5553 requested an alarm).
5554
5555 @cindex fatal signals
5556 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5557 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5558 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5559 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5560 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5561 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5562
5563 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5564 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5565 signal.
5566
5567 @cindex handling signals
5568 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5569 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5570 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5571 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5572 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5573
5574 @table @code
5575 @kindex info signals
5576 @kindex info handle
5577 @item info signals
5578 @itemx info handle
5579 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5580 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5581 the defined types of signals.
5582
5583 @item info signals @var{sig}
5584 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5585
5586 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5587
5588 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5589 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5590 for details about this command.
5591
5592 @kindex handle
5593 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5594 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5595 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5596 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5597 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5598 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5599 say what change to make.
5600 @end table
5601
5602 @c @group
5603 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5604 Their full names are:
5605
5606 @table @code
5607 @item nostop
5608 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5609 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5610
5611 @item stop
5612 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5613 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5614
5615 @item print
5616 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5617
5618 @item noprint
5619 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5620 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5621
5622 @item pass
5623 @itemx noignore
5624 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5625 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5626 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5627
5628 @item nopass
5629 @itemx ignore
5630 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5631 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5632 @end table
5633 @c @end group
5634
5635 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5636 program until you
5637 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5638 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5639 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5640 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5641 program sees that signal when you continue.
5642
5643 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5644 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5645 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5646 erroneous signals.
5647
5648 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5649 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5650 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5651 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5652 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5653 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5654 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5655 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5656 Program a Signal}.
5657
5658 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5659 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5660
5661 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5662 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5663 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5664 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5665 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5666 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5667 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5668 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5669 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5670 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5671 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5672 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5673 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5674
5675 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5676
5677 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5678 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5679 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5680 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5681
5682 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5683 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5684 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5685 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5686
5687 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5688 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5689
5690 @smallexample
5691 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5692 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5693 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5694 (@value{GDBP}) c
5695 Continuing.
5696
5697 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5698 main () sigusr1.c:28
5699 28 p = 0;
5700 (@value{GDBP}) si
5701 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5702 9 @{
5703 @end smallexample
5704
5705 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5706 program to receive the signal first:
5707
5708 @smallexample
5709 (@value{GDBP}) n
5710 28 p = 0;
5711 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5712 (@value{GDBP}) si
5713 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5714 9 @{
5715 (@value{GDBP})
5716 @end smallexample
5717
5718 @cindex extra signal information
5719 @anchor{extra signal information}
5720
5721 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5722 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5723 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5724 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5725 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5726 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5727 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5728 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5729 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5730 system header.
5731
5732 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5733 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5734
5735 @smallexample
5736 @group
5737 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5738 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5739 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5740 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5741 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5742 type = struct @{
5743 int si_signo;
5744 int si_errno;
5745 int si_code;
5746 union @{
5747 int _pad[28];
5748 struct @{...@} _kill;
5749 struct @{...@} _timer;
5750 struct @{...@} _rt;
5751 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5752 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5753 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5754 @} _sifields;
5755 @}
5756 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5757 type = struct @{
5758 void *si_addr;
5759 @}
5760 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5761 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5762 @end group
5763 @end smallexample
5764
5765 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5766
5767 @node Thread Stops
5768 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5769
5770 @cindex stopped threads
5771 @cindex threads, stopped
5772
5773 @cindex continuing threads
5774 @cindex threads, continuing
5775
5776 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5777 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5778 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5779 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5780 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5781 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5782 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5783 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5784 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5785
5786 @menu
5787 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5788 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5789 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5790 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5791 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5792 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5793 @end menu
5794
5795 @node All-Stop Mode
5796 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5797
5798 @cindex all-stop mode
5799
5800 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5801 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5802 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5803 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5804 underfoot.
5805
5806 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5807 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5808 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5809
5810 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5811 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5812 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5813 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5814 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5815 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5816 stops.
5817
5818 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5819 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5820 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5821 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5822
5823 @cindex automatic thread selection
5824 @cindex switching threads automatically
5825 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5826 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5827 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5828 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5829 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5830 thread.
5831
5832 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5833 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5834
5835 @table @code
5836 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5837 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5838 @cindex lock scheduler
5839 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5840 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5841 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5842 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5843 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5844 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5845 Other threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
5846 completely free to run when you use commands
5847 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5848 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5849 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5850
5851 @item show scheduler-locking
5852 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5853 @end table
5854
5855 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5856 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5857 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5858 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5859 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5860 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5861 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5862 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5863 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5864 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5865 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5866 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5867 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5868 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5869
5870 @table @code
5871 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5872 @item set schedule-multiple
5873 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5874 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5875 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5876 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5877 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5878 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5879
5880 @item show schedule-multiple
5881 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5882 multiple processes.
5883 @end table
5884
5885 @node Non-Stop Mode
5886 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5887
5888 @cindex non-stop mode
5889
5890 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5891 @c with more details.
5892
5893 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5894 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5895 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5896 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5897 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5898 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5899
5900 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5901 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5902 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5903 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5904 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5905 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5906 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5907 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5908 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5909 independently and simultaneously.
5910
5911 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5912 or attach to your program:
5913
5914 @smallexample
5915 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5916 set pagination off
5917
5918 # Finally, turn it on!
5919 set non-stop on
5920 @end smallexample
5921
5922 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5923
5924 @table @code
5925 @kindex set non-stop
5926 @item set non-stop on
5927 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5928 @item set non-stop off
5929 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5930 @kindex show non-stop
5931 @item show non-stop
5932 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5933 @end table
5934
5935 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5936 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5937 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5938 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5939 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5940 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5941 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5942 default.
5943
5944 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5945 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5946 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5947
5948 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5949 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5950 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5951 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5952 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5953
5954 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5955 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5956 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5957 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5958 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5959
5960 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5961
5962 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5963 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5964 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5965 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5966 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5967 previously current thread.
5968
5969 @node Background Execution
5970 @subsection Background Execution
5971
5972 @cindex foreground execution
5973 @cindex background execution
5974 @cindex asynchronous execution
5975 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5976
5977 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5978 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5979 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5980 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5981 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5982 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5983
5984 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5985 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5986
5987 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5988 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5989 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5990 are:
5991
5992 @table @code
5993 @kindex run&
5994 @item run
5995 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5996
5997 @item attach
5998 @kindex attach&
5999 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6000
6001 @item step
6002 @kindex step&
6003 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6004
6005 @item stepi
6006 @kindex stepi&
6007 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6008
6009 @item next
6010 @kindex next&
6011 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6012
6013 @item nexti
6014 @kindex nexti&
6015 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6016
6017 @item continue
6018 @kindex continue&
6019 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6020
6021 @item finish
6022 @kindex finish&
6023 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6024
6025 @item until
6026 @kindex until&
6027 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6028
6029 @end table
6030
6031 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6032 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6033 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6034 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6035 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6036 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6037
6038 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6039 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6040
6041 @table @code
6042 @kindex interrupt
6043 @item interrupt
6044 @itemx interrupt -a
6045
6046 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6047 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6048 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6049 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6050 @end table
6051
6052 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6053 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6054
6055 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6056 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6057 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6058
6059 @table @code
6060 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6061 @cindex thread breakpoints
6062 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
6063 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
6064 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
6065 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6066 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6067 specify some source line.
6068
6069 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
6070 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6071 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
6072 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6073 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6074
6075 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
6076 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6077 program.
6078
6079 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6080 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
6081 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6082
6083 @smallexample
6084 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6085 @end smallexample
6086
6087 @end table
6088
6089 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6090 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6091 thread list. For example:
6092
6093 @smallexample
6094 (@value{GDBP}) c
6095 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6096 @end smallexample
6097
6098 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6099 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6100 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6101 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6102 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6103 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6104 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6105 command.
6106
6107 @node Interrupted System Calls
6108 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6109
6110 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6111 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6112 @cindex premature return from system calls
6113 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6114 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6115 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6116 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6117 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6118 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6119 stop execution.
6120
6121 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6122 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6123 style anyways.
6124
6125 For example, do not write code like this:
6126
6127 @smallexample
6128 sleep (10);
6129 @end smallexample
6130
6131 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6132 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6133
6134 Instead, write this:
6135
6136 @smallexample
6137 int unslept = 10;
6138 while (unslept > 0)
6139 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6140 @end smallexample
6141
6142 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6143 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6144 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6145 @value{GDBN}.
6146
6147 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6148 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6149 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6150 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6151
6152 @node Observer Mode
6153 @subsection Observer Mode
6154
6155 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6156 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6157 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6158 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6159 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6160
6161 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6162 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6163 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6164 mode.
6165
6166 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6167 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6168 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6169 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6170 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6171
6172 @table @code
6173
6174 @kindex observer
6175 @item set observer on
6176 @itemx set observer off
6177 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6178 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6179 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6180 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6181
6182 @item show observer
6183 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6184
6185 @kindex may-write-registers
6186 @item set may-write-registers on
6187 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6188 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6189 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6190 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6191
6192 @item show may-write-registers
6193 Show the current permission to write registers.
6194
6195 @kindex may-write-memory
6196 @item set may-write-memory on
6197 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6198 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6199 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6200 defaults to @code{on}.
6201
6202 @item show may-write-memory
6203 Show the current permission to write memory.
6204
6205 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6206 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6207 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6208 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6209 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6210 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6211
6212 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6213 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6214
6215 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6216 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6217 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6218 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6219 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6220 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6221 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6222
6223 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6224 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6225
6226 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6227 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6228 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6229 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6230 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6231 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6232 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6233
6234 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6235 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6236
6237 @kindex may-interrupt
6238 @item set may-interrupt on
6239 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6240 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6241 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6242 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6243 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6244
6245 @item show may-interrupt
6246 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6247
6248 @end table
6249
6250 @node Reverse Execution
6251 @chapter Running programs backward
6252 @cindex reverse execution
6253 @cindex running programs backward
6254
6255 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6256 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6257 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6258 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6259
6260 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6261 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6262 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6263 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6264 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6265 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6266
6267 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6268 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6269 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6270 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6271 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6272 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6273 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6274 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6275 prior values@footnote{
6276 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6277 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6278 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6279
6280 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6281 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6282 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6283 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6284 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6285 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6286 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6287 }.
6288
6289 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6290 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6291
6292 @table @code
6293 @kindex reverse-continue
6294 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6295 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6296 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6297 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6298 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6299 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6300 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6301
6302 @kindex reverse-step
6303 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6304 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6305 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6306 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6307
6308 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6309 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6310 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6311 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6312 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6313 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6314
6315 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6316 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6317
6318 @kindex reverse-stepi
6319 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6320 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6321 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6322 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6323 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6324 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6325 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6326
6327 @kindex reverse-next
6328 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6329 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6330 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6331 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6332 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6333 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6334 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6335 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6336 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6337 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6338
6339 @kindex reverse-nexti
6340 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6341 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6342 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6343 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6344 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6345 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6346 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6347 frame) is reached.
6348
6349 @kindex reverse-finish
6350 @item reverse-finish
6351 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6352 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6353 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6354 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6355
6356 @kindex set exec-direction
6357 @item set exec-direction
6358 Set the direction of target execution.
6359 @item set exec-direction reverse
6360 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6361 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6362 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6363 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6364 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6365 @item set exec-direction forward
6366 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6367 This is the default.
6368 @end table
6369
6370
6371 @node Process Record and Replay
6372 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6373 @cindex process record and replay
6374 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6375
6376 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6377 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6378 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6379
6380 @cindex replay mode
6381 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6382 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6383 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6384 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6385 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6386 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6387 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6388 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6389 execution log.
6390
6391 @cindex record mode
6392 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6393 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6394 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6395 for future replay.
6396
6397 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6398 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6399 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6400 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6401 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6402 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6403
6404 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6405 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6406 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6407 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6408
6409 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6410 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6411
6412 @table @code
6413 @kindex target record
6414 @kindex target record-full
6415 @kindex target record-btrace
6416 @kindex record
6417 @kindex record full
6418 @kindex record btrace
6419 @kindex record btrace bts
6420 @kindex record bts
6421 @kindex rec
6422 @kindex rec full
6423 @kindex rec btrace
6424 @kindex rec btrace bts
6425 @kindex rec bts
6426 @item record @var{method}
6427 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6428 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6429 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6430 recording methods are available:
6431
6432 @table @code
6433 @item full
6434 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6435 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6436 execution.
6437
6438 @item btrace @var{format}
6439 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6440 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6441 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited replay and
6442 reverse execution.
6443
6444 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6445 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6446 formats are available:
6447
6448 @table @code
6449 @item bts
6450 @cindex branch trace store
6451 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6452 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6453 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6454 @end table
6455
6456 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6457 @end table
6458
6459 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6460 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6461 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6462 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6463
6464 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6465 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6466
6467 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6468 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6469 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6470 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6471 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6472
6473 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6474 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6475 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6476 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6477 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6478 does not support these two modes.
6479
6480 @kindex record stop
6481 @kindex rec s
6482 @item record stop
6483 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6484 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6485 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6486
6487 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6488 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6489 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6490 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6491 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6492
6493 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6494 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6495 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6496 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6497 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6498
6499 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6500 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6501
6502 @kindex record goto
6503 @item record goto
6504 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6505 ways to specify the location to go to:
6506
6507 @table @code
6508 @item record goto begin
6509 @itemx record goto start
6510 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6511
6512 @item record goto end
6513 Go to the end of the execution log.
6514
6515 @item record goto @var{n}
6516 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6517 @end table
6518
6519 @kindex record save
6520 @item record save @var{filename}
6521 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6522 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6523 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6524
6525 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6526
6527 @kindex record restore
6528 @item record restore @var{filename}
6529 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6530 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6531
6532 @kindex set record full
6533 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6534 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6535 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6536 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6537
6538 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6539 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6540 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6541 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6542 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6543 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6544 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6545 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6546
6547 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6548 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6549 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6550
6551 @kindex show record full
6552 @item show record full insn-number-max
6553 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6554 recording method.
6555
6556 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6557 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6558 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6559 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6560 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6561 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6562 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6563 oldest one to be deleted.
6564
6565 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6566 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6567
6568 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6569 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6570
6571 @item set record full memory-query
6572 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6573 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6574 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6575 case.
6576
6577 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6578 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6579 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6580 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6581 results.
6582
6583 @item show record full memory-query
6584 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6585
6586 @kindex set record btrace
6587 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6588 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6589 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6590 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6591 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6592 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6593 You can use the following command for that:
6594
6595 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6596 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6597 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6598 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6599 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6600 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6601 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6602 position.
6603
6604 @kindex show record btrace
6605 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6606 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6607
6608 @kindex set record btrace bts
6609 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6610 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6611 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6612 format. Default is 64KB.
6613
6614 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6615 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6616 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6617 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6618 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6619 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6620 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6621
6622 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6623 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6624
6625 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6626 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6627
6628 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6629 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6630 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6631
6632 @kindex info record
6633 @item info record
6634 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6635 method:
6636
6637 @table @code
6638 @item full
6639 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6640 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6641
6642 @itemize @bullet
6643 @item
6644 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6645 @item
6646 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6647 @item
6648 Highest recorded instruction number.
6649 @item
6650 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6651 @item
6652 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6653 @item
6654 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6655 @end itemize
6656
6657 @item btrace
6658 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6659
6660 @itemize @bullet
6661 @item
6662 Recording format.
6663 @item
6664 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6665 @item
6666 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6667 instructions.
6668 @item
6669 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6670 @end itemize
6671
6672 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6673 @itemize @bullet
6674 @item
6675 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6676 @end itemize
6677 @end table
6678
6679 @kindex record delete
6680 @kindex rec del
6681 @item record delete
6682 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6683 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6684 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6685 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6686
6687 @kindex record instruction-history
6688 @kindex rec instruction-history
6689 @item record instruction-history
6690 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6691 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6692 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6693 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6694 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6695
6696 @table @code
6697 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6698 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6699 @var{insn}.
6700
6701 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6702 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6703 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6704 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6705 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6706 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6707
6708 @item record instruction-history
6709 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6710
6711 @item record instruction-history -
6712 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6713
6714 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6715 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6716 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6717 number @var{end} is included.
6718 @end table
6719
6720 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6721
6722 @kindex set record
6723 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6724 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6725 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6726 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6727 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6728
6729 @kindex show record
6730 @item show record instruction-history-size
6731 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6732 instruction-history} command.
6733
6734 @kindex record function-call-history
6735 @kindex rec function-call-history
6736 @item record function-call-history
6737 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6738 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6739 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6740 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6741 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6742 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6743 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6744 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6745 given together.
6746
6747 @smallexample
6748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6749 1 void foo (void)
6750 2 @{
6751 3 @}
6752 4
6753 5 void bar (void)
6754 6 @{
6755 7 ...
6756 8 foo ();
6757 9 ...
6758 10 @}
6759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6760 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6761 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6762 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6763 @end smallexample
6764
6765 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6766 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6767 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6768 to print:
6769
6770 @table @code
6771 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6772 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6773
6774 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6775 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6776 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6777 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6778 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6779
6780 @item record function-call-history
6781 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6782
6783 @item record function-call-history -
6784 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6785
6786 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6787 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6788 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6789 @end table
6790
6791 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6792
6793 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6794 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6795 Define how many lines to print in the
6796 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6797 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6798
6799 @item show record function-call-history-size
6800 Show how many lines to print in the
6801 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6802 @end table
6803
6804
6805 @node Stack
6806 @chapter Examining the Stack
6807
6808 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6809 stopped and how it got there.
6810
6811 @cindex call stack
6812 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6813 is generated.
6814 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6815 the arguments of the call,
6816 and the local variables of the function being called.
6817 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6818 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6819 stack}.
6820
6821 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6822 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6823
6824 @cindex selected frame
6825 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6826 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6827 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6828 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6829 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6830 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6831
6832 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6833 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6834 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6835
6836 @menu
6837 * Frames:: Stack frames
6838 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6839 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6840 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6841 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6842
6843 @end menu
6844
6845 @node Frames
6846 @section Stack Frames
6847
6848 @cindex frame, definition
6849 @cindex stack frame
6850 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6851 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6852 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6853 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6854 which the function is executing.
6855
6856 @cindex initial frame
6857 @cindex outermost frame
6858 @cindex innermost frame
6859 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6860 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6861 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6862 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6863 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6864 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6865 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6866 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6867
6868 @cindex frame pointer
6869 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6870 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6871 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6872 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6873 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6874 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6875
6876 @cindex frame number
6877 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6878 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6879 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6880 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6881 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6882
6883 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6884 @c underflow problems.
6885 @cindex frameless execution
6886 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6887 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6888 @smallexample
6889 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6890 @end smallexample
6891 generates functions without a frame.)
6892 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6893 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6894 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6895 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6896 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6897 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6898 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6899
6900 @table @code
6901 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6902 @cindex current stack frame
6903 @item frame @r{[}@var{framespec}@r{]}
6904 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6905 and to print the stack frame you select. The @var{framespec} may be either the
6906 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6907 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6908
6909 @kindex select-frame
6910 @cindex selecting frame silently
6911 @item select-frame
6912 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6913 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6914 @code{frame}.
6915 @end table
6916
6917 @node Backtrace
6918 @section Backtraces
6919
6920 @cindex traceback
6921 @cindex call stack traces
6922 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6923 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6924 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6925 stack.
6926
6927 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6928 @table @code
6929 @kindex backtrace
6930 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6931 @item backtrace
6932 @itemx bt
6933 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6934 frames in the stack.
6935
6936 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6937 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6938
6939 @item backtrace @var{n}
6940 @itemx bt @var{n}
6941 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6942
6943 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6944 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6945 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6946
6947 @item backtrace full
6948 @itemx bt full
6949 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6950 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6951 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
6952 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
6953
6954 @item backtrace no-filters
6955 @itemx bt no-filters
6956 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6957 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6958 @itemx bt no-filters full
6959 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6960 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6961 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6962 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6963 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6964 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6965 support.
6966 @end table
6967
6968 @kindex where
6969 @kindex info stack
6970 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6971 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6972
6973 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6974 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6975 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6976 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6977 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6978 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6979 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6980 multi-threaded program.
6981
6982 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6983 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6984 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6985 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6986 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6987 line number.
6988
6989 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6990 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6991
6992 @smallexample
6993 @group
6994 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6995 at builtin.c:993
6996 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6997 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6998 at macro.c:71
6999 (More stack frames follow...)
7000 @end group
7001 @end smallexample
7002
7003 @noindent
7004 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7005 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7006 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7007
7008 @noindent
7009 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7010 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7011 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7012 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7013 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7014
7015 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7016 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7017 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7018 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7019 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7020 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7021 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7022 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7023 such a backtrace might look like:
7024
7025 @smallexample
7026 @group
7027 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7028 at builtin.c:993
7029 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7030 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7031 at macro.c:71
7032 (More stack frames follow...)
7033 @end group
7034 @end smallexample
7035
7036 @noindent
7037 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7038 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7039
7040 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7041 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7042 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7043
7044 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7045 @cindex program entry point
7046 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7047 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7048 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7049 @code{main}@footnote{
7050 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7051 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7052 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7053 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7054 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7055 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7056
7057 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7058 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7059
7060 @table @code
7061 @item set backtrace past-main
7062 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7063 @kindex set backtrace
7064 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7065
7066 @item set backtrace past-main off
7067 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7068 default.
7069
7070 @item show backtrace past-main
7071 @kindex show backtrace
7072 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7073
7074 @item set backtrace past-entry
7075 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7076 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7077 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7078 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7079
7080 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7081 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7082 application. This is the default.
7083
7084 @item show backtrace past-entry
7085 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7086
7087 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7088 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7089 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7090 @cindex backtrace limit
7091 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7092 or zero means unlimited levels.
7093
7094 @item show backtrace limit
7095 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7096 @end table
7097
7098 You can control how file names are displayed.
7099
7100 @table @code
7101 @item set filename-display
7102 @itemx set filename-display relative
7103 @cindex filename-display
7104 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7105
7106 @item set filename-display basename
7107 Display only basename of a filename.
7108
7109 @item set filename-display absolute
7110 Display an absolute filename.
7111
7112 @item show filename-display
7113 Show the current way to display filenames.
7114 @end table
7115
7116 @node Frame Filter Management
7117 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7118 @cindex managing frame filters
7119
7120 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7121 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7122
7123 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7124 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7125
7126 @table @code
7127 @kindex info frame-filter
7128 @item info frame-filter
7129 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7130 their name, priority and enabled status.
7131
7132 @kindex disable frame-filter
7133 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7134 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7135 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7136 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7137 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7138 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7139 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7140 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7141 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7142 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7143 may be enabled again later.
7144
7145 @kindex enable frame-filter
7146 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7147 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7148 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7149 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7150 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7151 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7152 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7153 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7154 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7155
7156 Example:
7157
7158 @smallexample
7159 (gdb) info frame-filter
7160
7161 global frame-filters:
7162 Priority Enabled Name
7163 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7164 100 Yes Reverse
7165
7166 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7167 Priority Enabled Name
7168 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7169
7170 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7171 Priority Enabled Name
7172 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7173
7174 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7175 (gdb) info frame-filter
7176
7177 global frame-filters:
7178 Priority Enabled Name
7179 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7180 100 Yes Reverse
7181
7182 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7183 Priority Enabled Name
7184 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7185
7186 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7187 Priority Enabled Name
7188 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7189
7190 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7191 (gdb) info frame-filter
7192
7193 global frame-filters:
7194 Priority Enabled Name
7195 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7196 100 Yes Reverse
7197
7198 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7199 Priority Enabled Name
7200 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7201
7202 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7203 Priority Enabled Name
7204 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7205 @end smallexample
7206
7207 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7208 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7209 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7210 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7211 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7212 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7213 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7214
7215 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7216 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7217 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7218 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7219 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7220 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7221 dictionary resides.
7222
7223 Example:
7224
7225 @smallexample
7226 (gdb) info frame-filter
7227
7228 global frame-filters:
7229 Priority Enabled Name
7230 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7231 100 Yes Reverse
7232
7233 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7234 Priority Enabled Name
7235 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7236
7237 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7238 Priority Enabled Name
7239 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7240
7241 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7242 (gdb) info frame-filter
7243
7244 global frame-filters:
7245 Priority Enabled Name
7246 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7247 50 Yes Reverse
7248
7249 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7250 Priority Enabled Name
7251 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7252
7253 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7254 Priority Enabled Name
7255 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7256 @end smallexample
7257 @end table
7258
7259 @node Selection
7260 @section Selecting a Frame
7261
7262 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7263 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7264 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7265 of the stack frame just selected.
7266
7267 @table @code
7268 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7269 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7270 @item frame @var{n}
7271 @itemx f @var{n}
7272 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7273 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7274 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7275 @code{main}.
7276
7277 @item frame @var{addr}
7278 @itemx f @var{addr}
7279 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7280 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7281 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7282 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7283 switches between them.
7284
7285 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7286 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7287
7288 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7289 pointer and a program counter.
7290
7291 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7292 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7293
7294 @kindex up
7295 @item up @var{n}
7296 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7297 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7298 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7299
7300 @kindex down
7301 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7302 @item down @var{n}
7303 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7304 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7305 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7306 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7307 @end table
7308
7309 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7310 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7311 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7312 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7313
7314 @need 1000
7315 For example:
7316
7317 @smallexample
7318 @group
7319 (@value{GDBP}) up
7320 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7321 at env.c:10
7322 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7323 @end group
7324 @end smallexample
7325
7326 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7327 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7328 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7329 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7330 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7331 for details.
7332
7333 @table @code
7334 @kindex down-silently
7335 @kindex up-silently
7336 @item up-silently @var{n}
7337 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7338 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7339 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7340 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7341 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7342 distracting.
7343 @end table
7344
7345 @node Frame Info
7346 @section Information About a Frame
7347
7348 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7349 stack frame.
7350
7351 @table @code
7352 @item frame
7353 @itemx f
7354 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7355 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7356 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7357 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7358 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7359
7360 @kindex info frame
7361 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7362 @item info frame
7363 @itemx info f
7364 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7365 including:
7366
7367 @itemize @bullet
7368 @item
7369 the address of the frame
7370 @item
7371 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7372 @item
7373 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7374 @item
7375 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7376 @item
7377 the address of the frame's arguments
7378 @item
7379 the address of the frame's local variables
7380 @item
7381 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7382 @item
7383 which registers were saved in the frame
7384 @end itemize
7385
7386 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7387 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7388 the usual conventions.
7389
7390 @item info frame @var{addr}
7391 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7392 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7393 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7394 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7395 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7396 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7397
7398 @kindex info args
7399 @item info args
7400 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7401
7402 @item info locals
7403 @kindex info locals
7404 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7405 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7406 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7407
7408 @end table
7409
7410
7411 @node Source
7412 @chapter Examining Source Files
7413
7414 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7415 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7416 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7417 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7418 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7419 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7420 source files by explicit command.
7421
7422 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7423 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7424 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7425
7426 @menu
7427 * List:: Printing source lines
7428 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7429 * Edit:: Editing source files
7430 * Search:: Searching source files
7431 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7432 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7433 @end menu
7434
7435 @node List
7436 @section Printing Source Lines
7437
7438 @kindex list
7439 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7440 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7441 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7442 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7443 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7444
7445 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7446
7447 @table @code
7448 @item list @var{linenum}
7449 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7450 current source file.
7451
7452 @item list @var{function}
7453 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7454 @var{function}.
7455
7456 @item list
7457 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7458 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7459 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7460 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7461 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7462
7463 @item list -
7464 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7465 @end table
7466
7467 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7468 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7469 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7470
7471 @table @code
7472 @kindex set listsize
7473 @item set listsize @var{count}
7474 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7475 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7476 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7477 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7478
7479 @kindex show listsize
7480 @item show listsize
7481 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7482 @end table
7483
7484 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7485 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7486 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7487 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7488 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7489
7490 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7491 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7492 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7493 to specify some source line.
7494
7495 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7496
7497 @table @code
7498 @item list @var{linespec}
7499 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7500
7501 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7502 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7503 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7504 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7505 the same source file as the first linespec.
7506
7507 @item list ,@var{last}
7508 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7509
7510 @item list @var{first},
7511 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7512
7513 @item list +
7514 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7515
7516 @item list -
7517 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7518
7519 @item list
7520 As described in the preceding table.
7521 @end table
7522
7523 @node Specify Location
7524 @section Specifying a Location
7525 @cindex specifying location
7526 @cindex linespec
7527
7528 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7529 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7530 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7531 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7532
7533 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7534 @value{GDBN} understands:
7535
7536 @table @code
7537 @item @var{linenum}
7538 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7539
7540 @item -@var{offset}
7541 @itemx +@var{offset}
7542 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7543 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7544 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7545 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7546 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7547 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7548 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7549 linespec.
7550
7551 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7552 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7553 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7554 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7555 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7556 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7557 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7558
7559 @item @var{function}
7560 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7561 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7562
7563 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7564 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7565
7566 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7567 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7568 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7569 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7570 functions in different source files.
7571
7572 @item @var{label}
7573 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7574 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7575 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7576 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7577 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7578
7579 @item *@var{address}
7580 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7581 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7582 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7583 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7584 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7585 source files.
7586
7587 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7588 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7589 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7590 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7591 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7592 of @var{address}:
7593
7594 @table @code
7595 @item @var{expression}
7596 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7597
7598 @item @var{funcaddr}
7599 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7600 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7601 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7602 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7603 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7604 (although the Pascal form also works).
7605
7606 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7607 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7608
7609 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7610 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7611 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7612 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7613 functions with identical names in different source files.
7614 @end table
7615
7616 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7617 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7618 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7619 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7620 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7621 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7622
7623 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7624 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7625 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7626 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7627 each one of those probes.
7628
7629 @end table
7630
7631
7632 @node Edit
7633 @section Editing Source Files
7634 @cindex editing source files
7635
7636 @kindex edit
7637 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7638 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7639 The editing program of your choice
7640 is invoked with the current line set to
7641 the active line in the program.
7642 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7643 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7644
7645 @table @code
7646 @item edit @var{location}
7647 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7648 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7649 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7650 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7651 command most commonly used:
7652
7653 @table @code
7654 @item edit @var{number}
7655 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7656
7657 @item edit @var{function}
7658 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7659 @end table
7660
7661 @end table
7662
7663 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7664 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7665 @footnote{
7666 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7667 following command-line syntax:
7668 @smallexample
7669 ex +@var{number} file
7670 @end smallexample
7671 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7672 the file where to start editing.}.
7673 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7674 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7675 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7676 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7677 @smallexample
7678 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7679 export EDITOR
7680 gdb @dots{}
7681 @end smallexample
7682 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7683 @smallexample
7684 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7685 gdb @dots{}
7686 @end smallexample
7687
7688 @node Search
7689 @section Searching Source Files
7690 @cindex searching source files
7691
7692 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7693 regular expression.
7694
7695 @table @code
7696 @kindex search
7697 @kindex forward-search
7698 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7699 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7700 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7701 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7702 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7703 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7704 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7705 @code{fo}.
7706
7707 @kindex reverse-search
7708 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7709 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7710 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7711 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7712 this command as @code{rev}.
7713 @end table
7714
7715 @node Source Path
7716 @section Specifying Source Directories
7717
7718 @cindex source path
7719 @cindex directories for source files
7720 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7721 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7722 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7723 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7724 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7725 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7726 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7727
7728 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7729 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7730 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7731 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7732 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7733 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7734 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7735 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7736 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7737 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7738 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7739
7740 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7741 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7742 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7743 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7744 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7745 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7746
7747 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7748 source files.
7749
7750 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7751 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7752 each line is in the file.
7753
7754 @kindex directory
7755 @kindex dir
7756 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7757 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7758 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7759
7760 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7761 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7762
7763 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7764 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7765 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7766 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7767 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7768 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7769 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7770 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7771 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7772 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7773 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7774 name to look up the sources.
7775
7776 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7777 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7778 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7779 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7780 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7781 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7782 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7783 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7784
7785 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7786 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7787 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7788 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7789 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7790 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7791 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7792
7793 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7794 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7795 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7796 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7797 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7798 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7799 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7800 command.
7801
7802 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7803 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7804 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7805 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7806 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7807 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7808 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7809
7810 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7811 @cindex default source path substitution
7812 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7813 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7814 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7815 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7816 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7817 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7818 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7819 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7820 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7821 together.
7822
7823 @table @code
7824 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7825 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7826 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7827 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7828 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7829 part of absolute file names) or
7830 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7831 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7832
7833 @kindex cdir
7834 @kindex cwd
7835 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7836 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7837 @cindex compilation directory
7838 @cindex current directory
7839 @cindex working directory
7840 @cindex directory, current
7841 @cindex directory, compilation
7842 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7843 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7844 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7845 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7846 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7847 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7848
7849 @item directory
7850 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7851
7852 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7853 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7854
7855 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7856 @kindex set directories
7857 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7858 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7859
7860 @item show directories
7861 @kindex show directories
7862 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7863
7864 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7865 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7866 @kindex set substitute-path
7867 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7868 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7869 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7870
7871 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7872 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7873
7874 @smallexample
7875 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7876 @end smallexample
7877
7878 @noindent
7879 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7880 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7881 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7882
7883 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7884 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7885 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7886 the substitution.
7887
7888 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7889
7890 @smallexample
7891 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7892 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7893 @end smallexample
7894
7895 @noindent
7896 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7897 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7898 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7899 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7900
7901
7902 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7903 @kindex unset substitute-path
7904 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7905 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7906 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7907
7908 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7909
7910 @item show substitute-path [path]
7911 @kindex show substitute-path
7912 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7913 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7914
7915 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7916 rules.
7917
7918 @end table
7919
7920 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7921 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7922 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7923
7924 @enumerate
7925 @item
7926 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7927
7928 @item
7929 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7930 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7931 directories in one command.
7932 @end enumerate
7933
7934 @node Machine Code
7935 @section Source and Machine Code
7936 @cindex source line and its code address
7937
7938 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7939 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7940 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7941 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7942 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7943 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7944 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7945 well as hex.
7946
7947 @table @code
7948 @kindex info line
7949 @item info line @var{linespec}
7950 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7951 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7952 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7953 @end table
7954
7955 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7956 the object code for the first line of function
7957 @code{m4_changequote}:
7958
7959 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7960 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7961 @smallexample
7962 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7963 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7964 @end smallexample
7965
7966 @noindent
7967 @cindex code address and its source line
7968 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7969 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7970 @smallexample
7971 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7972 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7973 @end smallexample
7974
7975 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7976 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7977 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7978 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7979 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7980 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7981 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7982 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7983 Variables}).
7984
7985 @table @code
7986 @kindex disassemble
7987 @cindex assembly instructions
7988 @cindex instructions, assembly
7989 @cindex machine instructions
7990 @cindex listing machine instructions
7991 @item disassemble
7992 @itemx disassemble /m
7993 @itemx disassemble /r
7994 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7995 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7996 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7997 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7998 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7999 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8000 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8001 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8002 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8003 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8004
8005 @table @code
8006 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8007 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8008 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8009 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8010 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8011 @end table
8012
8013 @noindent
8014 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8015 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8016
8017 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8018 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8019
8020 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8021 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8022 @end table
8023
8024 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8025 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8026
8027 @smallexample
8028 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8029 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8030 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8031 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8032 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8033 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8034 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8035 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8036 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8037 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8038 End of assembler dump.
8039 @end smallexample
8040
8041 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
8042 program is stopped just after function prologue:
8043
8044 @smallexample
8045 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8046 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8047 5 @{
8048 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8049 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8050 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8051 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8052 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8053
8054 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8055 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8056 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8057
8058 7 return 0;
8059 8 @}
8060 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8061 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8062 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8063
8064 End of assembler dump.
8065 @end smallexample
8066
8067 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8068
8069 @smallexample
8070 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8071 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8072 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8073 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8074 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8075 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8076 End of assembler dump.
8077 @end smallexample
8078
8079 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8080 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8081 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8082 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8083
8084 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8085 mnemonics or other syntax.
8086
8087 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8088 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8089 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8090 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8091 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8092
8093 @table @code
8094 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8095 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8096 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8097 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8098 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8099 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8100
8101 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8102 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8103 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8104 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8105
8106 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8107 @item show disassembly-flavor
8108 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8109 @end table
8110
8111 @table @code
8112 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8113 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8114 @item set disassemble-next-line
8115 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8116 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8117 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8118 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8119 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8120 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8121 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8122 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8123 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8124 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8125 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8126 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8127 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8128 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8129 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8130 instruction.
8131 @end table
8132
8133
8134 @node Data
8135 @chapter Examining Data
8136
8137 @cindex printing data
8138 @cindex examining data
8139 @kindex print
8140 @kindex inspect
8141 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8142 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8143 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8144 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8145 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8146 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8147
8148 @table @code
8149 @item print @var{expr}
8150 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8151 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8152 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8153 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8154 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8155 Formats}.
8156
8157 @item print
8158 @itemx print /@var{f}
8159 @cindex reprint the last value
8160 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8161 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8162 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8163 @end table
8164
8165 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8166 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8167 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8168
8169 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8170 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8171 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8172 Table}.
8173
8174 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8175 @kindex explore
8176 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8177 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8178 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8179 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8180 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8181 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8182 embedded in the higher level data types.
8183
8184 @table @code
8185 @item explore @var{arg}
8186 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8187 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8188 @end table
8189
8190 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8191 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8192 C program as
8193
8194 @smallexample
8195 struct SimpleStruct
8196 @{
8197 int i;
8198 double d;
8199 @};
8200
8201 struct ComplexStruct
8202 @{
8203 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8204 int arr[10];
8205 @};
8206 @end smallexample
8207
8208 @noindent
8209 followed by variable declarations as
8210
8211 @smallexample
8212 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8213 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8214 @end smallexample
8215
8216 @noindent
8217 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8218 @code{explore} command as follows.
8219
8220 @smallexample
8221 (gdb) explore cs
8222 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8223 the following fields:
8224
8225 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8226 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8227
8228 Enter the field number of choice:
8229 @end smallexample
8230
8231 @noindent
8232 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8233 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8234 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8235 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8236 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8237 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8238 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8239 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8240
8241 @smallexample
8242 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8243 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8244 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8245 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8246
8247 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8248 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8249
8250 Press enter to return to parent value:
8251 @end smallexample
8252
8253 @noindent
8254 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8255 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8256 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8257 to explore.
8258
8259 @smallexample
8260 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8261 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8262
8263 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8264
8265 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8266
8267 Press enter to return to parent value:
8268 @end smallexample
8269
8270 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8271 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8272 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8273 level data structure).
8274
8275 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8276 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8277 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8278 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8279 same example as above, your can explore the type
8280 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8281 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8282
8283 @smallexample
8284 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8285 @end smallexample
8286
8287 @noindent
8288 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8289 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8290 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8291 example.
8292
8293 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8294 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8295 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8296 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8297 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8298
8299 @table @code
8300 @item explore value @var{expr}
8301 @cindex explore value
8302 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8303 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8304 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8305 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8306 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8307
8308 @item explore type @var{arg}
8309 @cindex explore type
8310 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8311 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8312 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8313 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8314 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8315 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8316 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8317 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8318 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8319 @end table
8320
8321 @menu
8322 * Expressions:: Expressions
8323 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8324 * Variables:: Program variables
8325 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8326 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8327 * Memory:: Examining memory
8328 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8329 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8330 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8331 * Value History:: Value history
8332 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8333 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8334 * Registers:: Registers
8335 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8336 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8337 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8338 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8339 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8340 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8341 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8342 character set than GDB does
8343 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8344 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8345 @end menu
8346
8347 @node Expressions
8348 @section Expressions
8349
8350 @cindex expressions
8351 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8352 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8353 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8354 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8355 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8356 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8357 @ref{Compilation}.
8358
8359 @cindex arrays in expressions
8360 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8361 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8362 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8363 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8364 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8365 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8366
8367 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8368 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8369 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8370 languages.
8371
8372 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8373 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8374
8375 @cindex casts, in expressions
8376 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8377 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8378 at that address in memory.
8379 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8380
8381 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8382 to programming languages:
8383
8384 @table @code
8385 @item @@
8386 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8387 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8388
8389 @item ::
8390 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8391 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8392
8393 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8394 @cindex type casting memory
8395 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8396 @cindex casts, to view memory
8397 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8398 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8399 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8400 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8401 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8402 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8403 @end table
8404
8405 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8406 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8407 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8408
8409 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8410 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8411 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8412 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8413 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8414 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8415 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8416
8417 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8418 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8419 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8420 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8421 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8422 as well.
8423
8424 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8425 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8426 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8427 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8428 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8429 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8430 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8431 choices.
8432
8433 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8434 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8435 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8436
8437 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8438 @smallexample
8439 @group
8440 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8441 [0] cancel
8442 [1] all
8443 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8444 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8445 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8446 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8447 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8448 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8449 > 2 4 6
8450 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8451 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8452 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8453 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8454 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8455 breakpoints.
8456 (@value{GDBP})
8457 @end group
8458 @end smallexample
8459
8460 @table @code
8461 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8462 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8463 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8464
8465 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8466 is ambiguous.
8467
8468 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8469 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8470 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8471 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8472 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8473 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8474 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8475 in the use of the menu.
8476
8477 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8478 when an ambiguity is detected.
8479
8480 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8481 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8482
8483 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8484 @item show multiple-symbols
8485 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8486 @end table
8487
8488 @node Variables
8489 @section Program Variables
8490
8491 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8492 in your program.
8493
8494 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8495 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8496
8497 @itemize @bullet
8498 @item
8499 global (or file-static)
8500 @end itemize
8501
8502 @noindent or
8503
8504 @itemize @bullet
8505 @item
8506 visible according to the scope rules of the
8507 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8508 @end itemize
8509
8510 @noindent This means that in the function
8511
8512 @smallexample
8513 foo (a)
8514 int a;
8515 @{
8516 bar (a);
8517 @{
8518 int b = test ();
8519 bar (b);
8520 @}
8521 @}
8522 @end smallexample
8523
8524 @noindent
8525 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8526 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8527 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8528 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8529
8530 @cindex variable name conflict
8531 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8532 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8533 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8534 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8535 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8536 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8537 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8538
8539 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8540 @ifnotinfo
8541 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8542 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8543 @end ifnotinfo
8544 @smallexample
8545 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8546 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8547 @end smallexample
8548
8549 @noindent
8550 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8551 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8552 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8553 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8554
8555 @smallexample
8556 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8557 @end smallexample
8558
8559 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8560 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8561 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8562 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8563 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8564
8565 @smallexample
8566 void
8567 foo (int a)
8568 @{
8569 if (a < 10)
8570 bar (a);
8571 else
8572 process (a); /* Stop here */
8573 @}
8574
8575 int
8576 bar (int a)
8577 @{
8578 foo (a + 5);
8579 @}
8580 @end smallexample
8581
8582 @noindent
8583 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8584 here is what you might see
8585 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8586
8587 @smallexample
8588 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8589 $1 = 10
8590 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8591 $2 = 5
8592 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8593 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8594 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8595 $3 = 5
8596 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8597 $4 = 0
8598 @end smallexample
8599
8600 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8601 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8602 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8603 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8604 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8605
8606 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8607 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8608 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8609 @code{some_global}.
8610
8611 @smallexample
8612 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8613 $1 = 23
8614 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8615 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8616 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8617 $2 = 27
8618 @end smallexample
8619
8620 @cindex wrong values
8621 @cindex variable values, wrong
8622 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8623 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8624 @quotation
8625 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8626 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8627 scope, and just before exit.
8628 @end quotation
8629 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8630 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8631 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8632 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8633 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8634 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8635 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8636 variable definitions may be gone.
8637
8638 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8639 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8640 when compiling.
8641
8642 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8643 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8644 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8645 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8646 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8647 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8648 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8649
8650 @smallexample
8651 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8652 @end smallexample
8653
8654 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8655 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8656 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8657 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8658 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8659
8660 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8661 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8662 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8663 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8664
8665 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8666 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8667 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8668 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8669 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8670
8671 @smallexample
8672 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8673 29 i++;
8674 (gdb) next
8675 30 e (i);
8676 (gdb) print i
8677 $1 = 31
8678 (gdb) print i@@entry
8679 $2 = 30
8680 @end smallexample
8681
8682 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8683 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8684 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8685 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8686 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8687 For program code
8688
8689 @smallexample
8690 char var0[] = "A";
8691 signed char var1[] = "A";
8692 @end smallexample
8693
8694 You get during debugging
8695 @smallexample
8696 (gdb) print var0
8697 $1 = "A"
8698 (gdb) print var1
8699 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8700 @end smallexample
8701
8702 @node Arrays
8703 @section Artificial Arrays
8704
8705 @cindex artificial array
8706 @cindex arrays
8707 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8708 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8709 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8710 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8711 program.
8712
8713 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8714 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8715 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8716 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8717 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8718 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8719 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8720 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8721 example. If a program says
8722
8723 @smallexample
8724 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8725 @end smallexample
8726
8727 @noindent
8728 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8729
8730 @smallexample
8731 p *array@@len
8732 @end smallexample
8733
8734 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8735 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8736 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8737 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8738 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8739
8740 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8741 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8742 The value need not be in memory:
8743 @smallexample
8744 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8745 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8746 @end smallexample
8747
8748 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8749 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8750 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8751 @smallexample
8752 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8753 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8754 @end smallexample
8755
8756 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8757 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8758 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8759 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8760 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8761 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8762 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8763 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8764 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8765 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8766
8767 @smallexample
8768 set $i = 0
8769 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8770 @key{RET}
8771 @key{RET}
8772 @dots{}
8773 @end smallexample
8774
8775 @node Output Formats
8776 @section Output Formats
8777
8778 @cindex formatted output
8779 @cindex output formats
8780 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8781 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8782 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8783 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8784 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8785
8786 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8787 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8788 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8789 letters supported are:
8790
8791 @table @code
8792 @item x
8793 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8794 hexadecimal.
8795
8796 @item d
8797 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8798
8799 @item u
8800 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8801
8802 @item o
8803 Print as integer in octal.
8804
8805 @item t
8806 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8807 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8808 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8809 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8810
8811 @item a
8812 @cindex unknown address, locating
8813 @cindex locate address
8814 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8815 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8816 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8817
8818 @smallexample
8819 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8820 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8821 @end smallexample
8822
8823 @noindent
8824 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8825 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8826
8827 @item c
8828 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8829 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8830 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8831 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8832
8833 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8834 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8835 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8836 data.
8837
8838 @item f
8839 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8840 using typical floating point syntax.
8841
8842 @item s
8843 @cindex printing strings
8844 @cindex printing byte arrays
8845 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8846 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8847 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8848 natural types.
8849
8850 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8851 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8852 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8853 array.
8854
8855 @item z
8856 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8857 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8858 to the size of the integer type.
8859
8860 @item r
8861 @cindex raw printing
8862 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8863 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8864 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8865 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8866 pretty-printer which might exist.
8867 @end table
8868
8869 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8870
8871 @smallexample
8872 p/x $pc
8873 @end smallexample
8874
8875 @noindent
8876 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8877 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8878
8879 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8880 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8881 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8882
8883 @node Memory
8884 @section Examining Memory
8885
8886 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8887 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8888
8889 @cindex examining memory
8890 @table @code
8891 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8892 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8893 @itemx x @var{addr}
8894 @itemx x
8895 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8896 @end table
8897
8898 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8899 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8900 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8901 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8902 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8903
8904 @table @r
8905 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8906 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8907 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8908 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8909 @c 4.1.2.
8910
8911 @item @var{f}, the display format
8912 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8913 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8914 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8915 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8916 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8917
8918 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8919 The unit size is any of
8920
8921 @table @code
8922 @item b
8923 Bytes.
8924 @item h
8925 Halfwords (two bytes).
8926 @item w
8927 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8928 @item g
8929 Giant words (eight bytes).
8930 @end table
8931
8932 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8933 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8934 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8935 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8936 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8937 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8938 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8939 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8940 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8941 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8942 be altered.
8943
8944 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8945 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8946 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8947 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8948 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8949 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8950 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8951 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8952 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8953 a value from memory).
8954 @end table
8955
8956 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8957 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8958 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8959 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8960 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8961
8962 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8963 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8964 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8965 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8966 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8967
8968 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8969 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8970 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8971 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8972 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8973 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8974 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8975 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8976 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8977
8978 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8979 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8980 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8981 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8982 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8983 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8984 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8985
8986 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8987 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8988
8989 @smallexample
8990 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8991 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8992 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8993 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8994 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8995 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8996 @end smallexample
8997
8998 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8999 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9000 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9001 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9002 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9003 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9004 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9005 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9006 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9007
9008 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9009 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9010 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9011
9012 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9013 @cindex addressable memory unit
9014 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9015 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9016 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9017 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9018 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9019 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9020 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9021 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9022 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9023
9024 @cindex remote memory comparison
9025 @cindex target memory comparison
9026 @cindex verify remote memory image
9027 @cindex verify target memory image
9028 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9029 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9030 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9031 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9032 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9033 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9034
9035 @table @code
9036 @kindex compare-sections
9037 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9038 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9039 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9040 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9041 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9042 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9043
9044 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9045 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9046 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9047 @end table
9048
9049 @node Auto Display
9050 @section Automatic Display
9051 @cindex automatic display
9052 @cindex display of expressions
9053
9054 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9055 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9056 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9057 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9058 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9059 The automatic display looks like this:
9060
9061 @smallexample
9062 2: foo = 38
9063 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9064 @end smallexample
9065
9066 @noindent
9067 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9068 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9069 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9070 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9071 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9072 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9073
9074 @table @code
9075 @kindex display
9076 @item display @var{expr}
9077 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9078 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9079
9080 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9081
9082 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9083 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9084 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9085 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9086 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9087
9088 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9089 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9090 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9091 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9092 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9093 @end table
9094
9095 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9096 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9097 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9098
9099 @table @code
9100 @kindex delete display
9101 @kindex undisplay
9102 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9103 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9104 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9105 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9106 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9107 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9108 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9109
9110 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9111 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9112
9113 @kindex disable display
9114 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9115 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9116 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9117 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9118 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9119 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9120 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9121 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9122
9123 @kindex enable display
9124 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9125 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9126 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9127 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9128 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9129 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9130 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9131
9132 @item display
9133 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9134 done when your program stops.
9135
9136 @kindex info display
9137 @item info display
9138 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9139 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9140 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9141 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9142 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9143 @end table
9144
9145 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9146 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9147 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9148 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9149 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9150 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9151 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9152 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9153 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9154 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9155 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9156
9157 @node Print Settings
9158 @section Print Settings
9159
9160 @cindex format options
9161 @cindex print settings
9162 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9163 and symbols are printed.
9164
9165 @noindent
9166 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9167
9168 @table @code
9169 @kindex set print
9170 @item set print address
9171 @itemx set print address on
9172 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9173 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9174 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9175 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9176 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9177 @code{set print address on}:
9178
9179 @smallexample
9180 @group
9181 (@value{GDBP}) f
9182 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9183 at input.c:530
9184 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9185 @end group
9186 @end smallexample
9187
9188 @item set print address off
9189 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9190 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9191
9192 @smallexample
9193 @group
9194 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9195 (@value{GDBP}) f
9196 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9197 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9198 @end group
9199 @end smallexample
9200
9201 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9202 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9203 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9204 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9205
9206 @kindex show print
9207 @item show print address
9208 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9209 @end table
9210
9211 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9212 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9213 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9214 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9215 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9216 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9217 it prints a symbolic address:
9218
9219 @table @code
9220 @item set print symbol-filename on
9221 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9222 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9223 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9224 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9225
9226 @item set print symbol-filename off
9227 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9228 default.
9229
9230 @item show print symbol-filename
9231 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9232 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9233 @end table
9234
9235 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9236 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9237 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9238
9239 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9240 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9241
9242 @table @code
9243 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9244 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9245 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9246 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9247 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9248 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9249 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9250 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9251
9252 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9253 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9254 symbolic address.
9255 @end table
9256
9257 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9258 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9259 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9260 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9261 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9262 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9263 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9264 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9265
9266 @smallexample
9267 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9268 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9269 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9270 @end smallexample
9271
9272 @quotation
9273 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9274 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9275 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9276 @end quotation
9277
9278 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9279 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9280
9281 @table @code
9282 @item set print symbol on
9283 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9284 one exists.
9285
9286 @item set print symbol off
9287 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9288 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9289 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9290
9291 @item show print symbol
9292 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9293 address.
9294 @end table
9295
9296 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9297
9298 @table @code
9299 @item set print array
9300 @itemx set print array on
9301 @cindex pretty print arrays
9302 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9303 but uses more space. The default is off.
9304
9305 @item set print array off
9306 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9307
9308 @item show print array
9309 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9310 arrays.
9311
9312 @cindex print array indexes
9313 @item set print array-indexes
9314 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9315 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9316 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9317 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9318
9319 @item set print array-indexes off
9320 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9321
9322 @item show print array-indexes
9323 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9324 arrays.
9325
9326 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9327 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9328 @cindex number of array elements to print
9329 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9330 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9331 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9332 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9333 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9334 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9335 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9336 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9337
9338 @item show print elements
9339 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9340 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9341
9342 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9343 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9344 @cindex printing frame argument values
9345 @cindex print all frame argument values
9346 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9347 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9348 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9349 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9350 values are:
9351
9352 @table @code
9353 @item all
9354 The values of all arguments are printed.
9355
9356 @item scalars
9357 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9358 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9359 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9360 only scalar arguments are shown:
9361
9362 @smallexample
9363 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9364 at frame-args.c:23
9365 @end smallexample
9366
9367 @item none
9368 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9369 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9370
9371 @smallexample
9372 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9373 at frame-args.c:23
9374 @end smallexample
9375 @end table
9376
9377 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9378 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9379 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9380 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9381 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9382 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9383 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9384 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9385 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9386 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9387
9388 @item show print frame-arguments
9389 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9390
9391 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9392 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9393
9394 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9395 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9396 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9397 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9398 This is the default.
9399
9400 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9401 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9402
9403 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9404 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9405 @kindex set print entry-values
9406 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9407 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9408 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9409 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9410 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9411
9412 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9413 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9414 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9415 @code{no} setting.
9416
9417 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9418 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9419 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9420 this information.
9421
9422 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9423
9424 @table @code
9425 @item no
9426 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9427 point.
9428 @smallexample
9429 #0 equal (val=5)
9430 #0 different (val=6)
9431 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9432 #0 born (val=10)
9433 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9434 @end smallexample
9435
9436 @item only
9437 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9438 values are never printed.
9439 @smallexample
9440 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9441 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9442 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9443 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9444 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9445 @end smallexample
9446
9447 @item preferred
9448 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9449 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9450 value for such parameter.
9451 @smallexample
9452 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9453 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9454 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9455 #0 born (val=10)
9456 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9457 @end smallexample
9458
9459 @item if-needed
9460 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9461 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9462 parameter.
9463 @smallexample
9464 #0 equal (val=5)
9465 #0 different (val=6)
9466 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9467 #0 born (val=10)
9468 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9469 @end smallexample
9470
9471 @item both
9472 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9473 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9474 optimizations.
9475 @smallexample
9476 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9477 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9478 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9479 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9480 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9481 @end smallexample
9482
9483 @item compact
9484 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9485 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9486 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9487 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9488 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9489 @smallexample
9490 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9491 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9492 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9493 #0 born (val=10)
9494 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9495 @end smallexample
9496
9497 @item default
9498 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9499 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9500 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9501 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9502 @smallexample
9503 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9504 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9505 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9506 #0 born (val=10)
9507 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9508 @end smallexample
9509 @end table
9510
9511 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9512 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9513
9514 @item show print entry-values
9515 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9516 entry.
9517
9518 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9519 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9520 @cindex repeated array elements
9521 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9522 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9523 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9524 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9525 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9526 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9527 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9528 is 10.
9529
9530 @item show print repeats
9531 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9532 elements.
9533
9534 @item set print null-stop
9535 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9536 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9537 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9538 contain only short strings.
9539 The default is off.
9540
9541 @item show print null-stop
9542 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9543 @sc{null} character.
9544
9545 @item set print pretty on
9546 @cindex print structures in indented form
9547 @cindex indentation in structure display
9548 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9549 per line, like this:
9550
9551 @smallexample
9552 @group
9553 $1 = @{
9554 next = 0x0,
9555 flags = @{
9556 sweet = 1,
9557 sour = 1
9558 @},
9559 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9560 @}
9561 @end group
9562 @end smallexample
9563
9564 @item set print pretty off
9565 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9566
9567 @smallexample
9568 @group
9569 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9570 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9571 @end group
9572 @end smallexample
9573
9574 @noindent
9575 This is the default format.
9576
9577 @item show print pretty
9578 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9579
9580 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9581 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9582 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9583 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9584 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9585 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9586 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9587 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9588
9589 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9590 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9591 international character sets, and is the default.
9592
9593 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9594 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9595
9596 @item set print union on
9597 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9598 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9599 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9600
9601 @item set print union off
9602 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9603 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9604 instead.
9605
9606 @item show print union
9607 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9608 structures and other unions.
9609
9610 For example, given the declarations
9611
9612 @smallexample
9613 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9614 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9615 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9616 Bug_forms;
9617
9618 struct thing @{
9619 Species it;
9620 union @{
9621 Tree_forms tree;
9622 Bug_forms bug;
9623 @} form;
9624 @};
9625
9626 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9627 @end smallexample
9628
9629 @noindent
9630 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9631
9632 @smallexample
9633 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9634 @end smallexample
9635
9636 @noindent
9637 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9638
9639 @smallexample
9640 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9641 @end smallexample
9642
9643 @noindent
9644 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9645 and in Pascal.
9646 @end table
9647
9648 @need 1000
9649 @noindent
9650 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9651
9652 @table @code
9653 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9654 @item set print demangle
9655 @itemx set print demangle on
9656 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9657 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9658 linkage. The default is on.
9659
9660 @item show print demangle
9661 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9662
9663 @item set print asm-demangle
9664 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9665 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9666 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9667 The default is off.
9668
9669 @item show print asm-demangle
9670 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9671 or demangled form.
9672
9673 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9674 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9675 @kindex set demangle-style
9676 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9677 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9678 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9679
9680 @table @code
9681 @item auto
9682 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9683 This is the default.
9684
9685 @item gnu
9686 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9687
9688 @item hp
9689 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9690
9691 @item lucid
9692 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9693
9694 @item arm
9695 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9696 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9697 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9698 require further enhancement to permit that.
9699
9700 @end table
9701 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9702
9703 @item show demangle-style
9704 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9705
9706 @item set print object
9707 @itemx set print object on
9708 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9709 @cindex display derived types
9710 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9711 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9712 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9713 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9714 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9715 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9716 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9717
9718 @item set print object off
9719 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9720 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9721
9722 @item show print object
9723 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9724
9725 @item set print static-members
9726 @itemx set print static-members on
9727 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9728 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9729
9730 @item set print static-members off
9731 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9732
9733 @item show print static-members
9734 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9735
9736 @item set print pascal_static-members
9737 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9738 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9739 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9740 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9741
9742 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9743 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9744
9745 @item show print pascal_static-members
9746 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9747
9748 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9749 @item set print vtbl
9750 @itemx set print vtbl on
9751 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9752 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9753 @cindex VTBL display
9754 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9755 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9756 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9757
9758 @item set print vtbl off
9759 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9760
9761 @item show print vtbl
9762 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9763 @end table
9764
9765 @node Pretty Printing
9766 @section Pretty Printing
9767
9768 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9769 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9770 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9771
9772 @menu
9773 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9774 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9775 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9776 @end menu
9777
9778 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9779 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9780
9781 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9782 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9783 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9784
9785 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9786 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9787 pretty-printers with their names.
9788 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9789 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9790 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9791 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9792
9793 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9794 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9795 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9796 do anything special.
9797
9798 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9799
9800 @itemize @bullet
9801 @item
9802 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9803 all inferiors.
9804
9805 @item
9806 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9807 when debugging that program.
9808 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9809
9810 @item
9811 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9812 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9813 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9814 @end itemize
9815
9816 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9817 pretty-printers are selected,
9818
9819 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9820 for new types.
9821
9822 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9823 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9824
9825 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9826
9827 @smallexample
9828 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9829 $1 = @{
9830 static npos = 4294967295,
9831 _M_dataplus = @{
9832 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9833 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9834 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9835 @},
9836 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9837 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9838 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9839 @}
9840 @}
9841 @end smallexample
9842
9843 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9844
9845 @smallexample
9846 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9847 $2 = "abcd"
9848 @end smallexample
9849
9850 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9851 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9852 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9853
9854 @table @code
9855 @kindex info pretty-printer
9856 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9857 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9858 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9859
9860 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9861 whose pretty-printers to list.
9862 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9863 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9864 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9865 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9866 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9867
9868 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9869 to list.
9870
9871 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9872 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9873 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9874 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9875
9876 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9877 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9878 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9879 @end table
9880
9881 Example:
9882
9883 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9884 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9885 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9886 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9887
9888 @smallexample
9889 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9890 library1.so:
9891 foo
9892 library2.so:
9893 bar
9894 bar1
9895 bar2
9896 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9897 library2.so:
9898 bar
9899 bar1
9900 bar2
9901 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9902 1 printer disabled
9903 2 of 3 printers enabled
9904 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9905 library1.so:
9906 foo [disabled]
9907 library2.so:
9908 bar
9909 bar1
9910 bar2
9911 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9912 1 printer disabled
9913 1 of 3 printers enabled
9914 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9915 library1.so:
9916 foo [disabled]
9917 library2.so:
9918 bar
9919 bar1 [disabled]
9920 bar2
9921 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9922 1 printer disabled
9923 0 of 3 printers enabled
9924 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9925 library1.so:
9926 foo [disabled]
9927 library2.so:
9928 bar [disabled]
9929 bar1 [disabled]
9930 bar2
9931 @end smallexample
9932
9933 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9934 as can each individual subprinter.
9935
9936 @node Value History
9937 @section Value History
9938
9939 @cindex value history
9940 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9941 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9942 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9943 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9944 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9945 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9946 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9947 symbol table.
9948
9949 @cindex @code{$}
9950 @cindex @code{$$}
9951 @cindex history number
9952 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9953 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9954 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9955 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9956 history number.
9957
9958 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9959 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9960 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9961 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9962 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9963 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9964 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9965
9966 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9967 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9968
9969 @smallexample
9970 p *$
9971 @end smallexample
9972
9973 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9974 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9975
9976 @smallexample
9977 p *$.next
9978 @end smallexample
9979
9980 @noindent
9981 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9982 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9983
9984 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9985 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9986
9987 @smallexample
9988 print x
9989 set x=5
9990 @end smallexample
9991
9992 @noindent
9993 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9994 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9995
9996 @table @code
9997 @kindex show values
9998 @item show values
9999 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10000 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10001 values} does not change the history.
10002
10003 @item show values @var{n}
10004 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10005
10006 @item show values +
10007 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10008 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10009 @end table
10010
10011 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10012 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10013
10014 @node Convenience Vars
10015 @section Convenience Variables
10016
10017 @cindex convenience variables
10018 @cindex user-defined variables
10019 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10020 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10021 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10022 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10023 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10024
10025 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10026 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10027 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10028 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10029 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10030
10031 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10032 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10033 For example:
10034
10035 @smallexample
10036 set $foo = *object_ptr
10037 @end smallexample
10038
10039 @noindent
10040 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10041 @code{object_ptr}.
10042
10043 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10044 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10045 value with another assignment at any time.
10046
10047 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10048 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10049 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10050 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10051
10052 @table @code
10053 @kindex show convenience
10054 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10055 @item show convenience
10056 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10057 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10058 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10059
10060 @kindex init-if-undefined
10061 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10062 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10063 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10064 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10065 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10066 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10067 override default values used in a command script.
10068
10069 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10070 any side-effects do not occur.
10071 @end table
10072
10073 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10074 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10075 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10076
10077 @smallexample
10078 set $i = 0
10079 print bar[$i++]->contents
10080 @end smallexample
10081
10082 @noindent
10083 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10084
10085 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10086 values likely to be useful.
10087
10088 @table @code
10089 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10090 @item $_
10091 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10092 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10093 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10094 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10095 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10096 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10097 to the type of @code{$__}.
10098
10099 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10100 @item $__
10101 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10102 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10103 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10104
10105 @item $_exitcode
10106 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10107 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10108 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10109 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10110
10111 @item $_exitsignal
10112 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10113 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10114 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10115 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10116
10117 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10118 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10119 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10120 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10121 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10122
10123 @smallexample
10124 #include <signal.h>
10125
10126 int
10127 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10128 @{
10129 raise (SIGALRM);
10130 return 0;
10131 @}
10132 @end smallexample
10133
10134 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10135 or signalled would be:
10136
10137 @smallexample
10138 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10139 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10140 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10141 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10142 >echo The program has exited\n
10143 >else
10144 >echo The program has signalled\n
10145 >end
10146 >end
10147 (@value{GDBP}) run
10148 Starting program:
10149
10150 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10151 The program no longer exists.
10152 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10153 The program has signalled
10154 @end smallexample
10155
10156 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10157 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10158 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10159 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10160
10161 @smallexample
10162 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10163 The program has exited
10164 @end smallexample
10165
10166 @item $_exception
10167 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10168 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10169
10170 @item $_probe_argc
10171 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10172 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10173
10174 @item $_sdata
10175 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10176 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10177 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10178 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10179 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10180
10181 @item $_siginfo
10182 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10183 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10184 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10185 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10186 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10187
10188 @item $_tlb
10189 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10190 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10191 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10192 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10193 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10194 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10195
10196 @end table
10197
10198 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10199 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10200 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10201
10202 @node Convenience Funs
10203 @section Convenience Functions
10204
10205 @cindex convenience functions
10206 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10207 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10208 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10209 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10210 @value{GDBN}.
10211
10212 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10213 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10214
10215 @table @code
10216
10217 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10218 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10219 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10220 returns zero.
10221
10222 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10223 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10224 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10225 it is @code{void}:
10226
10227 @smallexample
10228 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10229 $1 = void
10230 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10231 $2 = 1
10232 (@value{GDBP}) run
10233 Starting program: ./a.out
10234 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10235 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10236 $3 = 0
10237 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10238 $4 = 0
10239 @end smallexample
10240
10241 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10242 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10243 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10244 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10245 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10246 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10247 anymore.
10248
10249 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10250 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10251
10252 @smallexample
10253 void
10254 foo (void)
10255 @{
10256 @}
10257 @end smallexample
10258
10259 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10260
10261 @smallexample
10262 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10263 $1 = void
10264 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10265 $2 = 1
10266 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10267 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10268 $3 = void
10269 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10270 $4 = 1
10271 @end smallexample
10272
10273 @end table
10274
10275 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10276 @code{Python} support.
10277
10278 @table @code
10279
10280 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10281 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10282 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10283 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10284 Otherwise it returns zero.
10285
10286 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10287 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10288 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10289 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10290 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10291 regular expression support.
10292
10293 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10294 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10295 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10296 Otherwise it returns zero.
10297
10298 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10299 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10300 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10301
10302 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10303 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10304 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10305 Otherwise it returns zero.
10306
10307 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10308 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10309 The default is 1.
10310
10311 Example:
10312
10313 @smallexample
10314 (gdb) backtrace
10315 #0 bottom_func ()
10316 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10317 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10318 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10319 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10320 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10321 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10322 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10323 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10324 $1 = 1
10325 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10326 $1 = 1
10327 @end smallexample
10328
10329 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10330 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10331 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10332 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10333
10334 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10335 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10336 The default is 1.
10337
10338 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10339 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10340 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10341 Otherwise it returns zero.
10342
10343 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10344 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10345 The default is 1.
10346
10347 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10348 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10349 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10350 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10351
10352 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10353 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10354 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10355 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10356
10357 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10358 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10359 The default is 1.
10360
10361 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10362 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10363 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10364 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10365
10366 @end table
10367
10368 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10369 convenience functions.
10370
10371 @table @code
10372 @item help function
10373 @kindex help function
10374 @cindex show all convenience functions
10375 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10376 @end table
10377
10378 @node Registers
10379 @section Registers
10380
10381 @cindex registers
10382 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10383 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10384 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10385 your machine.
10386
10387 @table @code
10388 @kindex info registers
10389 @item info registers
10390 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10391 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10392
10393 @kindex info all-registers
10394 @cindex floating point registers
10395 @item info all-registers
10396 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10397 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10398
10399 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10400 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10401 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10402 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10403 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10404 @end table
10405
10406 @anchor{standard registers}
10407 @cindex stack pointer register
10408 @cindex program counter register
10409 @cindex process status register
10410 @cindex frame pointer register
10411 @cindex standard registers
10412 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10413 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10414 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10415 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10416 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10417 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10418 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10419 you could print the program counter in hex with
10420
10421 @smallexample
10422 p/x $pc
10423 @end smallexample
10424
10425 @noindent
10426 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10427
10428 @smallexample
10429 x/i $pc
10430 @end smallexample
10431
10432 @noindent
10433 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10434 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10435 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10436 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10437 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10438 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10439 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10440
10441 @smallexample
10442 set $sp += 4
10443 @end smallexample
10444
10445 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10446 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10447 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10448 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10449 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10450 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10451 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10452
10453 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10454 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10455 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10456 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10457 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10458 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10459 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10460
10461 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10462 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10463 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10464 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10465 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10466 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10467 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10468 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10469 prints the data in both formats.
10470
10471 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10472 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10473 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10474 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10475 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10476 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10477 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10478
10479 @smallexample
10480 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10481 $1 = @{
10482 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10483 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10484 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10485 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10486 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10487 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10488 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10489 @}
10490 @end smallexample
10491
10492 @noindent
10493 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10494 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10495 value to a @code{struct} member:
10496
10497 @smallexample
10498 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10499 @end smallexample
10500
10501 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10502 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10503 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10504 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10505 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10506 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10507
10508 @cindex caller-saved registers
10509 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10510 @cindex volatile registers
10511 @cindex <not saved> values
10512 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10513 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10514 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10515 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10516 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10517 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10518 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10519 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10520 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10521 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10522 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10523 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10524 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10525 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10526 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10527 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10528 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10529 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10530 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10531 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10532 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10533 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10534 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10535
10536 @node Floating Point Hardware
10537 @section Floating Point Hardware
10538 @cindex floating point
10539
10540 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10541 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10542
10543 @table @code
10544 @kindex info float
10545 @item info float
10546 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10547 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10548 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10549 the ARM and x86 machines.
10550 @end table
10551
10552 @node Vector Unit
10553 @section Vector Unit
10554 @cindex vector unit
10555
10556 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10557 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10558
10559 @table @code
10560 @kindex info vector
10561 @item info vector
10562 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10563 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10564 @end table
10565
10566 @node OS Information
10567 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10568 @cindex OS information
10569
10570 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10571 you debug your program.
10572
10573 @cindex auxiliary vector
10574 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10575 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10576 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10577 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10578 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10579 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10580 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10581 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10582 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10583 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10584 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10585 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10586
10587 @table @code
10588 @kindex info auxv
10589 @item info auxv
10590 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10591 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10592 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10593 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10594 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10595 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10596 an unrecognized tag.
10597 @end table
10598
10599 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10600 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10601 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10602 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10603 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10604 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10605 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10606
10607 @table @code
10608 @kindex info os
10609 @item info os @var{infotype}
10610
10611 Display OS information of the requested type.
10612
10613 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10614
10615 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10616 @table @code
10617 @kindex info os cpus
10618 @item cpus
10619 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
10620 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
10621 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
10622 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
10623 kernel initialization.
10624
10625 @kindex info os files
10626 @item files
10627 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10628 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10629 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10630 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10631
10632 @kindex info os modules
10633 @item modules
10634 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10635 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10636 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10637 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10638 in memory.
10639
10640 @kindex info os msg
10641 @item msg
10642 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10643 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10644 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10645 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10646 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10647 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10648 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10649 the message queue was last changed.
10650
10651 @kindex info os processes
10652 @item processes
10653 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10654 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10655 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10656 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10657 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10658 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10659
10660 @kindex info os procgroups
10661 @item procgroups
10662 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10663 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10664 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10665 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10666 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10667 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10668 and the process group leader is listed first.
10669
10670 @kindex info os semaphores
10671 @item semaphores
10672 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10673 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10674 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10675 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10676 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10677
10678 @kindex info os shm
10679 @item shm
10680 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10681 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10682 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10683 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10684 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10685 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10686 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10687
10688 @kindex info os sockets
10689 @item sockets
10690 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10691 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10692 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10693 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10694 connection.
10695
10696 @kindex info os threads
10697 @item threads
10698 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10699 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10700 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10701 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10702 process is not listed.
10703 @end table
10704
10705 @item info os
10706 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10707 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10708 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10709 types, this command will report an error.
10710 @end table
10711
10712 @node Memory Region Attributes
10713 @section Memory Region Attributes
10714 @cindex memory region attributes
10715
10716 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10717 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10718 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10719 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10720 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10721 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10722 user can override the fetched regions.
10723
10724 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10725 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10726 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10727 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10728 all memory.
10729
10730 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10731 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10732
10733 @table @code
10734 @kindex mem
10735 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10736 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10737 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10738 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10739 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10740 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10741
10742 @item mem auto
10743 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10744 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10745
10746 @kindex delete mem
10747 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10748 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10749 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10750
10751 @kindex disable mem
10752 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10753 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10754 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10755 It may be enabled again later.
10756
10757 @kindex enable mem
10758 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10759 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10760
10761 @kindex info mem
10762 @item info mem
10763 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10764 for each region:
10765
10766 @table @emph
10767 @item Memory Region Number
10768 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10769 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10770 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10771
10772 @item Lo Address
10773 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10774
10775 @item Hi Address
10776 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10777
10778 @item Attributes
10779 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10780 @end table
10781 @end table
10782
10783
10784 @subsection Attributes
10785
10786 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10787 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10788 write accesses to a memory region.
10789
10790 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10791 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10792 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10793
10794 @table @code
10795 @item ro
10796 Memory is read only.
10797 @item wo
10798 Memory is write only.
10799 @item rw
10800 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10801 @end table
10802
10803 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10804 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10805 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10806 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10807 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10808
10809 @table @code
10810 @item 8
10811 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10812 @item 16
10813 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10814 @item 32
10815 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10816 @item 64
10817 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10818 @end table
10819
10820 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10821 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10822 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10823 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10824 @c
10825 @c @table @code
10826 @c @item hwbreak
10827 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10828 @c @item swbreak (default)
10829 @c @end table
10830
10831 @subsubsection Data Cache
10832 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10833 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10834 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10835 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10836 registers.
10837
10838 @table @code
10839 @item cache
10840 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10841 @item nocache
10842 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10843 @end table
10844
10845 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10846 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10847 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10848 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10849 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10850
10851 @table @code
10852 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10853 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10854 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10855 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10856 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10857 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10858 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10859 The default value is @code{on}.
10860 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10861 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10862 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10863 @end table
10864
10865
10866 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10867 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10868 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10869 @c
10870 @c @table @code
10871 @c @item verify
10872 @c @item noverify (default)
10873 @c @end table
10874
10875 @node Dump/Restore Files
10876 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10877 @cindex dump/restore files
10878 @cindex append data to a file
10879 @cindex dump data to a file
10880 @cindex restore data from a file
10881
10882 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10883 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10884 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10885 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10886 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
10887 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
10888 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
10889
10890 @table @code
10891
10892 @kindex dump
10893 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10894 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10895 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10896 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10897
10898 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10899 @table @code
10900 @item binary
10901 Raw binary form.
10902 @item ihex
10903 Intel hex format.
10904 @item srec
10905 Motorola S-record format.
10906 @item tekhex
10907 Tektronix Hex format.
10908 @item verilog
10909 Verilog Hex format.
10910 @end table
10911
10912 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10913 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10914 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10915 form.
10916
10917 @kindex append
10918 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10919 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10920 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10921 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10922 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10923
10924 @kindex restore
10925 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10926 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10927 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10928 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10929 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10930
10931 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10932 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10933 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10934 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10935 from that location.
10936
10937 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10938 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10939 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10940 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10941
10942 @end table
10943
10944 @node Core File Generation
10945 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10946 @cindex dump core from inferior
10947
10948 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10949 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10950 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10951 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10952 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10953 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10954 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10955
10956 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10957 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10958 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10959
10960 @table @code
10961 @kindex gcore
10962 @kindex generate-core-file
10963 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10964 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10965 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10966 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10967 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10968 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10969
10970 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10971 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10972
10973 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
10974 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
10975 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
10976
10977 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
10978 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
10979 @item set use-coredump-filter on
10980 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
10981 Enable or disable the use of the file
10982 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
10983 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
10984 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
10985 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
10986
10987 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
10988 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
10989 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
10990 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
10991 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
10992 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
10993 about the bits that can be set in the
10994 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
10995 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
10996
10997 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
10998 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
10999 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11000 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11001 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11002 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11003 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11004 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11005 @end table
11006
11007 @node Character Sets
11008 @section Character Sets
11009 @cindex character sets
11010 @cindex charset
11011 @cindex translating between character sets
11012 @cindex host character set
11013 @cindex target character set
11014
11015 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11016 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11017 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11018 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11019 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11020 @dfn{target character set}.
11021
11022 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11023 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11024 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11025 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11026 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11027 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11028 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11029 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11030 character and string literals in expressions.
11031
11032 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11033 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11034 target-charset} command, described below.
11035
11036 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11037 support:
11038
11039 @table @code
11040 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11041 @kindex set target-charset
11042 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11043 list of supported target character sets, type
11044 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11045
11046 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11047 @kindex set host-charset
11048 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11049
11050 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11051 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11052 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11053 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11054 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11055
11056 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11057 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11058 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11059
11060 @item set charset @var{charset}
11061 @kindex set charset
11062 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11063 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11064 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11065 for both host and target.
11066
11067 @item show charset
11068 @kindex show charset
11069 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11070
11071 @item show host-charset
11072 @kindex show host-charset
11073 Show the name of the current host character set.
11074
11075 @item show target-charset
11076 @kindex show target-charset
11077 Show the name of the current target character set.
11078
11079 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11080 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11081 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11082 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11083 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11084 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11085
11086 @item show target-wide-charset
11087 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11088 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11089 @end table
11090
11091 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11092 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11093 @file{charset-test.c}:
11094
11095 @smallexample
11096 #include <stdio.h>
11097
11098 char ascii_hello[]
11099 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11100 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11101 char ibm1047_hello[]
11102 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11103 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11104
11105 main ()
11106 @{
11107 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11108 @}
11109 @end smallexample
11110
11111 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11112 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11113 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11114
11115 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11116
11117 @smallexample
11118 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11119 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11120 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11121 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11122 @dots{}
11123 (@value{GDBP})
11124 @end smallexample
11125
11126 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11127 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11128 strings:
11129
11130 @smallexample
11131 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11132 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11133 (@value{GDBP})
11134 @end smallexample
11135
11136 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11137 initial character set:
11138 @smallexample
11139 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11140 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11141 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11142 (@value{GDBP})
11143 @end smallexample
11144
11145 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11146 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11147 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11148 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11149 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11150
11151 @smallexample
11152 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11153 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11154 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11155 $2 = 72 'H'
11156 (@value{GDBP})
11157 @end smallexample
11158
11159 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11160 literals you use in expressions:
11161
11162 @smallexample
11163 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11164 $3 = 43 '+'
11165 (@value{GDBP})
11166 @end smallexample
11167
11168 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11169 character.
11170
11171 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11172 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11173 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11174
11175 @smallexample
11176 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11177 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11178 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11179 $5 = 200 '\310'
11180 (@value{GDBP})
11181 @end smallexample
11182
11183 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11184 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11185
11186 @smallexample
11187 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11188 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11189 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11190 @end smallexample
11191
11192 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11193 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11194 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11195 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11196 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11197
11198 @smallexample
11199 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11200 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11201 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11202 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11203 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11204 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11205 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11206 $7 = 72 '\110'
11207 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11208 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11209 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11210 $9 = 200 'H'
11211 (@value{GDBP})
11212 @end smallexample
11213
11214 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11215 string literals you use in expressions:
11216
11217 @smallexample
11218 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11219 $10 = 78 '+'
11220 (@value{GDBP})
11221 @end smallexample
11222
11223 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11224 character.
11225
11226 @node Caching Target Data
11227 @section Caching Data of Targets
11228 @cindex caching data of targets
11229
11230 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11231 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11232 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11233 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11234 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11235 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11236 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11237 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11238 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11239 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11240 is executing.
11241 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11242 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11243 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11244 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11245 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11246 in the code segment.
11247 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11248 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11249
11250 @table @code
11251 @kindex set remotecache
11252 @item set remotecache on
11253 @itemx set remotecache off
11254 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11255 with old scripts.
11256
11257 @kindex show remotecache
11258 @item show remotecache
11259 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11260
11261 @kindex set stack-cache
11262 @item set stack-cache on
11263 @itemx set stack-cache off
11264 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11265 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11266
11267 @kindex show stack-cache
11268 @item show stack-cache
11269 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11270
11271 @kindex set code-cache
11272 @item set code-cache on
11273 @itemx set code-cache off
11274 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11275 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11276 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11277
11278 @kindex show code-cache
11279 @item show code-cache
11280 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11281 accesses.
11282
11283 @kindex info dcache
11284 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11285 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11286 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11287 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11288 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11289 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11290
11291 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11292 printed in hex.
11293
11294 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11295 @cindex dcache size
11296 @kindex set dcache size
11297 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11298
11299 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11300 @cindex dcache line-size
11301 @kindex set dcache line-size
11302 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11303 Must be a power of 2.
11304
11305 @item show dcache size
11306 @kindex show dcache size
11307 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11308
11309 @item show dcache line-size
11310 @kindex show dcache line-size
11311 Show default size of dcache lines.
11312
11313 @end table
11314
11315 @node Searching Memory
11316 @section Search Memory
11317 @cindex searching memory
11318
11319 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11320 @code{find} command.
11321
11322 @table @code
11323 @kindex find
11324 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11325 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11326 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11327 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11328 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11329 @end table
11330
11331 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11332 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11333
11334 @table @r
11335 @item @var{s}, search query size
11336 The size of each search query value.
11337
11338 @table @code
11339 @item b
11340 bytes
11341 @item h
11342 halfwords (two bytes)
11343 @item w
11344 words (four bytes)
11345 @item g
11346 giant words (eight bytes)
11347 @end table
11348
11349 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11350 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11351 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11352
11353 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11354 value's type in the current language.
11355 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11356 pattern as a mixture of types.
11357 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11358 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11359 which is typically four bytes.
11360
11361 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11362 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11363 @end table
11364
11365 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11366 (@code{"}).
11367 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11368 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11369
11370 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11371 number of matches found.
11372
11373 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11374 @samp{$_}.
11375 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11376
11377 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11378
11379 @smallexample
11380 void
11381 hello ()
11382 @{
11383 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11384 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11385 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11386 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11387 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11388 @}
11389 @end smallexample
11390
11391 @noindent
11392 you get during debugging:
11393
11394 @smallexample
11395 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11396 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11397 1 pattern found
11398 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11399 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11400 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11401 2 patterns found
11402 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11403 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11404 1 pattern found
11405 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11406 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11407 1 pattern found
11408 (gdb) print $numfound
11409 $1 = 1
11410 (gdb) print $_
11411 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11412 @end smallexample
11413
11414 @node Optimized Code
11415 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11416 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11417 @cindex debugging optimized code
11418
11419 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11420 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11421 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11422 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11423 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11424 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11425 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11426
11427 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11428 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11429 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11430 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11431
11432 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11433 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11434 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11435 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11436 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11437 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11438
11439 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11440 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11441 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11442 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11443 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11444
11445 @menu
11446 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11447 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11448 @end menu
11449
11450 @node Inline Functions
11451 @section Inline Functions
11452 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11453
11454 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11455 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11456 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11457 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11458 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11459 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11460 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11461 @code{info frame} command.
11462
11463 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11464 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11465 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11466 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11467 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11468 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11469 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11470 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11471 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11472 local variables in the caller.
11473
11474 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11475 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11476 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11477 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11478 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11479 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11480 instructions are executed.
11481
11482 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11483 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11484 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11485 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11486
11487 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11488 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11489
11490 @itemize @bullet
11491 @item
11492 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11493 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11494 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11495 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11496 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11497 or inside the inlined function instead.
11498
11499 @item
11500 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11501 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11502 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11503 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11504
11505 @end itemize
11506
11507 @node Tail Call Frames
11508 @section Tail Call Frames
11509 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11510
11511 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11512 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11513 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11514 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11515 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11516
11517 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11518 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11519 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11520 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11521 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11522 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11523 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11524
11525 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11526 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11527 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11528 this information.
11529
11530 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11531 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11532
11533 @smallexample
11534 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11535 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11536 (gdb) info frame
11537 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11538 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11539 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11540 source language c++.
11541 Arglist at unknown address.
11542 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11543 @end smallexample
11544
11545 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11546 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11547 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11548 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11549 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11550 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11551
11552 @table @code
11553 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11554 @item set debug entry-values
11555 @kindex set debug entry-values
11556 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11557 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11558 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11559 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11560 result.
11561
11562 @item show debug entry-values
11563 @kindex show debug entry-values
11564 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11565 values at function entry and tail calls.
11566 @end table
11567
11568 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11569 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11570 reference by variable @code{x}):
11571
11572 @smallexample
11573 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11574 void (*x) (void) = c;
11575 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11576 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11577 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11578
11579 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11580 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11581 a () at t.c:3
11582 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11583 (gdb) bt
11584 #0 a () at t.c:3
11585 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11586 @end smallexample
11587
11588 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11589
11590 @smallexample
11591 int i;
11592 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11593 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11594 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11595 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11596 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11597 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11598 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11599 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11600
11601 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11602 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11603 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11604 (gdb) bt
11605 #0 f () at t.c:2
11606 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11607 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11608 @end smallexample
11609
11610 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11611 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11612
11613 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11614 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11615 @set ARROW @click{}
11616 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11617 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11618 @end ifset
11619 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11620 @set ARROW ->
11621 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11622 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11623 @end ifclear
11624
11625 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11626 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11627 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11628
11629 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11630 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11631 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11632 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11633 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11634 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11635
11636 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11637 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11638 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11639 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11640 omitted.
11641
11642 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11643 entry may fail:
11644
11645 @smallexample
11646 int v;
11647 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11648 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11649 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11650 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11651 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11652 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11653
11654 (gdb) bt
11655 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11656 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11657 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11658 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11659 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11660 @end smallexample
11661
11662 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11663 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11664 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11665 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11666 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11667
11668 @node Macros
11669 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11670
11671 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11672 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11673 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11674 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11675 where it was defined.
11676
11677 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11678 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11679 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11680 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11681
11682 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11683 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11684 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11685 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11686 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11687 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11688 see @ref{List}.
11689
11690 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11691 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11692 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11693
11694 @table @code
11695
11696 @kindex macro expand
11697 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11698 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11699 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11700 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11701 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11702 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11703 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11704 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11705 it can be any string of tokens.
11706
11707 @kindex macro exp1
11708 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11709 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11710 @cindex expand macro once
11711 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11712 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11713 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11714 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11715 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11716 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11717 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11718 can be any string of tokens.
11719
11720 @kindex info macro
11721 @cindex macro definition, showing
11722 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11723 @cindex macros, from debug info
11724 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11725 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11726 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11727 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11728 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11729 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11730
11731 @kindex info macros
11732 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11733 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11734 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11735 command-line where those definitions were established.
11736
11737 @kindex macro define
11738 @cindex user-defined macros
11739 @cindex defining macros interactively
11740 @cindex macros, user-defined
11741 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11742 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11743 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11744 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11745 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11746 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11747 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11748 @var{arglist}.
11749
11750 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11751 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11752 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11753 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11754 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11755
11756 @kindex macro undef
11757 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11758 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11759 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11760 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11761 in the program being debugged.
11762
11763 @kindex macro list
11764 @item macro list
11765 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11766 @end table
11767
11768 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11769 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11770 show our source files:
11771
11772 @smallexample
11773 $ cat sample.c
11774 #include <stdio.h>
11775 #include "sample.h"
11776
11777 #define M 42
11778 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11779
11780 main ()
11781 @{
11782 #define N 28
11783 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11784 #undef N
11785 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11786 #define N 1729
11787 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11788 @}
11789 $ cat sample.h
11790 #define Q <
11791 $
11792 @end smallexample
11793
11794 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11795 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11796 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11797 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11798 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11799 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11800 information.
11801
11802 @smallexample
11803 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11804 $
11805 @end smallexample
11806
11807 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11808
11809 @smallexample
11810 $ gdb -nw sample
11811 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11812 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11813 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11814 (@value{GDBP})
11815 @end smallexample
11816
11817 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11818 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11819 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11820
11821 @smallexample
11822 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11823 3
11824 4 #define M 42
11825 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11826 6
11827 7 main ()
11828 8 @{
11829 9 #define N 28
11830 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11831 11 #undef N
11832 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11833 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11834 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11835 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11836 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11837 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11838 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11839 #define Q <
11840 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11841 expands to: (42 + 1)
11842 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11843 expands to: once (M + 1)
11844 (@value{GDBP})
11845 @end smallexample
11846
11847 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11848 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11849 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11850 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11851
11852 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11853 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11854
11855 @smallexample
11856 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11857 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11858 (@value{GDBP}) run
11859 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11860
11861 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11862 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11863 (@value{GDBP})
11864 @end smallexample
11865
11866 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11867
11868 @smallexample
11869 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11870 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11871 #define N 28
11872 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11873 expands to: 28 < 42
11874 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11875 $1 = 1
11876 (@value{GDBP})
11877 @end smallexample
11878
11879 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11880 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11881 thereof) in force at each point:
11882
11883 @smallexample
11884 (@value{GDBP}) next
11885 Hello, world!
11886 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11887 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11888 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11889 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11890 (@value{GDBP}) next
11891 We're so creative.
11892 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11893 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11894 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11895 #define N 1729
11896 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11897 expands to: 1729 < 42
11898 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11899 $2 = 0
11900 (@value{GDBP})
11901 @end smallexample
11902
11903 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11904 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11905 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11906 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11907
11908 @smallexample
11909 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11910 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11911 -D__STDC__=1
11912 (@value{GDBP})
11913 @end smallexample
11914
11915
11916 @node Tracepoints
11917 @chapter Tracepoints
11918 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11919 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11920
11921 @cindex tracepoints
11922 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11923 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11924 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11925 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11926 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11927 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11928 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11929
11930 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11931 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11932 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11933 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11934 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11935 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11936 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11937 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11938 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11939 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11940 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11941
11942 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11943 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11944 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11945 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11946 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11947 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11948 Packets}.
11949
11950 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11951 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11952 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11953
11954 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11955
11956 @menu
11957 * Set Tracepoints::
11958 * Analyze Collected Data::
11959 * Tracepoint Variables::
11960 * Trace Files::
11961 @end menu
11962
11963 @node Set Tracepoints
11964 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11965
11966 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11967 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11968 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11969 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11970 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11971 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11972 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11973
11974 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11975 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11976 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11977 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11978 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11979 tracepoint was hit.
11980
11981 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11982 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11983 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11984 either.
11985
11986 @cindex fast tracepoints
11987 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11988 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11989 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11990
11991 @cindex static tracepoints
11992 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11993 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11994 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11995 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11996 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11997 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11998 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11999 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12000 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12001 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12002 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12003 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12004 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12005 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12006 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12007 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12008 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12009 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12010 static tracepoint marker.
12011
12012 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12013 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12014
12015 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12016 conditions and actions.
12017
12018 @menu
12019 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12020 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12021 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12022 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12023 * Trace State Variables::
12024 * Tracepoint Actions::
12025 * Listing Tracepoints::
12026 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12027 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12028 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12029 @end menu
12030
12031 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12032 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12033
12034 @table @code
12035 @cindex set tracepoint
12036 @kindex trace
12037 @item trace @var{location}
12038 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12039 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
12040 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
12041 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
12042 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
12043 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
12044 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12045 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12046 in tracing}).
12047 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12048 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12049 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12050 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12051 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12052 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12053 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12054 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12055 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12056 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12057 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12058 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12059
12060 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12061
12062 @smallexample
12063 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12064
12065 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12066
12067 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12068
12069 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12070
12071 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12072 @end smallexample
12073
12074 @noindent
12075 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12076
12077 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12078 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12079 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12080 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12081 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12082 information on tracepoint conditions.
12083
12084 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12085 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12086 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12087 @kindex ftrace
12088 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12089 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12090 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12091 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12092 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12093 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12094 message.
12095
12096 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12097 @code{trace}.
12098
12099 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12100 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12101 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12102 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12103 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12104 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12105 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12106 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12107
12108 @example
12109 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12110 @end example
12111
12112 @noindent
12113 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12114 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12115
12116 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12117 @cindex set static tracepoint
12118 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12119 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12120 @kindex strace
12121 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12122 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12123 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12124 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12125 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12126
12127 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12128 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12129 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12130 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12131 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12132 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12133 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12134 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12135 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12136 tracing engine:
12137
12138 @smallexample
12139 main ()
12140 @{
12141 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12142 @}
12143 @end smallexample
12144
12145 @noindent
12146 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12147 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12148
12149 @smallexample
12150 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12151 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12152 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12153 Data: "str %s"
12154 [etc...]
12155 @end smallexample
12156
12157 @noindent
12158 so you may probe the marker above with:
12159
12160 @smallexample
12161 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12162 @end smallexample
12163
12164 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12165 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12166 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12167 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12168 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12169 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12170 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12171 the @samp{Data:} field.
12172
12173 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12174 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12175 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12176
12177 @vindex $tpnum
12178 @cindex last tracepoint number
12179 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12180 @cindex tracepoint number
12181 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12182 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12183
12184 @kindex delete tracepoint
12185 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12186 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12187 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12188 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12189 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12190
12191 Examples:
12192
12193 @smallexample
12194 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12195
12196 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12197 @end smallexample
12198
12199 @noindent
12200 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12201 @end table
12202
12203 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12204 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12205
12206 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12207
12208 @table @code
12209 @kindex disable tracepoint
12210 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12211 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12212 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12213 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12214 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12215 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12216 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12217 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12218 next trace experiment.
12219
12220 @kindex enable tracepoint
12221 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12222 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12223 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12224 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12225 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12226 next time a trace experiment is run.
12227 @end table
12228
12229 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12230 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12231
12232 @table @code
12233 @kindex passcount
12234 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12235 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12236 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12237 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12238 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12239 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12240 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12241 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12242 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12243 user.
12244
12245 Examples:
12246
12247 @smallexample
12248 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12249 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12250
12251 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12252 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12253 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12254 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12255 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12256 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12257 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12258 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12259 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12260 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12261 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12262 @end smallexample
12263 @end table
12264
12265 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12266 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12267 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12268 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12269
12270 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12271 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12272 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12273 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12274 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12275 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12276 is true.
12277
12278 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12279 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12280 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12281 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12282 just as with breakpoints.
12283
12284 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12285 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12286 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12287 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12288 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12289 accesses, and so forth.
12290
12291 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12292 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12293 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12294 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12295 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12296 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12297 search through.
12298
12299 @smallexample
12300 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12301 @end smallexample
12302
12303 @node Trace State Variables
12304 @subsection Trace State Variables
12305 @cindex trace state variables
12306
12307 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12308 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12309 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12310 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12311 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12312 integers.
12313
12314 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12315 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12316 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12317 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12318
12319 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12320 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12321 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12322 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12323 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12324 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12325 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12326 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12327 variable with the same name.
12328
12329 @table @code
12330
12331 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12332 @kindex tvariable
12333 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12334 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12335 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12336 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12337 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12338 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12339 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12340 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12341 value. The default initial value is 0.
12342
12343 @item info tvariables
12344 @kindex info tvariables
12345 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12346 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12347 currently running.
12348
12349 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12350 @kindex delete tvariable
12351 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12352 are specified.
12353
12354 @end table
12355
12356 @node Tracepoint Actions
12357 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12358
12359 @table @code
12360 @kindex actions
12361 @cindex tracepoint actions
12362 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12363 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12364 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12365 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12366 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12367 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12368 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12369 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12370 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12371 @code{while-stepping}.
12372
12373 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12374 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12375 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12376
12377 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12378 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12379 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12380
12381 @smallexample
12382 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12383
12384 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12385
12386 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12387 @end smallexample
12388
12389 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12390 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12391 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12392 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12393 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12394 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12395 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12396 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12397
12398 @smallexample
12399 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12400 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12401 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12402 > collect bar,baz
12403 > collect $regs
12404 > while-stepping 12
12405 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12406 > end
12407 end
12408 @end smallexample
12409
12410 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12411 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12412 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12413 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12414 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12415 special arguments are supported:
12416
12417 @table @code
12418 @item $regs
12419 Collect all registers.
12420
12421 @item $args
12422 Collect all function arguments.
12423
12424 @item $locals
12425 Collect all local variables.
12426
12427 @item $_ret
12428 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12429 of a backtrace.
12430
12431 @item $_probe_argc
12432 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12433 tracepoint is located.
12434 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12435
12436 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12437 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12438 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12439 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12440
12441 @item $_sdata
12442 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12443 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12444 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12445 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12446 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12447 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12448 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12449 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12450 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12451
12452 @smallexample
12453 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12454 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12455 @end smallexample
12456
12457 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12458 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12459 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12460 @value{GDBN}.
12461 @end table
12462
12463 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12464 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12465 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12466
12467 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12468 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12469 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12470 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12471 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12472 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12473 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12474 @samp{mystr}.
12475
12476 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12477 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12478
12479 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12480 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12481 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12482 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12483 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12484 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12485 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12486 action were used.
12487
12488 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12489 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12490 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12491 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12492 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12493 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12494
12495 @smallexample
12496 > while-stepping 12
12497 > collect $regs, myglobal
12498 > end
12499 >
12500 @end smallexample
12501
12502 @noindent
12503 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12504 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12505 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12506 @code{stepping}.
12507
12508 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12509 @kindex set default-collect
12510 @cindex default collection action
12511 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12512 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12513 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12514 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12515 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12516 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12517
12518 @item show default-collect
12519 @kindex show default-collect
12520 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12521 tracepoint hit.
12522
12523 @end table
12524
12525 @node Listing Tracepoints
12526 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12527
12528 @table @code
12529 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12530 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12531 @cindex information about tracepoints
12532 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12533 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12534 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12535 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12536 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12537 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12538
12539 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12540 tracing:
12541
12542 @itemize @bullet
12543 @item
12544 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12545
12546 @item
12547 the state about installed on target of each location
12548 @end itemize
12549
12550 @smallexample
12551 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12552 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12553 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12554 while-stepping 20
12555 collect globfoo, $regs
12556 end
12557 collect globfoo2
12558 end
12559 pass count 1200
12560 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12561 collect $eip
12562 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12563 installed on target
12564 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12565 installed on target
12566 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12567 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12568 not installed on target
12569 (@value{GDBP})
12570 @end smallexample
12571
12572 @noindent
12573 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12574 @end table
12575
12576 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12577 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12578
12579 @table @code
12580 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12581 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12582 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12583 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12584 program.
12585
12586 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12587
12588 @table @emph
12589 @item Count
12590 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12591 stable identifier.
12592 @item ID
12593 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12594 @item Enabled or Disabled
12595 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12596 that are not enabled.
12597 @item Address
12598 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12599 @item What
12600 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12601 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12602 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12603 will be left blank.
12604 @end table
12605
12606 @noindent
12607 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12608
12609 @table @emph
12610 @item Data
12611 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12612 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12613 marker call.
12614 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12615 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12616 @end table
12617
12618 @smallexample
12619 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12620 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12621 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12622 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12623 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12624 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12625 Data: str %s
12626 (@value{GDBP})
12627 @end smallexample
12628 @end table
12629
12630 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12631 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12632
12633 @table @code
12634 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12635 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12636 @cindex collected data discarded
12637 @item tstart
12638 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12639 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12640 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12641 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12642 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12643 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12644 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12645 information, and so forth.
12646
12647 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12648 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12649 @item tstop
12650 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12651 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12652 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12653 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12654 needs to be stopped quickly.
12655
12656 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12657 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12658 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12659
12660 @kindex tstatus
12661 @cindex status of trace data collection
12662 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12663 @item tstatus
12664 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12665 collection.
12666 @end table
12667
12668 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12669
12670 @smallexample
12671 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12673 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12674 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12675 > while-stepping 11
12676 > collect $regs
12677 > end
12678 > end
12679 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12680 [time passes @dots{}]
12681 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12682 @end smallexample
12683
12684 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12685 @cindex disconnected tracing
12686 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12687 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12688 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12689 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12690 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12691 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12692 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12693 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12694
12695 @table @code
12696 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12697 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12698 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12699 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12700 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12701 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12702 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12703 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12704
12705 @item show disconnected-tracing
12706 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12707 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12708
12709 @end table
12710
12711 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12712 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12713 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12714 it will continue after reconnection.
12715
12716 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12717 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12718 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12719 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12720 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12721 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12722 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12723 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12724 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12725 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12726
12727 @cindex circular trace buffer
12728 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12729 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12730 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12731 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12732 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12733 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12734 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12735 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12736 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12737 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12738 the next run.
12739
12740 @table @code
12741 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12742 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12743 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12744 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12745 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12746 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12747 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12748
12749 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12750 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12751 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12752 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12753 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12754 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12755
12756 @end table
12757
12758 @table @code
12759 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12760 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12761 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12762 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12763 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12764 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12765 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12766 likes. This is also the default.
12767
12768 @item show trace-buffer-size
12769 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12770 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12771 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12772 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12773 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12774 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12775 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12776 @end table
12777
12778 @table @code
12779 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12780 @kindex set trace-user
12781
12782 @item show trace-user
12783 @kindex show trace-user
12784
12785 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12786 @kindex set trace-notes
12787 Set the trace run's notes.
12788
12789 @item show trace-notes
12790 @kindex show trace-notes
12791 Show the trace run's notes.
12792
12793 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12794 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12795 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12796 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12797 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12798
12799 @item show trace-stop-notes
12800 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12801 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12802
12803 @end table
12804
12805 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12806 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12807
12808 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12809 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12810 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12811 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12812 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12813 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12814 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12815 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12816 mentioned here.
12817
12818 @itemize @bullet
12819
12820 @item
12821 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12822 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12823 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12824 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12825 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12826 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12827 cannot be collected either.
12828
12829 @item
12830 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12831 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12832 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12833 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12834 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12835 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12836 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12837 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12838 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12839 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12840
12841 @item
12842 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12843 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12844 in a misleading way.
12845
12846 @item
12847 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12848 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12849 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12850 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12851 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12852 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12853 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12854 by @code{ptr}.
12855
12856 @item
12857 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12858 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12859 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12860 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12861 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12862 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12863 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12864 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12865 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12866 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12867 invalid address.
12868
12869 @item
12870 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12871 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12872 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12873 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12874 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12875 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12876 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12877 it to zero.
12878
12879 @end itemize
12880
12881 @node Analyze Collected Data
12882 @section Using the Collected Data
12883
12884 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12885 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12886 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12887 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12888 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12889 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12890 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12891 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12892 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12893 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12894 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12895 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12896 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12897 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12898 the buffer will fail.
12899
12900 @menu
12901 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12902 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12903 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12904 @end menu
12905
12906 @node tfind
12907 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12908
12909 @kindex tfind
12910 @cindex select trace snapshot
12911 @cindex find trace snapshot
12912 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12913 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12914 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12915 snapshot is selected.
12916
12917 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12918
12919 @table @code
12920 @item tfind start
12921 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12922 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12923
12924 @item tfind none
12925 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12926
12927 @item tfind end
12928 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12929
12930 @item tfind
12931 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12932
12933 @item tfind -
12934 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12935 retracing earlier steps.
12936
12937 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12938 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12939 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12940 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12941 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12942
12943 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12944 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12945 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12946 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12947 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12948
12949 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12950 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12951 addresses (exclusive).
12952
12953 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12954 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12955 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12956
12957 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12958 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12959 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12960 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12961 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12962 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12963 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12964 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12965 @end table
12966
12967 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12968 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12969 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12970 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12971 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12972 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12973 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12974 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12975 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12976 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12977 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12978 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12979 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12980 tracepoint as the current one.
12981
12982 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12983 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12984 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12985 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12986 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12987
12988 @smallexample
12989 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12990 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12991 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12992 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12993 > tfind
12994 > end
12995
12996 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12997 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12998 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12999 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13000 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13001 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13002 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13003 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13004 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13005 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13006 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13007 @end smallexample
13008
13009 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13010 the buffer:
13011
13012 @smallexample
13013 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13014 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13015 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13016 > tfind line
13017 > end
13018
13019 Frame 0, X = 1
13020 Frame 7, X = 2
13021 Frame 13, X = 255
13022 @end smallexample
13023
13024 @node tdump
13025 @subsection @code{tdump}
13026 @kindex tdump
13027 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13028 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13029
13030 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13031 the current trace snapshot.
13032
13033 @smallexample
13034 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13035 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13036 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13037 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13038 > end
13039
13040 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13041
13042 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13043 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13044 at gdb_test.c:444
13045 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13046
13047 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13048 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13049 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13050 d1 0x18 24
13051 d2 0x80 128
13052 d3 0x33 51
13053 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13054 d5 0x22 34
13055 d6 0xe0 224
13056 d7 0x380035 3670069
13057 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13058 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13059 a2 0x100 256
13060 a3 0x322000 3284992
13061 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13062 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13063 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13064 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13065 ps 0x0 0
13066 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13067 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13068 fpstatus 0x0 0
13069 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13070 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13071 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13072 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13073 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13074 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13075 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13076 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13077 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13078
13079 (@value{GDBP})
13080 @end smallexample
13081
13082 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13083 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13084 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13085 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13086
13087 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13088 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13089 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13090 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13091 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13092 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13093 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13094 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13095 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13096 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13097
13098 @node save tracepoints
13099 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13100 @kindex save tracepoints
13101 @kindex save-tracepoints
13102 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13103
13104 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13105 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13106 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13107 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13108 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13109 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13110
13111 @node Tracepoint Variables
13112 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13113 @cindex tracepoint variables
13114 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13115
13116 @table @code
13117 @vindex $trace_frame
13118 @item (int) $trace_frame
13119 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13120 snapshot is selected.
13121
13122 @vindex $tracepoint
13123 @item (int) $tracepoint
13124 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13125
13126 @vindex $trace_line
13127 @item (int) $trace_line
13128 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13129
13130 @vindex $trace_file
13131 @item (char []) $trace_file
13132 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13133
13134 @vindex $trace_func
13135 @item (char []) $trace_func
13136 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13137 @end table
13138
13139 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13140 use @code{output} instead.
13141
13142 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13143 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13144 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13145 which are managed by the target.
13146
13147 @smallexample
13148 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13149
13150 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13151 > output $trace_file
13152 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13153 > tfind
13154 > end
13155 @end smallexample
13156
13157 @node Trace Files
13158 @section Using Trace Files
13159 @cindex trace files
13160
13161 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13162 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13163 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13164 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13165 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13166
13167 @table @code
13168
13169 @kindex tsave
13170 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13171 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13172 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13173 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13174 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13175 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13176 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13177 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13178 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13179 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13180 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13181 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13182 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13183 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13184 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13185
13186 @kindex target tfile
13187 @kindex tfile
13188 @kindex target ctf
13189 @kindex ctf
13190 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13191 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13192 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13193 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13194 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13195 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13196 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13197 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13198 the host.
13199
13200 @smallexample
13201 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13202 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13203 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13204 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13205 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13206 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13207 i = 0
13208 a = 0
13209 b = 1 '\001'
13210 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13211 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13212 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13213 $1 = 1
13214 @end smallexample
13215
13216 @end table
13217
13218 @node Overlays
13219 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13220 @cindex overlays
13221
13222 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13223 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13224 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13225 use overlays.
13226
13227 @menu
13228 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13229 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13230 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13231 mapped by asking the inferior.
13232 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13233 @end menu
13234
13235 @node How Overlays Work
13236 @section How Overlays Work
13237 @cindex mapped overlays
13238 @cindex unmapped overlays
13239 @cindex load address, overlay's
13240 @cindex mapped address
13241 @cindex overlay area
13242
13243 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13244 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13245 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13246 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13247 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13248
13249 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13250 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13251 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13252 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13253 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13254 largest overlay as well.
13255
13256 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13257 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13258 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13259 there.
13260
13261 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13262 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13263 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13264
13265 @smallexample
13266 @group
13267 Data Instruction Larger
13268 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13269 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13270 | | | | | |
13271 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13272 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13273 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13274 | and heap | | | | | |
13275 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13276 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13277 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13278 | | | | | |
13279 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13280 address | | | | | |
13281 | overlay | <-' | | |
13282 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13283 | | <---. | | load address
13284 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13285 | | | |
13286 +-----------+ | |
13287 +-----------+
13288 | |
13289 +-----------+
13290
13291 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13292 @end group
13293 @end smallexample
13294
13295 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13296 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13297 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13298 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13299 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13300 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13301 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13302 program and the overlay area.
13303
13304 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13305 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13306 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13307 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13308 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13309 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13310 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13311
13312 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13313 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13314 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13315
13316 @itemize @bullet
13317
13318 @item
13319 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13320 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13321 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13322 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13323
13324 @item
13325 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13326 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13327 your program's performance.
13328
13329 @item
13330 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13331 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13332 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13333 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13334 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13335 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13336 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13337
13338 @item
13339 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13340 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13341 instruction and data spaces.
13342
13343 @end itemize
13344
13345 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13346 improved in many ways:
13347
13348 @itemize @bullet
13349
13350 @item
13351 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13352 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13353 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13354 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13355 area in the usual way.
13356
13357 @item
13358 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13359 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13360
13361 @item
13362 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13363 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13364 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13365 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13366 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13367 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13368 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13369
13370 @end itemize
13371
13372
13373 @node Overlay Commands
13374 @section Overlay Commands
13375
13376 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13377 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13378 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13379 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13380 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13381 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13382
13383 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13384 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13385
13386 @table @code
13387 @item overlay off
13388 @kindex overlay
13389 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13390 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13391 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13392 overlay support is disabled.
13393
13394 @item overlay manual
13395 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13396 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13397 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13398 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13399 commands described below.
13400
13401 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13402 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13403 @cindex map an overlay
13404 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13405 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13406 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13407 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13408 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13409 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13410
13411 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13412 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13413 @cindex unmap an overlay
13414 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13415 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13416 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13417 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13418
13419 @item overlay auto
13420 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13421 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13422 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13423 Overlay Debugging}.
13424
13425 @item overlay load-target
13426 @itemx overlay load
13427 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13428 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13429 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13430 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13431 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13432 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13433
13434 @item overlay list-overlays
13435 @itemx overlay list
13436 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13437 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13438 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13439
13440 @end table
13441
13442 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13443 of the function the address falls in:
13444
13445 @smallexample
13446 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13447 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13448 @end smallexample
13449 @noindent
13450 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13451 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13452 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13453 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13454
13455 @smallexample
13456 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13457 No sections are mapped.
13458 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13459 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13460 @end smallexample
13461 @noindent
13462 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13463 name normally:
13464
13465 @smallexample
13466 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13467 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13468 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13469 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13470 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13471 @end smallexample
13472
13473 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13474 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13475 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13476 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13477 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13478
13479 @itemize @bullet
13480 @item
13481 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13482 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13483 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13484 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13485 @item
13486 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13487 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13488 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13489 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13490 breakpoints properly.
13491 @end itemize
13492
13493
13494 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13495 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13496 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13497
13498 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13499 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13500 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13501 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13502 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13503 current state of the overlays.
13504
13505 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13506 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13507
13508 @table @asis
13509
13510 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13511 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13512
13513 @smallexample
13514 struct
13515 @{
13516 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13517 unsigned long vma;
13518
13519 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13520 unsigned long size;
13521
13522 /* The overlay's load address. */
13523 unsigned long lma;
13524
13525 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13526 zero otherwise. */
13527 unsigned long mapped;
13528 @}
13529 @end smallexample
13530
13531 @item @code{_novlys}:
13532 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13533 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13534
13535 @end table
13536
13537 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13538 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13539 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13540 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13541 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13542 currently mapped.
13543
13544 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13545 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13546 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13547 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13548 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13549 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13550 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13551 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13552 are not being executed.
13553
13554 @node Overlay Sample Program
13555 @section Overlay Sample Program
13556 @cindex overlay example program
13557
13558 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13559 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13560 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13561 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13562 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13563 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13564 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13565
13566 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13567 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13568 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13569 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13570
13571 @table @file
13572 @item overlays.c
13573 The main program file.
13574 @item ovlymgr.c
13575 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13576 @item foo.c
13577 @itemx bar.c
13578 @itemx baz.c
13579 @itemx grbx.c
13580 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13581 @item d10v.ld
13582 @itemx m32r.ld
13583 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13584 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13585 @end table
13586
13587 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13588 cross-compiler like this:
13589
13590 @smallexample
13591 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13592 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13593 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13594 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13595 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13596 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13597 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13598 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13599 @end smallexample
13600
13601 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13602 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13603 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13604
13605
13606 @node Languages
13607 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13608 @cindex languages
13609
13610 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13611 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13612 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13613 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13614 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13615 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13616
13617 @cindex working language
13618 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13619 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13620 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13621 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13622 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13623 language}.
13624
13625 @menu
13626 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13627 * Show:: Displaying the language
13628 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13629 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13630 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13631 @end menu
13632
13633 @node Setting
13634 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13635
13636 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13637 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13638 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13639 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13640 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13641 are printed, etc.
13642
13643 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13644 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13645 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13646 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13647 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13648 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13649 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13650 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13651 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13652 Displaying the Language}.
13653
13654 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13655 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13656 another language. In that case, make the
13657 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13658 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13659 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13660
13661 @menu
13662 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13663 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13664 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13665 @end menu
13666
13667 @node Filenames
13668 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13669
13670 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13671 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13672
13673 @table @file
13674 @item .ada
13675 @itemx .ads
13676 @itemx .adb
13677 @itemx .a
13678 Ada source file.
13679
13680 @item .c
13681 C source file
13682
13683 @item .C
13684 @itemx .cc
13685 @itemx .cp
13686 @itemx .cpp
13687 @itemx .cxx
13688 @itemx .c++
13689 C@t{++} source file
13690
13691 @item .d
13692 D source file
13693
13694 @item .m
13695 Objective-C source file
13696
13697 @item .f
13698 @itemx .F
13699 Fortran source file
13700
13701 @item .mod
13702 Modula-2 source file
13703
13704 @item .s
13705 @itemx .S
13706 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13707 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13708 @end table
13709
13710 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13711 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13712
13713 @node Manually
13714 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13715
13716 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13717 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13718 your program.
13719
13720 @kindex set language
13721 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13722 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13723 a language, such as
13724 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13725 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13726
13727 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13728 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13729 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13730 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13731 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13732 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13733 command such as:
13734
13735 @smallexample
13736 print a = b + c
13737 @end smallexample
13738
13739 @noindent
13740 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13741 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13742 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13743 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13744
13745 @node Automatically
13746 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13747
13748 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13749 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13750 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13751 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13752 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13753 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13754 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13755 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13756 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13757
13758 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13759 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13760 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13761 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13762 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13763
13764 @node Show
13765 @section Displaying the Language
13766
13767 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13768 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13769
13770 @table @code
13771 @item show language
13772 @anchor{show language}
13773 @kindex show language
13774 Display the current working language. This is the
13775 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13776 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13777
13778 @item info frame
13779 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13780 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13781 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13782 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13783 information listed here.
13784
13785 @item info source
13786 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13787 Display the source language of this source file.
13788 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13789 information listed here.
13790 @end table
13791
13792 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13793 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13794 with a language explicitly:
13795
13796 @table @code
13797 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13798 @kindex set extension-language
13799 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13800 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13801
13802 @item info extensions
13803 @kindex info extensions
13804 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13805 @end table
13806
13807 @node Checks
13808 @section Type and Range Checking
13809
13810 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13811 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13812 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13813 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13814 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13815 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13816 errors when your program is running.
13817
13818 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13819 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13820 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13821 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13822
13823 @menu
13824 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13825 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13826 @end menu
13827
13828 @cindex type checking
13829 @cindex checks, type
13830 @node Type Checking
13831 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13832
13833 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13834 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13835 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13836 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13837
13838 @smallexample
13839 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13840
13841 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13842 $1 = 2
13843 @exdent but
13844 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13845 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13846 @end smallexample
13847
13848 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13849 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13850
13851 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13852 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13853 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13854 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13855 expressions like the second example above.
13856
13857 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13858 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13859 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13860 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13861 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13862 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13863
13864 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13865
13866 @kindex set check type
13867 @kindex show check type
13868 @table @code
13869 @item set check type on
13870 @itemx set check type off
13871 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13872 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13873 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13874
13875 @item show check type
13876 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13877 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13878 @end table
13879
13880 @cindex range checking
13881 @cindex checks, range
13882 @node Range Checking
13883 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13884
13885 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13886 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13887 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13888 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13889 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13890
13891 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13892 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13893 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13894 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13895
13896 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13897 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13898 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13899 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13900 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13901 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13902
13903 @smallexample
13904 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13905 @end smallexample
13906
13907 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13908 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13909 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13910
13911 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13912
13913 @kindex set check range
13914 @kindex show check range
13915 @table @code
13916 @item set check range auto
13917 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13918 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13919 each language.
13920
13921 @item set check range on
13922 @itemx set check range off
13923 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13924 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13925 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13926 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13927
13928 @item set check range warn
13929 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13930 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13931 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13932 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13933 systems).
13934
13935 @item show range
13936 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13937 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13938 @end table
13939
13940 @node Supported Languages
13941 @section Supported Languages
13942
13943 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13944 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13945 @c This is false ...
13946 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13947 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13948 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13949 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13950 language.
13951
13952 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13953 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13954 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13955 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13956 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13957 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13958 language reference or tutorial.
13959
13960 @menu
13961 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13962 * D:: D
13963 * Go:: Go
13964 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13965 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13966 * Fortran:: Fortran
13967 * Pascal:: Pascal
13968 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13969 * Ada:: Ada
13970 @end menu
13971
13972 @node C
13973 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13974
13975 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13976 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13977
13978 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13979 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13980 together.
13981
13982 @cindex C@t{++}
13983 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13984 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13985 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13986 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13987 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13988 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13989 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13990
13991 @menu
13992 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13993 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13994 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13995 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13996 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13997 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13998 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13999 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14000 @end menu
14001
14002 @node C Operators
14003 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14004
14005 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14006
14007 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14008 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14009 often defined on groups of types.
14010
14011 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14012
14013 @itemize @bullet
14014
14015 @item
14016 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14017 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14018
14019 @item
14020 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14021 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14022
14023 @item
14024 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14025
14026 @item
14027 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14028
14029 @end itemize
14030
14031 @noindent
14032 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14033 in order of increasing precedence:
14034
14035 @table @code
14036 @item ,
14037 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14038 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14039 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14040
14041 @item =
14042 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14043 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14044
14045 @item @var{op}=
14046 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14047 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14048 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14049 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14050 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14051
14052 @item ?:
14053 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14054 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14055 should be of an integral type.
14056
14057 @item ||
14058 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14059
14060 @item &&
14061 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14062
14063 @item |
14064 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14065
14066 @item ^
14067 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14068
14069 @item &
14070 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14071
14072 @item ==@r{, }!=
14073 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14074 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14075
14076 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14077 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14078 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14079 and non-zero for true.
14080
14081 @item <<@r{, }>>
14082 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14083
14084 @item @@
14085 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14086
14087 @item +@r{, }-
14088 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14089 pointer types.
14090
14091 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14092 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14093 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14094 integral types.
14095
14096 @item ++@r{, }--
14097 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14098 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14099 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14100 operation takes place.
14101
14102 @item *
14103 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14104 @code{++}.
14105
14106 @item &
14107 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14108
14109 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14110 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14111 to examine the address
14112 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14113 stored.
14114
14115 @item -
14116 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14117 precedence as @code{++}.
14118
14119 @item !
14120 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14121 @code{++}.
14122
14123 @item ~
14124 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14125 @code{++}.
14126
14127
14128 @item .@r{, }->
14129 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14130 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14131 pointer based on the stored type information.
14132 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14133
14134 @item .*@r{, }->*
14135 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14136
14137 @item []
14138 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14139 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14140
14141 @item ()
14142 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14143
14144 @item ::
14145 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14146 and @code{class} types.
14147
14148 @item ::
14149 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14150 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14151 above.
14152 @end table
14153
14154 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14155 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14156 predefined meaning.
14157
14158 @node C Constants
14159 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14160
14161 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14162
14163 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14164 following ways:
14165
14166 @itemize @bullet
14167 @item
14168 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14169 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14170 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14171 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14172 @code{long} value.
14173
14174 @item
14175 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14176 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14177 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14178 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14179 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14180 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14181 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14182 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14183 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14184 constant.
14185
14186 @item
14187 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14188 integral equivalents.
14189
14190 @item
14191 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14192 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14193 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14194 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14195 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14196 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14197 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14198 @samp{\n} for newline.
14199
14200 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14201 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14202 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14203 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14204
14205 @item
14206 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14207 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14208 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14209 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14210 characters.
14211
14212 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14213 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14214 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14215
14216 @item
14217 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14218 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14219
14220 @item
14221 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14222 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14223 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14224 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14225 @end itemize
14226
14227 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14228 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14229
14230 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14231 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14232
14233 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14234 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14235 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14236 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14237 @quotation
14238 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14239 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14240 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14241 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14242 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14243 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14244 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14245 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14246 @end quotation
14247
14248 @enumerate
14249
14250 @cindex member functions
14251 @item
14252 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14253
14254 @smallexample
14255 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14256 @end smallexample
14257
14258 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14259 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14260 @item
14261 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14262 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14263 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14264 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14265 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14266
14267 @cindex call overloaded functions
14268 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14269 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14270 @item
14271 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14272 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14273 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14274 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14275 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14276 default arguments.
14277
14278 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14279 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14280 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14281 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14282 number of function arguments.
14283
14284 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14285 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14286 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14287
14288 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14289 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14290 @smallexample
14291 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14292 @end smallexample
14293
14294 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14295 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14296
14297 @cindex reference declarations
14298 @item
14299 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14300 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14301 dereferenced.
14302
14303 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14304 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14305 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14306 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14307 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14308
14309 @item
14310 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14311 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14312 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14313 necessary, for example in an expression like
14314 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14315 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14316 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14317
14318 @item
14319 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14320 specification.
14321 @end enumerate
14322
14323 @node C Defaults
14324 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14325
14326 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14327
14328 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14329 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14330 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14331 selects the working language.
14332
14333 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14334 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14335 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14336 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14337 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14338 for further details.
14339
14340 @node C Checks
14341 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14342
14343 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14344
14345 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14346 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14347 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14348 constants to pointers.
14349
14350 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14351 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14352 that is not itself an array.
14353
14354 @node Debugging C
14355 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14356
14357 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14358 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14359 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14360 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14361
14362 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14363 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14364 ,Expressions}.
14365
14366 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14367 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14368
14369 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14370
14371 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14372 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14373
14374 @table @code
14375 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14376 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14377 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14378 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14379 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14380 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14381
14382 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14383 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14384 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14385 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14386 classes.
14387 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14388
14389 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14390 @item catch throw
14391 @itemx catch rethrow
14392 @itemx catch catch
14393 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14394 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14395
14396 @cindex inheritance
14397 @item ptype @var{typename}
14398 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14399 @var{typename}.
14400 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14401
14402 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14403 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14404 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14405 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14406 multiple inheritance is in use.
14407
14408 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14409 @item demangle @var{name}
14410 Demangle @var{name}.
14411 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14412
14413 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14414 @item set print demangle
14415 @itemx show print demangle
14416 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14417 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14418 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14419 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14420 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14421
14422 @item set print object
14423 @itemx show print object
14424 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14425 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14426
14427 @item set print vtbl
14428 @itemx show print vtbl
14429 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14430 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14431 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14432 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14433
14434 @kindex set overload-resolution
14435 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14436 @item set overload-resolution on
14437 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14438 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14439 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14440 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14441 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14442 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14443
14444 @item set overload-resolution off
14445 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14446 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14447 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14448 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14449 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14450 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14451 argument types.
14452
14453 @kindex show overload-resolution
14454 @item show overload-resolution
14455 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14456
14457 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14458 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14459 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14460 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14461 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14462 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14463 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14464 @end table
14465
14466 @node Decimal Floating Point
14467 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14468 @cindex decimal floating point format
14469
14470 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14471 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14472 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14473 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14474
14475 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14476 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14477 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14478 configured target.
14479
14480 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14481 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14482 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14483
14484 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14485 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14486 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14487
14488 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14489 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14490 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14491
14492 @node D
14493 @subsection D
14494
14495 @cindex D
14496 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14497 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14498 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14499
14500 @node Go
14501 @subsection Go
14502
14503 @cindex Go (programming language)
14504 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14505 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14506
14507 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14508
14509 @table @code
14510 @cindex current Go package
14511 @item The current Go package
14512 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14513 specifying global variables and functions.
14514
14515 For example, given the program:
14516
14517 @example
14518 package main
14519 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14520 func main () @{
14521 // ...
14522 @}
14523 @end example
14524
14525 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14526
14527 @example
14528 (gdb) p myglob
14529 (gdb) p main.myglob
14530 @end example
14531
14532 @cindex builtin Go types
14533 @item Builtin Go types
14534 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14535 as a string.
14536
14537 @cindex builtin Go functions
14538 @item Builtin Go functions
14539 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14540 function and handles it internally.
14541
14542 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14543 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14544 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14545 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14546 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14547 @end table
14548
14549 @node Objective-C
14550 @subsection Objective-C
14551
14552 @cindex Objective-C
14553 This section provides information about some commands and command
14554 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14555 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14556 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14557
14558 @menu
14559 * Method Names in Commands::
14560 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14561 @end menu
14562
14563 @node Method Names in Commands
14564 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14565
14566 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14567 names as line specifications:
14568
14569 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14570 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14571 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14572 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14573 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14574 @itemize
14575 @item @code{clear}
14576 @item @code{break}
14577 @item @code{info line}
14578 @item @code{jump}
14579 @item @code{list}
14580 @end itemize
14581
14582 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14583
14584 @smallexample
14585 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14586 @end smallexample
14587
14588 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14589 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14590 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14591 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14592 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14593 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14594 debugged, enter:
14595
14596 @smallexample
14597 break -[Fruit create]
14598 @end smallexample
14599
14600 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14601 enter:
14602
14603 @smallexample
14604 list +[NSText initialize]
14605 @end smallexample
14606
14607 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14608 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14609 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14610 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14611
14612 @smallexample
14613 break create
14614 @end smallexample
14615
14616 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14617 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14618 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14619 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14620 none apply.
14621
14622 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14623 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14624
14625 @smallexample
14626 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14627 @end smallexample
14628
14629 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14630 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14631 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14632 @kindex print-object
14633 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14634
14635 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14636
14637 @smallexample
14638 print -[@var{object} hash]
14639 @end smallexample
14640
14641 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14642 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14643 @noindent
14644 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14645 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14646 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14647 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14648 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14649 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14650
14651 @node OpenCL C
14652 @subsection OpenCL C
14653
14654 @cindex OpenCL C
14655 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14656
14657 @menu
14658 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14659 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14660 * OpenCL C Operators::
14661 @end menu
14662
14663 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14664 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14665
14666 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14667 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14668 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14669 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14670 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14671
14672 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14673 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14674
14675 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14676 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14677 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14678 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14679
14680 @node OpenCL C Operators
14681 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14682
14683 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14684 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14685 vector data types.
14686
14687 @node Fortran
14688 @subsection Fortran
14689 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14690
14691 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14692 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14693
14694 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14695 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14696 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14697 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14698 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14699 underscore.
14700
14701 @menu
14702 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14703 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14704 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14705 @end menu
14706
14707 @node Fortran Operators
14708 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14709
14710 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14711
14712 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14713 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14714 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14715
14716 @table @code
14717 @item **
14718 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14719 of the second one.
14720
14721 @item :
14722 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14723 represent a section of array.
14724
14725 @item %
14726 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14727 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14728 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14729 union type.
14730 @end table
14731
14732 @node Fortran Defaults
14733 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14734
14735 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14736
14737 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14738 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14739 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14740 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14741
14742 @node Special Fortran Commands
14743 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14744
14745 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14746
14747 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14748 such as displaying common blocks.
14749
14750 @table @code
14751 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14752 @kindex info common
14753 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14754 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14755 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14756 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14757 printed.
14758 @end table
14759
14760 @node Pascal
14761 @subsection Pascal
14762
14763 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14764 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14765 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14766 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14767 syntax.
14768
14769 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14770 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14771 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14772
14773 @node Modula-2
14774 @subsection Modula-2
14775
14776 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14777
14778 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14779 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14780 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14781 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14782 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14783 table.
14784
14785 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14786 @menu
14787 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14788 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14789 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14790 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14791 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14792 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14793 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14794 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14795 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14796 @end menu
14797
14798 @node M2 Operators
14799 @subsubsection Operators
14800 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14801
14802 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14803 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14804 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14805 following definitions hold:
14806
14807 @itemize @bullet
14808
14809 @item
14810 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14811 their subranges.
14812
14813 @item
14814 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14815
14816 @item
14817 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14818
14819 @item
14820 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14821 @var{type}}.
14822
14823 @item
14824 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14825
14826 @item
14827 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14828
14829 @item
14830 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14831 @end itemize
14832
14833 @noindent
14834 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14835 increasing precedence:
14836
14837 @table @code
14838 @item ,
14839 Function argument or array index separator.
14840
14841 @item :=
14842 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14843 @var{value}.
14844
14845 @item <@r{, }>
14846 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14847 types.
14848
14849 @item <=@r{, }>=
14850 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14851 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14852 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14853
14854 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14855 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14856 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14857 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14858 comment character.
14859
14860 @item IN
14861 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14862 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14863
14864 @item OR
14865 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14866
14867 @item AND@r{, }&
14868 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14869
14870 @item @@
14871 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14872
14873 @item +@r{, }-
14874 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14875 and difference on set types.
14876
14877 @item *
14878 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14879 on set types.
14880
14881 @item /
14882 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14883 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14884
14885 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14886 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14887 precedence as @code{*}.
14888
14889 @item -
14890 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14891
14892 @item ^
14893 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14894
14895 @item NOT
14896 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14897 @code{^}.
14898
14899 @item .
14900 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14901 precedence as @code{^}.
14902
14903 @item []
14904 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14905
14906 @item ()
14907 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14908 as @code{^}.
14909
14910 @item ::@r{, }.
14911 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14912 @end table
14913
14914 @quotation
14915 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14916 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14917 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14918 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14919 @end quotation
14920
14921
14922 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14923 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14924 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14925
14926 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14927 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14928
14929 @table @var
14930
14931 @item a
14932 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14933
14934 @item c
14935 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14936
14937 @item i
14938 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14939
14940 @item m
14941 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14942 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14943 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14944
14945 @item n
14946 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14947
14948 @item r
14949 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14950
14951 @item t
14952 represents a type.
14953
14954 @item v
14955 represents a variable.
14956
14957 @item x
14958 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14959 explanation of the function for details.
14960 @end table
14961
14962 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14963
14964 @table @code
14965 @item ABS(@var{n})
14966 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14967
14968 @item CAP(@var{c})
14969 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14970 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14971
14972 @item CHR(@var{i})
14973 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14974
14975 @item DEC(@var{v})
14976 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14977
14978 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14979 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14980 new value.
14981
14982 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14983 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14984 set.
14985
14986 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14987 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14988
14989 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14990 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14991
14992 @item INC(@var{v})
14993 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14994
14995 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14996 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14997 new value.
14998
14999 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15000 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15001 there. Returns the new set.
15002
15003 @item MAX(@var{t})
15004 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15005
15006 @item MIN(@var{t})
15007 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15008
15009 @item ODD(@var{i})
15010 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15011
15012 @item ORD(@var{x})
15013 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15014 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15015 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15016 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15017
15018 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15019 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15020 variable or a type.
15021
15022 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15023 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15024
15025 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15026 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15027 variable or a type.
15028
15029 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15030 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15031 @end table
15032
15033 @quotation
15034 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15035 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15036 an error.
15037 @end quotation
15038
15039 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15040 @node M2 Constants
15041 @subsubsection Constants
15042
15043 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15044 ways:
15045
15046 @itemize @bullet
15047
15048 @item
15049 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15050 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15051 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15052 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15053
15054 @item
15055 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15056 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15057 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15058 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15059 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15060 digits.
15061
15062 @item
15063 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15064 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15065 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15066 followed by a @samp{C}.
15067
15068 @item
15069 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15070 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15071 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15072 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15073 sequences.
15074
15075 @item
15076 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15077
15078 @item
15079 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15080 @code{FALSE}.
15081
15082 @item
15083 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15084
15085 @item
15086 Set constants are not yet supported.
15087 @end itemize
15088
15089 @node M2 Types
15090 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15091 @cindex Modula-2 types
15092
15093 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15094 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15095 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15096 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15097 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15098 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15099
15100 The first example contains the following section of code:
15101
15102 @smallexample
15103 VAR
15104 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15105 r: [20..40] ;
15106 @end smallexample
15107
15108 @noindent
15109 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15110 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15111
15112 @smallexample
15113 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15114 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15115 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15116 SET OF CHAR
15117 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15118 21
15119 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15120 [20..40]
15121 @end smallexample
15122
15123 @noindent
15124 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15125
15126 @smallexample
15127 VAR
15128 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15129 @end smallexample
15130
15131 @noindent
15132 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15133
15134 @smallexample
15135 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15136 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15137 @end smallexample
15138
15139 @noindent
15140 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15141 expressions using the debugger.
15142
15143 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15144 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15145
15146 @smallexample
15147 VAR
15148 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15149 @end smallexample
15150
15151 @smallexample
15152 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15153 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15154 @end smallexample
15155
15156 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15157 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15158 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15159 above.
15160
15161 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15162
15163 @smallexample
15164 TYPE
15165 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15166 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15167 VAR
15168 s: t ;
15169 BEGIN
15170 s := blue ;
15171 @end smallexample
15172
15173 @noindent
15174 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15175 and value of a variable.
15176
15177 @smallexample
15178 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15179 $1 = blue
15180 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15181 type = [blue..yellow]
15182 @end smallexample
15183
15184 @noindent
15185 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15186 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15187 their @code{C} counterparts.
15188
15189 @smallexample
15190 VAR
15191 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15192 BEGIN
15193 s[1] := 1 ;
15194 @end smallexample
15195
15196 @smallexample
15197 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15198 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15199 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15200 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15201 @end smallexample
15202
15203 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15204 pointer types as shown in this example:
15205
15206 @smallexample
15207 VAR
15208 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15209 BEGIN
15210 NEW(s) ;
15211 s^[1] := 1 ;
15212 @end smallexample
15213
15214 @noindent
15215 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15216
15217 @smallexample
15218 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15219 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15220 @end smallexample
15221
15222 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15223 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15224 types:
15225
15226 @smallexample
15227 TYPE
15228 foo = RECORD
15229 f1: CARDINAL ;
15230 f2: CHAR ;
15231 f3: myarray ;
15232 END ;
15233
15234 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15235 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15236 VAR
15237 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15238 @end smallexample
15239
15240 @noindent
15241 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15242 below.
15243
15244 @smallexample
15245 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15246 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15247 f1 : CARDINAL;
15248 f2 : CHAR;
15249 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15250 END
15251 @end smallexample
15252
15253 @node M2 Defaults
15254 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15255 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15256
15257 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15258 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15259 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15260 selected the working language.
15261
15262 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15263 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15264 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15265 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15266
15267 @node Deviations
15268 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15269 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15270
15271 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15272 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15273
15274 @itemize @bullet
15275 @item
15276 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15277 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15278 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15279 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15280 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15281 returned a pointer.)
15282
15283 @item
15284 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15285 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15286 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15287 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15288
15289 @item
15290 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15291 argument.
15292
15293 @item
15294 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15295 @end itemize
15296
15297 @node M2 Checks
15298 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15299 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15300
15301 @quotation
15302 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15303 range checking.
15304 @end quotation
15305 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15306
15307 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15308
15309 @itemize @bullet
15310 @item
15311 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15312 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15313
15314 @item
15315 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15316 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15317 @end itemize
15318
15319 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15320 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15321
15322 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15323 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15324
15325 @node M2 Scope
15326 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15327 @cindex scope
15328 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15329 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15330 @ifinfo
15331 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15332 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15333 @end ifinfo
15334 @ifnotinfo
15335 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15336 @end ifnotinfo
15337
15338 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15339 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15340 similar syntax:
15341
15342 @smallexample
15343
15344 @var{module} . @var{id}
15345 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15346 @end smallexample
15347
15348 @noindent
15349 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15350 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15351 identifier within your program, except another module.
15352
15353 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15354 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15355 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15356 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15357
15358 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15359 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15360 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15361 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15362 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15363 @var{module}.
15364
15365 @node GDB/M2
15366 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15367
15368 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15369 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15370 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15371 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15372 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15373 analogue in Modula-2.
15374
15375 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15376 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15377 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15378 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15379 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15380 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15381
15382 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15383 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15384 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15385
15386 @node Ada
15387 @subsection Ada
15388 @cindex Ada
15389
15390 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15391 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15392 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15393 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15394 to be difficult.
15395
15396
15397 @cindex expressions in Ada
15398 @menu
15399 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15400 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15401 in @value{GDBN}.
15402 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15403 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15404 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15405 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15406 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15407 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15408 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15409 Profile
15410 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15411 @end menu
15412
15413 @node Ada Mode Intro
15414 @subsubsection Introduction
15415 @cindex Ada mode, general
15416
15417 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15418 syntax, with some extensions.
15419 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15420
15421 @itemize @bullet
15422 @item
15423 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15424 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15425 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15426 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15427
15428 @item
15429 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15430 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15431
15432 @item
15433 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15434 @end itemize
15435
15436 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15437 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15438 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15439 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15440 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15441
15442 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15443 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15444 was translated from an Ada source file.
15445
15446 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15447 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15448 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15449 middle (to allow based literals).
15450
15451 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15452 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15453 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15454 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15455 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15456 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15457
15458 @node Omissions from Ada
15459 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15460 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15461
15462 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15463
15464 @itemize @bullet
15465 @item
15466 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15467
15468 @itemize @minus
15469 @item
15470 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15471 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15472
15473 @item
15474 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15475
15476 @item
15477 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15478
15479 @item
15480 @t{'Tag}.
15481
15482 @item
15483 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15484 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15485
15486 @item
15487 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15488 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15489
15490 @item
15491 @t{'Address}.
15492 @end itemize
15493
15494 @item
15495 The names in
15496 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15497 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15498 not currently available.
15499
15500 @item
15501 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15502 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15503 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15504 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15505 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15506 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15507 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15508 indeterminate values.
15509
15510 @item
15511 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15512 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15513 are not implemented.
15514
15515 @item
15516 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15517 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15518 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15519 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15520 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15521
15522 @smallexample
15523 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15524 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15525 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15526 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15527 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15528 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15529 @end smallexample
15530
15531 Changing a
15532 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15533 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15534 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15535 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15536 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15537 declared to have a type such as:
15538
15539 @smallexample
15540 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15541 Id : Integer;
15542 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15543 end record;
15544 @end smallexample
15545
15546 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15547 assignments:
15548
15549 @smallexample
15550 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15551 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15552 @end smallexample
15553
15554 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15555 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15556 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15557 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15558 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15559 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15560 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15561 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15562
15563 @item
15564 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15565
15566 @item
15567 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15568 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15569 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15570 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15571 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15572 the proper resolution.
15573
15574 @item
15575 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15576
15577 @item
15578 Entry calls are not implemented.
15579
15580 @item
15581 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15582 formats are not supported.
15583
15584 @item
15585 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15586
15587 @item
15588 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15589 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15590 context.
15591 Should your program
15592 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15593 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15594 @end itemize
15595
15596 @node Additions to Ada
15597 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15598 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15599
15600 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15601 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15602
15603 @itemize @bullet
15604 @item
15605 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15606 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15607 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15608 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15609 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15610 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15611 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15612 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15613
15614 @item
15615 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15616 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15617 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15618
15619 @item
15620 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15621 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15622
15623 @item
15624 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15625 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15626 @end itemize
15627
15628 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15629 additions specific to Ada:
15630
15631 @itemize @bullet
15632 @item
15633 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15634 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15635
15636 @smallexample
15637 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15638 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15639 @end smallexample
15640
15641 @item
15642 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15643 the value of its right-hand operand.
15644 This allows, for example,
15645 complex conditional breaks:
15646
15647 @smallexample
15648 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15649 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15650 @end smallexample
15651
15652 @item
15653 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15654 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15655 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15656 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15657 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15658 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15659 in strings. For example,
15660 @smallexample
15661 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15662 @end smallexample
15663 @noindent
15664 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15665 after each period.
15666
15667 @item
15668 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15669 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15670 to write
15671
15672 @smallexample
15673 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15674 @end smallexample
15675
15676 @item
15677 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15678 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15679 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15680 of 3 might print as
15681
15682 @smallexample
15683 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15684 @end smallexample
15685
15686 @noindent
15687 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15688 clause.
15689
15690 @item
15691 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15692 multi-character subsequence of
15693 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15694 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15695 in place of @t{a'length}.
15696
15697 @item
15698 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15699 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15700 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15701 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15702 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15703 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15704 For example,
15705 @smallexample
15706 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15707 @end smallexample
15708
15709 @item
15710 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15711 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15712 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15713 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15714 object.
15715
15716 @end itemize
15717
15718 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15719 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15720
15721 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15722 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15723 before reaching the main procedure.
15724 As defined in the Ada Reference
15725 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15726 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15727 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15728 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15729
15730 @node Ada Exceptions
15731 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15732
15733 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15734
15735 @table @code
15736 @kindex info exceptions
15737 @item info exceptions
15738 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15739 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15740 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15741 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15742 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15743 @end table
15744
15745 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15746 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15747 argument.
15748
15749 @smallexample
15750 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15751 All defined Ada exceptions:
15752 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15753 program_error: 0x613d20
15754 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15755 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15756 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15757 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15758 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15759 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15760 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15761 @end smallexample
15762
15763 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15764 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15765
15766 @node Ada Tasks
15767 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15768 @cindex Ada, tasking
15769
15770 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15771 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15772
15773 @table @code
15774 @kindex info tasks
15775 @item info tasks
15776 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15777
15778
15779 @smallexample
15780 @iftex
15781 @leftskip=0.5cm
15782 @end iftex
15783 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15784 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15785 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15786 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15787 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15788 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15789
15790 @end smallexample
15791
15792 @noindent
15793 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15794 task currently being inspected.
15795
15796 @table @asis
15797 @item ID
15798 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15799
15800 @item TID
15801 The Ada task ID.
15802
15803 @item P-ID
15804 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15805
15806 @item Pri
15807 The base priority of the task.
15808
15809 @item State
15810 Current state of the task.
15811
15812 @table @code
15813 @item Unactivated
15814 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15815 executing.
15816
15817 @item Runnable
15818 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15819 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15820
15821 @item Terminated
15822 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15823 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15824 terminated themselves.
15825
15826 @item Child Activation Wait
15827 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15828
15829 @item Accept Statement
15830 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15831
15832 @item Waiting on entry call
15833 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15834
15835 @item Async Select Wait
15836 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15837 select statement.
15838
15839 @item Delay Sleep
15840 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15841 alternative open.
15842
15843 @item Child Termination Wait
15844 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15845 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15846 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15847
15848 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15849 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15850 finish terminating.
15851
15852 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15853 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15854 @end table
15855
15856 @item Name
15857 Name of the task in the program.
15858
15859 @end table
15860
15861 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15862 @item info task @var{taskno}
15863 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15864 the following example:
15865 @smallexample
15866 @iftex
15867 @leftskip=0.5cm
15868 @end iftex
15869 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15870 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15871 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15872 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15873 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15874 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15875 Name: task_1
15876 Thread: 0x807f378
15877 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15878 Base Priority: 15
15879 State: Runnable
15880 @end smallexample
15881
15882 @item task
15883 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15884 @cindex current Ada task ID
15885 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15886
15887 @smallexample
15888 @iftex
15889 @leftskip=0.5cm
15890 @end iftex
15891 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15892 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15893 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15894 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15895 (@value{GDBP}) task
15896 [Current task is 2]
15897 @end smallexample
15898
15899 @item task @var{taskno}
15900 @cindex Ada task switching
15901 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15902 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15903 from the current task to the given task.
15904
15905 @smallexample
15906 @iftex
15907 @leftskip=0.5cm
15908 @end iftex
15909 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15910 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15911 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15912 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15913 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15914 [Switching to task 1]
15915 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15916 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15917 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15918 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15919 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15920 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15921 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15922 @end smallexample
15923
15924 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15925 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15926 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15927 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15928 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15929 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15930 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
15931 @var{linespec} argument specifies source lines, as described
15932 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15933
15934 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15935 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15936 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
15937 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15938 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15939
15940 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15941 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15942 program.
15943
15944 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15945 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15946 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15947
15948 For example,
15949
15950 @smallexample
15951 @iftex
15952 @leftskip=0.5cm
15953 @end iftex
15954 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15955 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15956 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15957 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15958 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15959 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15960 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15961 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15962 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15963 Continuing.
15964 task # 1 running
15965 task # 2 running
15966
15967 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15968 15 flush;
15969 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15970 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15971 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15972 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15973 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15974 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15975 @end smallexample
15976 @end table
15977
15978 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15979 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15980 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15981
15982 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15983 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15984 the platform being used.
15985 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15986 switching is not supported.
15987
15988 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
15989 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15990 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15991 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15992 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15993 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15994
15995 @node Ravenscar Profile
15996 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15997 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15998
15999 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16000 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16001 requirements.
16002
16003 @table @code
16004 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16005 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16006 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16007 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16008 Profile. This is the default.
16009
16010 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16011 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16012 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16013 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16014 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16015 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16016 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16017
16018 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16019 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16020 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16021 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16022
16023 @end table
16024
16025 @node Ada Glitches
16026 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16027 @cindex Ada, problems
16028
16029 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16030 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16031 @value{GDBN},
16032 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16033 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16034
16035 @itemize @bullet
16036 @item
16037 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16038 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16039
16040 @item
16041 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16042 argument lists are treated as positional).
16043
16044 @item
16045 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16046
16047 @item
16048 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16049 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16050 the host machine.
16051
16052 @item
16053 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16054 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16055 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16056 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16057 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16058 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16059 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16060 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16061 you can usually resolve the confusion
16062 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16063 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16064 @end itemize
16065
16066 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16067 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16068 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16069 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16070 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16071 enabled.
16072
16073 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16074 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16075 @table @code
16076
16077 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16078 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16079 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16080 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16081 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16082 This is the default.
16083
16084 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16085 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16086 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16087 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16088 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16089 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16090 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16091
16092 @end table
16093
16094 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16095 @cindex GNAT encoding
16096 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16097 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16098 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16099 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16100 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16101 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16102
16103 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16104 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16105 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16106 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16107 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16108 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16109 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16110 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16111
16112 @table @code
16113
16114 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16115 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16116 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16117 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16118
16119 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16120 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16121 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16122
16123 @end table
16124
16125 @node Unsupported Languages
16126 @section Unsupported Languages
16127
16128 @cindex unsupported languages
16129 @cindex minimal language
16130 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16131 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16132 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16133 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16134 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16135 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16136
16137 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16138 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16139 language.
16140
16141 @node Symbols
16142 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16143
16144 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16145 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16146 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16147 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16148 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16149 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16150 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16151
16152 @cindex symbol names
16153 @cindex names of symbols
16154 @cindex quoting names
16155 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16156 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16157 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16158 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16159 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16160 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16161 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16162 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16163
16164 @smallexample
16165 p 'foo.c'::x
16166 @end smallexample
16167
16168 @noindent
16169 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16170
16171 @table @code
16172 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16173 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16174 @kindex set case-sensitive
16175 @item set case-sensitive on
16176 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16177 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16178 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16179 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16180 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16181 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16182 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16183 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16184 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16185 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16186 case-insensitive matches.
16187
16188 @kindex show case-sensitive
16189 @item show case-sensitive
16190 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16191 lookups.
16192
16193 @kindex set print type methods
16194 @item set print type methods
16195 @itemx set print type methods on
16196 @itemx set print type methods off
16197 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16198 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16199 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16200 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16201 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16202 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16203
16204 @kindex show print type methods
16205 @item show print type methods
16206 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16207 classes.
16208
16209 @kindex set print type typedefs
16210 @item set print type typedefs
16211 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16212 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16213
16214 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16215 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16216 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16217 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16218 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16219 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16220 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16221 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16222 types.
16223
16224 @kindex show print type typedefs
16225 @item show print type typedefs
16226 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16227 printing classes.
16228
16229 @kindex info address
16230 @cindex address of a symbol
16231 @item info address @var{symbol}
16232 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16233 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16234 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16235 is always stored.
16236
16237 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16238 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16239 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16240
16241 @kindex info symbol
16242 @cindex symbol from address
16243 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16244 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16245 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16246 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16247 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16248
16249 @smallexample
16250 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16251 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16252 @end smallexample
16253
16254 @noindent
16255 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16256 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16257
16258 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16259 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16260
16261 @smallexample
16262 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16263 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16264 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16265 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16266 @end smallexample
16267
16268 @kindex demangle
16269 @cindex demangle
16270 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16271 Demangle @var{name}.
16272 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16273 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16274
16275 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16276 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16277
16278 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16279 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16280
16281 @kindex whatis
16282 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16283 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16284 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16285 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16286
16287 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16288 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16289 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16290
16291 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16292 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16293 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16294 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16295 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16296 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16297 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16298 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16299 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16300
16301 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16302 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16303 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16304 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16305 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16306 unroll it.
16307
16308 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16309 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16310 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16311
16312 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16313 Available flags are:
16314
16315 @table @code
16316 @item r
16317 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16318 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16319 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16320
16321 @item m
16322 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16323
16324 @item M
16325 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16326 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16327
16328 @item t
16329 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16330 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16331 names are substituted when printing other types.
16332
16333 @item T
16334 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16335 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16336 @end table
16337
16338 @kindex ptype
16339 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16340 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16341 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16342 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16343
16344 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16345 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16346 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16347 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16348 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16349 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16350 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16351 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16352
16353 For example, for this variable declaration:
16354
16355 @smallexample
16356 typedef double real_t;
16357 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16358 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16359 complex_t var;
16360 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16361 @end smallexample
16362
16363 @noindent
16364 the two commands give this output:
16365
16366 @smallexample
16367 @group
16368 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16369 type = complex_t
16370 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16371 type = struct complex @{
16372 real_t real;
16373 double imag;
16374 @}
16375 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16376 type = struct complex
16377 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16378 type = struct complex
16379 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16380 type = struct complex @{
16381 real_t real;
16382 double imag;
16383 @}
16384 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16385 type = real_t *
16386 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16387 type = double *
16388 @end group
16389 @end smallexample
16390
16391 @noindent
16392 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16393 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16394
16395 @cindex incomplete type
16396 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16397 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16398 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16399 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16400 given these declarations:
16401
16402 @smallexample
16403 struct foo;
16404 struct foo *fooptr;
16405 @end smallexample
16406
16407 @noindent
16408 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16409
16410 @smallexample
16411 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16412 $1 = <incomplete type>
16413 @end smallexample
16414
16415 @noindent
16416 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16417 completely specified.
16418
16419 @kindex info types
16420 @item info types @var{regexp}
16421 @itemx info types
16422 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16423 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16424 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16425 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16426 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16427 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16428 name is @code{value}.
16429
16430 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16431 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16432 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16433
16434 @kindex info type-printers
16435 @item info type-printers
16436 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16437 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16438 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16439 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16440 type printers.
16441
16442 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16443
16444 @kindex enable type-printer
16445 @kindex disable type-printer
16446 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16447 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16448 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16449
16450 @kindex info scope
16451 @cindex local variables
16452 @item info scope @var{location}
16453 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16454 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16455 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16456 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16457 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16458
16459 @smallexample
16460 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16461 Scope for command_line_handler:
16462 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16463 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16464 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16465 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16466 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16467 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16468 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16469 @end smallexample
16470
16471 @noindent
16472 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16473 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16474 collect}.
16475
16476 @kindex info source
16477 @item info source
16478 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16479 the function containing the current point of execution:
16480 @itemize @bullet
16481 @item
16482 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16483 @item
16484 the directory it was compiled in,
16485 @item
16486 its length, in lines,
16487 @item
16488 which programming language it is written in,
16489 @item
16490 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
16491 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
16492 @item
16493 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16494 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16495 @item
16496 whether the debugging information includes information about
16497 preprocessor macros.
16498 @end itemize
16499
16500
16501 @kindex info sources
16502 @item info sources
16503 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16504 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16505 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16506
16507 @kindex info functions
16508 @item info functions
16509 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16510
16511 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16512 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16513 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16514 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16515 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16516 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16517 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16518 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16519
16520 @kindex info variables
16521 @item info variables
16522 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16523 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16524
16525 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16526 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16527 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16528 @var{regexp}.
16529
16530 @kindex info classes
16531 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16532 @item info classes
16533 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16534 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16535 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16536 expression.
16537
16538 @kindex info selectors
16539 @item info selectors
16540 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16541 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16542 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16543 expression.
16544
16545 @ignore
16546 This was never implemented.
16547 @kindex info methods
16548 @item info methods
16549 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16550 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16551 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16552 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16553 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16554 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16555 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16556 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16557 @end ignore
16558
16559 @cindex opaque data types
16560 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16561 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16562 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16563 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16564 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16565 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16566 another source file. The default is on.
16567
16568 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16569 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16570
16571 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16572 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16573 is printed as follows:
16574 @smallexample
16575 @{<no data fields>@}
16576 @end smallexample
16577
16578 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16579 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16580 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16581
16582 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16583 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16584 @item set print symbol-loading
16585 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16586 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16587 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16588 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16589 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16590 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16591 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16592 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16593 can be annoying.
16594 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16595 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16596 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16597 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16598
16599 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16600 @item show print symbol-loading
16601 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16602 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16603
16604 @kindex maint print symbols
16605 @cindex symbol dump
16606 @kindex maint print psymbols
16607 @cindex partial symbol dump
16608 @kindex maint print msymbols
16609 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16610 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16611 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16612 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16613 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16614 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16615 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16616 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16617 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16618 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16619 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16620 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16621 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16622 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16623 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16624 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16625 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16626 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16627
16628 @kindex maint info symtabs
16629 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16630 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16631 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16632 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16633 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16634 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16635 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16636
16637 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16638 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16639 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16640 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16641 structure in more detail. For example:
16642
16643 @smallexample
16644 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16645 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16646 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16647 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16648 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16649 readin no
16650 fullname (null)
16651 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16652 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16653 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16654 dependencies (none)
16655 @}
16656 @}
16657 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16658 (@value{GDBP})
16659 @end smallexample
16660 @noindent
16661 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16662 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16663 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16664 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16665 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16666
16667 @smallexample
16668 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16669 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16670 line 1574.
16671 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16672 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16673 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16674 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16675 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16676 dirname (null)
16677 fullname (null)
16678 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16679 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16680 debugformat DWARF 2
16681 @}
16682 @}
16683 (@value{GDBP})
16684 @end smallexample
16685
16686 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
16687 @cindex symbol cache size
16688 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
16689 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
16690 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
16691 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
16692 with different sizes.
16693
16694 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
16695 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
16696 Show the size of the symbol cache.
16697
16698 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
16699 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
16700 @item maint print symbol-cache
16701 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
16702 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
16703
16704 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16705 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
16706 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16707 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
16708 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
16709
16710 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
16711 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
16712 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
16713 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
16714 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
16715 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
16716
16717 @end table
16718
16719 @node Altering
16720 @chapter Altering Execution
16721
16722 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16723 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16724 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16725 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16726 program.
16727
16728 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16729 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16730 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16731
16732 @menu
16733 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16734 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16735 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16736 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16737 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16738 * Patching:: Patching your program
16739 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
16740 @end menu
16741
16742 @node Assignment
16743 @section Assignment to Variables
16744
16745 @cindex assignment
16746 @cindex setting variables
16747 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16748 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16749
16750 @smallexample
16751 print x=4
16752 @end smallexample
16753
16754 @noindent
16755 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16756 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16757 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16758 information on operators in supported languages.
16759
16760 @kindex set variable
16761 @cindex variables, setting
16762 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16763 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16764 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16765 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16766 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16767
16768 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16769 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16770 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16771 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16772 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16773 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16774 command @code{set width}:
16775
16776 @smallexample
16777 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16778 type = double
16779 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16780 $4 = 13
16781 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16782 Invalid syntax in expression.
16783 @end smallexample
16784
16785 @noindent
16786 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16787 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16788
16789 @smallexample
16790 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16791 @end smallexample
16792
16793 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16794 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16795 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16796 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16797 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16798 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16799
16800 @smallexample
16801 @group
16802 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16803 type = double
16804 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16805 $1 = 1
16806 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16807 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16808 $2 = 1
16809 (@value{GDBP}) r
16810 The program being debugged has been started already.
16811 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16812 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16813 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16814 Invalid bfd target.
16815 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16816 The current BFD target is "=4".
16817 @end group
16818 @end smallexample
16819
16820 @noindent
16821 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16822 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16823 @code{g}, use
16824
16825 @smallexample
16826 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16827 @end smallexample
16828
16829 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16830 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16831 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16832 same length or shorter.
16833 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16834 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16835
16836 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16837 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16838 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16839 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16840 and representation in memory), and
16841
16842 @smallexample
16843 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16844 @end smallexample
16845
16846 @noindent
16847 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16848
16849 @node Jumping
16850 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16851
16852 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16853 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16854 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16855
16856 @table @code
16857 @kindex jump
16858 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16859 @item jump @var{linespec}
16860 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16861 @itemx jump @var{location}
16862 @itemx j @var{location}
16863 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16864 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16865 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16866 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16867 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16868 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16869
16870 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16871 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16872 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16873 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16874 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16875 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16876 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16877 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16878 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16879 @end table
16880
16881 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16882 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16883 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16884 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16885 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16886 example,
16887
16888 @smallexample
16889 set $pc = 0x485
16890 @end smallexample
16891
16892 @noindent
16893 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16894 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16895 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16896
16897 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16898 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16899 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16900 detail.
16901
16902 @c @group
16903 @node Signaling
16904 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16905 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16906
16907 @table @code
16908 @kindex signal
16909 @item signal @var{signal}
16910 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
16911 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16912 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16913 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16914
16915 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16916 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16917 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16918 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16919 signal.
16920
16921 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
16922 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
16923 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
16924 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
16925 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
16926 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
16927 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
16928 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
16929
16930 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16931 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16932 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16933 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16934 passes the signal directly to your program.
16935
16936 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16937 after executing the command.
16938
16939 @kindex queue-signal
16940 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
16941 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
16942 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
16943 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
16944 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16945 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
16946 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
16947 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
16948 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
16949
16950 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
16951 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
16952 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
16953 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16954 @code{continue} command.
16955
16956 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
16957 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
16958 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
16959 (@pxref{Signals}).
16960 @end table
16961 @c @end group
16962
16963 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
16964 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
16965
16966 @node Returning
16967 @section Returning from a Function
16968
16969 @table @code
16970 @cindex returning from a function
16971 @kindex return
16972 @item return
16973 @itemx return @var{expression}
16974 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16975 command. If you give an
16976 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16977 value.
16978 @end table
16979
16980 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16981 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16982 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16983 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16984
16985 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16986 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16987 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16988 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16989 of functions.
16990
16991 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16992 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16993 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16994 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16995 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16996
16997 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16998 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16999 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17000 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17001 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17002 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17003 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17004 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17005 assignment into the right register(s).
17006
17007 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17008 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17009 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17010 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17011 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17012 into a @code{long long int}:
17013
17014 @smallexample
17015 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17016 29 return 31;
17017 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17018 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17019 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17020 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17021 (@value{GDBP})
17022 @end smallexample
17023
17024 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17025 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17026 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17027 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17028 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17029 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17030 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17031 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17032
17033 @smallexample
17034 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17035 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17036 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17037 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17038 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17039 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17040 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17041 (@value{GDBP})
17042 @end smallexample
17043
17044 @node Calling
17045 @section Calling Program Functions
17046
17047 @table @code
17048 @cindex calling functions
17049 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17050 @item print @var{expr}
17051 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17052 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17053 debugged.
17054
17055 @kindex call
17056 @item call @var{expr}
17057 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17058 returned values.
17059
17060 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17061 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17062 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17063 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17064 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17065 value history.
17066 @end table
17067
17068 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17069 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17070 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17071 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17072
17073 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17074 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17075 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17076 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17077 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17078 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17079 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17080 in that case is controlled by the
17081 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17082
17083 @table @code
17084 @item set unwindonsignal
17085 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17086 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17087 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17088 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17089 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17090 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17091 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17092 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17093 received.
17094
17095 @item show unwindonsignal
17096 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17097 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17098 @value{GDBN}.
17099
17100 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17101 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17102 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17103 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17104 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17105 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17106 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17107 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17108 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17109 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17110
17111 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17112 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17113 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17114 @value{GDBN}.
17115
17116 @end table
17117
17118 @cindex weak alias functions
17119 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17120 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17121 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17122 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17123 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17124 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17125 function instead.
17126
17127 @node Patching
17128 @section Patching Programs
17129
17130 @cindex patching binaries
17131 @cindex writing into executables
17132 @cindex writing into corefiles
17133
17134 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17135 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17136 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17137 patching your program's binary.
17138
17139 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17140 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17141 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17142 repairs.
17143
17144 @table @code
17145 @kindex set write
17146 @item set write on
17147 @itemx set write off
17148 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17149 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17150 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17151
17152 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17153 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17154 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17155
17156 @item show write
17157 @kindex show write
17158 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17159 as well as reading.
17160 @end table
17161
17162 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17163 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17164 @cindex injecting code
17165 @cindex writing into executables
17166 @cindex compiling code
17167
17168 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17169 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17170 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17171 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17172
17173 @table @code
17174 @kindex compile code
17175 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17176 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17177 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17178 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17179 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17180 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17181 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17182 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17183 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17184 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17185 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17186 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17187
17188 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17189 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17190 E.g.:
17191
17192 @smallexample
17193 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17194 @end smallexample
17195
17196 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17197 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17198 from actual source code. E.g.:
17199
17200 @smallexample
17201 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17202 @end smallexample
17203
17204 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17205 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17206 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17207 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17208 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17209 editor.
17210
17211 @smallexample
17212 compile code
17213 >printf ("hello\n");
17214 >printf ("world\n");
17215 >end
17216 @end smallexample
17217
17218 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17219 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17220 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17221 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17222 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17223 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17224 inferior symbols otherwise.
17225
17226 @kindex compile file
17227 @item compile file @var{filename}
17228 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17229 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17230
17231 @smallexample
17232 compile file /home/user/example.c
17233 @end smallexample
17234 @end table
17235
17236 @table @code
17237 @item compile print @var{expr}
17238 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17239 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17240 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17241 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17242 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17243 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17244 Formats}.
17245
17246 @item compile print
17247 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17248 @cindex reprint the last value
17249 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17250 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17251 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17252 multiple-line editor.
17253 @end table
17254
17255 @noindent
17256 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17257
17258 @table @code
17259 @anchor{set debug compile}
17260 @item set debug compile
17261 @cindex compile command debugging info
17262 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17263 injecting the code. The default is off.
17264
17265 @item show debug compile
17266 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17267 compiling and injecting the code.
17268 @end table
17269
17270 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17271
17272 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17273 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17274 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17275 injecting process.
17276
17277 @noindent
17278 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17279
17280 @table @asis
17281 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17282 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17283 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17284 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17285
17286 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17287 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17288 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17289 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17290 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17291 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17292 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17293 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17294
17295 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17296 @end table
17297
17298 @noindent
17299 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17300
17301 @table @code
17302 @item set compile-args
17303 @cindex compile command options override
17304 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17305 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17306 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17307 compilation.
17308
17309 @item show compile-args
17310 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17311 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17312 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17313 @end table
17314
17315 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17316
17317 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17318 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17319 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17320
17321 @table @asis
17322 @item C code examples and caveats
17323 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17324 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17325 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17326 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17327 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17328
17329 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17330 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17331 much like any other normal debugging session.
17332
17333 @smallexample
17334 void function1 (void)
17335 @{
17336 int i = 42;
17337 printf ("function 1\n");
17338 @}
17339
17340 void function2 (void)
17341 @{
17342 int j = 12;
17343 function1 ();
17344 @}
17345
17346 int main(void)
17347 @{
17348 int k = 6;
17349 int *p;
17350 function2 ();
17351 return 0;
17352 @}
17353 @end smallexample
17354
17355 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17356 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17357 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17358
17359 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17360 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17361 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17362 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17363 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17364
17365 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17366 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17367 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17368 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17369 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17370 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17371 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17372 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17373 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17374 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17375
17376 @smallexample
17377 compile code k = 3;
17378 @end smallexample
17379
17380 @noindent
17381 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17382 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17383 @code{compile} command changes it.
17384
17385 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17386 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17387 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17388 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
17389 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
17390
17391 @smallexample
17392 compile code j = 3;
17393 @end smallexample
17394
17395 @noindent
17396 will result in a compilation error message.
17397
17398 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
17399 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
17400 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
17401
17402 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
17403 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
17404 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
17405 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
17406
17407 @smallexample
17408 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
17409 @end smallexample
17410
17411 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
17412 command has completed:
17413
17414 @smallexample
17415 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
17416 @end smallexample
17417
17418 @noindent
17419 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
17420 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
17421 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
17422 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
17423 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
17424
17425 @smallexample
17426 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
17427 @end smallexample
17428
17429 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
17430 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
17431 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
17432 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
17433 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
17434 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
17435 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
17436 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
17437
17438 @smallexample
17439 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
17440 @end smallexample
17441
17442 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
17443 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
17444 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
17445 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
17446 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
17447 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
17448 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
17449
17450 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
17451 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
17452 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
17453 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
17454 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
17455 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
17456
17457 @smallexample
17458 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
17459 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17460 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
17461 Compilation failed.
17462 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17463 42
17464 @end smallexample
17465
17466 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
17467 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
17468 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
17469 will print to the console.
17470 @end table
17471
17472 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
17473
17474 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
17475 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
17476 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
17477 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
17478 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
17479 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
17480 target architecture and operating system.
17481
17482 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
17483 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
17484 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
17485 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
17486 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
17487 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
17488 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
17489
17490 @node GDB Files
17491 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
17492
17493 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
17494 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
17495 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
17496 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
17497
17498 @menu
17499 * Files:: Commands to specify files
17500 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
17501 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
17502 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
17503 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
17504 * Data Files:: GDB data files
17505 @end menu
17506
17507 @node Files
17508 @section Commands to Specify Files
17509
17510 @cindex symbol table
17511 @cindex core dump file
17512
17513 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
17514 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
17515 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
17516 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
17517
17518 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
17519 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
17520 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
17521 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
17522 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
17523 new files are useful.
17524
17525 @table @code
17526 @cindex executable file
17527 @kindex file
17528 @item file @var{filename}
17529 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
17530 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
17531 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
17532 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
17533 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
17534 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
17535 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
17536 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
17537
17538 @cindex unlinked object files
17539 @cindex patching object files
17540 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
17541 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
17542 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
17543 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
17544 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
17545 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
17546 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
17547 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
17548
17549 @item file
17550 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
17551 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
17552
17553 @kindex exec-file
17554 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17555 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
17556 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
17557 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
17558 discard information on the executable file.
17559
17560 @kindex symbol-file
17561 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17562 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
17563 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
17564 table and program to run from the same file.
17565
17566 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
17567 program's symbol table.
17568
17569 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
17570 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
17571 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
17572 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
17573 @value{GDBN}.
17574
17575 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
17576 executing it once.
17577
17578 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
17579 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
17580 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
17581 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
17582 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
17583 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
17584 optimized code.
17585
17586 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
17587 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
17588 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
17589 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
17590 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
17591
17592 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
17593 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
17594 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
17595 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
17596 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
17597 Warnings and Messages}.)
17598
17599 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
17600 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
17601 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
17602 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
17603 in stabs format.
17604
17605 @kindex readnow
17606 @cindex reading symbols immediately
17607 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
17608 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17609 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17610 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
17611 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
17612 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
17613 entire symbol table available.
17614
17615 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
17616 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
17617 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
17618 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
17619 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
17620 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
17621 @c files.
17622
17623 @kindex core-file
17624 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17625 @itemx core
17626 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
17627 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
17628 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
17629 executable file itself for other parts.
17630
17631 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
17632 to be used.
17633
17634 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
17635 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
17636 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
17637 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
17638 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
17639
17640 @kindex add-symbol-file
17641 @cindex dynamic linking
17642 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
17643 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
17644 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
17645 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
17646 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
17647 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
17648 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17649 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17650 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17651 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17652 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17653 @var{address} as an expression.
17654
17655 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17656 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17657 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17658 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17659
17660 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17661
17662 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17663 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17664 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17665 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17666 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17667 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17668 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17669 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17670 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17671
17672 @itemize @bullet
17673 @item
17674 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17675 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
17676 @item
17677 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
17678 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
17679 @item
17680 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
17681 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17682 @end itemize
17683
17684 @noindent
17685 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
17686 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
17687 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
17688 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
17689 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17690 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
17691 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
17692 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
17693 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
17694 way.
17695
17696 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17697
17698 @kindex remove-symbol-file
17699 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
17700 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
17701 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
17702 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
17703 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
17704
17705 @smallexample
17706 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
17707 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
17708 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
17709 (y or n) y
17710 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
17711 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
17712 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
17713 (gdb)
17714 @end smallexample
17715
17716
17717 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17718
17719 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
17720 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
17721 @cindex load symbols from memory
17722 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17723 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17724 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17725 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17726 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17727 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17728 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17729 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17730 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17731
17732 @kindex section
17733 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17734 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17735 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17736 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17737 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17738 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17739 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17740 their addresses.
17741
17742 @kindex info files
17743 @kindex info target
17744 @item info files
17745 @itemx info target
17746 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17747 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17748 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17749 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17750 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17751 current ones.
17752
17753 @kindex maint info sections
17754 @item maint info sections
17755 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17756 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17757 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17758 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17759 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17760 may be arbitrarily combined):
17761
17762 @table @code
17763 @item ALLOBJ
17764 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17765 @item @var{sections}
17766 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17767 @item @var{section-flags}
17768 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17769 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17770 @table @code
17771 @item ALLOC
17772 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17773 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17774 @item LOAD
17775 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17776 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17777 @item RELOC
17778 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17779 @item READONLY
17780 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17781 @item CODE
17782 Section contains executable code only.
17783 @item DATA
17784 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17785 @item ROM
17786 Section will reside in ROM.
17787 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17788 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17789 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17790 Section is not empty.
17791 @item NEVER_LOAD
17792 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17793 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17794 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17795 COFF shared library information.
17796 @item IS_COMMON
17797 Section contains common symbols.
17798 @end table
17799 @end table
17800 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17801 @cindex read-only sections
17802 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17803 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17804 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17805 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17806 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17807 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17808 enhancement to debugging performance.
17809
17810 The default is off.
17811
17812 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17813 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17814 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17815 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17816
17817 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17818 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17819 @end table
17820
17821 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17822 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17823 name and remembers it that way.
17824
17825 @cindex shared libraries
17826 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17827 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17828 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17829
17830 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17831 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17832
17833 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17834 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17835 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17836 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17837 debugging a core file).
17838
17839 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17840 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17841
17842 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17843 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17844 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17845
17846 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17847 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17848 particularly large or there are many of them.
17849
17850 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17851 commands:
17852
17853 @table @code
17854 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17855 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17856 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17857 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17858 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17859 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17860 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17861 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17862
17863 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17864 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17865 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17866 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17867 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17868 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17869 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17870 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17871 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17872
17873 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17874 @item show auto-solib-add
17875 Display the current autoloading mode.
17876 @end table
17877
17878 @cindex load shared library
17879 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17880 command:
17881
17882 @table @code
17883 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17884 @kindex info share
17885 @item info share @var{regex}
17886 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17887 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17888 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17889 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17890
17891 @kindex info dll
17892 @item info dll @var{regex}
17893 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
17894
17895 @kindex sharedlibrary
17896 @kindex share
17897 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17898 @itemx share @var{regex}
17899 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17900 Unix regular expression.
17901 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17902 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17903 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17904 loaded.
17905
17906 @item nosharedlibrary
17907 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17908 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17909 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17910 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17911 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17912 discarded.
17913 @end table
17914
17915 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17916 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17917 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17918 Catchpoints}).
17919
17920 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17921 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17922 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17923 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17924
17925 @table @code
17926 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17927 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17928 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17929 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17930 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17931 shared library.
17932
17933 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17934 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17935 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17936 library events happen.
17937 @end table
17938
17939 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17940 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17941 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17942 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17943 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17944 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17945 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17946 not.
17947
17948 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17949 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17950 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17951 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17952 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17953
17954 @table @code
17955 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
17956 @cindex system root, alternate
17957 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17958 @kindex set sysroot
17959 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17960 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17961 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17962 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17963 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
17964 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
17965 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
17966 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
17967 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
17968 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
17969 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
17970 @var{path}.
17971
17972 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
17973 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
17974 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
17975 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
17976 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
17977 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
17978 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
17979 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
17980 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
17981 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
17982 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
17983 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
17984 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
17985 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
17986
17987 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17988 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17989 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17990 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17991 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17992
17993 @smallexample
17994 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17995 @end smallexample
17996
17997 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17998 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17999 system:
18000
18001 @smallexample
18002 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18003 @end smallexample
18004
18005 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18006 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18007 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18008 colons:
18009
18010 @smallexample
18011 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18012 @end smallexample
18013
18014 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18015 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18016 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18017 @samp{z}):
18018
18019 @smallexample
18020 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18021 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18022 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18023 @end smallexample
18024
18025 @noindent
18026 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18027 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18028 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18029
18030 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18031 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18032
18033 @smallexample
18034 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18035 @end smallexample
18036
18037 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18038 if you don't want or need to.
18039
18040 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18041 sysroot}.
18042
18043 @cindex default system root
18044 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18045 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18046 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18047 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18048 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18049 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18050 location.
18051
18052 @kindex show sysroot
18053 @item show sysroot
18054 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18055
18056 @kindex set solib-search-path
18057 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18058 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18059 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18060 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18061 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18062 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18063 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18064 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18065 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18066 of shared library symbols.
18067
18068 @kindex show solib-search-path
18069 @item show solib-search-path
18070 Display the current shared library search path.
18071
18072 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18073 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18074 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18075 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18076 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18077
18078 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18079 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18080 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18081 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18082 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18083 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18084 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18085 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18086 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18087 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18088 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18089 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18090 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18091 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18092 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18093 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18094 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18095 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18096 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18097 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18098 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18099 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18100
18101 @table @code
18102 @item unix
18103 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18104 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18105 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18106 the forward slash.
18107
18108 @item dos-based
18109 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18110 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18111 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18112 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18113 considered directory separators.
18114
18115 @item auto
18116 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18117 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18118 This is the default.
18119 @end table
18120 @end table
18121
18122 @cindex file name canonicalization
18123 @cindex base name differences
18124 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18125 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18126 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18127 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18128 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18129 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18130 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18131 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18132 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18133 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18134 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18135 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18136 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18137 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18138 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18139
18140 @table @code
18141 @item set basenames-may-differ
18142 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18143 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18144
18145 @item show basenames-may-differ
18146 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18147 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18148 @end table
18149
18150 @node Separate Debug Files
18151 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18152 @cindex separate debugging information files
18153 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18154 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18155 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18156 @cindex global debugging information directories
18157 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18158 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18159
18160 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18161 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18162 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18163 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18164 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18165 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18166 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18167
18168 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18169 file:
18170
18171 @itemize @bullet
18172 @item
18173 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18174 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18175 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18176 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18177 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18178 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18179 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18180 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18181
18182 @item
18183 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18184 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18185 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18186 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18187 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18188 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18189 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18190 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18191 below.
18192 @end itemize
18193
18194 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18195 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18196
18197 @itemize @bullet
18198 @item
18199 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18200 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18201 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18202 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18203 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18204
18205 @item
18206 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18207 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18208 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18209 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18210 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18211 hex characters, not 10.)
18212 @end itemize
18213
18214 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18215 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18216 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18217 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18218 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18219 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18220
18221 @itemize @minus
18222 @item
18223 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18224 @item
18225 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18226 @item
18227 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18228 @item
18229 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18230 @end itemize
18231
18232 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18233 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18234 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18235 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18236 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18237
18238 @table @code
18239
18240 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18241 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18242 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18243 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18244 concatenating them by a path separator.
18245
18246 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18247 @item show debug-file-directory
18248 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18249 information files.
18250
18251 @end table
18252
18253 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18254 @cindex debug link sections
18255 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18256 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18257
18258 @itemize
18259 @item
18260 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18261 a zero byte,
18262 @item
18263 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18264 boundary within the section, and
18265 @item
18266 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18267 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18268 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18269 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18270 @end itemize
18271
18272 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18273 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18274 described above.
18275
18276 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18277 @cindex build ID sections
18278 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18279 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18280 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18281 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18282 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18283 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18284 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18285 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18286 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18287
18288 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18289 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18290 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18291 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18292 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18293 in an ordinary executable.
18294
18295 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18296 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18297 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18298 following commands:
18299
18300 @smallexample
18301 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18302 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18303 @end smallexample
18304
18305 @noindent
18306 These commands remove the debugging
18307 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18308 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18309 two files:
18310
18311 @itemize @bullet
18312 @item
18313 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18314 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18315
18316 @smallexample
18317 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18318 @end smallexample
18319
18320 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18321 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18322 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18323 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18324
18325 @item
18326 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18327 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18328 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18329 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18330 @end itemize
18331
18332 @noindent
18333
18334 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18335 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18336 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18337
18338 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18339 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18340 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18341 @c different ways!
18342 @ifhtml
18343 @display
18344 @html
18345 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18346 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18347 @end html
18348 @end display
18349 @end ifhtml
18350 @ifnothtml
18351 @display
18352 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
18353 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
18354 @end display
18355 @end ifnothtml
18356
18357 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
18358 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
18359 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
18360 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
18361 CRC.
18362
18363 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
18364 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
18365 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
18366 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
18367 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
18368
18369 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
18370 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
18371 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
18372 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
18373 @code{0xffffffff}.
18374
18375 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
18376 @smallexample
18377 unsigned long
18378 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
18379 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
18380 @{
18381 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
18382 @{
18383 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
18384 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
18385 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
18386 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
18387 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
18388 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
18389 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
18390 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
18391 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
18392 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
18393 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
18394 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
18395 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
18396 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
18397 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
18398 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
18399 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
18400 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
18401 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
18402 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
18403 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
18404 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
18405 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
18406 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
18407 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
18408 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
18409 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
18410 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
18411 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
18412 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
18413 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
18414 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
18415 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
18416 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
18417 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
18418 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
18419 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
18420 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
18421 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
18422 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
18423 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
18424 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
18425 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
18426 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
18427 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
18428 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
18429 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
18430 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
18431 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
18432 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
18433 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
18434 0x2d02ef8d
18435 @};
18436 unsigned char *end;
18437
18438 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18439 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
18440 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
18441 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18442 @}
18443 @end smallexample
18444
18445 @noindent
18446 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
18447
18448 @node MiniDebugInfo
18449 @section Debugging information in a special section
18450 @cindex separate debug sections
18451 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
18452
18453 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
18454 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
18455 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
18456 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
18457
18458 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
18459 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
18460 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
18461 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
18462 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
18463 debugging information might be included in the section.
18464
18465 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
18466 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
18467 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
18468
18469 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
18470 standard utilities:
18471
18472 @smallexample
18473 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
18474 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
18475 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18476 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
18477
18478 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
18479 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
18480 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
18481 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18482 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
18483 | sort > funcsyms
18484
18485 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
18486 # table.
18487 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
18488
18489 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
18490 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
18491
18492 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
18493 # removing some unnecessary sections.
18494 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
18495 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
18496
18497 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
18498 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
18499
18500 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
18501 # original binary.
18502 xz mini_debuginfo
18503 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
18504 @end smallexample
18505
18506 @node Index Files
18507 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
18508 @cindex index files
18509 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
18510
18511 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
18512 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
18513 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
18514 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
18515 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
18516 startup.
18517
18518 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
18519 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
18520 using @command{objcopy}.
18521
18522 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
18523
18524 @table @code
18525 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
18526 @kindex save gdb-index
18527 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
18528 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
18529 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
18530 @var{directory}.
18531 @end table
18532
18533 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
18534 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
18535
18536 @smallexample
18537 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
18538 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
18539 @end smallexample
18540
18541 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
18542 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
18543 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
18544 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
18545 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
18546 The default is @code{off}.
18547 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
18548 @xref{Index Section Format}.
18549
18550 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
18551 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
18552
18553 @smallexample
18554 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18555 @end smallexample
18556
18557 Instead you must do, for example,
18558
18559 @smallexample
18560 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18561 @end smallexample
18562
18563 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
18564 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
18565 currently work for programs using Ada.
18566
18567 @node Symbol Errors
18568 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
18569
18570 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
18571 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
18572 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
18573 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
18574 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
18575 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
18576 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
18577 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
18578 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
18579 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18580 Messages}).
18581
18582 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
18583
18584 @table @code
18585 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
18586
18587 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
18588 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
18589 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
18590 in its outer scope blocks.
18591
18592 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
18593 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
18594 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
18595 function.
18596
18597 @item block at @var{address} out of order
18598
18599 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
18600 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
18601 do so.
18602
18603 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
18604 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
18605 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
18606 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18607 Messages}.)
18608
18609 @item bad block start address patched
18610
18611 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
18612 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
18613 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
18614
18615 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
18616 starting on the previous source line.
18617
18618 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
18619
18620 @cindex foo
18621 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
18622 larger than the size of the string table.
18623
18624 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
18625 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
18626 with this name.
18627
18628 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
18629
18630 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
18631 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
18632 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
18633
18634 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
18635 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
18636 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
18637 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
18638 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
18639 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
18640
18641 @item stub type has NULL name
18642
18643 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
18644
18645 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
18646 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
18647 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
18648 it.
18649
18650 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
18651
18652 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
18653
18654 @end table
18655
18656 @node Data Files
18657 @section GDB Data Files
18658
18659 @cindex prefix for data files
18660 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
18661 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
18662
18663 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
18664 is currently using.
18665
18666 @table @code
18667 @kindex set data-directory
18668 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
18669 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
18670 to @var{directory}.
18671
18672 @kindex show data-directory
18673 @item show data-directory
18674 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
18675 @end table
18676
18677 @cindex default data directory
18678 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
18679 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
18680 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
18681 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18682 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
18683 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18684 location.
18685
18686 The data directory may also be specified with the
18687 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
18688 @xref{Mode Options}.
18689
18690 @node Targets
18691 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
18692
18693 @cindex debugging target
18694 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
18695
18696 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
18697 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
18698 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
18699 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
18700 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
18701 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
18702 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
18703 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
18704
18705 @cindex target architecture
18706 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
18707 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
18708 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
18709 command.
18710
18711 @table @code
18712 @kindex set architecture
18713 @kindex show architecture
18714 @item set architecture @var{arch}
18715 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
18716 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
18717 supported architectures.
18718
18719 @item show architecture
18720 Show the current target architecture.
18721
18722 @item set processor
18723 @itemx processor
18724 @kindex set processor
18725 @kindex show processor
18726 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18727 and @code{show architecture}.
18728 @end table
18729
18730 @menu
18731 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18732 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18733 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18734 @end menu
18735
18736 @node Active Targets
18737 @section Active Targets
18738
18739 @cindex stacking targets
18740 @cindex active targets
18741 @cindex multiple targets
18742
18743 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
18744 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
18745 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
18746 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
18747 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
18748 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
18749 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
18750 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
18751 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
18752
18753 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
18754 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
18755 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
18756 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
18757
18758 @node Target Commands
18759 @section Commands for Managing Targets
18760
18761 @table @code
18762 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
18763 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
18764 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
18765 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
18766 protocol of the target machine.
18767
18768 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
18769 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
18770 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
18771
18772 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
18773 after executing the command.
18774
18775 @kindex help target
18776 @item help target
18777 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
18778 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
18779 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18780
18781 @item help target @var{name}
18782 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
18783 select it.
18784
18785 @kindex set gnutarget
18786 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18787 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18788 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18789 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18790 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18791 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18792
18793 @quotation
18794 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18795 you must know the actual BFD name.
18796 @end quotation
18797
18798 @noindent
18799 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18800
18801 @kindex show gnutarget
18802 @item show gnutarget
18803 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18804 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18805 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18806 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18807 @end table
18808
18809 @cindex common targets
18810 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18811 configuration):
18812
18813 @table @code
18814 @kindex target
18815 @item target exec @var{program}
18816 @cindex executable file target
18817 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18818 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18819
18820 @item target core @var{filename}
18821 @cindex core dump file target
18822 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18823 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18824
18825 @item target remote @var{medium}
18826 @cindex remote target
18827 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18828 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18829 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18830
18831 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18832 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18833
18834 @smallexample
18835 target remote /dev/ttya
18836 @end smallexample
18837
18838 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18839 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18840 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18841 clobbered by the download.
18842
18843 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18844 @cindex built-in simulator target
18845 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18846 In general,
18847 @smallexample
18848 target sim
18849 load
18850 run
18851 @end smallexample
18852 @noindent
18853 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18854 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18855 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18856 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18857 Processors}.
18858
18859 @item target native
18860 @cindex native target
18861 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
18862 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
18863 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
18864 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
18865
18866 @end table
18867
18868 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18869 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18870
18871 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18872 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18873 various aspects of this process.
18874
18875 @table @code
18876
18877 @item set hash
18878 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18879 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18880 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18881 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18882 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18883 monitor.
18884
18885 @item show hash
18886 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18887 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18888
18889 @item set debug monitor
18890 @kindex set debug monitor
18891 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18892 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18893 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18894
18895 @item show debug monitor
18896 @kindex show debug monitor
18897 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18898 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18899 @end table
18900
18901 @table @code
18902
18903 @kindex load @var{filename}
18904 @item load @var{filename}
18905 @anchor{load}
18906 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18907 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18908 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18909 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18910 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18911 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18912
18913 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18914 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18915 target is @dots{}}''
18916
18917 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18918 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18919 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18920 specifies a fixed address.
18921 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18922
18923 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18924 load programs into flash memory.
18925
18926 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18927 @end table
18928
18929 @node Byte Order
18930 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18931
18932 @cindex choosing target byte order
18933 @cindex target byte order
18934
18935 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18936 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18937 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18938 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18939 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18940 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18941
18942 @table @code
18943 @kindex set endian
18944 @item set endian big
18945 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18946
18947 @item set endian little
18948 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18949
18950 @item set endian auto
18951 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18952 executable.
18953
18954 @item show endian
18955 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18956
18957 @end table
18958
18959 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18960 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18961 target system.
18962
18963
18964 @node Remote Debugging
18965 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18966 @cindex remote debugging
18967
18968 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18969 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18970 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18971 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18972 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18973
18974 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18975 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18976 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18977 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18978 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18979 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18980
18981 Other remote targets may be available in your
18982 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18983
18984 @menu
18985 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18986 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18987 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18988 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18989 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18990 @end menu
18991
18992 @node Connecting
18993 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18994
18995 @value{GDBN} needs an unstripped copy of your program to access symbol
18996 and debugging information. Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer
18997 executable filename read}, and @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow
18998 @value{GDBN} to access program files over the same connection used to
18999 communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a target, if the remote
19000 program is unstripped, the only command you need is @code{target
19001 remote}. Otherwise, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19002 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19003 @code{file} command.
19004
19005 @cindex @code{target remote}
19006 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19007 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19008 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19009 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19010 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
19011 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
19012
19013 @table @code
19014
19015 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19016 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19017 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19018 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19019
19020 @smallexample
19021 target remote /dev/ttyb
19022 @end smallexample
19023
19024 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19025 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19026 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19027 @code{target} command.
19028
19029 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19030 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19031 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19032 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19033 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19034 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19035 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19036 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19037 target.
19038
19039 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19040 @code{manyfarms}:
19041
19042 @smallexample
19043 target remote manyfarms:2828
19044 @end smallexample
19045
19046 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19047 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19048 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19049 port 1234 on your local machine:
19050
19051 @smallexample
19052 target remote :1234
19053 @end smallexample
19054 @noindent
19055
19056 Note that the colon is still required here.
19057
19058 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19059 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19060 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19061 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19062
19063 @smallexample
19064 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19065 @end smallexample
19066
19067 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19068 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19069 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19070 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19071
19072 @item target remote | @var{command}
19073 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19074 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19075 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19076 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19077 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19078 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19079 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19080 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19081
19082 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19083 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19084 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19085
19086 @end table
19087
19088 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
19089 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
19090 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
19091 need to use @kbd{run}.
19092
19093 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19094 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19095 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19096 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19097 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19098 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19099 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19100
19101 @smallexample
19102 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19103 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19104 @end smallexample
19105
19106 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
19107 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
19108 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
19109 goes back to waiting.
19110
19111 @table @code
19112 @kindex detach (remote)
19113 @item detach
19114 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19115 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19116 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19117 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19118 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
19119
19120 @kindex disconnect
19121 @item disconnect
19122 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
19123 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19124 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19125 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19126 another target.
19127
19128 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19129 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19130 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19131 @kindex monitor
19132 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19133 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19134 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19135 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19136 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19137 and implement.
19138 @end table
19139
19140 @node File Transfer
19141 @section Sending files to a remote system
19142 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19143 @cindex file transfer
19144 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19145
19146 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19147 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19148 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19149 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19150 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19151 the only way to upload or download files.
19152
19153 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19154
19155 @table @code
19156 @kindex remote put
19157 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19158 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19159 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19160
19161 @kindex remote get
19162 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19163 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19164 on the host system.
19165
19166 @kindex remote delete
19167 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19168 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19169
19170 @end table
19171
19172 @node Server
19173 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19174
19175 @kindex gdbserver
19176 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19177 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19178 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19179 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
19180
19181 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19182 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19183 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19184 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19185 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19186 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19187 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19188 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19189 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19190 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19191 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19192 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19193 choice for debugging.
19194
19195 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19196 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19197 protocol.
19198
19199 @quotation
19200 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
19201 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
19202 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
19203 target system with the same privileges as the user running
19204 @code{gdbserver}.
19205 @end quotation
19206
19207 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
19208 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
19209 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
19210
19211 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
19212 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
19213 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19214 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19215 system does all the symbol handling.
19216
19217 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19218 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19219 syntax is:
19220
19221 @smallexample
19222 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19223 @end smallexample
19224
19225 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
19226 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
19227 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
19228 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
19229 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
19230 @file{/dev/com1}:
19231
19232 @smallexample
19233 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
19234 @end smallexample
19235
19236 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
19237 with it.
19238
19239 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
19240
19241 @smallexample
19242 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
19243 @end smallexample
19244
19245 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
19246 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
19247 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
19248 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
19249 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
19250 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
19251 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
19252 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
19253 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
19254 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
19255 @code{target remote} command.
19256
19257 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
19258 with ssh:
19259
19260 @smallexample
19261 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
19262 @end smallexample
19263
19264 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
19265 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
19266 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
19267 You could elide it if you want to.
19268
19269 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
19270 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
19271 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
19272 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
19273
19274 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
19275 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
19276 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
19277
19278 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
19279 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
19280
19281 @smallexample
19282 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
19283 @end smallexample
19284
19285 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
19286 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
19287
19288 @pindex pidof
19289 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
19290 @code{pidof} utility:
19291
19292 @smallexample
19293 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
19294 @end smallexample
19295
19296 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
19297 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
19298 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
19299
19300 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
19301 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
19302 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
19303
19304 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
19305 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
19306 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
19307 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
19308
19309 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
19310 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
19311 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
19312 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
19313 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
19314 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
19315 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
19316 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
19317 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19318
19319 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19320 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19321 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
19322 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
19323 the program you want to debug.
19324
19325 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
19326 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
19327 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
19328 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
19329 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
19330 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19331
19332 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
19333
19334 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
19335
19336 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
19337 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
19338 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
19339 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
19340 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
19341 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
19342 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
19343 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
19344
19345 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
19346 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
19347 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
19348
19349 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
19350 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
19351 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
19352 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
19353 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
19354 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
19355 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
19356 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
19357 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
19358 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
19359 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
19360 instance closes its port after the first connection.
19361
19362 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
19363 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
19364
19365 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19366 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
19367 status information about the debugging process.
19368 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19369 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
19370 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
19371 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
19372
19373 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
19374 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
19375 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
19376 Possible options are:
19377
19378 @table @code
19379 @item none
19380 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19381 @item all
19382 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19383 @item timestamps
19384 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19385 @end table
19386
19387 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19388 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19389
19390 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
19391 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
19392 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
19393 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
19394 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
19395
19396 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
19397 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
19398 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
19399 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
19400
19401 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
19402 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
19403 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
19404 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
19405
19406 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
19407 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
19408 environment:
19409
19410 @smallexample
19411 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
19412 @end smallexample
19413
19414 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
19415
19416 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
19417
19418 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
19419 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
19420 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
19421 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
19422
19423 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19424 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19425 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19426 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19427 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19428 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19429 programs.
19430
19431 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19432 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
19433 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
19434 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
19435 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
19436 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
19437 already on the target.
19438
19439 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
19440 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
19441 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
19442
19443 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
19444 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
19445 Here are the available commands.
19446
19447 @table @code
19448 @item monitor help
19449 List the available monitor commands.
19450
19451 @item monitor set debug 0
19452 @itemx monitor set debug 1
19453 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
19454
19455 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
19456 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
19457 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
19458 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
19459
19460 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
19461 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
19462 Possible options are:
19463
19464 @table @code
19465 @item none
19466 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19467 @item all
19468 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19469 @item timestamps
19470 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19471 @end table
19472
19473 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19474 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19475
19476 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
19477 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
19478 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19479 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
19480 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
19481 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
19482
19483 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
19484 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
19485
19486 @item monitor exit
19487 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
19488 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
19489 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
19490 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
19491 of a multi-process mode debug session.
19492
19493 @end table
19494
19495 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19496 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19497
19498 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
19499 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
19500
19501 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
19502 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
19503 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
19504 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
19505 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
19506 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
19507 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
19508 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
19509 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
19510 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
19511 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
19512 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
19513
19514 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
19515
19516 @table @code
19517 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
19518
19519 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
19520 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
19521 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
19522
19523 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
19524
19525 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
19526 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
19527 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
19528 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
19529 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
19530 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
19531
19532 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
19533
19534 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
19535 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
19536 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
19537 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
19538 command for that. For example:
19539
19540 @smallexample
19541 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
19542 @end smallexample
19543
19544 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
19545 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
19546 @end table
19547
19548 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
19549 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
19550 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
19551 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
19552 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
19553 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
19554 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
19555 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
19556 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
19557 @code{gdbserver} like so:
19558
19559 @smallexample
19560 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
19561 @end smallexample
19562
19563 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
19564
19565 @smallexample
19566 $ gdb myprogram
19567 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
19568 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
19569 (@value{GDBP}) b main
19570 (@value{GDBP}) continue
19571 @end smallexample
19572
19573 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
19574 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
19575 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
19576 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
19577 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
19578 tracing.
19579
19580 @node Remote Configuration
19581 @section Remote Configuration
19582
19583 @kindex set remote
19584 @kindex show remote
19585 This section documents the configuration options available when
19586 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
19587 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
19588 system-call-allowed}.
19589
19590 @table @code
19591 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
19592 @cindex address size for remote targets
19593 @cindex bits in remote address
19594 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
19595 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
19596 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
19597 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
19598
19599 @item show remoteaddresssize
19600 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
19601
19602 @item set serial baud @var{n}
19603 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
19604 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
19605 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
19606 remote targets.
19607
19608 @item show serial baud
19609 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
19610
19611 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
19612 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
19613 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
19614
19615 @item show serial parity
19616 Show the current parity of the serial port.
19617
19618 @item set remotebreak
19619 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19620 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
19621 @anchor{set remotebreak}
19622 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
19623 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
19624 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
19625 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
19626 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
19627
19628 @item show remotebreak
19629 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
19630 interrupt the remote program.
19631
19632 @item set remoteflow on
19633 @itemx set remoteflow off
19634 @kindex set remoteflow
19635 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
19636 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
19637
19638 @item show remoteflow
19639 @kindex show remoteflow
19640 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
19641
19642 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
19643 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
19644 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
19645 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
19646 @code{ascii}.
19647
19648 @item show remotelogbase
19649 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
19650 protocol.
19651
19652 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
19653 @cindex record serial communications on file
19654 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
19655 default is not to record at all.
19656
19657 @item show remotelogfile.
19658 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
19659 serial communications.
19660
19661 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
19662 @cindex timeout for serial communications
19663 @cindex remote timeout
19664 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
19665 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
19666
19667 @item show remotetimeout
19668 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
19669 responses.
19670
19671 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
19672 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
19673 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
19674 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
19675 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
19676 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
19677 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
19678 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
19679
19680 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
19681 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
19682 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
19683 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
19684 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
19685 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
19686 as unlimited.
19687
19688 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
19689 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
19690 a remote hardware watchpoint.
19691
19692 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
19693 @itemx show remote exec-file
19694 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
19695 @cindex executable file, for remote target
19696 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
19697 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
19698 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
19699 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
19700
19701 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
19702 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19703 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
19704 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
19705 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
19706 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
19707 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
19708 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
19709 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
19710 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
19711
19712 @item show interrupt-sequence
19713 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
19714 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
19715 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
19716 also known as Magic SysRq g.
19717
19718 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
19719 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
19720 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
19721 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
19722 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
19723 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
19724
19725 @item show interrupt-on-connect
19726 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
19727 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
19728
19729 @kindex set tcp
19730 @kindex show tcp
19731 @item set tcp auto-retry on
19732 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
19733 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
19734 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
19735 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
19736 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
19737 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
19738 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
19739 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
19740
19741 @item set tcp auto-retry off
19742 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
19743
19744 @item show tcp auto-retry
19745 Show the current auto-retry setting.
19746
19747 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
19748 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
19749 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
19750 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
19751 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
19752 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
19753 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
19754 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
19755 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
19756 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
19757 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
19758
19759 @item show tcp connect-timeout
19760 Show the current connection timeout setting.
19761 @end table
19762
19763 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
19764 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
19765 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
19766 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
19767 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
19768 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
19769 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
19770 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
19771 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
19772
19773 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
19774 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
19775 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
19776 @value{GDBN} developers.
19777
19778 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
19779 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
19780 are:
19781
19782 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
19783 @item Command Name
19784 @tab Remote Packet
19785 @tab Related Features
19786
19787 @item @code{fetch-register}
19788 @tab @code{p}
19789 @tab @code{info registers}
19790
19791 @item @code{set-register}
19792 @tab @code{P}
19793 @tab @code{set}
19794
19795 @item @code{binary-download}
19796 @tab @code{X}
19797 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
19798
19799 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
19800 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
19801 @tab @code{info auxv}
19802
19803 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19804 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19805 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19806
19807 @item @code{attach}
19808 @tab @code{vAttach}
19809 @tab @code{attach}
19810
19811 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19812 @tab @code{vCont}
19813 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19814
19815 @item @code{run}
19816 @tab @code{vRun}
19817 @tab @code{run}
19818
19819 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19820 @tab @code{Z0}
19821 @tab @code{break}
19822
19823 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19824 @tab @code{Z1}
19825 @tab @code{hbreak}
19826
19827 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19828 @tab @code{Z2}
19829 @tab @code{watch}
19830
19831 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19832 @tab @code{Z3}
19833 @tab @code{rwatch}
19834
19835 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19836 @tab @code{Z4}
19837 @tab @code{awatch}
19838
19839 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
19840 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
19841 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
19842
19843 @item @code{target-features}
19844 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19845 @tab @code{set architecture}
19846
19847 @item @code{library-info}
19848 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19849 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19850
19851 @item @code{memory-map}
19852 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19853 @tab @code{info mem}
19854
19855 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19856 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19857 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19858
19859 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19860 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19861 @tab @code{info spu}
19862
19863 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19864 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19865 @tab @code{info spu}
19866
19867 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19868 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19869 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19870
19871 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19872 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19873 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19874
19875 @item @code{threads}
19876 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19877 @tab @code{info threads}
19878
19879 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19880 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19881 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19882
19883 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19884 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19885 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19886
19887 @item @code{search-memory}
19888 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19889 @tab @code{find}
19890
19891 @item @code{supported-packets}
19892 @tab @code{qSupported}
19893 @tab Remote communications parameters
19894
19895 @item @code{pass-signals}
19896 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19897 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19898
19899 @item @code{program-signals}
19900 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19901 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19902
19903 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19904 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19905 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19906
19907 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19908 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19909 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19910
19911 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19912 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19913 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19914
19915 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19916 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19917 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19918
19919 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19920 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19921 @tab @code{remote delete}
19922
19923 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19924 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19925 @tab Host I/O
19926
19927 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
19928 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
19929 @tab Host I/O
19930
19931 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
19932 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
19933 @tab Host I/O
19934
19935 @item @code{noack-packet}
19936 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19937 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19938
19939 @item @code{osdata}
19940 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19941 @tab @code{info os}
19942
19943 @item @code{query-attached}
19944 @tab @code{qAttached}
19945 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19946
19947 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19948 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19949 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19950
19951 @item @code{trace-status}
19952 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19953 @tab @code{tstatus}
19954
19955 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19956 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19957 @tab Traceframe info
19958
19959 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19960 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19961 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19962
19963 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19964 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19965 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19966
19967 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19968 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19969 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19970
19971 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
19972 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
19973 @tab @code{break}
19974
19975 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
19976 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
19977 @tab @code{hbreak}
19978
19979 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
19980 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
19981 @tab @code{fork}
19982
19983 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
19984 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
19985 @tab @code{vfork}
19986
19987 @end multitable
19988
19989 @node Remote Stub
19990 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19991
19992 @cindex debugging stub, example
19993 @cindex remote stub, example
19994 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19995 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19996 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19997 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19998 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19999 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20000 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20001 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20002
20003 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20004 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20005 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20006 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20007 program, you need:
20008
20009 @enumerate
20010 @item
20011 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20012 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20013 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20014
20015 @item
20016 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20017 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20018
20019 @item
20020 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20021 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20022 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20023 documentation.
20024 @end enumerate
20025
20026 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20027 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20028 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20029
20030 @table @emph
20031 @item On the host,
20032 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20033 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20034 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20035
20036 @item On the target,
20037 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20038 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20039 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20040
20041 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20042 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20043 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20044 @end table
20045
20046 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20047 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20048 @sc{sparc} boards.
20049
20050 @cindex remote serial stub list
20051 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20052
20053 @table @code
20054
20055 @item i386-stub.c
20056 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20057 @cindex Intel
20058 @cindex i386
20059 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20060
20061 @item m68k-stub.c
20062 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20063 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20064 @cindex m680x0
20065 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20066
20067 @item sh-stub.c
20068 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20069 @cindex Renesas
20070 @cindex SH
20071 For Renesas SH architectures.
20072
20073 @item sparc-stub.c
20074 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20075 @cindex Sparc
20076 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20077
20078 @item sparcl-stub.c
20079 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20080 @cindex Fujitsu
20081 @cindex SparcLite
20082 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20083
20084 @end table
20085
20086 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20087 recently added stubs.
20088
20089 @menu
20090 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20091 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20092 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20093 @end menu
20094
20095 @node Stub Contents
20096 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20097
20098 @cindex remote serial stub
20099 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20100 subroutines:
20101
20102 @table @code
20103 @item set_debug_traps
20104 @findex set_debug_traps
20105 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20106 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20107 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20108 program's startup code.
20109
20110 @item handle_exception
20111 @findex handle_exception
20112 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20113 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20114 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20115 run when a trap is triggered.
20116
20117 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20118 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20119 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20120 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20121 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20122 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20123 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20124 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20125 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20126 machine.
20127
20128 @item breakpoint
20129 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20130 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20131 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20132 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20133 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20134 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20135 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20136 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20137 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20138 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20139 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20140
20141 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20142 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20143 start of your debugging session.
20144 @end table
20145
20146 @node Bootstrapping
20147 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20148
20149 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20150 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20151 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20152 debugging target machine.
20153
20154 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20155 serial port.
20156
20157 @table @code
20158 @item int getDebugChar()
20159 @findex getDebugChar
20160 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20161 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20162 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20163
20164 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20165 @findex putDebugChar
20166 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20167 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20168 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20169 @end table
20170
20171 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20172 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20173 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20174 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20175 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20176 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20177 remote system to stop.
20178
20179 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20180 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20181 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20182 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20183
20184 Other routines you need to supply are:
20185
20186 @table @code
20187 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20188 @findex exceptionHandler
20189 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20190 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20191 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
20192 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
20193 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
20194 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
20195 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
20196 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
20197 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
20198 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
20199 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
20200 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
20201 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
20202
20203 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
20204 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
20205 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
20206 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
20207 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
20208
20209 @item void flush_i_cache()
20210 @findex flush_i_cache
20211 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
20212 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
20213 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
20214
20215 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
20216 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
20217 @end table
20218
20219 @noindent
20220 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
20221
20222 @table @code
20223 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
20224 @findex memset
20225 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
20226 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
20227 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
20228 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
20229 @end table
20230
20231 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
20232 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
20233 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
20234 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
20235
20236
20237 @node Debug Session
20238 @subsection Putting it All Together
20239
20240 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
20241 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
20242 steps.
20243
20244 @enumerate
20245 @item
20246 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
20247 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
20248 @display
20249 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
20250 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
20251 @end display
20252
20253 @item
20254 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
20255 procedure is called:
20256
20257 @smallexample
20258 set_debug_traps();
20259 breakpoint();
20260 @end smallexample
20261
20262 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
20263 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
20264 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
20265 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
20266 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
20267 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
20268 progress.
20269
20270 @item
20271 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
20272 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
20273
20274 @smallexample
20275 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
20276 @end smallexample
20277
20278 @noindent
20279 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
20280 function in your program, that function is called when
20281 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
20282 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
20283 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
20284
20285 @item
20286 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
20287 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
20288
20289 @item
20290 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
20291 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
20292
20293 @item
20294 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
20295 @c document that. FIXME.
20296 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
20297 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
20298
20299 @item
20300 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
20301 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20302
20303 @end enumerate
20304
20305 @node Configurations
20306 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
20307
20308 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
20309 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
20310 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
20311
20312 There are three major categories of configurations: native
20313 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
20314 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
20315 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
20316 are quite different from each other.
20317
20318 @menu
20319 * Native::
20320 * Embedded OS::
20321 * Embedded Processors::
20322 * Architectures::
20323 @end menu
20324
20325 @node Native
20326 @section Native
20327
20328 This section describes details specific to particular native
20329 configurations.
20330
20331 @menu
20332 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
20333 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
20334 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
20335 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
20336 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
20337 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
20338 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
20339 @end menu
20340
20341 @node HP-UX
20342 @subsection HP-UX
20343
20344 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
20345 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
20346 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
20347
20348
20349 @node BSD libkvm Interface
20350 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
20351
20352 @cindex libkvm
20353 @cindex kernel memory image
20354 @cindex kernel crash dump
20355
20356 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
20357 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
20358 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
20359 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
20360 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
20361 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
20362 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
20363 @code{kvm} target:
20364
20365 @smallexample
20366 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
20367 @end smallexample
20368
20369 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
20370 argument:
20371
20372 @smallexample
20373 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
20374 @end smallexample
20375
20376 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
20377 available:
20378
20379 @table @code
20380 @kindex kvm
20381 @item kvm pcb
20382 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
20383
20384 @item kvm proc
20385 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
20386 modern FreeBSD systems.
20387 @end table
20388
20389 @node SVR4 Process Information
20390 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
20391 @cindex /proc
20392 @cindex examine process image
20393 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
20394
20395 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
20396 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
20397 process using file-system subroutines.
20398
20399 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
20400 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
20401 information about the process running your program, or about any
20402 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
20403 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, but not HP-UX, for example.
20404
20405 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
20406 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
20407
20408 @table @code
20409 @kindex info proc
20410 @cindex process ID
20411 @item info proc
20412 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
20413 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
20414 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
20415 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
20416 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
20417 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
20418 executable file's absolute file name.
20419
20420 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
20421 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
20422 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
20423 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
20424 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
20425 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
20426
20427 @item info proc cmdline
20428 @cindex info proc cmdline
20429 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
20430 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20431
20432 @item info proc cwd
20433 @cindex info proc cwd
20434 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
20435 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20436
20437 @item info proc exe
20438 @cindex info proc exe
20439 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
20440 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20441
20442 @item info proc mappings
20443 @cindex memory address space mappings
20444 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
20445 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
20446 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
20447 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
20448 memory access rights to that range.
20449
20450 @item info proc stat
20451 @itemx info proc status
20452 @cindex process detailed status information
20453 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
20454 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
20455 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
20456 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
20457 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
20458 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
20459 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
20460
20461 @item info proc all
20462 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
20463 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
20464
20465 @ignore
20466 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
20467 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
20468 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
20469 @kindex info proc times
20470 @item info proc times
20471 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
20472 its children.
20473
20474 @kindex info proc id
20475 @item info proc id
20476 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
20477 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
20478 @end ignore
20479
20480 @item set procfs-trace
20481 @kindex set procfs-trace
20482 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
20483 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
20484
20485 @item show procfs-trace
20486 @kindex show procfs-trace
20487 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
20488
20489 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
20490 @kindex set procfs-file
20491 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
20492 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
20493 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
20494 standard output.
20495
20496 @item show procfs-file
20497 @kindex show procfs-file
20498 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
20499
20500 @item proc-trace-entry
20501 @itemx proc-trace-exit
20502 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
20503 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
20504 @kindex proc-trace-entry
20505 @kindex proc-trace-exit
20506 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
20507 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
20508 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
20509 from the @code{syscall} interface.
20510
20511 @item info pidlist
20512 @kindex info pidlist
20513 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
20514 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
20515 processes and all the threads within each process.
20516
20517 @item info meminfo
20518 @kindex info meminfo
20519 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
20520 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
20521 @end table
20522
20523 @node DJGPP Native
20524 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
20525 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
20526 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
20527 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
20528
20529 @cindex DPMI
20530 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
20531 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
20532 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
20533 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
20534
20535 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
20536 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
20537 subsection describes those commands.
20538
20539 @table @code
20540 @kindex info dos
20541 @item info dos
20542 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
20543 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20544
20545 @kindex sysinfo
20546 @cindex MS-DOS system info
20547 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
20548 @item info dos sysinfo
20549 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
20550 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
20551 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
20552
20553 @cindex GDT
20554 @cindex LDT
20555 @cindex IDT
20556 @cindex segment descriptor tables
20557 @cindex descriptor tables display
20558 @item info dos gdt
20559 @itemx info dos ldt
20560 @itemx info dos idt
20561 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
20562 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
20563 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
20564 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
20565 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
20566 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
20567 rights.
20568
20569 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
20570 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
20571 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
20572 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
20573 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
20574
20575 @cindex garbled pointers
20576 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
20577 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
20578 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
20579 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
20580 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
20581 debugged program's data segment:
20582
20583 @smallexample
20584 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
20585 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
20586 @end smallexample
20587
20588 @noindent
20589 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
20590 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
20591
20592 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
20593 @item info dos pde
20594 @itemx info dos pte
20595 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
20596 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
20597 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
20598 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
20599 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
20600 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
20601 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
20602 that is currently in use.
20603
20604 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
20605 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
20606 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
20607 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
20608 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
20609 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
20610 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
20611
20612 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
20613 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
20614 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
20615 controller.
20616
20617 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
20618
20619 @cindex physical address from linear address
20620 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
20621 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
20622 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
20623 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
20624 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
20625 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
20626 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
20627
20628 @smallexample
20629 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
20630 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
20631 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
20632 @end smallexample
20633
20634 @noindent
20635 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
20636 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
20637 attributes of that page.
20638
20639 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
20640 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
20641 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
20642 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
20643 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
20644 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
20645
20646 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
20647 transfer buffer:
20648
20649 @smallexample
20650 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
20651 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
20652 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
20653 @end smallexample
20654
20655 @noindent
20656 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
20657 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
20658 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
20659 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
20660 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
20661
20662 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
20663 @end table
20664
20665 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
20666 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
20667 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
20668 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
20669
20670 @table @code
20671 @kindex set com1base
20672 @kindex set com1irq
20673 @kindex set com2base
20674 @kindex set com2irq
20675 @kindex set com3base
20676 @kindex set com3irq
20677 @kindex set com4base
20678 @kindex set com4irq
20679 @item set com1base @var{addr}
20680 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
20681 port.
20682
20683 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
20684 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
20685 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
20686
20687 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
20688 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
20689 other 3 COM ports.
20690
20691 @kindex show com1base
20692 @kindex show com1irq
20693 @kindex show com2base
20694 @kindex show com2irq
20695 @kindex show com3base
20696 @kindex show com3irq
20697 @kindex show com4base
20698 @kindex show com4irq
20699 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
20700 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
20701 lines used by the COM ports.
20702
20703 @item info serial
20704 @kindex info serial
20705 @cindex DOS serial port status
20706 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
20707 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
20708 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
20709 counts of various errors encountered so far.
20710 @end table
20711
20712
20713 @node Cygwin Native
20714 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
20715 @cindex MS Windows debugging
20716 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
20717 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
20718
20719 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
20720 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
20721
20722 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
20723 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
20724 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
20725 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
20726 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
20727 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
20728 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
20729 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
20730
20731 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
20732 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
20733 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
20734
20735 @table @code
20736 @kindex info w32
20737 @item info w32
20738 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
20739 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20740
20741 @item info w32 selector
20742 This command displays information returned by
20743 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
20744 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
20745 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
20746 Without argument, this command displays information
20747 about the six segment registers.
20748
20749 @item info w32 thread-information-block
20750 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
20751 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
20752 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
20753
20754 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
20755 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
20756 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
20757 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
20758 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
20759 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
20760 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
20761 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
20762 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
20763 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
20764 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
20765
20766 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
20767 @item show cygwin-exceptions
20768 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
20769 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
20770
20771 @kindex set new-console
20772 @item set new-console @var{mode}
20773 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
20774 be started in a new console on next start.
20775 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
20776 be started in the same console as the debugger.
20777
20778 @kindex show new-console
20779 @item show new-console
20780 Displays whether a new console is used
20781 when the debuggee is started.
20782
20783 @kindex set new-group
20784 @item set new-group @var{mode}
20785 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
20786 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
20787 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
20788 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
20789
20790 @kindex show new-group
20791 @item show new-group
20792 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
20793
20794 @kindex set debugevents
20795 @item set debugevents
20796 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
20797 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
20798 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
20799 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
20800 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
20801
20802 @kindex set debugexec
20803 @item set debugexec
20804 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
20805 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
20806
20807 @kindex set debugexceptions
20808 @item set debugexceptions
20809 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
20810 debuggee seen by the debugger.
20811
20812 @kindex set debugmemory
20813 @item set debugmemory
20814 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
20815 and writes by the debugger.
20816
20817 @kindex set shell
20818 @item set shell
20819 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20820 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20821
20822 @kindex show shell
20823 @item show shell
20824 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20825
20826 @end table
20827
20828 @menu
20829 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20830 @end menu
20831
20832 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20833 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20834 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20835 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20836
20837 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20838 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20839 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20840 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20841 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20842 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20843 ``minimal symbols''.
20844
20845 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20846 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20847 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20848 program run once to completion.
20849
20850 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20851
20852 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20853 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20854 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20855 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20856 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20857 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20858 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20859 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20860 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20861
20862 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20863 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20864 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20865 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20866 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20867 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20868
20869 @smallexample
20870 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20871 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20872
20873 Non-debugging symbols:
20874 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20875 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20876 @end smallexample
20877
20878 @smallexample
20879 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20880 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20881
20882 Non-debugging symbols:
20883 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20884 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20885 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20886 [etc...]
20887 @end smallexample
20888
20889 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20890
20891 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20892 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20893 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20894 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20895 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20896 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20897 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20898
20899 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20900 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20901 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20902 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20903 problem:
20904
20905 @smallexample
20906 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20907 $1 = 268572168
20908 @end smallexample
20909
20910 @smallexample
20911 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20912 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20913 @end smallexample
20914
20915 And two possible solutions:
20916
20917 @smallexample
20918 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20919 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20920 @end smallexample
20921
20922 @smallexample
20923 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20924 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20925 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20926 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20927 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20928 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20929 @end smallexample
20930
20931 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20932 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20933 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20934 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20935 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20936
20937 @smallexample
20938 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20939 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20940 @end smallexample
20941
20942 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20943 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20944 safe.
20945
20946 @node Hurd Native
20947 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20948 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20949
20950 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20951 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20952
20953 @table @code
20954 @item set signals
20955 @itemx set sigs
20956 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20957 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20958 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20959 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20960 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20961 @code{signals}.
20962
20963 @item show signals
20964 @itemx show sigs
20965 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20966 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20967 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20968
20969 @item set signal-thread
20970 @itemx set sigthread
20971 @kindex set signal-thread
20972 @kindex set sigthread
20973 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20974 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20975 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20976 signal-thread}.
20977
20978 @item show signal-thread
20979 @itemx show sigthread
20980 @kindex show signal-thread
20981 @kindex show sigthread
20982 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20983 delivered a signal.
20984
20985 @item set stopped
20986 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20987 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20988 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20989 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20990
20991 @item show stopped
20992 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20993 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20994 stopped.
20995
20996 @item set exceptions
20997 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20998 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20999 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21000 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21001 trapping on.
21002
21003 @item show exceptions
21004 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21005 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21006
21007 @item set task pause
21008 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21009 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21010 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21011 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21012 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21013 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21014 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21015 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21016 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21017
21018 @item show task pause
21019 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21020 Show the current state of task suspension.
21021
21022 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21023 @cindex task suspend count
21024 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21025 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21026 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21027
21028 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21029 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21030
21031 @item set task exception-port
21032 @itemx set task excp
21033 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21034 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21035 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21036 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21037
21038 @item set noninvasive
21039 @cindex noninvasive task options
21040 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21041 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21042 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21043 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21044
21045 @item info send-rights
21046 @itemx info receive-rights
21047 @itemx info port-rights
21048 @itemx info port-sets
21049 @itemx info dead-names
21050 @itemx info ports
21051 @itemx info psets
21052 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21053 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21054 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21055 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21056 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21057 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21058 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21059 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21060 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21061
21062 @item set thread pause
21063 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21064 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21065 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21066 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21067 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21068 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21069 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21070 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21071 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21072 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21073 only the current thread.
21074
21075 @item show thread pause
21076 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21077 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21078
21079 @item set thread run
21080 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21081
21082 @item show thread run
21083 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21084
21085 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21086 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21087 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21088 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21089 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21090 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21091 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21092
21093 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21094 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21095 detaching.
21096
21097 @item set thread exception-port
21098 @itemx set thread excp
21099 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21100 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21101 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21102
21103 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21104 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21105 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21106 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21107
21108 @item set thread default
21109 @itemx show thread default
21110 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21111 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21112 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21113 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21114 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21115 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21116 the non-default commands.
21117 @end table
21118
21119 @node Darwin
21120 @subsection Darwin
21121 @cindex Darwin
21122
21123 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21124
21125 @table @code
21126 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21127 @kindex set debug darwin
21128 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21129 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21130
21131 @item show debug darwin
21132 @kindex show debug darwin
21133 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21134
21135 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21136 @kindex set debug mach-o
21137 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21138 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21139 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21140 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21141 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21142 usage.
21143
21144 @item show debug mach-o
21145 @kindex show debug mach-o
21146 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21147
21148 @item set mach-exceptions on
21149 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21150 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21151 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21152 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21153 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21154 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21155
21156 @item show mach-exceptions
21157 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21158 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21159 @end table
21160
21161
21162 @node Embedded OS
21163 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21164
21165 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21166 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21167 architectures.
21168
21169 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21170 various real-time operating systems.
21171
21172 @node Embedded Processors
21173 @section Embedded Processors
21174
21175 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
21176 configurations.
21177
21178 @cindex send command to simulator
21179 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
21180 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
21181
21182 @table @code
21183 @item sim @var{command}
21184 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
21185 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
21186 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
21187 acceptable commands.
21188 @end table
21189
21190
21191 @menu
21192 * ARM:: ARM RDI
21193 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
21194 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
21195 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
21196 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
21197 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
21198 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
21199 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
21200 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
21201 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
21202 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
21203 * CRIS:: CRIS
21204 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
21205 @end menu
21206
21207 @node ARM
21208 @subsection ARM
21209 @cindex ARM RDI
21210
21211 @table @code
21212 @kindex target rdi
21213 @item target rdi @var{dev}
21214 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
21215 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
21216 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
21217
21218 @kindex target rdp
21219 @item target rdp @var{dev}
21220 ARM Demon monitor.
21221
21222 @end table
21223
21224 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
21225
21226 @table @code
21227 @item set arm disassembler
21228 @kindex set arm
21229 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
21230 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
21231
21232 @item show arm disassembler
21233 @kindex show arm
21234 Show the current disassembly style.
21235
21236 @item set arm apcs32
21237 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
21238 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
21239
21240 @item show arm apcs32
21241 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
21242
21243 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
21244 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
21245 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21246
21247 @table @code
21248 @item auto
21249 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
21250 @item softfpa
21251 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
21252 processors.
21253 @item fpa
21254 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
21255 @item softvfp
21256 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
21257 @item vfp
21258 VFP co-processor.
21259 @end table
21260
21261 @item show arm fpu
21262 Show the current type of the FPU.
21263
21264 @item set arm abi
21265 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
21266
21267 @item show arm abi
21268 Show the currently used ABI.
21269
21270 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21271 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
21272 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
21273 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
21274 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
21275 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
21276 register).
21277
21278 @item show arm fallback-mode
21279 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
21280
21281 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21282 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
21283 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
21284 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
21285 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
21286
21287 @item show arm force-mode
21288 Show the current forced instruction mode.
21289
21290 @item set debug arm
21291 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
21292 target support subsystem.
21293
21294 @item show debug arm
21295 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21296 @end table
21297
21298 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
21299 using the RDI interface:
21300
21301 @table @code
21302 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21303 @kindex rdilogfile
21304 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
21305 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
21306 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
21307 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
21308 @file{rdi.log}.
21309
21310 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
21311 @kindex rdilogenable
21312 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
21313 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
21314 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
21315 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
21316 are logged to a file.
21317
21318 @item set rdiromatzero
21319 @kindex set rdiromatzero
21320 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
21321 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
21322 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
21323 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
21324 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
21325
21326 @item show rdiromatzero
21327 @kindex show rdiromatzero
21328 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
21329
21330 @item set rdiheartbeat
21331 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
21332 @cindex RDI heartbeat
21333 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
21334 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
21335 well as the Angel monitor.
21336
21337 @item show rdiheartbeat
21338 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
21339 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
21340 @end table
21341
21342 @table @code
21343 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21344 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
21345
21346 @table @code
21347 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
21348 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
21349 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
21350 The default value is @code{all}.
21351
21352 @table @code
21353 @item none
21354 @item demon
21355 @item angel
21356 @item redboot
21357 @item all
21358 @end table
21359 @end table
21360 @end table
21361
21362 @node M32R/D
21363 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
21364
21365 @table @code
21366 @kindex target m32r
21367 @item target m32r @var{dev}
21368 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
21369
21370 @kindex target m32rsdi
21371 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
21372 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
21373 @end table
21374
21375 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
21376
21377 @table @code
21378 @item set download-path @var{path}
21379 @kindex set download-path
21380 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
21381 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21382
21383 @item show download-path
21384 @kindex show download-path
21385 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21386
21387 @item set board-address @var{addr}
21388 @kindex set board-address
21389 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
21390 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
21391
21392 @item show board-address
21393 @kindex show board-address
21394 Show the current IP address of the target board.
21395
21396 @item set server-address @var{addr}
21397 @kindex set server-address
21398 @cindex download server address (M32R)
21399 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
21400 host machine.
21401
21402 @item show server-address
21403 @kindex show server-address
21404 Display the IP address of the download server.
21405
21406 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21407 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
21408 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
21409 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
21410 executable file is uploaded.
21411
21412 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21413 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
21414 Test the @code{upload} command.
21415 @end table
21416
21417 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
21418
21419 @table @code
21420 @item sdireset
21421 @kindex sdireset
21422 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
21423 This command resets the SDI connection.
21424
21425 @item sdistatus
21426 @kindex sdistatus
21427 This command shows the SDI connection status.
21428
21429 @item debug_chaos
21430 @kindex debug_chaos
21431 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
21432 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
21433
21434 @item use_debug_dma
21435 @kindex use_debug_dma
21436 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
21437
21438 @item use_mon_code
21439 @kindex use_mon_code
21440 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
21441
21442 @item use_ib_break
21443 @kindex use_ib_break
21444 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
21445
21446 @item use_dbt_break
21447 @kindex use_dbt_break
21448 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
21449 @end table
21450
21451 @node M68K
21452 @subsection M68k
21453
21454 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
21455 target command for the following ROM monitor.
21456
21457 @table @code
21458
21459 @kindex target dbug
21460 @item target dbug @var{dev}
21461 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
21462
21463 @end table
21464
21465 @node MicroBlaze
21466 @subsection MicroBlaze
21467 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
21468 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
21469
21470 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
21471 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
21472 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
21473 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
21474 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
21475 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
21476 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
21477 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
21478 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
21479 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
21480 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
21481
21482 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
21483
21484 @table @code
21485 @item target remote :1234
21486 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
21487 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
21488
21489 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
21490 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
21491 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
21492
21493 @item load
21494 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
21495
21496 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
21497 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
21498
21499 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
21500 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
21501 @end table
21502
21503 @node MIPS Embedded
21504 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
21505
21506 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
21507 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
21508 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
21509 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
21510
21511 @need 1000
21512 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
21513
21514 @table @code
21515 @item target mips @var{port}
21516 @kindex target mips @var{port}
21517 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
21518 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
21519 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
21520 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
21521 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
21522 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
21523
21524 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
21525 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
21526 debugger:
21527
21528 @smallexample
21529 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
21530 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
21531 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
21532 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
21533 (@value{GDBP}) run
21534 @end smallexample
21535
21536 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
21537 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
21538 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
21539 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
21540 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
21541
21542 @item target pmon @var{port}
21543 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
21544 PMON ROM monitor.
21545
21546 @item target ddb @var{port}
21547 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
21548 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
21549
21550 @item target lsi @var{port}
21551 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
21552 LSI variant of PMON.
21553
21554 @kindex target r3900
21555 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
21556 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
21557
21558 @kindex target array
21559 @item target array @var{dev}
21560 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
21561
21562 @end table
21563
21564
21565 @noindent
21566 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
21567
21568 @table @code
21569 @item set mipsfpu double
21570 @itemx set mipsfpu single
21571 @itemx set mipsfpu none
21572 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
21573 @itemx show mipsfpu
21574 @kindex set mipsfpu
21575 @kindex show mipsfpu
21576 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
21577 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
21578 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
21579 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
21580 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
21581 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
21582 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
21583 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
21584 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
21585 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
21586 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
21587 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
21588 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
21589
21590 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
21591 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
21592 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
21593
21594 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
21595 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
21596
21597 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
21598 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
21599 @itemx show timeout
21600 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
21601 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21602 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21603 @kindex set timeout
21604 @kindex show timeout
21605 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
21606 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
21607 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
21608 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
21609 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
21610 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
21611 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
21612 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
21613 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
21614 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
21615
21616 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
21617 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
21618 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
21619 to run before stopping.
21620
21621 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
21622 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21623 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
21624 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
21625 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
21626 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
21627
21628 @item show syn-garbage-limit
21629 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21630 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
21631 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
21632
21633 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
21634 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21635 @cindex remote monitor prompt
21636 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
21637 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
21638 @table @asis
21639 @item pmon target
21640 @samp{PMON}
21641 @item ddb target
21642 @samp{NEC010}
21643 @item lsi target
21644 @samp{PMON>}
21645 @end table
21646
21647 @item show monitor-prompt
21648 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21649 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
21650 remote monitor.
21651
21652 @item set monitor-warnings
21653 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21654 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21655 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21656 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21657 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21658
21659 @item show monitor-warnings
21660 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21661 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21662
21663 @item pmon @var{command}
21664 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21665 @cindex send PMON command
21666 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21667 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21668 @end table
21669
21670 @node PowerPC Embedded
21671 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21672
21673 @cindex DVC register
21674 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21675 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21676
21677 @smallexample
21678 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21679 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21680 @end smallexample
21681
21682 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21683 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21684 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21685 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21686 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21687 or newer.
21688
21689 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21690 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21691 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21692 watching variables of scalar types.
21693
21694 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21695 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21696
21697 @smallexample
21698 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21699 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21700 @end smallexample
21701
21702 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21703 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21704
21705 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21706 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21707 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21708 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21709 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21710 use the @code{break-range} command.
21711
21712 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21713
21714 @table @code
21715 @kindex break-range
21716 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21717 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21718 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21719 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21720 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21721 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21722 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21723 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21724 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21725
21726 @kindex set powerpc
21727 @item set powerpc soft-float
21728 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21729 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21730 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21731 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21732
21733 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21734 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21735 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21736 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21737 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21738 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21739 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21740 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21741
21742 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21743 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21744 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21745 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21746 address of its first byte.
21747
21748 @kindex target dink32
21749 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21750 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21751
21752 @kindex target ppcbug
21753 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21754 @kindex target ppcbug1
21755 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21756 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21757
21758 @kindex target sds
21759 @item target sds @var{dev}
21760 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21761 @end table
21762
21763 @cindex SDS protocol
21764 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21765 by @value{GDBN}:
21766
21767 @table @code
21768 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21769 @kindex set sdstimeout
21770 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21771 default is 2 seconds.
21772
21773 @item show sdstimeout
21774 @kindex show sdstimeout
21775 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21776
21777 @item sds @var{command}
21778 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21779 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21780 @end table
21781
21782
21783 @node PA
21784 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21785
21786 @table @code
21787
21788 @kindex target op50n
21789 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21790 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21791
21792 @kindex target w89k
21793 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21794 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21795
21796 @end table
21797
21798 @node Sparclet
21799 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21800
21801 @cindex Sparclet
21802
21803 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21804 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21805 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21806 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21807 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21808
21809 @table @code
21810 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21811 @kindex remotetimeout
21812 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21813 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21814 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21815 @end table
21816
21817 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21818 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21819 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21820 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21821 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21822
21823 @smallexample
21824 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21825 @end smallexample
21826
21827 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21828
21829 @smallexample
21830 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21831 @end smallexample
21832
21833 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21834 Once you have set
21835 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21836 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21837 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21838
21839 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21840
21841 @smallexample
21842 (gdbslet)
21843 @end smallexample
21844
21845 @menu
21846 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21847 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21848 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21849 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21850 @end menu
21851
21852 @node Sparclet File
21853 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21854
21855 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21856
21857 @smallexample
21858 (gdbslet) file prog
21859 @end smallexample
21860
21861 @need 1000
21862 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21863 @value{GDBN} locates
21864 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21865 path.
21866 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21867 files will be searched as well.
21868 @value{GDBN} locates
21869 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21870 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21871 If it fails
21872 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21873
21874 @smallexample
21875 prog: No such file or directory.
21876 @end smallexample
21877
21878 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21879 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21880 @code{target} command again.
21881
21882 @node Sparclet Connection
21883 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21884
21885 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21886 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21887
21888 @smallexample
21889 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21890 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21891 main () at ../prog.c:3
21892 @end smallexample
21893
21894 @need 750
21895 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21896
21897 @smallexample
21898 Connected to ttya.
21899 @end smallexample
21900
21901 @node Sparclet Download
21902 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21903
21904 @cindex download to Sparclet
21905 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21906 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21907 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21908 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21909 command.
21910 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21911 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21912 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21913 of each of the file's sections.
21914 For instance, if the program
21915 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21916 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21917
21918 @smallexample
21919 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21920 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21921 @end smallexample
21922
21923 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21924 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21925 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21926
21927 @node Sparclet Execution
21928 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21929
21930 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21931 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21932 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21933 manual for the list of commands.
21934
21935 @smallexample
21936 (gdbslet) b main
21937 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21938 (gdbslet) run
21939 Starting program: prog
21940 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21941 3 char *symarg = 0;
21942 (gdbslet) step
21943 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21944 (gdbslet)
21945 @end smallexample
21946
21947 @node Sparclite
21948 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21949
21950 @table @code
21951
21952 @kindex target sparclite
21953 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21954 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21955 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21956 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21957 remote protocol.
21958
21959 @end table
21960
21961 @node Z8000
21962 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21963
21964 @cindex Z8000
21965 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21966 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21967
21968 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21969 a Z8000 simulator.
21970
21971 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21972 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21973 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21974 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21975
21976 @table @code
21977 @item target sim @var{args}
21978 @kindex sim
21979 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21980 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21981 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21982 @end table
21983
21984 @noindent
21985 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21986 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21987 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21988 to run your program, and so on.
21989
21990 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21991 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21992 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21993
21994 @table @code
21995
21996 @item cycles
21997 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21998
21999 @item insts
22000 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
22001
22002 @item time
22003 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
22004
22005 @end table
22006
22007 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
22008 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
22009 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
22010 simulated clock ticks.
22011
22012 @node AVR
22013 @subsection Atmel AVR
22014 @cindex AVR
22015
22016 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22017 following AVR-specific commands:
22018
22019 @table @code
22020 @item info io_registers
22021 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22022 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22023 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22024 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22025 @end table
22026
22027 @node CRIS
22028 @subsection CRIS
22029 @cindex CRIS
22030
22031 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22032 following CRIS-specific commands:
22033
22034 @table @code
22035 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22036 @cindex CRIS version
22037 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22038 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22039 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22040
22041 @item show cris-version
22042 Show the current CRIS version.
22043
22044 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22045 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22046 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22047 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22048 @code{R59}.
22049
22050 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22051 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22052
22053 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22054 @cindex CRIS mode
22055 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22056 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22057 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22058
22059 @item show cris-mode
22060 Show the current CRIS mode.
22061 @end table
22062
22063 @node Super-H
22064 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22065 @cindex Super-H
22066
22067 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22068 commands:
22069
22070 @table @code
22071 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22072 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22073 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22074 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22075 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22076 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22077 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22078 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22079 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22080 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22081 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22082 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22083
22084 @item show sh calling-convention
22085 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22086 Show the current calling convention setting.
22087
22088 @end table
22089
22090
22091 @node Architectures
22092 @section Architectures
22093
22094 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22095 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22096
22097 @menu
22098 * AArch64::
22099 * i386::
22100 * Alpha::
22101 * MIPS::
22102 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22103 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22104 * PowerPC::
22105 * Nios II::
22106 @end menu
22107
22108 @node AArch64
22109 @subsection AArch64
22110 @cindex AArch64 support
22111
22112 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22113 following special commands:
22114
22115 @table @code
22116 @item set debug aarch64
22117 @kindex set debug aarch64
22118 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22119 messages are to be displayed.
22120
22121 @item show debug aarch64
22122 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22123
22124 @end table
22125
22126 @node i386
22127 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22128
22129 @table @code
22130 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22131 @kindex set struct-convention
22132 @cindex struct return convention
22133 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22134 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22135 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22136 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22137 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22138 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22139 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22140 be returned in a register.
22141
22142 @item show struct-convention
22143 @kindex show struct-convention
22144 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22145 from functions.
22146 @end table
22147
22148
22149 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22150 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22151
22152 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22153 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22154 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22155 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22156 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22157 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22158 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22159
22160 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22161 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22162 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22163 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22164 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22165 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22166
22167 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22168 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22169 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22170
22171 @smallexample
22172 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22173 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22174 @end smallexample
22175
22176 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22177 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22178 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22179 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22180 the pointer.
22181
22182 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22183 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22184 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22185 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22186 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22187
22188 @table @code
22189 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22190 @kindex show mpx bound
22191 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22192
22193 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22194 @kindex set mpx bound
22195 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22196 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22197 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22198 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22199 @end table
22200
22201 @node Alpha
22202 @subsection Alpha
22203
22204 See the following section.
22205
22206 @node MIPS
22207 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22208
22209 @cindex stack on Alpha
22210 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22211 @cindex Alpha stack
22212 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22213 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22214 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22215 find the beginning of a function.
22216
22217 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22218 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22219 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22220 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22221 commands:
22222
22223 @table @code
22224 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22225 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22226 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22227 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22228 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22229 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22230 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22231 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22232
22233 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22234 Display the current limit.
22235 @end table
22236
22237 @noindent
22238 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22239 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22240
22241 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22242 programs:
22243
22244 @table @code
22245 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22246 @kindex set mips abi
22247 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22248 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22249 values of @var{arg} are:
22250
22251 @table @samp
22252 @item auto
22253 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22254 default).
22255 @item o32
22256 @item o64
22257 @item n32
22258 @item n64
22259 @item eabi32
22260 @item eabi64
22261 @end table
22262
22263 @item show mips abi
22264 @kindex show mips abi
22265 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22266
22267 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22268 @kindex set mips compression
22269 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22270 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22271 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22272 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22273 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22274 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22275 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22276 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22277 provided by the executable.
22278
22279 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22280 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22281 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22282 identified as such.
22283
22284 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22285 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22286 implicitly from an executable.
22287
22288 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22289 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22290 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22291 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22292 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22293
22294 @item show mips compression
22295 @kindex show mips compression
22296 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22297 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22298
22299 @item set mipsfpu
22300 @itemx show mipsfpu
22301 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22302
22303 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22304 @kindex set mips mask-address
22305 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22306 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22307 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22308 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22309 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22310
22311 @item show mips mask-address
22312 @kindex show mips mask-address
22313 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22314 not.
22315
22316 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22317 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22318 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22319 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22320 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22321 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22322
22323 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22324 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22325 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22326
22327 @item set debug mips
22328 @kindex set debug mips
22329 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22330 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22331
22332 @item show debug mips
22333 @kindex show debug mips
22334 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22335 @end table
22336
22337
22338 @node HPPA
22339 @subsection HPPA
22340 @cindex HPPA support
22341
22342 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22343 following special commands:
22344
22345 @table @code
22346 @item set debug hppa
22347 @kindex set debug hppa
22348 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22349 messages are to be displayed.
22350
22351 @item show debug hppa
22352 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22353
22354 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22355 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22356 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22357 given @var{address}.
22358
22359 @end table
22360
22361
22362 @node SPU
22363 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22364 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22365 @cindex SPU
22366
22367 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22368 it provides the following special commands:
22369
22370 @table @code
22371 @item info spu event
22372 @kindex info spu
22373 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22374 and pending event status.
22375
22376 @item info spu signal
22377 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22378 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22379 notification channels.
22380
22381 @item info spu mailbox
22382 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22383 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22384 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22385
22386 @item info spu dma
22387 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22388 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22389 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22390
22391 @item info spu proxydma
22392 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22393 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22394 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22395
22396 @end table
22397
22398 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22399 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22400 special commands:
22401
22402 @table @code
22403 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22404 @kindex set spu
22405 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22406 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22407 function. The default is @code{off}.
22408
22409 @item show spu stop-on-load
22410 @kindex show spu
22411 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22412
22413 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22414 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22415 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22416 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22417 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22418 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22419
22420 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22421 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22422
22423 @end table
22424
22425 @node PowerPC
22426 @subsection PowerPC
22427 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22428
22429 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22430 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22431 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22432 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22433 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22434
22435 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22436 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22437 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22438
22439 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22440 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22441
22442 @node Nios II
22443 @subsection Nios II
22444 @cindex Nios II architecture
22445
22446 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22447 it provides the following special commands:
22448
22449 @table @code
22450
22451 @item set debug nios2
22452 @kindex set debug nios2
22453 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22454 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22455
22456 @item show debug nios2
22457 @kindex show debug nios2
22458 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22459 @end table
22460
22461 @node Controlling GDB
22462 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22463
22464 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22465 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22466 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22467 described here.
22468
22469 @menu
22470 * Prompt:: Prompt
22471 * Editing:: Command editing
22472 * Command History:: Command history
22473 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22474 * Numbers:: Numbers
22475 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22476 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22477 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22478 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22479 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22480 @end menu
22481
22482 @node Prompt
22483 @section Prompt
22484
22485 @cindex prompt
22486
22487 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22488 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22489 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22490 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22491 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22492 which one you are talking to.
22493
22494 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22495 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22496 or a prompt that does not.
22497
22498 @table @code
22499 @kindex set prompt
22500 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22501 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22502
22503 @kindex show prompt
22504 @item show prompt
22505 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22506 @end table
22507
22508 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22509 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22510 are:
22511
22512 @table @code
22513 @kindex set extended-prompt
22514 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22515 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22516 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22517 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22518 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22519 is displayed.
22520
22521 For example:
22522
22523 @smallexample
22524 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22525 @end smallexample
22526
22527 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22528 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22529
22530 @kindex show extended-prompt
22531 @item show extended-prompt
22532 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22533 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22534 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22535 @end table
22536
22537 @node Editing
22538 @section Command Editing
22539 @cindex readline
22540 @cindex command line editing
22541
22542 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22543 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22544 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22545 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22546 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22547 debugging sessions.
22548
22549 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22550 command @code{set}.
22551
22552 @table @code
22553 @kindex set editing
22554 @cindex editing
22555 @item set editing
22556 @itemx set editing on
22557 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22558
22559 @item set editing off
22560 Disable command line editing.
22561
22562 @kindex show editing
22563 @item show editing
22564 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22565 @end table
22566
22567 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22568 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22569 @end ifset
22570 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22571 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22572 @end ifclear
22573 for more details about the Readline
22574 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22575 encouraged to read that chapter.
22576
22577 @node Command History
22578 @section Command History
22579 @cindex command history
22580
22581 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22582 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22583 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22584 history facility.
22585
22586 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22587 package, to provide the history facility.
22588 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22589 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22590 @end ifset
22591 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22592 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22593 @end ifclear
22594 for the detailed description of the History library.
22595
22596 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22597 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22598 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22599 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22600 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22601 pressed on a line by itself.
22602
22603 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22604 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22605 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22606 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22607
22608 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22609 history.
22610
22611 @table @code
22612 @cindex history substitution
22613 @cindex history file
22614 @kindex set history filename
22615 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22616 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22617 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22618 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22619 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22620 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22621 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22622 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22623 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22624 is not set.
22625
22626 @cindex save command history
22627 @kindex set history save
22628 @item set history save
22629 @itemx set history save on
22630 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22631 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22632
22633 @item set history save off
22634 Stop recording command history in a file.
22635
22636 @cindex history size
22637 @kindex set history size
22638 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22639 @item set history size @var{size}
22640 @itemx set history size unlimited
22641 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22642 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
22643 @code{GDBHISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
22644 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
22645 history list is unlimited.
22646 @end table
22647
22648 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22649 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22650 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22651 @end ifset
22652 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22653 @xref{Event Designators},
22654 @end ifclear
22655 for more details.
22656
22657 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22658 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22659 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22660 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22661 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22662 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22663 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22664 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22665
22666 The commands to control history expansion are:
22667
22668 @table @code
22669 @item set history expansion on
22670 @itemx set history expansion
22671 @kindex set history expansion
22672 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22673
22674 @item set history expansion off
22675 Disable history expansion.
22676
22677 @c @group
22678 @kindex show history
22679 @item show history
22680 @itemx show history filename
22681 @itemx show history save
22682 @itemx show history size
22683 @itemx show history expansion
22684 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22685 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22686 @c @end group
22687 @end table
22688
22689 @table @code
22690 @kindex show commands
22691 @cindex show last commands
22692 @cindex display command history
22693 @item show commands
22694 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22695
22696 @item show commands @var{n}
22697 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22698
22699 @item show commands +
22700 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22701 @end table
22702
22703 @node Screen Size
22704 @section Screen Size
22705 @cindex size of screen
22706 @cindex screen size
22707 @cindex pagination
22708 @cindex page size
22709 @cindex pauses in output
22710
22711 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22712 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22713 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22714 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22715 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22716 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22717 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22718 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22719
22720 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22721 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22722 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22723 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22724 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22725 width} commands:
22726
22727 @table @code
22728 @kindex set height
22729 @kindex set width
22730 @kindex show width
22731 @kindex show height
22732 @item set height @var{lpp}
22733 @itemx set height unlimited
22734 @itemx show height
22735 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22736 @itemx set width unlimited
22737 @itemx show width
22738 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22739 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22740 commands display the current settings.
22741
22742 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22743 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22744 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22745 buffer.
22746
22747 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22748 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22749
22750 @item set pagination on
22751 @itemx set pagination off
22752 @kindex set pagination
22753 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22754 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22755 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22756 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22757
22758 @item show pagination
22759 @kindex show pagination
22760 Show the current pagination mode.
22761 @end table
22762
22763 @node Numbers
22764 @section Numbers
22765 @cindex number representation
22766 @cindex entering numbers
22767
22768 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22769 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22770 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22771 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22772 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22773 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22774 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22775 both input and output with the commands described below.
22776
22777 @table @code
22778 @kindex set input-radix
22779 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22780 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22781 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22782 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22783 example, any of
22784
22785 @smallexample
22786 set input-radix 012
22787 set input-radix 10.
22788 set input-radix 0xa
22789 @end smallexample
22790
22791 @noindent
22792 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22793 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22794 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22795 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22796 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22797 change the radix.
22798
22799 @kindex set output-radix
22800 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22801 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22802 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22803 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22804
22805 @kindex show input-radix
22806 @item show input-radix
22807 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22808
22809 @kindex show output-radix
22810 @item show output-radix
22811 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22812
22813 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22814 @itemx show radix
22815 @kindex set radix
22816 @kindex show radix
22817 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22818 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22819 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22820 default value of 10.
22821
22822 @end table
22823
22824 @node ABI
22825 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22826
22827 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22828 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22829 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22830 current ABI.
22831
22832 @cindex OS ABI
22833 @kindex set osabi
22834 @kindex show osabi
22835 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22836
22837 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22838 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22839 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22840 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22841 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22842 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22843 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22844 platform provides.
22845
22846 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22847 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22848 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22849 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22850
22851 @table @code
22852 @item show osabi
22853 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22854
22855 @item set osabi
22856 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22857
22858 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22859 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22860 @end table
22861
22862 @cindex float promotion
22863
22864 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22865 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22866 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22867 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22868 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22869 @code{double} and then passed.
22870
22871 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22872 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22873 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22874
22875 @table @code
22876 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22877 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22878 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22879 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22880 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22881
22882 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22883 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22884 functions.
22885
22886 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22887 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22888 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22889 @end table
22890
22891 @kindex set cp-abi
22892 @kindex show cp-abi
22893 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22894 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22895 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22896 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22897 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22898 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22899 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22900 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22901 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22902 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22903 ``auto''.
22904
22905 @table @code
22906 @item show cp-abi
22907 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22908
22909 @item set cp-abi
22910 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22911
22912 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22913 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22914 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22915 @end table
22916
22917 @node Auto-loading
22918 @section Automatically loading associated files
22919 @cindex auto-loading
22920
22921 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22922 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22923 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22924 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22925 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22926 sources).
22927
22928 @menu
22929 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22930 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22931
22932 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22933 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22934 @end menu
22935
22936 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22937 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22938 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22939
22940 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22941 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22942 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22943
22944 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22945 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22946
22947 @table @code
22948 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22949 @kindex set auto-load off
22950 @item set auto-load off
22951 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22952 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22953 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22954 @smallexample
22955 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22956 @end smallexample
22957
22958 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22959 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22960 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22961 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22962 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22963 @code{set auto-load no}.
22964
22965 @anchor{show auto-load}
22966 @kindex show auto-load
22967 @item show auto-load
22968 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22969 or disabled.
22970
22971 @smallexample
22972 (gdb) show auto-load
22973 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22974 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22975 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22976 is on.
22977 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22978 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22979 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22980 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22981 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22982 @end smallexample
22983
22984 @anchor{info auto-load}
22985 @kindex info auto-load
22986 @item info auto-load
22987 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22988 not.
22989
22990 @smallexample
22991 (gdb) info auto-load
22992 gdb-scripts:
22993 Loaded Script
22994 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22995 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22996 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22997 loaded.
22998 python-scripts:
22999 Loaded Script
23000 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23001 @end smallexample
23002 @end table
23003
23004 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23005
23006 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23007 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23008 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23009 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23010 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23011 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23012 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23013 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23014 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23015 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23016 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23017 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23018 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23019 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23020 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23021 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23022 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23023 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23024 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23025 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23026 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23027 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23028 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23029 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23030 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23031 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23032 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23033 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23034 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23035 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23036 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23037 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23038 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23039 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23040 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23041 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23042 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23043 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23044 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23045 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23046 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23047 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23048 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23049 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23050 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23051 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23052 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23053 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23054 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23055 @end multitable
23056
23057 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23058 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23059 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23060
23061 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23062 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23063 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23064
23065 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23066 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23067
23068 @table @code
23069 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23070 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23071 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23072 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23073 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23074
23075 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23076 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23077 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23078 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23079 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23080
23081 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23082 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23083 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23084 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23085 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23086 @end table
23087
23088 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23089 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23090 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23091
23092 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23093
23094 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23095 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23096
23097 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23098 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23099 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23100 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23101 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23102 library.
23103
23104 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23105 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23106
23107 @table @code
23108 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23109 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23110 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23111 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23112
23113 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23114 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23115 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23116 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23117 enabled or disabled.
23118
23119 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23120 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23121 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23122 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23123 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23124 @end table
23125
23126 @node Auto-loading safe path
23127 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23128 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23129
23130 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23131 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23132 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23133 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23134 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23135
23136 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23137 get loaded:
23138
23139 @smallexample
23140 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23141 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23142 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23143 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23144 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23145 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23146 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23147 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23148 @end smallexample
23149
23150 @noindent
23151 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23152 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23153
23154 @smallexample
23155 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23156 @end smallexample
23157
23158 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23159
23160 @table @code
23161 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23162 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23163 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23164 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23165 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23166 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23167 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23168 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23169 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23170 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23171
23172 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23173 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23174 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23175
23176 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23177 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23178 @item show auto-load safe-path
23179 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23180 scripts.
23181
23182 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23183 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23184 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23185 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23186 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23187 by the host platform path separator in use.
23188 @end table
23189
23190 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23191 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23192 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23193 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23194 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23195
23196 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23197 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23198 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23199 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23200 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23201 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23202 init file in the current directory
23203 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23204
23205 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23206 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23207
23208 @table @asis
23209 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23210 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23211 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23212 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23213
23214 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23215 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23216 @value{GDBN} session.
23217
23218 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23219 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23220 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23221 from trusted sources.
23222
23223 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23224 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23225 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23226 trusted sources.
23227 @end table
23228
23229 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23230 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23231
23232 @table @asis
23233 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23234 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23235
23236 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23237 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23238 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23239 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23240 @end table
23241
23242 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23243 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23244 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23245 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23246 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23247 recommended to be entered.
23248
23249 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23250 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23251 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23252
23253 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23254 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23255 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23256 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23257 be printed.
23258
23259 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23260 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23261 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23262
23263 @smallexample
23264 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23265 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23266 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23267 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23268 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23269 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23270 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23271 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23272 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23273 @end smallexample
23274
23275 @table @code
23276 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23277 @kindex set debug auto-load
23278 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23279 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23280
23281 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23282 @kindex show debug auto-load
23283 @item show debug auto-load
23284 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23285 on or off.
23286 @end table
23287
23288 @node Messages/Warnings
23289 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23290
23291 @cindex verbose operation
23292 @cindex optional warnings
23293 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23294 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23295 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23296 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23297
23298 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23299 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23300 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23301
23302 @table @code
23303 @kindex set verbose
23304 @item set verbose on
23305 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23306
23307 @item set verbose off
23308 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23309
23310 @kindex show verbose
23311 @item show verbose
23312 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23313 @end table
23314
23315 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23316 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23317 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23318 Symbol Files}).
23319
23320 @table @code
23321
23322 @kindex set complaints
23323 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23324 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23325 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23326 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23327 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23328
23329 @kindex show complaints
23330 @item show complaints
23331 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23332
23333 @end table
23334
23335 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23336 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23337 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23338 you try to run a program which is already running:
23339
23340 @smallexample
23341 (@value{GDBP}) run
23342 The program being debugged has been started already.
23343 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23344 @end smallexample
23345
23346 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23347 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23348
23349 @table @code
23350
23351 @kindex set confirm
23352 @cindex flinching
23353 @cindex confirmation
23354 @cindex stupid questions
23355 @item set confirm off
23356 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23357 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23358 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23359
23360 @item set confirm on
23361 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23362
23363 @kindex show confirm
23364 @item show confirm
23365 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23366
23367 @end table
23368
23369 @cindex command tracing
23370 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23371 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23372 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23373 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23374
23375 @table @code
23376 @kindex set trace-commands
23377 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23378 @item set trace-commands on
23379 Enable command tracing.
23380 @item set trace-commands off
23381 Disable command tracing.
23382 @item show trace-commands
23383 Display the current state of command tracing.
23384 @end table
23385
23386 @node Debugging Output
23387 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23388 @cindex optional debugging messages
23389
23390 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23391 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23392 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23393 section documents those commands.
23394
23395 @table @code
23396 @kindex set exec-done-display
23397 @item set exec-done-display
23398 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23399 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23400 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23401 @kindex show exec-done-display
23402 @item show exec-done-display
23403 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23404 notification.
23405 @kindex set debug
23406 @cindex ARM AArch64
23407 @item set debug aarch64
23408 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23409 The default is off.
23410 @kindex show debug
23411 @item show debug aarch64
23412 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23413 ARM AArch64.
23414 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23415 @cindex architecture debugging info
23416 @item set debug arch
23417 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23418 @item show debug arch
23419 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23420 @item set debug aix-solib
23421 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23422 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23423 support module. The default is off.
23424 @item show debug aix-thread
23425 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23426 @item set debug aix-thread
23427 @cindex AIX threads
23428 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23429 module.
23430 @item show debug aix-thread
23431 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23432 @item set debug check-physname
23433 @cindex physname
23434 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23435 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23436 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23437 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23438 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23439 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23440 @item show debug check-physname
23441 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23442 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23443 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23444 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23445 exported symbols. The default is off.
23446 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23447 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23448 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23449 @item set debug dwarf-die
23450 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23451 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23452 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23453 A value of zero turns off the display.
23454 @item show debug dwarf-die
23455 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23456 @item set debug dwarf-line
23457 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23458 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23459 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23460 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23461 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23462 @item show debug dwarf-line
23463 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23464 @item set debug dwarf-read
23465 @cindex DWARF Reading
23466 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23467 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23468 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23469 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23470 @item show debug dwarf-read
23471 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23472 @item set debug displaced
23473 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23474 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23475 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23476 @item show debug displaced
23477 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23478 related to displaced stepping.
23479 @item set debug event
23480 @cindex event debugging info
23481 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23482 default is off.
23483 @item show debug event
23484 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23485 info.
23486 @item set debug expression
23487 @cindex expression debugging info
23488 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23489 expression parsing. The default is off.
23490 @item show debug expression
23491 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23492 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23493 @item set debug frame
23494 @cindex frame debugging info
23495 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23496 default is off.
23497 @item show debug frame
23498 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23499 info.
23500 @item set debug gnu-nat
23501 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23502 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23503 @item show debug gnu-nat
23504 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23505 @item set debug infrun
23506 @cindex inferior debugging info
23507 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23508 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23509 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23510 @item show debug infrun
23511 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23512 @item set debug jit
23513 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23514 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23515 @item show debug jit
23516 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23517 @item set debug lin-lwp
23518 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23519 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23520 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23521 @item show debug lin-lwp
23522 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23523 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23524 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23525 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23526 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23527 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23528 @item set debug mach-o
23529 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23530 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23531 processing. The default is off.
23532 @item show debug mach-o
23533 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23534 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23535 @item set debug notification
23536 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23537 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23538 The default is off.
23539 @item show debug notification
23540 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23541 @item set debug observer
23542 @cindex observer debugging info
23543 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23544 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23545 @item show debug observer
23546 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23547 @item set debug overload
23548 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23549 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23550 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23551 is off.
23552 @item show debug overload
23553 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23554 debugging info.
23555 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23556 @cindex debug expression parser
23557 @item set debug parser
23558 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23559 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23560 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23561 details. The default is off.
23562 @item show debug parser
23563 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23564 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23565 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23566 @cindex debug remote protocol
23567 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23568 @cindex display remote packets
23569 @item set debug remote
23570 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23571 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23572 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23573 @item show debug remote
23574 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23575 @item set debug serial
23576 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23577 default is off.
23578 @item show debug serial
23579 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23580 info.
23581 @item set debug solib-frv
23582 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23583 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23584 @item show debug solib-frv
23585 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23586 messages.
23587 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23588 @cindex symbol lookup
23589 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23590 The default is 0 (off).
23591 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23592 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23593 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23594 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23595 @item set debug symfile
23596 @cindex symbol file functions
23597 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23598 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23599 @item show debug symfile
23600 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23601 @item set debug symtab-create
23602 @cindex symbol table creation
23603 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23604 The default is 0 (off).
23605 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23606 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23607 @item show debug symtab-create
23608 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23609 @item set debug target
23610 @cindex target debugging info
23611 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23612 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23613 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23614 value of large memory transfers.
23615 @item show debug target
23616 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23617 info.
23618 @item set debug timestamp
23619 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23620 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23621 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23622 message.
23623 @item show debug timestamp
23624 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23625 debugging info.
23626 @item set debug varobj
23627 @cindex variable object debugging info
23628 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23629 info. The default is off.
23630 @item show debug varobj
23631 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23632 debugging info.
23633 @item set debug xml
23634 @cindex XML parser debugging
23635 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23636 @item show debug xml
23637 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23638 @end table
23639
23640 @node Other Misc Settings
23641 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23642 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23643
23644 @table @code
23645 @kindex set interactive-mode
23646 @item set interactive-mode
23647 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23648 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23649 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23650 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23651 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23652 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23653 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23654 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23655
23656 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23657 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23658 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23659 inside a cygwin window.
23660
23661 @kindex show interactive-mode
23662 @item show interactive-mode
23663 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23664 @end table
23665
23666 @node Extending GDB
23667 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23668 @cindex extending GDB
23669
23670 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23671 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23672 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23673 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23674 being debugged.
23675
23676 @menu
23677 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23678 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23679 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23680 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23681 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23682 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23683 @end menu
23684
23685 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23686 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23687 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23688 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23689 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23690 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23691
23692 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23693 setting:
23694
23695 @table @code
23696 @kindex set script-extension
23697 @kindex show script-extension
23698 @item set script-extension off
23699 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23700
23701 @item set script-extension soft
23702 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23703 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23704 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23705 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23706
23707 @item set script-extension strict
23708 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23709 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23710 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23711
23712 @item show script-extension
23713 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23714
23715 @end table
23716
23717 @node Sequences
23718 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23719
23720 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23721 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23722 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23723 files.
23724
23725 @menu
23726 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23727 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23728 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23729 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23730 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23731 @end menu
23732
23733 @node Define
23734 @subsection User-defined Commands
23735
23736 @cindex user-defined command
23737 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23738 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23739 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23740 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23741 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23742 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23743
23744 @smallexample
23745 define adder
23746 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23747 end
23748 @end smallexample
23749
23750 @noindent
23751 To execute the command use:
23752
23753 @smallexample
23754 adder 1 2 3
23755 @end smallexample
23756
23757 @noindent
23758 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23759 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23760 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23761 functions calls.
23762
23763 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23764 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23765 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23766 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23767
23768 @smallexample
23769 define adder
23770 if $argc == 2
23771 print $arg0 + $arg1
23772 end
23773 if $argc == 3
23774 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23775 end
23776 end
23777 @end smallexample
23778
23779 @table @code
23780
23781 @kindex define
23782 @item define @var{commandname}
23783 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23784 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23785 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23786 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23787 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23788 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23789
23790 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23791 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23792 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23793
23794 @kindex document
23795 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23796 @item document @var{commandname}
23797 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23798 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23799 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23800 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23801 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23802 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23803
23804 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23805 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23806 does not change the documentation.
23807
23808 @kindex dont-repeat
23809 @cindex don't repeat command
23810 @item dont-repeat
23811 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23812 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23813 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23814
23815 @kindex help user-defined
23816 @item help user-defined
23817 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23818 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23819 included (if any).
23820
23821 @kindex show user
23822 @item show user
23823 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23824 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23825 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23826 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23827 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23828
23829 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23830 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23831 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23832 @item show max-user-call-depth
23833 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23834 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23835 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23836 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23837 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23838 @end table
23839
23840 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23841 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23842
23843 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23844 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23845 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23846
23847 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23848 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23849 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23850 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23851
23852 @node Hooks
23853 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23854 @cindex command hooks
23855 @cindex hooks, for commands
23856 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23857
23858 @kindex hook
23859 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23860 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23861 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23862 before that command.
23863
23864 @cindex hooks, post-command
23865 @kindex hookpost
23866 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23867 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23868 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23869 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23870 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23871
23872 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23873 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23874
23875 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23876 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23877
23878 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23879 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23880 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23881 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23882 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23883
23884 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23885 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23886 you could define:
23887
23888 @smallexample
23889 define hook-stop
23890 handle SIGALRM nopass
23891 end
23892
23893 define hook-run
23894 handle SIGALRM pass
23895 end
23896
23897 define hook-continue
23898 handle SIGALRM pass
23899 end
23900 @end smallexample
23901
23902 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23903 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23904 you could define:
23905
23906 @smallexample
23907 define hook-echo
23908 echo <<<---
23909 end
23910
23911 define hookpost-echo
23912 echo --->>>\n
23913 end
23914
23915 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23916 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23917 (@value{GDBP})
23918
23919 @end smallexample
23920
23921 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23922 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23923 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23924 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23925 @c or not?
23926 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23927 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23928 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23929
23930 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23931 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23932 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23933
23934 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23935 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23936
23937 @node Command Files
23938 @subsection Command Files
23939
23940 @cindex command files
23941 @cindex scripting commands
23942 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23943 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23944 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23945 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23946 terminal.
23947
23948 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23949 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23950 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23951 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23952 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23953
23954 @table @code
23955 @kindex source
23956 @cindex execute commands from a file
23957 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23958 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23959 @end table
23960
23961 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23962 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23963 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23964 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23965 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23966
23967 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23968 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23969 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23970 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23971 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23972 is not relevant to scripts.
23973
23974 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23975 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23976 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23977 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23978 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23979 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23980 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23981 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23982 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23983 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23984 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23985 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23986 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23987 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23988
23989 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23990 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23991 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23992
23993 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23994 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23995 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23996 when called from command files.
23997
23998 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23999 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24000 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24001 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24002 the next command.
24003
24004 @smallexample
24005 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24006 @end smallexample
24007
24008 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24009 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24010 would be directed to @file{log}.
24011
24012 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24013 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24014 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24015 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24016 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24017 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24018 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24019 conditionally, etc.
24020
24021 @table @code
24022 @kindex if
24023 @kindex else
24024 @item if
24025 @itemx else
24026 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24027 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24028 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24029 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24030 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24031 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24032 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24033
24034 @kindex while
24035 @item while
24036 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24037 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24038 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24039 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24040 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24041 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24042
24043 @kindex loop_break
24044 @item loop_break
24045 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24046 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24047 line.
24048
24049 @kindex loop_continue
24050 @item loop_continue
24051 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24052 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24053 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24054 the controlling expression.
24055
24056 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24057 @item end
24058 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24059 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24060 @end table
24061
24062
24063 @node Output
24064 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24065
24066 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24067 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24068 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24069 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24070 want.
24071
24072 @table @code
24073 @kindex echo
24074 @item echo @var{text}
24075 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24076 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24077 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24078 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24079 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24080 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24081 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24082 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24083 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24084 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24085 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24086
24087 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24088 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24089
24090 @smallexample
24091 echo This is some text\n\
24092 which is continued\n\
24093 onto several lines.\n
24094 @end smallexample
24095
24096 produces the same output as
24097
24098 @smallexample
24099 echo This is some text\n
24100 echo which is continued\n
24101 echo onto several lines.\n
24102 @end smallexample
24103
24104 @kindex output
24105 @item output @var{expression}
24106 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24107 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24108 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24109 on expressions.
24110
24111 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24112 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24113 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24114 Formats}, for more information.
24115
24116 @kindex printf
24117 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24118 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24119 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24120 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24121 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24122 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24123 executing the code below:
24124
24125 @smallexample
24126 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24127 @end smallexample
24128
24129 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24130 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24131 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24132 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24133 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24134 printed.
24135
24136 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24137
24138 @smallexample
24139 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24140 @end smallexample
24141
24142 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24143 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24144 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24145
24146 @itemize @bullet
24147 @item
24148 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24149
24150 @item
24151 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24152 width.
24153
24154 @item
24155 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24156 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24157
24158 @item
24159 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24160 supported.
24161
24162 @item
24163 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24164
24165 @item
24166 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24167 @end itemize
24168
24169 @noindent
24170 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24171 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24172 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24173 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24174
24175 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24176 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24177 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24178 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24179 supported.
24180
24181 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24182 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24183 together with a floating point specifier.
24184 letters:
24185
24186 @itemize @bullet
24187 @item
24188 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24189
24190 @item
24191 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24192
24193 @item
24194 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24195 @end itemize
24196
24197 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24198 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24199 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24200
24201 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24202 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24203
24204 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24205 @smallexample
24206 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24207 @end smallexample
24208
24209 @kindex eval
24210 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24211 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24212 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24213
24214 @end table
24215
24216 @node Auto-loading sequences
24217 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24218 @cindex native script auto-loading
24219
24220 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24221 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24222 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24223 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24224
24225 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24226 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24227
24228 @table @code
24229 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24230 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24231 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24232 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24233
24234 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24235 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24236 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24237 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24238 disabled.
24239
24240 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24241 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24242 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24243 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24244 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24245 auto-loaded.
24246 @end table
24247
24248 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24249 matching names are printed.
24250
24251 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24252 @include python.texi
24253
24254 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24255 @include guile.texi
24256
24257 @node Auto-loading extensions
24258 @section Auto-loading extensions
24259 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24260
24261 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24262 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24263 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24264 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24265 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24266
24267 @menu
24268 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24269 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24270 * Which flavor to choose?::
24271 @end menu
24272
24273 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24274 debugging commands and features.
24275
24276 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24277 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24278 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24279 for more information.
24280 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24281 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24282
24283 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24284 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24285
24286 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24287 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24288 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24289 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24290 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24291
24292 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24293 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24294 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24295 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24296
24297 @table @code
24298 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24299 GDB's own command language
24300 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24301 Python
24302 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24303 Guile
24304 @end table
24305
24306 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24307 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24308 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24309 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24310 script in the specified extension language.
24311
24312 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24313 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24314
24315 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24316 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24317
24318 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24319 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24320 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24321 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24322 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24323 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24324
24325 @table @code
24326 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24327 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24328 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24329 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24330 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24331 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24332
24333 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24334 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24335
24336 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24337 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24338 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24339 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24340
24341 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24342 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24343 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24344 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24345 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24346 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24347 platform.
24348
24349 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24350 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24351 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24352
24353 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24354 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24355 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24356 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24357
24358 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24359 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24360 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24361 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24362 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24363 @end table
24364
24365 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24366 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24367 @var{objfile} is opened.
24368 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24369 is evaluated more than once.
24370
24371 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24372 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24373 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24374
24375 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24376 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24377 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24378 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24379 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24380 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24381 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24382
24383 The following entries are supported:
24384
24385 @table @code
24386 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24387 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24388 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24389 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24390 @end table
24391
24392 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24393
24394 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24395 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24396 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24397 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24398 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24399
24400 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24401 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24402
24403 @example
24404 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24405 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24406 asm("\
24407 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24408 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24409 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24410 .popsection \n\
24411 ");
24412 @end example
24413
24414 @noindent
24415 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24416 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24417
24418 @example
24419 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24420 @end example
24421
24422 The script name may include directories if desired.
24423
24424 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24425 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24426
24427 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24428 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24429 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24430 will remove duplicates.
24431
24432 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24433
24434 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24435 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24436 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24437 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24438 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24439 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24440 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24441 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24442 on its name.
24443
24444 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24445 testsuite.
24446
24447 @example
24448 #include "symcat.h"
24449 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24450 asm(
24451 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24452 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24453 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24454 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24455 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24456 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24457 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24458 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24459 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24460 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24461 ".byte 0\n"
24462 ".popsection\n"
24463 );
24464 @end example
24465
24466 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24467 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24468 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24469 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24470
24471 @node Which flavor to choose?
24472 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24473
24474 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24475 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24476
24477 @noindent
24478 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24479
24480 @itemize @bullet
24481 @item
24482 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24483
24484 @item
24485 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24486
24487 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24488 in the source search path.
24489 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24490 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24491
24492 @item
24493 Doesn't require source code additions.
24494 @end itemize
24495
24496 @noindent
24497 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24498
24499 @itemize @bullet
24500 @item
24501 Works with static linking.
24502
24503 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24504 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24505 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24506 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24507 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24508
24509 @item
24510 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24511
24512 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24513 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24514
24515 @item
24516 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24517
24518 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24519 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24520 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24521 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24522 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24523 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24524 @end itemize
24525
24526 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24527 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24528
24529 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24530 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24531 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24532
24533 @subsection Python comes first
24534
24535 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24536 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24537 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24538 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24539 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24540 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24541 pretty-printed form of a value).
24542 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24543 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24544 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24545
24546 @node Aliases
24547 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24548 @cindex aliases for commands
24549
24550 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24551 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24552 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24553 that involves less typing.
24554
24555 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24556 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24557 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24558
24559 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24560 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24561 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24562
24563 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24564
24565 @table @code
24566
24567 @kindex alias
24568 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24569
24570 @end table
24571
24572 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24573 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24574 underscores.
24575
24576 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24577 that is being aliased.
24578
24579 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24580 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24581 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24582
24583 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24584 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24585
24586 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24587 of a command so that there is less to type.
24588 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24589 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24590 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24591 The following will accomplish this.
24592
24593 @smallexample
24594 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24595 @end smallexample
24596
24597 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24598 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24599 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24600 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24601
24602 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24603 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24604 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24605 of a command.
24606
24607 @smallexample
24608 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24609 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24610 (gdb) set p elms 20
24611 (gdb) show p elms
24612 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24613 @end smallexample
24614
24615 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24616 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24617 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24618
24619 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24620 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24621
24622 @smallexample
24623 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24624 @end smallexample
24625
24626 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24627 alias for a more complex command.
24628 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24629
24630 @smallexample
24631 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24632 (gdb) spe 20
24633 @end smallexample
24634
24635 @node Interpreters
24636 @chapter Command Interpreters
24637 @cindex command interpreters
24638
24639 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24640 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24641 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24642
24643 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24644 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24645 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24646 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24647
24648 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24649 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24650 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24651 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24652
24653 @table @code
24654 @item console
24655 @cindex console interpreter
24656 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24657 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24658 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24659
24660 @item mi
24661 @cindex mi interpreter
24662 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24663 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24664 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24665 Interface}.
24666
24667 @item mi2
24668 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24669 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24670
24671 @item mi1
24672 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24673 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24674
24675 @end table
24676
24677 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24678 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24679 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24680 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24681 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24682 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24683 the IDE inoperable!
24684
24685 @kindex interpreter-exec
24686 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24687 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24688 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24689 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24690
24691 @smallexample
24692 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24693 @end smallexample
24694
24695 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24696 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24697
24698 @node TUI
24699 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24700 @cindex TUI
24701 @cindex Text User Interface
24702
24703 @menu
24704 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24705 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24706 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24707 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24708 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24709 @end menu
24710
24711 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24712 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24713 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24714 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24715 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24716 is available.
24717
24718 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24719 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24720 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24721 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
24722 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands} and
24723 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24724
24725 @node TUI Overview
24726 @section TUI Overview
24727
24728 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24729
24730 @table @emph
24731 @item command
24732 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24733 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24734 managed using readline.
24735
24736 @item source
24737 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24738 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24739
24740 @item assembly
24741 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24742
24743 @item register
24744 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24745 when their values change.
24746 @end table
24747
24748 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24749 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24750 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24751 indicates the breakpoint type:
24752
24753 @table @code
24754 @item B
24755 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24756
24757 @item b
24758 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24759
24760 @item H
24761 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24762
24763 @item h
24764 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24765 @end table
24766
24767 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24768
24769 @table @code
24770 @item +
24771 Breakpoint is enabled.
24772
24773 @item -
24774 Breakpoint is disabled.
24775 @end table
24776
24777 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24778 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24779 changes.
24780
24781 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24782 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24783 layouts:
24784
24785 @itemize @bullet
24786 @item
24787 source only,
24788
24789 @item
24790 assembly only,
24791
24792 @item
24793 source and assembly,
24794
24795 @item
24796 source and registers, or
24797
24798 @item
24799 assembly and registers.
24800 @end itemize
24801
24802 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24803
24804 @table @emph
24805 @item target
24806 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24807 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24808
24809 @item process
24810 Gives the current process or thread number.
24811 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24812
24813 @item function
24814 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24815 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24816 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24817 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24818
24819 @item line
24820 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24821 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24822
24823 @item pc
24824 Indicates the current program counter address.
24825 @end table
24826
24827 @node TUI Keys
24828 @section TUI Key Bindings
24829 @cindex TUI key bindings
24830
24831 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24832 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24833 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24834 @end ifset
24835 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24836 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24837 @end ifclear
24838 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24839 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24840
24841 @table @kbd
24842 @kindex C-x C-a
24843 @item C-x C-a
24844 @kindex C-x a
24845 @itemx C-x a
24846 @kindex C-x A
24847 @itemx C-x A
24848 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24849 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24850 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24851 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24852 The screen is then refreshed.
24853
24854 @kindex C-x 1
24855 @item C-x 1
24856 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24857 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24858 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24859
24860 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24861
24862 @kindex C-x 2
24863 @item C-x 2
24864 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24865 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24866 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24867 previous layout and the new one.
24868
24869 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24870
24871 @kindex C-x o
24872 @item C-x o
24873 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24874 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24875 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24876
24877 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24878
24879 @kindex C-x s
24880 @item C-x s
24881 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24882 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24883 @end table
24884
24885 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24886
24887 @table @asis
24888 @kindex PgUp
24889 @item @key{PgUp}
24890 Scroll the active window one page up.
24891
24892 @kindex PgDn
24893 @item @key{PgDn}
24894 Scroll the active window one page down.
24895
24896 @kindex Up
24897 @item @key{Up}
24898 Scroll the active window one line up.
24899
24900 @kindex Down
24901 @item @key{Down}
24902 Scroll the active window one line down.
24903
24904 @kindex Left
24905 @item @key{Left}
24906 Scroll the active window one column left.
24907
24908 @kindex Right
24909 @item @key{Right}
24910 Scroll the active window one column right.
24911
24912 @kindex C-L
24913 @item @kbd{C-L}
24914 Refresh the screen.
24915 @end table
24916
24917 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24918 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24919 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24920 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24921 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24922
24923 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24924 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24925 @cindex TUI single key mode
24926
24927 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24928 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24929 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24930
24931 @table @kbd
24932 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24933 @item c
24934 continue
24935
24936 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24937 @item d
24938 down
24939
24940 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24941 @item f
24942 finish
24943
24944 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24945 @item n
24946 next
24947
24948 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24949 @item q
24950 exit the SingleKey mode.
24951
24952 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24953 @item r
24954 run
24955
24956 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24957 @item s
24958 step
24959
24960 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24961 @item u
24962 up
24963
24964 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24965 @item v
24966 info locals
24967
24968 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24969 @item w
24970 where
24971 @end table
24972
24973 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24974 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24975 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24976 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24977 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24978 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24979
24980
24981 @node TUI Commands
24982 @section TUI-specific Commands
24983 @cindex TUI commands
24984
24985 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24986 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24987 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24988 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24989
24990 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24991 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24992 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24993 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24994 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24995
24996 @table @code
24997 @item tui enable
24998 @kindex tui enable
24999 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25000 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25001 otherwise a default layout is used.
25002
25003 @item tui disable
25004 @kindex tui disable
25005 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25006
25007 @item info win
25008 @kindex info win
25009 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25010
25011 @item layout next
25012 @kindex layout
25013 Display the next layout.
25014
25015 @item layout prev
25016 Display the previous layout.
25017
25018 @item layout src
25019 Display the source window only.
25020
25021 @item layout asm
25022 Display the assembly window only.
25023
25024 @item layout split
25025 Display the source and assembly window.
25026
25027 @item layout regs
25028 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
25029
25030 @item focus next
25031 @kindex focus
25032 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25033
25034 @item focus prev
25035 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25036
25037 @item focus src
25038 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25039
25040 @item focus asm
25041 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25042
25043 @item focus regs
25044 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25045
25046 @item focus cmd
25047 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25048
25049 @item refresh
25050 @kindex refresh
25051 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25052
25053 @item tui reg @var{group}
25054 @kindex tui reg
25055 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25056 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25057 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25058 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25059 following groups are available on most targets:
25060 @table @code
25061 @item next
25062 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25063 through all of the available register groups.
25064
25065 @item prev
25066 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25067 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25068 @var{next}.
25069
25070 @item general
25071 Display the general registers.
25072 @item float
25073 Display the floating point registers.
25074 @item system
25075 Display the system registers.
25076 @item vector
25077 Display the vector registers.
25078 @item all
25079 Display all registers.
25080 @end table
25081
25082 @item update
25083 @kindex update
25084 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25085
25086 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25087 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25088 @kindex winheight
25089 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25090 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25091 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25092 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25093 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25094
25095 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25096 @kindex tabset
25097 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25098 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25099 assembly windows.
25100 @end table
25101
25102 @node TUI Configuration
25103 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25104 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25105
25106 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25107
25108 @table @code
25109 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25110 @kindex set tui border-kind
25111 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25112 The possible values are the following:
25113 @table @code
25114 @item space
25115 Use a space character to draw the border.
25116
25117 @item ascii
25118 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25119
25120 @item acs
25121 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25122 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25123 @end table
25124
25125 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25126 @kindex set tui border-mode
25127 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25128 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25129 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25130 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25131 @table @code
25132 @item normal
25133 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25134
25135 @item standout
25136 Use standout mode.
25137
25138 @item reverse
25139 Use reverse video mode.
25140
25141 @item half
25142 Use half bright mode.
25143
25144 @item half-standout
25145 Use half bright and standout mode.
25146
25147 @item bold
25148 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25149
25150 @item bold-standout
25151 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25152 @end table
25153 @end table
25154
25155 @node Emacs
25156 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25157
25158 @cindex Emacs
25159 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25160 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25161 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25162 @value{GDBN}.
25163
25164 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25165 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25166 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25167 created Emacs buffer.
25168 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25169
25170 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25171 things:
25172
25173 @itemize @bullet
25174 @item
25175 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25176 the GUD buffer.
25177
25178 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25179 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25180
25181 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25182 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25183 in this way.
25184
25185 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25186 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25187 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25188 stop.
25189
25190 @item
25191 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25192
25193 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25194 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25195 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25196 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25197 and the source.
25198
25199 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25200 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25201 @end itemize
25202
25203 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25204 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25205 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25206 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25207
25208 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25209 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25210 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25211 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25212 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25213 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25214 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25215 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25216 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25217
25218 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25219 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25220 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25221 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25222
25223 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25224 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25225 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25226 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25227 one you want.
25228
25229 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25230 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25231
25232 @table @kbd
25233 @item C-h m
25234 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25235
25236 @item C-c C-s
25237 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25238 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25239
25240 @item C-c C-n
25241 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25242 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25243 to show the current file and location.
25244
25245 @item C-c C-i
25246 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25247 display window accordingly.
25248
25249 @item C-c C-f
25250 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25251 @code{finish} command.
25252
25253 @item C-c C-r
25254 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25255 command.
25256
25257 @item C-c <
25258 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25259 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25260 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25261
25262 @item C-c >
25263 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25264 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25265 @end table
25266
25267 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25268 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25269
25270 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25271 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25272 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25273 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25274 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25275 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25276 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25277
25278 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25279 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25280 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25281 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25282 frame.
25283
25284 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25285 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25286 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25287 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25288 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25289 to correspond properly with the code.
25290
25291 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25292 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25293 Emacs Manual}).
25294
25295 @node GDB/MI
25296 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25297
25298 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25299
25300 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25301 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25302 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25303 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25304 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25305 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25306
25307 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25308 in the form of a reference manual.
25309
25310 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25311 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25312 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25313
25314 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25315
25316 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25317 This chapter uses the following notation:
25318
25319 @itemize @bullet
25320 @item
25321 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25322
25323 @item
25324 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25325 it may or may not be given.
25326
25327 @item
25328 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25329 may repeat zero or more times.
25330
25331 @item
25332 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25333 may repeat one or more times.
25334
25335 @item
25336 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25337 @end itemize
25338
25339 @ignore
25340 @heading Dependencies
25341 @end ignore
25342
25343 @menu
25344 * GDB/MI General Design::
25345 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25346 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25347 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25348 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25349 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25350 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25351 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25352 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25353 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25354 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25355 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25356 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25357 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25358 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25359 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25360 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25361 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25362 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25363 @ignore
25364 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25365 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25366 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25367 @end ignore
25368 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25369 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25370 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25371 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25372 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25373 @end menu
25374
25375 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25376 @node GDB/MI General Design
25377 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25378 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25379
25380 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25381 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25382 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25383 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25384 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25385 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25386 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25387 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25388 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25389 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25390
25391 The important examples of notifications are:
25392 @itemize @bullet
25393
25394 @item
25395 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25396 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25397 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25398 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25399 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25400 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25401 command itself was successfully executed.
25402
25403 @item
25404 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25405 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25406 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25407 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25408 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25409 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25410
25411 @item
25412 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25413 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25414 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25415 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25416 orthogonal frontend design.
25417
25418 @end itemize
25419
25420 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25421 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25422 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25423 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25424 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25425 the user interface.
25426
25427
25428 @menu
25429 * Context management::
25430 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25431 * Thread groups::
25432 @end menu
25433
25434 @node Context management
25435 @subsection Context management
25436
25437 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25438
25439 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25440 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25441 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25442 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25443 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25444 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25445 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25446 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25447 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25448
25449 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25450 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25451 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25452 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25453 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25454 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25455 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25456 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25457 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25458 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
25459 for thread and frame to operate on.
25460
25461 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25462 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25463 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25464 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25465 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25466 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25467 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25468 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25469 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25470 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25471
25472 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25473 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25474 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25475 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25476 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25477 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25478 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25479 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25480 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25481 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25482 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25483 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25484 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25485 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25486 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25487 @samp{--frame} options.
25488
25489 @subsubsection Language
25490
25491 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25492 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25493 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25494 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25495 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25496 For instance:
25497
25498 @smallexample
25499 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25500 ^done,value="4"
25501 (gdb)
25502 @end smallexample
25503
25504 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25505 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25506 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25507
25508 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25509 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25510
25511 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25512 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25513 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25514 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25515 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25516 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25517 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25518 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25519 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25520
25521 @table @code
25522 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25523 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25524 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25525
25526 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25527 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25528 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25529
25530 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25531 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25532 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25533 MI commands even while the target is running.
25534
25535 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25536 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25537 @end table
25538
25539 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25540 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25541 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25542 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25543 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25544 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25545
25546 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25547 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25548 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25549 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25550 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25551 are running.
25552
25553 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25554 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25555 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25556 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25557 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25558 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25559 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25560 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25561 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25562 @samp{--thread} option).
25563
25564 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25565 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25566 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25567 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25568
25569 @node Thread groups
25570 @subsection Thread groups
25571 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25572 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25573 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25574 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25575 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25576
25577 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25578 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25579 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25580 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25581 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25582 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25583 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25584 into processes.
25585
25586 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25587 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25588 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25589 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25590 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25591 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25592 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25593 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25594 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25595 the members of specific thread group.
25596
25597 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25598 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25599 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25600 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25601 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25602 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25603 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25604 after attaching to that thread group.
25605
25606 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25607 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25608 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25609 such thread groups.
25610
25611 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25612 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25613 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25614
25615 @menu
25616 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25617 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25618 @end menu
25619
25620 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25621 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25622
25623 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25624 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25625 @table @code
25626 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25627 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25628
25629 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25630 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25631 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25632
25633 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25634 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25635 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25636
25637 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25638 "any sequence of digits"
25639
25640 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25641 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25642
25643 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25644 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25645
25646 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25647 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25648
25649 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25650 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25651 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25652
25653 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25654 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25655
25656 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25657 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25658 @end table
25659
25660 @noindent
25661 Notes:
25662
25663 @itemize @bullet
25664 @item
25665 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25666 output is described below.
25667
25668 @item
25669 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25670 finishes.
25671
25672 @item
25673 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25674 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25675 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25676 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25677 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25678 @end itemize
25679
25680 Pragmatics:
25681
25682 @itemize @bullet
25683 @item
25684 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25685
25686 @item
25687 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25688 @end itemize
25689
25690 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25691 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25692
25693 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25694 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25695 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25696 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25697 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25698 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25699
25700 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25701 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25702 @var{token}.
25703
25704 @table @code
25705 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25706 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25707
25708 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25709 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25710
25711 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25712 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25713
25714 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25715 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25716
25717 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25718 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25719
25720 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25721 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25722
25723 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25724 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25725
25726 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25727 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25728
25729 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25730 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25731
25732 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25733 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25734 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25735
25736 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25737 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25738
25739 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25740 @code{ @var{string} }
25741
25742 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25743 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25744
25745 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25746 @code{@var{c-string}}
25747
25748 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25749 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25750
25751 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25752 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25753 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25754
25755 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25756 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25757
25758 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25759 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25760
25761 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25762 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25763
25764 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25765 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25766
25767 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25768 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25769
25770 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25771 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25772 @end table
25773
25774 @noindent
25775 Notes:
25776
25777 @itemize @bullet
25778 @item
25779 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25780
25781 @item
25782 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25783 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25784 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25785 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25786 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25787 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25788 prior command.
25789
25790 @item
25791 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25792 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25793 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25794 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25795
25796 @item
25797 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25798 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25799 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25800 @samp{*}.
25801
25802 @item
25803 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25804 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25805 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25806 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25807
25808 @item
25809 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25810 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25811 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25812 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25813
25814 @item
25815 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25816 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25817 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25818
25819 @item
25820 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25821 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25822 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25823 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25824
25825 @item
25826 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25827 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25828 @var{values}.
25829
25830
25831 @end itemize
25832
25833 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25834 details about the various output records.
25835
25836 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25837 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25838 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25839
25840 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25841 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25842
25843 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25844 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25845 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25846 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25847 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25848 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25849
25850 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25851 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25852 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25853
25854 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25855 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25856 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25857 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25858
25859 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25860 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25861
25862 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25863 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25864 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25865 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25866 might change.
25867
25868 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25869 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25870 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25871 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25872
25873 @itemize @bullet
25874 @item
25875 New MI commands may be added.
25876
25877 @item
25878 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25879
25880 @item
25881 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25882 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25883
25884 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25885 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25886
25887 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25888 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25889 @end itemize
25890
25891 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25892 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25893 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25894 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25895 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25896
25897 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25898 @c version?
25899
25900 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25901 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25902 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25903 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25904 @cindex mailing lists
25905
25906 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25907 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25908 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25909
25910 @menu
25911 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25912 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25913 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25914 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25915 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25916 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25917 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25918 @end menu
25919
25920 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25921 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25922
25923 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25924 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25925 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25926 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25927
25928 @table @code
25929 @findex ^done
25930 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25931 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25932 values.
25933
25934 @item "^running"
25935 @findex ^running
25936 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25937 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25938 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25939 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25940 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25941 which threads are resumed.
25942
25943 @item "^connected"
25944 @findex ^connected
25945 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25946
25947 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25948 @findex ^error
25949 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25950 the corresponding error message.
25951
25952 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25953 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25954 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25955
25956 @table @samp
25957 @item "undefined-command"
25958 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25959 @end table
25960
25961 @item "^exit"
25962 @findex ^exit
25963 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25964
25965 @end table
25966
25967 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25968 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25969
25970 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25971 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25972 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25973 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25974 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25975
25976 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25977 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25978 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25979 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25980 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25981
25982 @table @code
25983 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25984 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25985 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25986
25987 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25988 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25989 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25990 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25991
25992 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25993 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25994 internals.
25995 @end table
25996
25997 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25998 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25999
26000 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26001 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26002 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26003 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26004 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26005 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26006
26007 The following is the list of possible async records:
26008
26009 @table @code
26010
26011 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26012 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
26013 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
26014 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
26015 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
26016 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
26017 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
26018 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
26019 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
26020 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
26021
26022 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26023 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26024 following values:
26025
26026 @table @code
26027 @item breakpoint-hit
26028 A breakpoint was reached.
26029 @item watchpoint-trigger
26030 A watchpoint was triggered.
26031 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26032 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26033 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26034 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26035 @item function-finished
26036 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26037 @item location-reached
26038 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26039 @item watchpoint-scope
26040 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26041 @item end-stepping-range
26042 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26043 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26044 @item exited-signalled
26045 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26046 @item exited
26047 The inferior exited.
26048 @item exited-normally
26049 The inferior exited normally.
26050 @item signal-received
26051 A signal was received by the inferior.
26052 @item solib-event
26053 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26054 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26055 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26056 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26057 @item fork
26058 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26059 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26060 @item vfork
26061 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26062 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26063 @item syscall-entry
26064 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26065 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26066 @item syscall-return
26067 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26068 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26069 @item exec
26070 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26071 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26072 @end table
26073
26074 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
26075 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
26076 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26077 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26078 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26079 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26080 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26081 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26082 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26083 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26084 if such information is not available.
26085
26086 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26087 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26088 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26089 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26090 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26091 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26092 cannot be used in any way.
26093
26094 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26095 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26096 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26097 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26098 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26099 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26100
26101 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26102 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26103 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26104 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26105 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26106 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26107
26108 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26109 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26110 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26111 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26112 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26113
26114 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26115 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26116 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26117 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26118 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26119 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26120 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26121
26122 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26123 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26124 that thread.
26125
26126 @item =library-loaded,...
26127 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26128 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26129 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26130 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26131 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26132 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26133 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26134 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26135 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26136 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26137 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26138 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26139 thread groups.
26140
26141 @item =library-unloaded,...
26142 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26143 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26144 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26145 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26146 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26147 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26148 thread groups.
26149
26150 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26151 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26152 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26153 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26154 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26155
26156 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26157 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26158 initial value @var{initial}.
26159
26160 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26161 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26162 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26163 trace state variables are deleted.
26164
26165 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26166 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26167 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26168 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26169 value of trace state variable is known.
26170
26171 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26172 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26173 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26174 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26175 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26176 user.
26177
26178 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26179 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26180 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26181
26182 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26183 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26184
26185 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
26186 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26187 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26188 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26189 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26190
26191 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26192 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26193 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26194 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26195 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26196 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26197
26198 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26199 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26200 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26201 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26202 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26203 executable code.
26204 @end table
26205
26206 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26207 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26208
26209 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26210 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26211 following fields:
26212
26213 @table @code
26214 @item number
26215 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26216 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26217 @samp{1.2}.
26218
26219 @item type
26220 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26221 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26222
26223 @item catch-type
26224 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26225 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26226
26227 @item disp
26228 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26229 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26230 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26231
26232 @item enabled
26233 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26234 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26235 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26236
26237 @item addr
26238 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26239 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26240 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26241 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26242 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26243
26244 @item func
26245 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26246 If not known, this field is not present.
26247
26248 @item filename
26249 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26250 If not known, this field is not present.
26251
26252 @item fullname
26253 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26254 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26255
26256 @item line
26257 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26258 If not known, this field is not present.
26259
26260 @item at
26261 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26262 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26263 by a symbol name.
26264
26265 @item pending
26266 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26267 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26268
26269 @item evaluated-by
26270 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26271 @samp{target}.
26272
26273 @item thread
26274 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26275 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26276
26277 @item task
26278 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26279 field will hold the task identifier.
26280
26281 @item cond
26282 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26283
26284 @item ignore
26285 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26286
26287 @item enable
26288 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26289
26290 @item traceframe-usage
26291 FIXME.
26292
26293 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26294 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26295
26296 @item mask
26297 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26298
26299 @item pass
26300 A tracepoint's pass count.
26301
26302 @item original-location
26303 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26304 This field is optional.
26305
26306 @item times
26307 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26308
26309 @item installed
26310 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26311 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26312 is not.
26313
26314 @item what
26315 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26316
26317 @end table
26318
26319 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26320 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26321
26322 @smallexample
26323 -> -break-insert main
26324 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26325 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26326 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26327 times="0"@}
26328 <- (gdb)
26329 @end smallexample
26330
26331 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26332 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26333
26334 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26335 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26336 fields:
26337
26338 @table @code
26339 @item level
26340 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26341 zero. This field is always present.
26342
26343 @item func
26344 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26345 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26346
26347 @item addr
26348 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26349
26350 @item file
26351 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26352 address. This field may be absent.
26353
26354 @item line
26355 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26356 may be absent.
26357
26358 @item from
26359 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26360 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26361
26362 @end table
26363
26364 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26365 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26366
26367 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26368 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26369
26370 @table @code
26371 @item id
26372 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26373 always present.
26374
26375 @item target-id
26376 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26377
26378 @item details
26379 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26380 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26381 frontend. This field is optional.
26382
26383 @item state
26384 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26385 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26386
26387 @item core
26388 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26389 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26390 @end table
26391
26392 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26393 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26394
26395 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26396 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26397 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26398 the @code{exception-name} field.
26399
26400 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26401 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26402 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26403 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26404
26405 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26406 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26407 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26408 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26409
26410 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26411 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26412
26413 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26414
26415 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26416 information of the breakpoint.
26417
26418 @smallexample
26419 -> -break-insert main
26420 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26421 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26422 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26423 times="0"@}
26424 <- (gdb)
26425 @end smallexample
26426
26427 @subheading Program Execution
26428
26429 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26430 reason that execution stopped.
26431
26432 @smallexample
26433 -> -exec-run
26434 <- ^running
26435 <- (gdb)
26436 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26437 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26438 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26439 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26440 <- (gdb)
26441 -> -exec-continue
26442 <- ^running
26443 <- (gdb)
26444 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26445 <- (gdb)
26446 @end smallexample
26447
26448 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26449
26450 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26451
26452 @smallexample
26453 -> (gdb)
26454 <- -gdb-exit
26455 <- ^exit
26456 @end smallexample
26457
26458 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26459 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26460 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26461 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26462 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26463 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26464
26465 @subheading A Bad Command
26466
26467 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26468
26469 @smallexample
26470 -> -rubbish
26471 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26472 <- (gdb)
26473 @end smallexample
26474
26475
26476 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26477 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26478 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26479
26480 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26481 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26482
26483 @subheading Motivation
26484
26485 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26486
26487 @subheading Introduction
26488
26489 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26490
26491 @subheading Commands
26492
26493 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26494
26495 @subsubheading Synopsis
26496
26497 @smallexample
26498 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26499 @end smallexample
26500
26501 @subsubheading Result
26502
26503 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26504
26505 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26506
26507 @subsubheading Example
26508
26509 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26510 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26511
26512
26513 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26514 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26515 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26516
26517 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26518 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26519 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26520 breakpoints.
26521
26522 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26523 @findex -break-after
26524
26525 @subsubheading Synopsis
26526
26527 @smallexample
26528 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26529 @end smallexample
26530
26531 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26532 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26533 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26534 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26535
26536 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26537
26538 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26539
26540 @subsubheading Example
26541
26542 @smallexample
26543 (gdb)
26544 -break-insert main
26545 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26546 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26547 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26548 times="0"@}
26549 (gdb)
26550 -break-after 1 3
26551 ~
26552 ^done
26553 (gdb)
26554 -break-list
26555 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26556 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26557 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26558 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26559 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26560 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26561 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26562 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26563 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26564 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26565 (gdb)
26566 @end smallexample
26567
26568 @ignore
26569 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26570 @findex -break-catch
26571 @end ignore
26572
26573 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26574 @findex -break-commands
26575
26576 @subsubheading Synopsis
26577
26578 @smallexample
26579 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26580 @end smallexample
26581
26582 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26583 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26584 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26585 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26586 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26587 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26588
26589 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26590
26591 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26592
26593 @subsubheading Example
26594
26595 @smallexample
26596 (gdb)
26597 -break-insert main
26598 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26599 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26600 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26601 times="0"@}
26602 (gdb)
26603 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26604 ^done
26605 (gdb)
26606 @end smallexample
26607
26608 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26609 @findex -break-condition
26610
26611 @subsubheading Synopsis
26612
26613 @smallexample
26614 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26615 @end smallexample
26616
26617 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26618 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26619 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26620 command below).
26621
26622 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26623
26624 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26625
26626 @subsubheading Example
26627
26628 @smallexample
26629 (gdb)
26630 -break-condition 1 1
26631 ^done
26632 (gdb)
26633 -break-list
26634 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26635 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26636 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26637 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26638 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26639 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26640 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26641 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26642 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26643 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26644 (gdb)
26645 @end smallexample
26646
26647 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26648 @findex -break-delete
26649
26650 @subsubheading Synopsis
26651
26652 @smallexample
26653 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26654 @end smallexample
26655
26656 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26657 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26658
26659 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26660
26661 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26662
26663 @subsubheading Example
26664
26665 @smallexample
26666 (gdb)
26667 -break-delete 1
26668 ^done
26669 (gdb)
26670 -break-list
26671 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26672 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26673 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26674 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26675 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26676 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26677 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26678 body=[]@}
26679 (gdb)
26680 @end smallexample
26681
26682 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26683 @findex -break-disable
26684
26685 @subsubheading Synopsis
26686
26687 @smallexample
26688 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26689 @end smallexample
26690
26691 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26692 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26693
26694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26695
26696 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26697
26698 @subsubheading Example
26699
26700 @smallexample
26701 (gdb)
26702 -break-disable 2
26703 ^done
26704 (gdb)
26705 -break-list
26706 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26707 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26708 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26709 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26710 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26711 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26712 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26713 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26714 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26715 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26716 (gdb)
26717 @end smallexample
26718
26719 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26720 @findex -break-enable
26721
26722 @subsubheading Synopsis
26723
26724 @smallexample
26725 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26726 @end smallexample
26727
26728 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26729
26730 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26731
26732 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26733
26734 @subsubheading Example
26735
26736 @smallexample
26737 (gdb)
26738 -break-enable 2
26739 ^done
26740 (gdb)
26741 -break-list
26742 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26743 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26744 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26745 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26746 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26747 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26748 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26749 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26750 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26751 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26752 (gdb)
26753 @end smallexample
26754
26755 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26756 @findex -break-info
26757
26758 @subsubheading Synopsis
26759
26760 @smallexample
26761 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26762 @end smallexample
26763
26764 @c REDUNDANT???
26765 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26766
26767 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26768 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26769 table.
26770
26771 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26772
26773 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26774
26775 @subsubheading Example
26776 N.A.
26777
26778 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26779 @findex -break-insert
26780
26781 @subsubheading Synopsis
26782
26783 @smallexample
26784 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26785 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26786 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26787 @end smallexample
26788
26789 @noindent
26790 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26791
26792 @itemize @bullet
26793 @item function
26794 @c @item +offset
26795 @c @item -offset
26796 @c @item linenum
26797 @item filename:linenum
26798 @item filename:function
26799 @item *address
26800 @end itemize
26801
26802 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26803
26804 @table @samp
26805 @item -t
26806 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26807 @item -h
26808 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26809 @item -f
26810 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26811 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26812 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26813 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26814 cannot be parsed.
26815 @item -d
26816 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26817 @item -a
26818 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26819 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26820 @item -c @var{condition}
26821 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26822 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26823 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26824 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26825 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26826 @end table
26827
26828 @subsubheading Result
26829
26830 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26831 resulting breakpoint.
26832
26833 Note: this format is open to change.
26834 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26835
26836 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26837
26838 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26839 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26840
26841 @subsubheading Example
26842
26843 @smallexample
26844 (gdb)
26845 -break-insert main
26846 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26847 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26848 times="0"@}
26849 (gdb)
26850 -break-insert -t foo
26851 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26852 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26853 times="0"@}
26854 (gdb)
26855 -break-list
26856 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26857 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26858 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26859 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26860 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26861 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26862 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26863 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26864 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26865 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26866 times="0"@},
26867 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26868 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26869 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26870 times="0"@}]@}
26871 (gdb)
26872 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26873 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26874 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26875 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26876 @c times="0"@}
26877 @c (gdb)
26878 @end smallexample
26879
26880 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26881 @findex -dprintf-insert
26882
26883 @subsubheading Synopsis
26884
26885 @smallexample
26886 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26887 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26888 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26889 [ @var{argument} ]
26890 @end smallexample
26891
26892 @noindent
26893 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26894
26895 @itemize @bullet
26896 @item @var{function}
26897 @c @item +offset
26898 @c @item -offset
26899 @c @item @var{linenum}
26900 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26901 @item @var{filename}:function
26902 @item *@var{address}
26903 @end itemize
26904
26905 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26906
26907 @table @samp
26908 @item -t
26909 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26910 @item -f
26911 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26912 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26913 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26914 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26915 cannot be parsed.
26916 @item -d
26917 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26918 @item -c @var{condition}
26919 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26920 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26921 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26922 to @var{ignore-count}.
26923 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26924 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26925 @end table
26926
26927 @subsubheading Result
26928
26929 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26930 resulting breakpoint.
26931
26932 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26933
26934 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26935
26936 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26937
26938 @subsubheading Example
26939
26940 @smallexample
26941 (gdb)
26942 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26943 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26944 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26945 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26946 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26947 original-location="foo"@}
26948 (gdb)
26949 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26950 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26951 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26952 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26953 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26954 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26955 (gdb)
26956 @end smallexample
26957
26958 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26959 @findex -break-list
26960
26961 @subsubheading Synopsis
26962
26963 @smallexample
26964 -break-list
26965 @end smallexample
26966
26967 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26968
26969 @table @samp
26970 @item Number
26971 number of the breakpoint
26972 @item Type
26973 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26974 @item Disposition
26975 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26976 or @samp{nokeep}
26977 @item Enabled
26978 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26979 @item Address
26980 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26981 @item What
26982 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26983 name, line number
26984 @item Thread-groups
26985 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26986 @item Times
26987 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26988 @end table
26989
26990 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26991 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26992
26993 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26994
26995 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26996
26997 @subsubheading Example
26998
26999 @smallexample
27000 (gdb)
27001 -break-list
27002 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27003 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27004 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27005 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27006 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27007 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27008 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27009 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27010 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27011 times="0"@},
27012 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27013 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27014 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27015 (gdb)
27016 @end smallexample
27017
27018 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27019
27020 @smallexample
27021 (gdb)
27022 -break-list
27023 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27024 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27025 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27026 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27027 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27028 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27029 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27030 body=[]@}
27031 (gdb)
27032 @end smallexample
27033
27034 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27035 @findex -break-passcount
27036
27037 @subsubheading Synopsis
27038
27039 @smallexample
27040 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27041 @end smallexample
27042
27043 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27044 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27045 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27046 command @samp{passcount}.
27047
27048 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27049 @findex -break-watch
27050
27051 @subsubheading Synopsis
27052
27053 @smallexample
27054 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27055 @end smallexample
27056
27057 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27058 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27059 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27060 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27061 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27062 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27063 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27064 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27065
27066 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27067 breakpoints inserted.
27068
27069 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27070
27071 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27072 @samp{rwatch}.
27073
27074 @subsubheading Example
27075
27076 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27077
27078 @smallexample
27079 (gdb)
27080 -break-watch x
27081 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27082 (gdb)
27083 -exec-continue
27084 ^running
27085 (gdb)
27086 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27087 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27088 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27089 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27090 (gdb)
27091 @end smallexample
27092
27093 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27094 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27095 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27096
27097 @smallexample
27098 (gdb)
27099 -break-watch C
27100 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27101 (gdb)
27102 -exec-continue
27103 ^running
27104 (gdb)
27105 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27106 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27107 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27108 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27109 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27110 (gdb)
27111 -exec-continue
27112 ^running
27113 (gdb)
27114 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27115 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27116 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27117 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27118 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27119 (gdb)
27120 @end smallexample
27121
27122 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27123 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27124 deleted.
27125
27126 @smallexample
27127 (gdb)
27128 -break-watch C
27129 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27130 (gdb)
27131 -break-list
27132 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27133 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27134 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27135 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27136 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27137 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27138 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27139 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27140 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27141 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27142 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27143 times="1"@},
27144 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27145 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27146 (gdb)
27147 -exec-continue
27148 ^running
27149 (gdb)
27150 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27151 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27152 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27153 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27154 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27155 (gdb)
27156 -break-list
27157 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27158 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27159 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27160 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27161 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27162 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27163 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27164 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27165 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27166 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27167 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27168 times="1"@},
27169 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27170 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27171 (gdb)
27172 -exec-continue
27173 ^running
27174 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27175 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27176 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27177 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27178 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27179 (gdb)
27180 -break-list
27181 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27182 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27183 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27184 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27185 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27186 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27187 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27188 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27189 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27190 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27191 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27192 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27193 (gdb)
27194 @end smallexample
27195
27196
27197 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27198 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27199 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27200
27201 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27202 catchpoints.
27203
27204 @menu
27205 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27206 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27207 @end menu
27208
27209 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27210 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27211
27212 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27213 @findex -catch-load
27214
27215 @subsubheading Synopsis
27216
27217 @smallexample
27218 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27219 @end smallexample
27220
27221 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27222 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27223 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27224 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27225 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27226
27227
27228 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27229
27230 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27231
27232 @subsubheading Example
27233
27234 @smallexample
27235 -catch-load -t foo.so
27236 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27237 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27238 (gdb)
27239 @end smallexample
27240
27241
27242 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27243 @findex -catch-unload
27244
27245 @subsubheading Synopsis
27246
27247 @smallexample
27248 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27249 @end smallexample
27250
27251 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27252 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27253 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27254 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27255 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27256
27257 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27258
27259 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27260
27261 @subsubheading Example
27262
27263 @smallexample
27264 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27265 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27266 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27267 (gdb)
27268 @end smallexample
27269
27270 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27271 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27272
27273 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27274 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27275
27276 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27277 @findex -catch-assert
27278
27279 @subsubheading Synopsis
27280
27281 @smallexample
27282 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27283 @end smallexample
27284
27285 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27286
27287 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27288
27289 @table @samp
27290 @item -c @var{condition}
27291 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27292 @item -d
27293 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27294 @item -t
27295 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27296 @end table
27297
27298 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27299
27300 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27301
27302 @subsubheading Example
27303
27304 @smallexample
27305 -catch-assert
27306 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27307 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27308 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27309 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27310 (gdb)
27311 @end smallexample
27312
27313 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27314 @findex -catch-exception
27315
27316 @subsubheading Synopsis
27317
27318 @smallexample
27319 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27320 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27321 @end smallexample
27322
27323 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27324 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27325 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27326 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27327 catchpoints.
27328
27329 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27330
27331 @table @samp
27332 @item -c @var{condition}
27333 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27334 @item -d
27335 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27336 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27337 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27338 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27339 @item -t
27340 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27341 @item -u
27342 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27343 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27344 @end table
27345
27346 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27347
27348 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27349 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27350
27351 @subsubheading Example
27352
27353 @smallexample
27354 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27355 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27356 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27357 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27358 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27359 (gdb)
27360 @end smallexample
27361
27362 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27363 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27364 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27365
27366 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27367 @findex -exec-arguments
27368
27369
27370 @subsubheading Synopsis
27371
27372 @smallexample
27373 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27374 @end smallexample
27375
27376 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27377 @samp{-exec-run}.
27378
27379 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27380
27381 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27382
27383 @subsubheading Example
27384
27385 @smallexample
27386 (gdb)
27387 -exec-arguments -v word
27388 ^done
27389 (gdb)
27390 @end smallexample
27391
27392
27393 @ignore
27394 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27395 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27396
27397 @subsubheading Synopsis
27398
27399 @smallexample
27400 -exec-show-arguments
27401 @end smallexample
27402
27403 Print the arguments of the program.
27404
27405 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27406
27407 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27408
27409 @subsubheading Example
27410 N.A.
27411 @end ignore
27412
27413
27414 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27415 @findex -environment-cd
27416
27417 @subsubheading Synopsis
27418
27419 @smallexample
27420 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27421 @end smallexample
27422
27423 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27424
27425 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27426
27427 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27428
27429 @subsubheading Example
27430
27431 @smallexample
27432 (gdb)
27433 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27434 ^done
27435 (gdb)
27436 @end smallexample
27437
27438
27439 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27440 @findex -environment-directory
27441
27442 @subsubheading Synopsis
27443
27444 @smallexample
27445 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27446 @end smallexample
27447
27448 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27449 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27450 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27451 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27452 occurs as normal.
27453 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27454 multiple directories in a single command
27455 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27456 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27457 If blanks are needed as
27458 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27459 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27460 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27461 character must not be used
27462 in any directory name.
27463 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27464
27465 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27466
27467 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27468
27469 @subsubheading Example
27470
27471 @smallexample
27472 (gdb)
27473 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27474 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27475 (gdb)
27476 -environment-directory ""
27477 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27478 (gdb)
27479 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27480 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27481 (gdb)
27482 -environment-directory -r
27483 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27484 (gdb)
27485 @end smallexample
27486
27487
27488 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27489 @findex -environment-path
27490
27491 @subsubheading Synopsis
27492
27493 @smallexample
27494 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27495 @end smallexample
27496
27497 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27498 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27499 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27500 supplied in addition to the
27501 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27502 occurs as normal.
27503 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27504 multiple directories in a single command
27505 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27506 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27507 If blanks are needed as
27508 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27509 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27510 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27511 character must not be used
27512 in any directory name.
27513 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27514
27515
27516 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27517
27518 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27519
27520 @subsubheading Example
27521
27522 @smallexample
27523 (gdb)
27524 -environment-path
27525 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27526 (gdb)
27527 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27528 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27529 (gdb)
27530 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27531 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27532 (gdb)
27533 @end smallexample
27534
27535
27536 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27537 @findex -environment-pwd
27538
27539 @subsubheading Synopsis
27540
27541 @smallexample
27542 -environment-pwd
27543 @end smallexample
27544
27545 Show the current working directory.
27546
27547 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27548
27549 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27550
27551 @subsubheading Example
27552
27553 @smallexample
27554 (gdb)
27555 -environment-pwd
27556 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27557 (gdb)
27558 @end smallexample
27559
27560 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27561 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27562 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27563
27564
27565 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27566 @findex -thread-info
27567
27568 @subsubheading Synopsis
27569
27570 @smallexample
27571 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27572 @end smallexample
27573
27574 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
27575 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
27576 threads. When printing information about all threads,
27577 also reports the current thread.
27578
27579 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27580
27581 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27582 about all threads.
27583
27584 @subsubheading Result
27585
27586 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27587 defined for a given thread:
27588
27589 @table @samp
27590 @item current
27591 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27592
27593 @item id
27594 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27595
27596 @item target-id
27597 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27598
27599 @item details
27600 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27601 field is optional.
27602
27603 @item name
27604 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27605 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27606 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27607 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27608 field is omitted.
27609
27610 @item frame
27611 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27612
27613 @item state
27614 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27615 values:
27616
27617 @table @code
27618 @item stopped
27619 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27620 threads.
27621
27622 @item running
27623 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27624 threads.
27625
27626 @end table
27627
27628 @item core
27629 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27630 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27631
27632 @end table
27633
27634 @subsubheading Example
27635
27636 @smallexample
27637 -thread-info
27638 ^done,threads=[
27639 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27640 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27641 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27642 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27643 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27644 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27645 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27646 state="running"@}],
27647 current-thread-id="1"
27648 (gdb)
27649 @end smallexample
27650
27651 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27652 @findex -thread-list-ids
27653
27654 @subsubheading Synopsis
27655
27656 @smallexample
27657 -thread-list-ids
27658 @end smallexample
27659
27660 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
27661 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
27662
27663 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27664 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27665
27666 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27667
27668 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27669
27670 @subsubheading Example
27671
27672 @smallexample
27673 (gdb)
27674 -thread-list-ids
27675 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27676 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27677 (gdb)
27678 @end smallexample
27679
27680
27681 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27682 @findex -thread-select
27683
27684 @subsubheading Synopsis
27685
27686 @smallexample
27687 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
27688 @end smallexample
27689
27690 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
27691 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
27692
27693 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27694 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27695
27696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27697
27698 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27699
27700 @subsubheading Example
27701
27702 @smallexample
27703 (gdb)
27704 -exec-next
27705 ^running
27706 (gdb)
27707 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27708 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27709 (gdb)
27710 -thread-list-ids
27711 ^done,
27712 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27713 number-of-threads="3"
27714 (gdb)
27715 -thread-select 3
27716 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27717 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27718 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27719 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27720 (gdb)
27721 @end smallexample
27722
27723 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27724 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27725 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27726
27727 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27728 @findex -ada-task-info
27729
27730 @subsubheading Synopsis
27731
27732 @smallexample
27733 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27734 @end smallexample
27735
27736 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27737 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27738
27739 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27740
27741 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27742 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27743
27744 @subsubheading Result
27745
27746 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27747 defined for each Ada task:
27748
27749 @table @samp
27750 @item current
27751 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27752
27753 @item id
27754 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27755
27756 @item task-id
27757 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27758
27759 @item thread-id
27760 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
27761
27762 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27763 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27764 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27765
27766 @item parent-id
27767 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27768 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27769
27770 @item priority
27771 The base priority of the task.
27772
27773 @item state
27774 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27775 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27776
27777 @item name
27778 The name of the task.
27779
27780 @end table
27781
27782 @subsubheading Example
27783
27784 @smallexample
27785 -ada-task-info
27786 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27787 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27788 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27789 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27790 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27791 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27792 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27793 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27794 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27795 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27796 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27797 (gdb)
27798 @end smallexample
27799
27800 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27801 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27802 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27803
27804 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27805 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27806 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27807 other cases.
27808
27809 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27810 @findex -exec-continue
27811
27812 @subsubheading Synopsis
27813
27814 @smallexample
27815 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27816 @end smallexample
27817
27818 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27819 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27820 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27821 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27822 @itemize @bullet
27823 @item
27824 breakpoints or watchpoints
27825 @item
27826 signals or exceptions
27827 @item
27828 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27829 @item
27830 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27831 @end itemize
27832 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27833 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27834 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27835 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27836 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27837 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27838
27839 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27840
27841 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27842
27843 @subsubheading Example
27844
27845 @smallexample
27846 -exec-continue
27847 ^running
27848 (gdb)
27849 @@Hello world
27850 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27851 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27852 line="13"@}
27853 (gdb)
27854 @end smallexample
27855
27856
27857 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27858 @findex -exec-finish
27859
27860 @subsubheading Synopsis
27861
27862 @smallexample
27863 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27864 @end smallexample
27865
27866 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27867 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27868 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27869 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27870 function was called.
27871
27872 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27873
27874 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27875
27876 @subsubheading Example
27877
27878 Function returning @code{void}.
27879
27880 @smallexample
27881 -exec-finish
27882 ^running
27883 (gdb)
27884 @@hello from foo
27885 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27886 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27887 (gdb)
27888 @end smallexample
27889
27890 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27891 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27892 value itself.
27893
27894 @smallexample
27895 -exec-finish
27896 ^running
27897 (gdb)
27898 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27899 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27900 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27901 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27902 (gdb)
27903 @end smallexample
27904
27905
27906 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27907 @findex -exec-interrupt
27908
27909 @subsubheading Synopsis
27910
27911 @smallexample
27912 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27913 @end smallexample
27914
27915 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27916 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27917 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27918 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27919 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27920
27921 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27922 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27923 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27924 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27925
27926 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27927 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27928 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27929 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27930
27931 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27932
27933 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27934
27935 @subsubheading Example
27936
27937 @smallexample
27938 (gdb)
27939 111-exec-continue
27940 111^running
27941
27942 (gdb)
27943 222-exec-interrupt
27944 222^done
27945 (gdb)
27946 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27947 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27948 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27949 (gdb)
27950
27951 (gdb)
27952 -exec-interrupt
27953 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27954 (gdb)
27955 @end smallexample
27956
27957 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27958 @findex -exec-jump
27959
27960 @subsubheading Synopsis
27961
27962 @smallexample
27963 -exec-jump @var{location}
27964 @end smallexample
27965
27966 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27967 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27968 different forms of @var{location}.
27969
27970 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27971
27972 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27973
27974 @subsubheading Example
27975
27976 @smallexample
27977 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27978 *running,thread-id="all"
27979 ^running
27980 @end smallexample
27981
27982
27983 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27984 @findex -exec-next
27985
27986 @subsubheading Synopsis
27987
27988 @smallexample
27989 -exec-next [--reverse]
27990 @end smallexample
27991
27992 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27993 of the next source line is reached.
27994
27995 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27996 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27997 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27998 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27999 source line where the function was called.
28000
28001
28002 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28003
28004 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28005
28006 @subsubheading Example
28007
28008 @smallexample
28009 -exec-next
28010 ^running
28011 (gdb)
28012 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28013 (gdb)
28014 @end smallexample
28015
28016
28017 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28018 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28019
28020 @subsubheading Synopsis
28021
28022 @smallexample
28023 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28024 @end smallexample
28025
28026 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28027 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28028 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28029 printed as well.
28030
28031 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28032 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28033 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28034 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28035 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28036
28037 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28038
28039 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28040
28041 @subsubheading Example
28042
28043 @smallexample
28044 (gdb)
28045 -exec-next-instruction
28046 ^running
28047
28048 (gdb)
28049 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28050 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28051 (gdb)
28052 @end smallexample
28053
28054
28055 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28056 @findex -exec-return
28057
28058 @subsubheading Synopsis
28059
28060 @smallexample
28061 -exec-return
28062 @end smallexample
28063
28064 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28065 Displays the new current frame.
28066
28067 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28068
28069 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28070
28071 @subsubheading Example
28072
28073 @smallexample
28074 (gdb)
28075 200-break-insert callee4
28076 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28077 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28078 (gdb)
28079 000-exec-run
28080 000^running
28081 (gdb)
28082 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28083 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28084 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28085 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28086 (gdb)
28087 205-break-delete
28088 205^done
28089 (gdb)
28090 111-exec-return
28091 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28092 args=[@{name="strarg",
28093 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28094 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28095 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28096 (gdb)
28097 @end smallexample
28098
28099
28100 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28101 @findex -exec-run
28102
28103 @subsubheading Synopsis
28104
28105 @smallexample
28106 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28107 @end smallexample
28108
28109 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28110 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28111 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28112 the program has exited exceptionally.
28113
28114 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28115 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28116 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28117 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28118 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28119
28120 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28121 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28122 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28123 (@pxref{Starting}).
28124
28125 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28126
28127 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28128
28129 @subsubheading Examples
28130
28131 @smallexample
28132 (gdb)
28133 -break-insert main
28134 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28135 (gdb)
28136 -exec-run
28137 ^running
28138 (gdb)
28139 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28140 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28141 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28142 (gdb)
28143 @end smallexample
28144
28145 @noindent
28146 Program exited normally:
28147
28148 @smallexample
28149 (gdb)
28150 -exec-run
28151 ^running
28152 (gdb)
28153 x = 55
28154 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28155 (gdb)
28156 @end smallexample
28157
28158 @noindent
28159 Program exited exceptionally:
28160
28161 @smallexample
28162 (gdb)
28163 -exec-run
28164 ^running
28165 (gdb)
28166 x = 55
28167 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28168 (gdb)
28169 @end smallexample
28170
28171 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28172 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28173
28174 @smallexample
28175 (gdb)
28176 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28177 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28178 @end smallexample
28179
28180
28181 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28182
28183
28184 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28185 @findex -exec-step
28186
28187 @subsubheading Synopsis
28188
28189 @smallexample
28190 -exec-step [--reverse]
28191 @end smallexample
28192
28193 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28194 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28195 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28196 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28197 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28198 previously executed source line.
28199
28200 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28201
28202 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28203
28204 @subsubheading Example
28205
28206 Stepping into a function:
28207
28208 @smallexample
28209 -exec-step
28210 ^running
28211 (gdb)
28212 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28213 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28214 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28215 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28216 (gdb)
28217 @end smallexample
28218
28219 Regular stepping:
28220
28221 @smallexample
28222 -exec-step
28223 ^running
28224 (gdb)
28225 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28226 (gdb)
28227 @end smallexample
28228
28229
28230 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28231 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28232
28233 @subsubheading Synopsis
28234
28235 @smallexample
28236 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28237 @end smallexample
28238
28239 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28240 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28241 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28242 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28243 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28244 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28245 as well.
28246
28247 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28248
28249 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28250
28251 @subsubheading Example
28252
28253 @smallexample
28254 (gdb)
28255 -exec-step-instruction
28256 ^running
28257
28258 (gdb)
28259 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28260 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28261 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28262 (gdb)
28263 -exec-step-instruction
28264 ^running
28265
28266 (gdb)
28267 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28268 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28269 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28270 (gdb)
28271 @end smallexample
28272
28273
28274 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28275 @findex -exec-until
28276
28277 @subsubheading Synopsis
28278
28279 @smallexample
28280 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28281 @end smallexample
28282
28283 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28284 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28285 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28286 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28287
28288 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28289
28290 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28291
28292 @subsubheading Example
28293
28294 @smallexample
28295 (gdb)
28296 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28297 ^running
28298 (gdb)
28299 x = 55
28300 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28301 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28302 (gdb)
28303 @end smallexample
28304
28305 @ignore
28306 @subheading -file-clear
28307 Is this going away????
28308 @end ignore
28309
28310 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28311 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28312 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28313
28314 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28315 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28316
28317 @smallexample
28318 -enable-frame-filters
28319 @end smallexample
28320
28321 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28322 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28323 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28324 request that this functionality be enabled.
28325
28326 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28327
28328 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28329 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28330
28331 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28332 @findex -stack-info-frame
28333
28334 @subsubheading Synopsis
28335
28336 @smallexample
28337 -stack-info-frame
28338 @end smallexample
28339
28340 Get info on the selected frame.
28341
28342 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28343
28344 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28345 (without arguments).
28346
28347 @subsubheading Example
28348
28349 @smallexample
28350 (gdb)
28351 -stack-info-frame
28352 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28353 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28354 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28355 (gdb)
28356 @end smallexample
28357
28358 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28359 @findex -stack-info-depth
28360
28361 @subsubheading Synopsis
28362
28363 @smallexample
28364 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28365 @end smallexample
28366
28367 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28368 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28369
28370 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28371
28372 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28373
28374 @subsubheading Example
28375
28376 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28377
28378 @smallexample
28379 (gdb)
28380 -stack-info-depth
28381 ^done,depth="12"
28382 (gdb)
28383 -stack-info-depth 4
28384 ^done,depth="4"
28385 (gdb)
28386 -stack-info-depth 12
28387 ^done,depth="12"
28388 (gdb)
28389 -stack-info-depth 11
28390 ^done,depth="11"
28391 (gdb)
28392 -stack-info-depth 13
28393 ^done,depth="12"
28394 (gdb)
28395 @end smallexample
28396
28397 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28398 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28399 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28400
28401 @subsubheading Synopsis
28402
28403 @smallexample
28404 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28405 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28406 @end smallexample
28407
28408 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28409 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28410 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28411 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28412 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28413 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28414 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28415 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28416
28417 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28418 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28419 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28420 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28421 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28422 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28423
28424 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28425 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28426 are still displayed, however.
28427
28428 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28429 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28430
28431 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28432
28433 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28434 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28435 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28436
28437 @subsubheading Example
28438
28439 @smallexample
28440 (gdb)
28441 -stack-list-frames
28442 ^done,
28443 stack=[
28444 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28445 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28446 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28447 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28448 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28449 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28450 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28451 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28452 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28453 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28454 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28455 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28456 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28457 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28458 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28459 (gdb)
28460 -stack-list-arguments 0
28461 ^done,
28462 stack-args=[
28463 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28464 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28465 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28466 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28467 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28468 (gdb)
28469 -stack-list-arguments 1
28470 ^done,
28471 stack-args=[
28472 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28473 frame=@{level="1",
28474 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28475 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28476 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28477 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28478 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28479 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28480 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28481 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28482 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28483 (gdb)
28484 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28485 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28486 (gdb)
28487 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28488 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28489 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28490 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28491 (gdb)
28492 @end smallexample
28493
28494 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28495
28496
28497 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28498 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28499 @findex -stack-list-frames
28500
28501 @subsubheading Synopsis
28502
28503 @smallexample
28504 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28505 @end smallexample
28506
28507 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28508 following info:
28509
28510 @table @samp
28511 @item @var{level}
28512 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28513 @item @var{addr}
28514 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28515 @item @var{func}
28516 Function name.
28517 @item @var{file}
28518 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28519 @item @var{fullname}
28520 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28521 @item @var{line}
28522 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28523 @item @var{from}
28524 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28525 if the frame's function is not known.
28526 @end table
28527
28528 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28529 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28530 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28531 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28532 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28533 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28534 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28535 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28536 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28537
28538 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28539
28540 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28541
28542 @subsubheading Example
28543
28544 Full stack backtrace:
28545
28546 @smallexample
28547 (gdb)
28548 -stack-list-frames
28549 ^done,stack=
28550 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28551 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28552 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28553 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28554 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28555 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28556 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28557 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28558 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28559 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28560 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28561 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28562 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28563 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28564 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28565 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28566 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28567 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28568 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28569 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28570 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28571 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28572 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28573 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28574 (gdb)
28575 @end smallexample
28576
28577 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28578
28579 @smallexample
28580 (gdb)
28581 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28582 ^done,stack=
28583 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28584 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28585 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28586 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28587 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28588 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28589 (gdb)
28590 @end smallexample
28591
28592 Show a single frame:
28593
28594 @smallexample
28595 (gdb)
28596 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28597 ^done,stack=
28598 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28599 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28600 (gdb)
28601 @end smallexample
28602
28603
28604 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28605 @findex -stack-list-locals
28606 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28607
28608 @subsubheading Synopsis
28609
28610 @smallexample
28611 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28612 @end smallexample
28613
28614 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28615 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28616 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28617 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28618 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28619 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28620 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28621 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28622 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28623 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28624
28625 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28626 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28627 variables are still displayed, however.
28628
28629 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28630 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28631
28632 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28633
28634 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28635
28636 @subsubheading Example
28637
28638 @smallexample
28639 (gdb)
28640 -stack-list-locals 0
28641 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28642 (gdb)
28643 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28644 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28645 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28646 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28647 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28648 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28649 (gdb)
28650 @end smallexample
28651
28652 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28653 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28654 @findex -stack-list-variables
28655
28656 @subsubheading Synopsis
28657
28658 @smallexample
28659 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28660 @end smallexample
28661
28662 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28663 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28664 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28665 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28666 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28667 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28668 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28669
28670 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28671 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28672 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28673
28674 @subsubheading Example
28675
28676 @smallexample
28677 (gdb)
28678 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28679 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28680 (gdb)
28681 @end smallexample
28682
28683
28684 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28685 @findex -stack-select-frame
28686
28687 @subsubheading Synopsis
28688
28689 @smallexample
28690 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28691 @end smallexample
28692
28693 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28694 the stack.
28695
28696 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28697 option to every command.
28698
28699 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28700
28701 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28702 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28703
28704 @subsubheading Example
28705
28706 @smallexample
28707 (gdb)
28708 -stack-select-frame 2
28709 ^done
28710 (gdb)
28711 @end smallexample
28712
28713 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28714 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28715 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28716
28717 @ignore
28718
28719 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28720
28721 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28722 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28723 used by @code{Insight}.
28724
28725 The two main reasons for that are:
28726
28727 @enumerate 1
28728 @item
28729 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28730
28731 @item
28732 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28733 now).
28734 @end enumerate
28735
28736 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28737 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28738 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28739 hints about their use.
28740
28741 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28742 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28743 least, the following operations:
28744
28745 @itemize @bullet
28746 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28747 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28748 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28749 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28750 @end itemize
28751
28752 @end ignore
28753
28754 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28755
28756 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28757
28758 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28759 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28760 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28761 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28762 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28763 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28764 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28765 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28766 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28767 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28768 object, or to change display format.
28769
28770 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28771 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28772 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28773 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28774 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28775 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28776 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28777 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28778 child will be created.
28779
28780 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28781 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28782 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28783 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28784 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28785
28786 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28787 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28788 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28789 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28790 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28791 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28792 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28793 variables that frontend has created.
28794
28795 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28796 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28797 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28798 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28799 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28800 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28801 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28802 implicitly updated.
28803
28804 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28805 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28806 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28807 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28808 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28809 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28810 frame. Consider this example:
28811
28812 @smallexample
28813 void do_work(...)
28814 @{
28815 struct work_state state;
28816
28817 if (...)
28818 do_work(...);
28819 @}
28820 @end smallexample
28821
28822 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28823 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28824 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28825 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28826 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28827
28828 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28829 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28830 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28831 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28832 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28833 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28834
28835 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28836 access this functionality:
28837
28838 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28839 @item @strong{Operation}
28840 @tab @strong{Description}
28841
28842 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28843 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28844 @item @code{-var-create}
28845 @tab create a variable object
28846 @item @code{-var-delete}
28847 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28848 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28849 @tab set the display format of this variable
28850 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28851 @tab show the display format of this variable
28852 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28853 @tab tells how many children this object has
28854 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28855 @tab return a list of the object's children
28856 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28857 @tab show the type of this variable object
28858 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28859 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28860 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28861 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28862 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28863 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28864 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28865 @tab get the value of this variable
28866 @item @code{-var-assign}
28867 @tab set the value of this variable
28868 @item @code{-var-update}
28869 @tab update the variable and its children
28870 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28871 @tab set frozeness attribute
28872 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28873 @tab set range of children to display on update
28874 @end multitable
28875
28876 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28877 how it can be used.
28878
28879 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28880
28881 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28882 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28883
28884 @smallexample
28885 -enable-pretty-printing
28886 @end smallexample
28887
28888 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28889 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28890 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28891 request that this functionality be enabled.
28892
28893 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28894
28895 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28896 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28897
28898 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28899 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28900
28901 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28902 @findex -var-create
28903
28904 @subsubheading Synopsis
28905
28906 @smallexample
28907 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28908 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28909 @end smallexample
28910
28911 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28912 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28913 register.
28914
28915 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28916 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28917 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28918 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28919 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28920
28921 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28922 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28923 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28924 object must be created.
28925
28926 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28927 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28928
28929 @itemize @bullet
28930 @item
28931 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28932
28933 @item
28934 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28935
28936 @item
28937 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28938 @end itemize
28939
28940 @cindex dynamic varobj
28941 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28942 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28943 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28944 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28945 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28946 compatibility for existing clients.
28947
28948 @subsubheading Result
28949
28950 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28951 are:
28952
28953 @table @samp
28954 @item name
28955 The name of the varobj.
28956
28957 @item numchild
28958 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28959 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28960 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28961
28962 @item value
28963 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28964 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28965 will not be interesting.
28966
28967 @item type
28968 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28969 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28970 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28971 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28972 @emph{declared} one.
28973
28974 @item thread-id
28975 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28976 thread's identifier.
28977
28978 @item has_more
28979 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28980 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28981
28982 @item dynamic
28983 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28984 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28985 then this attribute will not be present.
28986
28987 @item displayhint
28988 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28989 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28990 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28991 @end table
28992
28993 Typical output will look like this:
28994
28995 @smallexample
28996 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28997 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28998 @end smallexample
28999
29000
29001 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29002 @findex -var-delete
29003
29004 @subsubheading Synopsis
29005
29006 @smallexample
29007 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29008 @end smallexample
29009
29010 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29011 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29012
29013 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29014
29015
29016 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29017 @findex -var-set-format
29018
29019 @subsubheading Synopsis
29020
29021 @smallexample
29022 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29023 @end smallexample
29024
29025 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29026 @var{format-spec}.
29027
29028 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29029 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29030
29031 @smallexample
29032 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29033 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
29034 @end smallexample
29035
29036 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29037 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29038 for pointers, etc.).
29039
29040 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29041 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29042
29043 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29044 @findex -var-show-format
29045
29046 @subsubheading Synopsis
29047
29048 @smallexample
29049 -var-show-format @var{name}
29050 @end smallexample
29051
29052 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29053
29054 @smallexample
29055 @var{format} @expansion{}
29056 @var{format-spec}
29057 @end smallexample
29058
29059
29060 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29061 @findex -var-info-num-children
29062
29063 @subsubheading Synopsis
29064
29065 @smallexample
29066 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29067 @end smallexample
29068
29069 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29070
29071 @smallexample
29072 numchild=@var{n}
29073 @end smallexample
29074
29075 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29076 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29077 be available.
29078
29079
29080 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29081 @findex -var-list-children
29082
29083 @subsubheading Synopsis
29084
29085 @smallexample
29086 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29087 @end smallexample
29088 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29089
29090 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29091 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29092 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29093 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29094 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29095 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29096 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29097 and unions.
29098
29099 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29100 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29101 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29102 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29103 reported.
29104
29105 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29106 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29107 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29108 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29109 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29110 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29111 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29112 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29113 the visible items.
29114
29115 For each child the following results are returned:
29116
29117 @table @var
29118
29119 @item name
29120 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29121
29122 @item exp
29123 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29124 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29125
29126 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29127 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29128
29129 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29130 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29131 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29132 type and value are not present.
29133
29134 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29135 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29136 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29137
29138 @item numchild
29139 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29140 0.
29141
29142 @item type
29143 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29144 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29145 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29146 @emph{declared} one.
29147
29148 @item value
29149 If values were requested, this is the value.
29150
29151 @item thread-id
29152 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
29153 Otherwise this result is not present.
29154
29155 @item frozen
29156 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29157
29158 @item displayhint
29159 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29160 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29161 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29162
29163 @item dynamic
29164 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29165 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29166 then this attribute will not be present.
29167
29168 @end table
29169
29170 The result may have its own attributes:
29171
29172 @table @samp
29173 @item displayhint
29174 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29175 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29176 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29177
29178 @item has_more
29179 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29180 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29181 @end table
29182
29183 @subsubheading Example
29184
29185 @smallexample
29186 (gdb)
29187 -var-list-children n
29188 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29189 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29190 (gdb)
29191 -var-list-children --all-values n
29192 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29193 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29194 @end smallexample
29195
29196
29197 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29198 @findex -var-info-type
29199
29200 @subsubheading Synopsis
29201
29202 @smallexample
29203 -var-info-type @var{name}
29204 @end smallexample
29205
29206 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29207 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29208 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29209
29210 @smallexample
29211 type=@var{typename}
29212 @end smallexample
29213
29214
29215 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29216 @findex -var-info-expression
29217
29218 @subsubheading Synopsis
29219
29220 @smallexample
29221 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29222 @end smallexample
29223
29224 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29225 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29226 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29227
29228 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29229 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29230
29231 @smallexample
29232 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29233 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29234 @end smallexample
29235
29236 @noindent
29237 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29238 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29239
29240 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29241 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29242 is of limited use.
29243
29244 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29245 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29246
29247 @subsubheading Synopsis
29248
29249 @smallexample
29250 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29251 @end smallexample
29252
29253 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29254 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29255 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29256 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29257 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29258 watchpoint from a variable object.
29259
29260 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29261 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29262
29263 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29264 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29265 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29266 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29267 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29268 @smallexample
29269 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29270 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29271 @end smallexample
29272
29273 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29274 @findex -var-show-attributes
29275
29276 @subsubheading Synopsis
29277
29278 @smallexample
29279 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29280 @end smallexample
29281
29282 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29283
29284 @smallexample
29285 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29286 @end smallexample
29287
29288 @noindent
29289 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29290
29291 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29292 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29293
29294 @subsubheading Synopsis
29295
29296 @smallexample
29297 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29298 @end smallexample
29299
29300 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29301 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29302 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29303 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29304 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29305 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29306 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29307
29308 @smallexample
29309 value=@var{value}
29310 @end smallexample
29311
29312 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29313 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29314
29315 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29316 @findex -var-assign
29317
29318 @subsubheading Synopsis
29319
29320 @smallexample
29321 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29322 @end smallexample
29323
29324 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29325 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29326 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29327 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29328
29329 @subsubheading Example
29330
29331 @smallexample
29332 (gdb)
29333 -var-assign var1 3
29334 ^done,value="3"
29335 (gdb)
29336 -var-update *
29337 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29338 (gdb)
29339 @end smallexample
29340
29341 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29342 @findex -var-update
29343
29344 @subsubheading Synopsis
29345
29346 @smallexample
29347 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29348 @end smallexample
29349
29350 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29351 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29352 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29353 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29354 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29355 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29356 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29357 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29358 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29359 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29360 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29361 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29362 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29363
29364 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29365 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29366 diagnostic.
29367
29368 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29369 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29370
29371 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29372 @samp{changelist}.
29373
29374 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29375
29376 @table @samp
29377 @item name
29378 The name of the varobj.
29379
29380 @item value
29381 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29382 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29383
29384 @item in_scope
29385 @anchor{-var-update}
29386 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29387
29388 @table @code
29389 @item "true"
29390 The variable object's current value is valid.
29391
29392 @item "false"
29393 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29394 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29395 scope.
29396
29397 @item "invalid"
29398 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29399 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29400 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29401 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29402 objects.
29403 @end table
29404
29405 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29406 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29407
29408 @item type_changed
29409 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29410 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29411 be @samp{false}.
29412
29413 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29414 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29415 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29416 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29417 unset.
29418
29419 @item new_type
29420 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29421 hold the new type.
29422
29423 @item new_num_children
29424 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29425 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29426
29427 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29428 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29429 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29430 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29431 children which may be available.
29432
29433 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29434 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29435 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29436 only happen at the end of the update range).
29437
29438 @item displayhint
29439 The display hint, if any.
29440
29441 @item has_more
29442 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29443 available outside the varobj's update range.
29444
29445 @item dynamic
29446 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29447 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29448 then this attribute will not be present.
29449
29450 @item new_children
29451 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29452 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29453 be listed in this attribute.
29454 @end table
29455
29456 @subsubheading Example
29457
29458 @smallexample
29459 (gdb)
29460 -var-assign var1 3
29461 ^done,value="3"
29462 (gdb)
29463 -var-update --all-values var1
29464 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29465 type_changed="false"@}]
29466 (gdb)
29467 @end smallexample
29468
29469 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29470 @findex -var-set-frozen
29471 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29472
29473 @subsubheading Synopsis
29474
29475 @smallexample
29476 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29477 @end smallexample
29478
29479 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29480 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29481 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29482 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29483 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29484 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29485 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29486 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29487 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29488 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29489 @code{-var-update} does.
29490
29491 @subsubheading Example
29492
29493 @smallexample
29494 (gdb)
29495 -var-set-frozen V 1
29496 ^done
29497 (gdb)
29498 @end smallexample
29499
29500 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29501 @findex -var-set-update-range
29502 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29503
29504 @subsubheading Synopsis
29505
29506 @smallexample
29507 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29508 @end smallexample
29509
29510 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29511 @code{-var-update}.
29512
29513 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29514 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29515 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29516 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29517
29518 @subsubheading Example
29519
29520 @smallexample
29521 (gdb)
29522 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29523 ^done
29524 @end smallexample
29525
29526 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29527 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29528 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29529
29530 @subsubheading Synopsis
29531
29532 @smallexample
29533 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29534 @end smallexample
29535
29536 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29537
29538 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29539 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29540
29541 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29542 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29543 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29544 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29545 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29546 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29547 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29548
29549 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29550 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29551 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29552 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29553
29554 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29555 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29556 can be used to check this.
29557
29558 @subsubheading Example
29559
29560 Resetting the visualizer:
29561
29562 @smallexample
29563 (gdb)
29564 -var-set-visualizer V None
29565 ^done
29566 @end smallexample
29567
29568 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29569
29570 @smallexample
29571 (gdb)
29572 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29573 ^done
29574 @end smallexample
29575
29576 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29577 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29578
29579 @smallexample
29580 (gdb)
29581 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29582 ^done
29583 @end smallexample
29584
29585 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29586 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29587 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29588
29589 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29590 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29591 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29592 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29593
29594 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
29595 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
29596
29597 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29598 @c @subheading -data-assign
29599 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29600 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29601 @c set variable
29602 @c @subsubheading Example
29603 @c N.A.
29604
29605 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29606 @findex -data-disassemble
29607
29608 @subsubheading Synopsis
29609
29610 @smallexample
29611 -data-disassemble
29612 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29613 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29614 -- @var{mode}
29615 @end smallexample
29616
29617 @noindent
29618 Where:
29619
29620 @table @samp
29621 @item @var{start-addr}
29622 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29623 @item @var{end-addr}
29624 is the end address
29625 @item @var{filename}
29626 is the name of the file to disassemble
29627 @item @var{linenum}
29628 is the line number to disassemble around
29629 @item @var{lines}
29630 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29631 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29632 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29633 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29634 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29635 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29636 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29637 are displayed.
29638 @item @var{mode}
29639 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
29640 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
29641 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
29642 @end table
29643
29644 @subsubheading Result
29645
29646 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29647 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29648 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29649
29650 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29651 following fields:
29652
29653 @table @code
29654 @item address
29655 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29656
29657 @item func-name
29658 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29659
29660 @item offset
29661 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29662
29663 @item inst
29664 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29665
29666 @item opcodes
29667 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
29668 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29669
29670 @end table
29671
29672 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29673 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29674
29675 @table @code
29676 @item line
29677 The line number within @samp{file}.
29678
29679 @item file
29680 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29681 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29682 used.
29683
29684 @item fullname
29685 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29686 using the source file search path
29687 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29688 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29689
29690 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29691 present in the debug information.
29692
29693 @item line_asm_insn
29694 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29695 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29696 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29697 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29698 @samp{opcodes}.
29699
29700 @end table
29701
29702 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29703 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29704 adjust its format.
29705
29706 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29707
29708 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
29709
29710 @subsubheading Example
29711
29712 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29713
29714 @smallexample
29715 (gdb)
29716 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29717 ^done,
29718 asm_insns=[
29719 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29720 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29721 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29722 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29723 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29724 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29725 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29726 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29727 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29728 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29729 (gdb)
29730 @end smallexample
29731
29732 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29733 @code{main}.
29734
29735 @smallexample
29736 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29737 ^done,asm_insns=[
29738 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29739 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29740 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29741 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29742 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29743 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29744 [@dots{}]
29745 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29746 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29747 (gdb)
29748 @end smallexample
29749
29750 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29751
29752 @smallexample
29753 (gdb)
29754 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29755 ^done,asm_insns=[
29756 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29757 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29758 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29759 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29760 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29761 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29762 (gdb)
29763 @end smallexample
29764
29765 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29766
29767 @smallexample
29768 (gdb)
29769 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29770 ^done,asm_insns=[
29771 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29772 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29773 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29774 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
29775 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29776 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29777 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29778 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29779 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
29780 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29781 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29782 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29783 (gdb)
29784 @end smallexample
29785
29786
29787 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29788 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29789
29790 @subsubheading Synopsis
29791
29792 @smallexample
29793 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29794 @end smallexample
29795
29796 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29797 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29798 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29799
29800 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29801
29802 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29803 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29804 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29805
29806 @subsubheading Example
29807
29808 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29809 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29810 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29811 output.
29812
29813 @smallexample
29814 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29815 211^done,value="1"
29816 (gdb)
29817 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29818 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29819 (gdb)
29820 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29821 411^done,value="4"
29822 (gdb)
29823 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29824 511^done,value="4"
29825 (gdb)
29826 @end smallexample
29827
29828
29829 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29830 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29831
29832 @subsubheading Synopsis
29833
29834 @smallexample
29835 -data-list-changed-registers
29836 @end smallexample
29837
29838 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29839
29840 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29841
29842 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29843 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29844
29845 @subsubheading Example
29846
29847 On a PPC MBX board:
29848
29849 @smallexample
29850 (gdb)
29851 -exec-continue
29852 ^running
29853
29854 (gdb)
29855 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29856 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29857 line="5"@}
29858 (gdb)
29859 -data-list-changed-registers
29860 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29861 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29862 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29863 (gdb)
29864 @end smallexample
29865
29866
29867 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29868 @findex -data-list-register-names
29869
29870 @subsubheading Synopsis
29871
29872 @smallexample
29873 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29874 @end smallexample
29875
29876 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29877 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29878 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29879 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29880 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29881 include empty register names.
29882
29883 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29884
29885 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29886 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29887 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29888
29889 @subsubheading Example
29890
29891 For the PPC MBX board:
29892 @smallexample
29893 (gdb)
29894 -data-list-register-names
29895 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29896 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29897 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29898 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29899 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29900 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29901 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29902 (gdb)
29903 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29904 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29905 (gdb)
29906 @end smallexample
29907
29908 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29909 @findex -data-list-register-values
29910
29911 @subsubheading Synopsis
29912
29913 @smallexample
29914 -data-list-register-values
29915 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29916 @end smallexample
29917
29918 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
29919 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
29920 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
29921 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
29922 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
29923 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
29924
29925 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29926
29927 @table @code
29928 @item x
29929 Hexadecimal
29930 @item o
29931 Octal
29932 @item t
29933 Binary
29934 @item d
29935 Decimal
29936 @item r
29937 Raw
29938 @item N
29939 Natural
29940 @end table
29941
29942 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29943
29944 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29945 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29946
29947 @subsubheading Example
29948
29949 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29950 don't appear in the actual output):
29951
29952 @smallexample
29953 (gdb)
29954 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29955 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29956 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29957 (gdb)
29958 -data-list-register-values x
29959 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29960 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29961 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29962 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29963 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29964 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29965 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29966 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29967 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29968 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29969 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29970 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29971 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29972 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29973 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29974 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29975 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29976 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29977 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29978 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29979 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29980 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29981 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29982 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29983 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29984 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29985 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29986 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29987 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29988 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29989 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29990 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29991 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29992 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29993 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29994 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29995 (gdb)
29996 @end smallexample
29997
29998
29999 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30000 @findex -data-read-memory
30001
30002 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30003
30004 @subsubheading Synopsis
30005
30006 @smallexample
30007 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30008 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30009 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30010 @end smallexample
30011
30012 @noindent
30013 where:
30014
30015 @table @samp
30016 @item @var{address}
30017 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30018 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30019 quoted using the C convention.
30020
30021 @item @var{word-format}
30022 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30023 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30024 ,Output Formats}).
30025
30026 @item @var{word-size}
30027 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30028
30029 @item @var{nr-rows}
30030 The number of rows in the output table.
30031
30032 @item @var{nr-cols}
30033 The number of columns in the output table.
30034
30035 @item @var{aschar}
30036 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30037 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30038 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30039 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30040
30041 @item @var{byte-offset}
30042 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30043 @end table
30044
30045 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30046 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30047 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30048 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30049 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30050 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30051 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30052 @samp{addr}.
30053
30054 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30055 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30056 @samp{prev-page}.
30057
30058 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30059
30060 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30061 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30062
30063 @subsubheading Example
30064
30065 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30066 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30067 word. Display each word in hex.
30068
30069 @smallexample
30070 (gdb)
30071 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30072 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30073 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30074 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30075 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30076 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30077 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30078 (gdb)
30079 @end smallexample
30080
30081 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30082 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30083
30084 @smallexample
30085 (gdb)
30086 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30087 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30088 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30089 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30090 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30091 (gdb)
30092 @end smallexample
30093
30094 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30095 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30096 used as the non-printable character.
30097
30098 @smallexample
30099 (gdb)
30100 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30101 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30102 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30103 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30104 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30105 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30106 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30107 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30108 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30109 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30110 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30111 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30112 (gdb)
30113 @end smallexample
30114
30115 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30116 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30117
30118 @subsubheading Synopsis
30119
30120 @smallexample
30121 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30122 @var{address} @var{count}
30123 @end smallexample
30124
30125 @noindent
30126 where:
30127
30128 @table @samp
30129 @item @var{address}
30130 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30131 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30132 quoted using the C convention.
30133
30134 @item @var{count}
30135 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30136 literal.
30137
30138 @item @var{offset}
30139 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30140 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30141 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30142 arithmetics itself.
30143
30144 @end table
30145
30146 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30147 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30148 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30149 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30150 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30151 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30152
30153 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30154 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30155 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30156 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30157 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30158 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30159 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30160 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30161
30162 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30163 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30164 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30165 and has the following fields:
30166
30167 @table @code
30168 @item begin
30169 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30170
30171 @item end
30172 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30173
30174 @item offset
30175 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30176 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30177
30178 @item contents
30179 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30180
30181 @end table
30182
30183
30184
30185 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30186
30187 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30188
30189 @subsubheading Example
30190
30191 @smallexample
30192 (gdb)
30193 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30194 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30195 end="0xbffff15e",
30196 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30197 (gdb)
30198 @end smallexample
30199
30200
30201 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30202 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30203
30204 @subsubheading Synopsis
30205
30206 @smallexample
30207 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30208 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30209 @end smallexample
30210
30211 @noindent
30212 where:
30213
30214 @table @samp
30215 @item @var{address}
30216 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30217 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30218 be quoted using the C convention.
30219
30220 @item @var{contents}
30221 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30222 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30223
30224 @item @var{count}
30225 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30226 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30227 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30228 @var{count} memory units.
30229
30230 @end table
30231
30232 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30233
30234 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30235
30236 @subsubheading Example
30237
30238 @smallexample
30239 (gdb)
30240 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30241 ^done
30242 (gdb)
30243 @end smallexample
30244
30245 @smallexample
30246 (gdb)
30247 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30248 ^done
30249 (gdb)
30250 @end smallexample
30251
30252 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30253 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30254 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30255
30256 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30257 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30258
30259 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30260 @findex -trace-find
30261
30262 @subsubheading Synopsis
30263
30264 @smallexample
30265 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30266 @end smallexample
30267
30268 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30269 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30270 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30271
30272 @table @samp
30273
30274 @item none
30275 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30276
30277 @item frame-number
30278 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30279 that index.
30280
30281 @item tracepoint-number
30282 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30283 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30284
30285 @item pc
30286 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30287 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30288 address.
30289
30290 @item pc-inside-range
30291 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30292 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30293 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30294
30295 @item pc-outside-range
30296 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30297 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30298 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30299
30300 @item line
30301 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30302 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30303 the specified location.
30304
30305 @end table
30306
30307 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30308 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30309
30310 @table @samp
30311 @item found
30312 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30313 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30314
30315 @item traceframe
30316 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30317 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30318
30319 @item tracepoint
30320 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30321 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30322
30323 @item frame
30324 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30325 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30326 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30327
30328 @end table
30329
30330 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30331
30332 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30333
30334 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30335 @findex -trace-define-variable
30336
30337 @subsubheading Synopsis
30338
30339 @smallexample
30340 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30341 @end smallexample
30342
30343 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30344 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30345 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30346 with the @samp{$} character.
30347
30348 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30349
30350 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30351
30352 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30353 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30354
30355 @subsubheading Synopsis
30356
30357 @smallexample
30358 -trace-frame-collected
30359 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30360 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30361 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30362 [--memory-contents]
30363 @end smallexample
30364
30365 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30366 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30367 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30368 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30369 See the output description table below for more details.
30370
30371 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30372 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30373 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30374 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30375 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30376
30377 For instance, if the actions were
30378 @smallexample
30379 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30380 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30381 @end smallexample
30382
30383 @noindent
30384 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30385 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30386 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30387 objects would be computed expressions.
30388
30389 An example output would be:
30390
30391 @smallexample
30392 (gdb)
30393 -trace-frame-collected
30394 ^done,
30395 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30396 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30397 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30398 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30399 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30400 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30401 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30402 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30403 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30404 ...
30405 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30406 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30407 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30408 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30409 (gdb)
30410 @end smallexample
30411
30412 Where:
30413
30414 @table @code
30415 @item explicit-variables
30416 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30417 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30418 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30419 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30420 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30421 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30422 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30423 arrays, structures and unions.
30424
30425 @item computed-expressions
30426 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30427 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30428 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30429 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30430
30431 @item registers
30432 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30433 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30434 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30435 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30436 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30437
30438 @item tvars
30439 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30440 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30441 current value are returned.
30442
30443 @item memory
30444 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30445 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30446 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30447
30448 @table @code
30449 @item address
30450 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30451
30452 @item length
30453 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30454
30455 @item contents
30456 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30457 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30458
30459 @end table
30460
30461 @end table
30462
30463 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30464
30465 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30466
30467 @subsubheading Example
30468
30469 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30470 @findex -trace-list-variables
30471
30472 @subsubheading Synopsis
30473
30474 @smallexample
30475 -trace-list-variables
30476 @end smallexample
30477
30478 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30479 table has the following fields:
30480
30481 @table @samp
30482 @item name
30483 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30484
30485 @item initial
30486 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30487 field is always present.
30488
30489 @item current
30490 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30491 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30492 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30493 presently running.
30494
30495 @end table
30496
30497 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30498
30499 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30500
30501 @subsubheading Example
30502
30503 @smallexample
30504 (gdb)
30505 -trace-list-variables
30506 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30507 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30508 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30509 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30510 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30511 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30512 (gdb)
30513 @end smallexample
30514
30515 @subheading -trace-save
30516 @findex -trace-save
30517
30518 @subsubheading Synopsis
30519
30520 @smallexample
30521 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30522 @end smallexample
30523
30524 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30525 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30526 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30527 to perform the save.
30528
30529 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30530
30531 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30532
30533
30534 @subheading -trace-start
30535 @findex -trace-start
30536
30537 @subsubheading Synopsis
30538
30539 @smallexample
30540 -trace-start
30541 @end smallexample
30542
30543 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30544 have any fields.
30545
30546 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30547
30548 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30549
30550 @subheading -trace-status
30551 @findex -trace-status
30552
30553 @subsubheading Synopsis
30554
30555 @smallexample
30556 -trace-status
30557 @end smallexample
30558
30559 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30560 the following fields:
30561
30562 @table @samp
30563
30564 @item supported
30565 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30566 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30567 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30568 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30569 started. This field is always present.
30570
30571 @item running
30572 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30573 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30574 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30575
30576 @item stop-reason
30577 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30578 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30579 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30580 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30581 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30582 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30583 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30584 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30585 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30586
30587 @item stopping-tracepoint
30588 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30589 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30590 @samp{passcount}.
30591
30592 @item frames
30593 @itemx frames-created
30594 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30595 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30596 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30597 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30598
30599 @item buffer-size
30600 @itemx buffer-free
30601 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30602 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30603
30604 @item circular
30605 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30606 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30607 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30608 and may fill up.
30609
30610 @item disconnected
30611 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30612 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30613 that the trace run will stop.
30614
30615 @item trace-file
30616 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30617 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30618
30619 @end table
30620
30621 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30622
30623 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30624
30625 @subheading -trace-stop
30626 @findex -trace-stop
30627
30628 @subsubheading Synopsis
30629
30630 @smallexample
30631 -trace-stop
30632 @end smallexample
30633
30634 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30635 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30636 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30637
30638 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30639
30640 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30641
30642
30643 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30644 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30645 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30646
30647
30648 @ignore
30649 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30650 @findex -symbol-info-address
30651
30652 @subsubheading Synopsis
30653
30654 @smallexample
30655 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30656 @end smallexample
30657
30658 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30659
30660 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30661
30662 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30663
30664 @subsubheading Example
30665 N.A.
30666
30667
30668 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30669 @findex -symbol-info-file
30670
30671 @subsubheading Synopsis
30672
30673 @smallexample
30674 -symbol-info-file
30675 @end smallexample
30676
30677 Show the file for the symbol.
30678
30679 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30680
30681 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30682 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30683
30684 @subsubheading Example
30685 N.A.
30686
30687
30688 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30689 @findex -symbol-info-function
30690
30691 @subsubheading Synopsis
30692
30693 @smallexample
30694 -symbol-info-function
30695 @end smallexample
30696
30697 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30698
30699 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30700
30701 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30702
30703 @subsubheading Example
30704 N.A.
30705
30706
30707 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30708 @findex -symbol-info-line
30709
30710 @subsubheading Synopsis
30711
30712 @smallexample
30713 -symbol-info-line
30714 @end smallexample
30715
30716 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30717
30718 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30719
30720 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30721 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30722
30723 @subsubheading Example
30724 N.A.
30725
30726
30727 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30728 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30729
30730 @subsubheading Synopsis
30731
30732 @smallexample
30733 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30734 @end smallexample
30735
30736 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30737
30738 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30739
30740 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30741
30742 @subsubheading Example
30743 N.A.
30744
30745
30746 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30747 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30748
30749 @subsubheading Synopsis
30750
30751 @smallexample
30752 -symbol-list-functions
30753 @end smallexample
30754
30755 List the functions in the executable.
30756
30757 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30758
30759 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30760 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30761
30762 @subsubheading Example
30763 N.A.
30764 @end ignore
30765
30766
30767 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30768 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30769
30770 @subsubheading Synopsis
30771
30772 @smallexample
30773 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30774 @end smallexample
30775
30776 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30777 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30778 ascending PC order.
30779
30780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30781
30782 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30783
30784 @subsubheading Example
30785 @smallexample
30786 (gdb)
30787 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30788 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30789 (gdb)
30790 @end smallexample
30791
30792
30793 @ignore
30794 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30795 @findex -symbol-list-types
30796
30797 @subsubheading Synopsis
30798
30799 @smallexample
30800 -symbol-list-types
30801 @end smallexample
30802
30803 List all the type names.
30804
30805 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30806
30807 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30808 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30809
30810 @subsubheading Example
30811 N.A.
30812
30813
30814 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30815 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30816
30817 @subsubheading Synopsis
30818
30819 @smallexample
30820 -symbol-list-variables
30821 @end smallexample
30822
30823 List all the global and static variable names.
30824
30825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30826
30827 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30828
30829 @subsubheading Example
30830 N.A.
30831
30832
30833 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30834 @findex -symbol-locate
30835
30836 @subsubheading Synopsis
30837
30838 @smallexample
30839 -symbol-locate
30840 @end smallexample
30841
30842 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30843
30844 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30845
30846 @subsubheading Example
30847 N.A.
30848
30849
30850 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30851 @findex -symbol-type
30852
30853 @subsubheading Synopsis
30854
30855 @smallexample
30856 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30857 @end smallexample
30858
30859 Show type of @var{variable}.
30860
30861 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30862
30863 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30864 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30865
30866 @subsubheading Example
30867 N.A.
30868 @end ignore
30869
30870
30871 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30872 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30873 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30874
30875 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30876 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30877
30878 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30879 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30880
30881 @subsubheading Synopsis
30882
30883 @smallexample
30884 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30885 @end smallexample
30886
30887 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30888 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30889 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30890 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30891 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30892 notification.
30893
30894 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30895
30896 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30897
30898 @subsubheading Example
30899
30900 @smallexample
30901 (gdb)
30902 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30903 ^done
30904 (gdb)
30905 @end smallexample
30906
30907
30908 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30909 @findex -file-exec-file
30910
30911 @subsubheading Synopsis
30912
30913 @smallexample
30914 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30915 @end smallexample
30916
30917 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30918 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30919 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30920 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30921 notification.
30922
30923 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30924
30925 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30926
30927 @subsubheading Example
30928
30929 @smallexample
30930 (gdb)
30931 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30932 ^done
30933 (gdb)
30934 @end smallexample
30935
30936
30937 @ignore
30938 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30939 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30940
30941 @subsubheading Synopsis
30942
30943 @smallexample
30944 -file-list-exec-sections
30945 @end smallexample
30946
30947 List the sections of the current executable file.
30948
30949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30950
30951 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30952 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30953 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30954
30955 @subsubheading Example
30956 N.A.
30957 @end ignore
30958
30959
30960 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30961 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30962
30963 @subsubheading Synopsis
30964
30965 @smallexample
30966 -file-list-exec-source-file
30967 @end smallexample
30968
30969 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30970 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30971 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30972 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30973
30974 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30975
30976 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30977
30978 @subsubheading Example
30979
30980 @smallexample
30981 (gdb)
30982 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30983 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30984 (gdb)
30985 @end smallexample
30986
30987
30988 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30989 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30990
30991 @subsubheading Synopsis
30992
30993 @smallexample
30994 -file-list-exec-source-files
30995 @end smallexample
30996
30997 List the source files for the current executable.
30998
30999 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31000 name) of a source file.
31001
31002 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31003
31004 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31005 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31006
31007 @subsubheading Example
31008 @smallexample
31009 (gdb)
31010 -file-list-exec-source-files
31011 ^done,files=[
31012 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31013 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31014 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31015 (gdb)
31016 @end smallexample
31017
31018 @ignore
31019 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31020 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31021
31022 @subsubheading Synopsis
31023
31024 @smallexample
31025 -file-list-shared-libraries
31026 @end smallexample
31027
31028 List the shared libraries in the program.
31029
31030 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31031
31032 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
31033
31034 @subsubheading Example
31035 N.A.
31036
31037
31038 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31039 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31040
31041 @subsubheading Synopsis
31042
31043 @smallexample
31044 -file-list-symbol-files
31045 @end smallexample
31046
31047 List symbol files.
31048
31049 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31050
31051 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31052
31053 @subsubheading Example
31054 N.A.
31055 @end ignore
31056
31057
31058 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31059 @findex -file-symbol-file
31060
31061 @subsubheading Synopsis
31062
31063 @smallexample
31064 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31065 @end smallexample
31066
31067 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31068 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31069 produced, except for a completion notification.
31070
31071 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31072
31073 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31074
31075 @subsubheading Example
31076
31077 @smallexample
31078 (gdb)
31079 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31080 ^done
31081 (gdb)
31082 @end smallexample
31083
31084 @ignore
31085 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31086 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31087 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31088
31089 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31090
31091 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31092
31093 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31094
31095 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31096
31097 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31098
31099 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31100
31101 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31102
31103 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31104
31105 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31106 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31107 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31108
31109 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31110
31111 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31112
31113 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31114
31115 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31116 @end ignore
31117
31118
31119 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31120 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31121 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31122
31123
31124 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31125 @findex -target-attach
31126
31127 @subsubheading Synopsis
31128
31129 @smallexample
31130 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31131 @end smallexample
31132
31133 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31134 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31135 group, the id previously returned by
31136 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31137
31138 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31139
31140 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31141
31142 @subsubheading Example
31143 @smallexample
31144 (gdb)
31145 -target-attach 34
31146 =thread-created,id="1"
31147 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31148 ^done
31149 (gdb)
31150 @end smallexample
31151
31152 @ignore
31153 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31154 @findex -target-compare-sections
31155
31156 @subsubheading Synopsis
31157
31158 @smallexample
31159 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31160 @end smallexample
31161
31162 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31163 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31164
31165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31166
31167 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31168
31169 @subsubheading Example
31170 N.A.
31171 @end ignore
31172
31173
31174 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31175 @findex -target-detach
31176
31177 @subsubheading Synopsis
31178
31179 @smallexample
31180 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31181 @end smallexample
31182
31183 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31184 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31185 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31186
31187 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31188
31189 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31190
31191 @subsubheading Example
31192
31193 @smallexample
31194 (gdb)
31195 -target-detach
31196 ^done
31197 (gdb)
31198 @end smallexample
31199
31200
31201 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31202 @findex -target-disconnect
31203
31204 @subsubheading Synopsis
31205
31206 @smallexample
31207 -target-disconnect
31208 @end smallexample
31209
31210 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31211 generally not resumed.
31212
31213 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31214
31215 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31216
31217 @subsubheading Example
31218
31219 @smallexample
31220 (gdb)
31221 -target-disconnect
31222 ^done
31223 (gdb)
31224 @end smallexample
31225
31226
31227 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31228 @findex -target-download
31229
31230 @subsubheading Synopsis
31231
31232 @smallexample
31233 -target-download
31234 @end smallexample
31235
31236 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31237 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31238
31239 @table @samp
31240 @item section
31241 The name of the section.
31242 @item section-sent
31243 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31244 @item section-size
31245 The size of the section.
31246 @item total-sent
31247 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31248 @item total-size
31249 The size of the overall executable to download.
31250 @end table
31251
31252 @noindent
31253 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31254 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31255
31256 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31257 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31258
31259 @table @samp
31260 @item section
31261 The name of the section.
31262 @item section-size
31263 The size of the section.
31264 @item total-size
31265 The size of the overall executable to download.
31266 @end table
31267
31268 @noindent
31269 At the end, a summary is printed.
31270
31271 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31272
31273 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31274
31275 @subsubheading Example
31276
31277 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31278 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31279
31280 @smallexample
31281 (gdb)
31282 -target-download
31283 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31284 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31285 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31286 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31287 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31288 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31289 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31290 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31291 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31292 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31293 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31294 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31295 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31296 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31297 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31298 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31299 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31300 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31301 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31302 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31303 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31304 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31305 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31306 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31307 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31308 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31309 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31310 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31311 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31312 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31313 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31314 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31315 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31316 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31317 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31318 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31319 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31320 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31321 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31322 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31323 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31324 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31325 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31326 write-rate="429"
31327 (gdb)
31328 @end smallexample
31329
31330
31331 @ignore
31332 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31333 @findex -target-exec-status
31334
31335 @subsubheading Synopsis
31336
31337 @smallexample
31338 -target-exec-status
31339 @end smallexample
31340
31341 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31342 not, for instance).
31343
31344 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31345
31346 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31347
31348 @subsubheading Example
31349 N.A.
31350
31351
31352 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31353 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31354
31355 @subsubheading Synopsis
31356
31357 @smallexample
31358 -target-list-available-targets
31359 @end smallexample
31360
31361 List the possible targets to connect to.
31362
31363 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31364
31365 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31366
31367 @subsubheading Example
31368 N.A.
31369
31370
31371 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31372 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31373
31374 @subsubheading Synopsis
31375
31376 @smallexample
31377 -target-list-current-targets
31378 @end smallexample
31379
31380 Describe the current target.
31381
31382 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31383
31384 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31385 other things).
31386
31387 @subsubheading Example
31388 N.A.
31389
31390
31391 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31392 @findex -target-list-parameters
31393
31394 @subsubheading Synopsis
31395
31396 @smallexample
31397 -target-list-parameters
31398 @end smallexample
31399
31400 @c ????
31401 @end ignore
31402
31403 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31404
31405 No equivalent.
31406
31407 @subsubheading Example
31408 N.A.
31409
31410
31411 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31412 @findex -target-select
31413
31414 @subsubheading Synopsis
31415
31416 @smallexample
31417 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31418 @end smallexample
31419
31420 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31421
31422 @table @samp
31423 @item @var{type}
31424 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31425 @item @var{parameters}
31426 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31427 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31428 @end table
31429
31430 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31431 which the target program is, in the following form:
31432
31433 @smallexample
31434 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31435 args=[@var{arg list}]
31436 @end smallexample
31437
31438 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31439
31440 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31441
31442 @subsubheading Example
31443
31444 @smallexample
31445 (gdb)
31446 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31447 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31448 (gdb)
31449 @end smallexample
31450
31451 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31452 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31453 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31454
31455
31456 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31457 @findex -target-file-put
31458
31459 @subsubheading Synopsis
31460
31461 @smallexample
31462 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31463 @end smallexample
31464
31465 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31466 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31467
31468 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31469
31470 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31471
31472 @subsubheading Example
31473
31474 @smallexample
31475 (gdb)
31476 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31477 ^done
31478 (gdb)
31479 @end smallexample
31480
31481
31482 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31483 @findex -target-file-get
31484
31485 @subsubheading Synopsis
31486
31487 @smallexample
31488 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31489 @end smallexample
31490
31491 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31492 on the host system.
31493
31494 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31495
31496 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31497
31498 @subsubheading Example
31499
31500 @smallexample
31501 (gdb)
31502 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31503 ^done
31504 (gdb)
31505 @end smallexample
31506
31507
31508 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31509 @findex -target-file-delete
31510
31511 @subsubheading Synopsis
31512
31513 @smallexample
31514 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31515 @end smallexample
31516
31517 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31518
31519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31520
31521 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31522
31523 @subsubheading Example
31524
31525 @smallexample
31526 (gdb)
31527 -target-file-delete remotefile
31528 ^done
31529 (gdb)
31530 @end smallexample
31531
31532
31533 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31534 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31535 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31536
31537 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31538 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31539
31540 @subsubheading Synopsis
31541
31542 @smallexample
31543 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31544 @end smallexample
31545
31546 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31547 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31548 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31549
31550 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31551
31552 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31553
31554 @subsubheading Result
31555
31556 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31557 defined for each exception:
31558
31559 @table @samp
31560 @item name
31561 The name of the exception.
31562
31563 @item address
31564 The address of the exception.
31565
31566 @end table
31567
31568 @subsubheading Example
31569
31570 @smallexample
31571 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31572 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31573 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31574 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31575 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31576 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31577 @end smallexample
31578
31579 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31580
31581 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31582 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31583 Catchpoint Commands}.
31584
31585
31586 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31587 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31588 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31589
31590 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31591 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31592 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31593 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31594
31595 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31596 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31597 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31598
31599 @subsubheading Synopsis
31600
31601 @smallexample
31602 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31603 @end smallexample
31604
31605 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31606
31607 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31608 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31609 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31610 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31611 dash.
31612
31613 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31614
31615 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31616
31617 @subsubheading Result
31618
31619 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31620
31621 @table @samp
31622 @item exists
31623 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31624 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31625
31626 @end table
31627
31628 @subsubheading Example
31629
31630 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31631
31632 @smallexample
31633 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31634 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31635 @end smallexample
31636
31637 @noindent
31638 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31639 to the debugger:
31640
31641 @smallexample
31642 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31643 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31644 @end smallexample
31645
31646 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31647 @findex -list-features
31648 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31649
31650 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31651 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31652 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31653 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31654 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31655 startup.
31656
31657 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31658 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31659 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31660 is given below.
31661
31662 Example output:
31663
31664 @smallexample
31665 (gdb) -list-features
31666 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31667 @end smallexample
31668
31669 The current list of features is:
31670
31671 @ftable @samp
31672 @item frozen-varobjs
31673 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31674 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31675 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31676 @item pending-breakpoints
31677 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31678 command.
31679 @item python
31680 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31681 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31682 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31683 @item thread-info
31684 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31685 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31686 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31687 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31688 @item breakpoint-notifications
31689 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31690 CLI will be announced via async records.
31691 @item ada-task-info
31692 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31693 @item language-option
31694 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31695 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31696 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31697 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31698 @item undefined-command-error-code
31699 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31700 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31701 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31702 @item exec-run-start-option
31703 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31704 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31705 @end ftable
31706
31707 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31708 @findex -list-target-features
31709
31710 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31711 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31712 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31713 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31714 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31715 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31716 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31717 Example output:
31718
31719 @smallexample
31720 (gdb) -list-target-features
31721 ^done,result=["async"]
31722 @end smallexample
31723
31724 The current list of features is:
31725
31726 @table @samp
31727 @item async
31728 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31729 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31730 while the target is running.
31731
31732 @item reverse
31733 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31734 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31735
31736 @end table
31737
31738 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31739 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31740 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31741
31742 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31743
31744 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31745 @findex -gdb-exit
31746
31747 @subsubheading Synopsis
31748
31749 @smallexample
31750 -gdb-exit
31751 @end smallexample
31752
31753 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31754
31755 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31756
31757 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31758
31759 @subsubheading Example
31760
31761 @smallexample
31762 (gdb)
31763 -gdb-exit
31764 ^exit
31765 @end smallexample
31766
31767
31768 @ignore
31769 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31770 @findex -exec-abort
31771
31772 @subsubheading Synopsis
31773
31774 @smallexample
31775 -exec-abort
31776 @end smallexample
31777
31778 Kill the inferior running program.
31779
31780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31781
31782 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31783
31784 @subsubheading Example
31785 N.A.
31786 @end ignore
31787
31788
31789 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31790 @findex -gdb-set
31791
31792 @subsubheading Synopsis
31793
31794 @smallexample
31795 -gdb-set
31796 @end smallexample
31797
31798 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31799 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31800
31801 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31802
31803 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31804
31805 @subsubheading Example
31806
31807 @smallexample
31808 (gdb)
31809 -gdb-set $foo=3
31810 ^done
31811 (gdb)
31812 @end smallexample
31813
31814
31815 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31816 @findex -gdb-show
31817
31818 @subsubheading Synopsis
31819
31820 @smallexample
31821 -gdb-show
31822 @end smallexample
31823
31824 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31825
31826 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31827
31828 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31829
31830 @subsubheading Example
31831
31832 @smallexample
31833 (gdb)
31834 -gdb-show annotate
31835 ^done,value="0"
31836 (gdb)
31837 @end smallexample
31838
31839 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31840
31841
31842 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31843 @findex -gdb-version
31844
31845 @subsubheading Synopsis
31846
31847 @smallexample
31848 -gdb-version
31849 @end smallexample
31850
31851 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31852
31853 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31854
31855 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31856 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31857
31858 @subsubheading Example
31859
31860 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31861 @c box in TeX.
31862 @smallexample
31863 (gdb)
31864 -gdb-version
31865 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31866 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31867 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31868 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31869 ~ certain conditions.
31870 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31871 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31872 ~ details.
31873 ~This GDB was configured as
31874 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31875 ^done
31876 (gdb)
31877 @end smallexample
31878
31879 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31880 @findex -list-thread-groups
31881
31882 @subheading Synopsis
31883
31884 @smallexample
31885 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31886 @end smallexample
31887
31888 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31889 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31890 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31891 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31892 top-level thread groups.
31893
31894 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31895 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31896 available on the target.
31897
31898 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31899 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31900 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31901 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31902 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31903 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31904 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31905 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31906
31907 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31908 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31909 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31910 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31911 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31912 @samp{threads} field.
31913
31914 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31915 the following caveats:
31916
31917 @itemize @bullet
31918 @item
31919 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31920 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31921 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31922
31923 @item
31924 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31925 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31926 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31927 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31928 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31929 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31930
31931 @end itemize
31932
31933 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31934 have the following fields:
31935
31936 @table @code
31937 @item id
31938 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31939 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31940 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31941
31942 @item type
31943 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31944 valid type.
31945
31946 @item pid
31947 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31948 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31949
31950 @item exit-code
31951 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
31952 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
31953 only if the process is not running.
31954
31955 @item num_children
31956 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31957 absent for an available thread group.
31958
31959 @item threads
31960 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31961 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31962 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31963
31964 @item cores
31965 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31966 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31967 such information is not available.
31968
31969 @item executable
31970 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31971 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31972 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31973
31974 @end table
31975
31976 @subheading Example
31977
31978 @smallexample
31979 @value{GDBP}
31980 -list-thread-groups
31981 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31982 -list-thread-groups 17
31983 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31984 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31985 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31986 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31987 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31988 -list-thread-groups --available
31989 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31990 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31991 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31992 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31993 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31994 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31995 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31996 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31997 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31998 @end smallexample
31999
32000 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32001 @findex -info-os
32002
32003 @subsubheading Synopsis
32004
32005 @smallexample
32006 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32007 @end smallexample
32008
32009 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32010 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32011 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32012 of data of that type.
32013
32014 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32015 system.
32016
32017 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32018
32019 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32020
32021 @subsubheading Example
32022
32023 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32024 like this:
32025
32026 @smallexample
32027 @value{GDBP}
32028 -info-os
32029 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32030 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32031 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32032 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32033 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32034 col2="CPUs"@},
32035 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32036 col2="File descriptors"@},
32037 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32038 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32039 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32040 col2="Message queues"@},
32041 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32042 col2="Processes"@},
32043 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32044 col2="Process groups"@},
32045 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32046 col2="Semaphores"@},
32047 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32048 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32049 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32050 col2="Sockets"@},
32051 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32052 col2="Threads"@}]
32053 @value{GDBP}
32054 -info-os processes
32055 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32056 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32057 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32058 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32059 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32060 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32061 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32062 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32063 ...
32064 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32065 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32066 (gdb)
32067 @end smallexample
32068
32069 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32070 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32071 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32072 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32073 @code{info os} omits it.)
32074
32075 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32076 @findex -add-inferior
32077
32078 @subheading Synopsis
32079
32080 @smallexample
32081 -add-inferior
32082 @end smallexample
32083
32084 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32085 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32086 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32087 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32088 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32089 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32090
32091 @subheading Example
32092
32093 @smallexample
32094 @value{GDBP}
32095 -add-inferior
32096 ^done,inferior="i3"
32097 @end smallexample
32098
32099 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32100 @findex -interpreter-exec
32101
32102 @subheading Synopsis
32103
32104 @smallexample
32105 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32106 @end smallexample
32107 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32108
32109 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32110
32111 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32112
32113 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32114
32115 @subheading Example
32116
32117 @smallexample
32118 (gdb)
32119 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32120 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32121 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32122 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32123 ^done
32124 (gdb)
32125 @end smallexample
32126
32127 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32128 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32129
32130 @subheading Synopsis
32131
32132 @smallexample
32133 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32134 @end smallexample
32135
32136 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32137
32138 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32139
32140 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32141
32142 @subheading Example
32143
32144 @smallexample
32145 (gdb)
32146 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32147 ^done
32148 (gdb)
32149 @end smallexample
32150
32151 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32152 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32153
32154 @subheading Synopsis
32155
32156 @smallexample
32157 -inferior-tty-show
32158 @end smallexample
32159
32160 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32161
32162 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32163
32164 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32165
32166 @subheading Example
32167
32168 @smallexample
32169 (gdb)
32170 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32171 ^done
32172 (gdb)
32173 -inferior-tty-show
32174 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32175 (gdb)
32176 @end smallexample
32177
32178 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32179 @findex -enable-timings
32180
32181 @subheading Synopsis
32182
32183 @smallexample
32184 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32185 @end smallexample
32186
32187 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32188 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32189 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32190 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32191
32192 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32193
32194 No equivalent.
32195
32196 @subheading Example
32197
32198 @smallexample
32199 (gdb)
32200 -enable-timings
32201 ^done
32202 (gdb)
32203 -break-insert main
32204 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32205 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32206 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32207 times="0"@},
32208 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32209 (gdb)
32210 -enable-timings no
32211 ^done
32212 (gdb)
32213 -exec-run
32214 ^running
32215 (gdb)
32216 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32217 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32218 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32219 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32220 (gdb)
32221 @end smallexample
32222
32223 @node Annotations
32224 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32225
32226 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32227 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32228 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32229 relatively high level.
32230
32231 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32232 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32233
32234 @ignore
32235 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32236 @end ignore
32237
32238 @menu
32239 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32240 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32241 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32242 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32243 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32244 * Annotations for Running::
32245 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32246 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32247 @end menu
32248
32249 @node Annotations Overview
32250 @section What is an Annotation?
32251 @cindex annotations
32252
32253 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32254 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32255 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32256 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32257 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32258 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32259 cannot contain newline characters.
32260
32261 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32262 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32263 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32264 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32265 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32266 means those three characters as output.
32267
32268 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32269 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32270 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32271 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32272 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32273 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32274 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32275 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32276 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32277
32278 @table @code
32279 @kindex set annotate
32280 @item set annotate @var{level}
32281 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32282 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32283
32284 @item show annotate
32285 @kindex show annotate
32286 Show the current annotation level.
32287 @end table
32288
32289 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32290
32291 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32292
32293 @smallexample
32294 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32295 GNU gdb 6.0
32296 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32297 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32298 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32299 under certain conditions.
32300 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32301 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32302 for details.
32303 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32304
32305 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32306 (@value{GDBP})
32307 ^Z^Zprompt
32308 @kbd{quit}
32309
32310 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32311 $
32312 @end smallexample
32313
32314 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32315 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32316 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32317 output from @value{GDBN}.
32318
32319 @node Server Prefix
32320 @section The Server Prefix
32321 @cindex server prefix
32322
32323 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32324 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32325 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32326 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32327 a transparent manner.
32328
32329 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32330 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32331 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32332 @code{print} command.
32333
32334 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32335 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32336
32337 @node Prompting
32338 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32339
32340 @cindex annotations for prompts
32341 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32342 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32343 over, etc.
32344
32345 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32346 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32347 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32348 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32349 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32350 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32351 features the following annotations:
32352
32353 @smallexample
32354 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32355 ^Z^Zprompt
32356 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32357 @end smallexample
32358
32359 The input types are
32360
32361 @table @code
32362 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32363 @findex prompt annotation
32364 @findex post-prompt annotation
32365 @item prompt
32366 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32367
32368 @findex pre-commands annotation
32369 @findex commands annotation
32370 @findex post-commands annotation
32371 @item commands
32372 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32373 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32374
32375 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32376 @findex overload-choice annotation
32377 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32378 @item overload-choice
32379 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32380
32381 @findex pre-query annotation
32382 @findex query annotation
32383 @findex post-query annotation
32384 @item query
32385 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32386
32387 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32388 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32389 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32390 @item prompt-for-continue
32391 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32392 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32393 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32394 presence of annotations.
32395 @end table
32396
32397 @node Errors
32398 @section Errors
32399 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32400
32401 @findex quit annotation
32402 @smallexample
32403 ^Z^Zquit
32404 @end smallexample
32405
32406 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32407
32408 @findex error annotation
32409 @smallexample
32410 ^Z^Zerror
32411 @end smallexample
32412
32413 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32414
32415 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32416 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32417 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32418 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32419 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32420 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32421 to the top level.
32422
32423 @findex error-begin annotation
32424 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32425
32426 @smallexample
32427 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32428 @end smallexample
32429
32430 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32431 message.
32432
32433 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32434 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32435 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32436
32437 @node Invalidation
32438 @section Invalidation Notices
32439
32440 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32441 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32442 changed.
32443
32444 @table @code
32445 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32446 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32447
32448 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32449 have changed.
32450
32451 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32452 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32453
32454 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32455 deleted a breakpoint.
32456 @end table
32457
32458 @node Annotations for Running
32459 @section Running the Program
32460 @cindex annotations for running programs
32461
32462 @findex starting annotation
32463 @findex stopping annotation
32464 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32465 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32466
32467 @smallexample
32468 ^Z^Zstarting
32469 @end smallexample
32470
32471 is output. When the program stops,
32472
32473 @smallexample
32474 ^Z^Zstopped
32475 @end smallexample
32476
32477 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32478 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32479
32480 @table @code
32481 @findex exited annotation
32482 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32483 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32484 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32485
32486 @findex signalled annotation
32487 @findex signal-name annotation
32488 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32489 @findex signal-string annotation
32490 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32491 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32492 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32493 annotation continues:
32494
32495 @smallexample
32496 @var{intro-text}
32497 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32498 @var{name}
32499 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32500 @var{middle-text}
32501 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32502 @var{string}
32503 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32504 @var{end-text}
32505 @end smallexample
32506
32507 @noindent
32508 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32509 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32510 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32511 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32512 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32513
32514 @findex signal annotation
32515 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32516 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32517 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32518 terminated with it.
32519
32520 @findex breakpoint annotation
32521 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32522 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32523
32524 @findex watchpoint annotation
32525 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32526 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32527 @end table
32528
32529 @node Source Annotations
32530 @section Displaying Source
32531 @cindex annotations for source display
32532
32533 @findex source annotation
32534 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32535
32536 @smallexample
32537 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32538 @end smallexample
32539
32540 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32541 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32542 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32543 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32544 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32545 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32546 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32547 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32548 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32549 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32550 depend on the language).
32551
32552 @node JIT Interface
32553 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32554 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32555 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32556
32557 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32558 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32559 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32560 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32561
32562 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32563 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32564 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32565 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32566 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32567 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32568
32569 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32570 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32571 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32572 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32573 LLVM JIT.
32574
32575 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32576 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32577 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32578 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32579 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32580 out about additional code.
32581
32582 @menu
32583 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32584 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32585 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32586 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32587 @end menu
32588
32589 @node Declarations
32590 @section JIT Declarations
32591
32592 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32593 implement the interface:
32594
32595 @smallexample
32596 typedef enum
32597 @{
32598 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32599 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32600 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32601 @} jit_actions_t;
32602
32603 struct jit_code_entry
32604 @{
32605 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32606 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32607 const char *symfile_addr;
32608 uint64_t symfile_size;
32609 @};
32610
32611 struct jit_descriptor
32612 @{
32613 uint32_t version;
32614 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32615 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32616 uint32_t action_flag;
32617 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32618 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32619 @};
32620
32621 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32622 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32623
32624 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32625 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32626 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32627 @end smallexample
32628
32629 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32630 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32631 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32632
32633 @node Registering Code
32634 @section Registering Code
32635
32636 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32637
32638 @itemize @bullet
32639 @item
32640 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32641 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32642
32643 @item
32644 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32645 file.
32646
32647 @item
32648 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32649
32650 @item
32651 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32652
32653 @item
32654 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32655 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32656 @end itemize
32657
32658 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32659 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32660 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32661 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32662
32663 @node Unregistering Code
32664 @section Unregistering Code
32665
32666 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32667
32668 @itemize @bullet
32669 @item
32670 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32671
32672 @item
32673 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32674
32675 @item
32676 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32677 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32678 @end itemize
32679
32680 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32681 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32682
32683 @node Custom Debug Info
32684 @section Custom Debug Info
32685 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32686 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32687
32688 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32689 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32690 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32691 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32692 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32693 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32694 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32695 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32696 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32697
32698 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32699 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32700 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32701 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32702 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32703 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32704 compiler.
32705
32706 @menu
32707 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32708 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
32709 @end menu
32710
32711 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32712 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32713 @kindex jit-reader-load
32714 @kindex jit-reader-unload
32715
32716 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
32717 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
32718
32719 @table @code
32720 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
32721 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
32722 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
32723 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
32724 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
32725 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32726 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32727
32728 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32729 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32730 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32731 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32732 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32733
32734 @item jit-reader-unload
32735 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32736
32737 @end table
32738
32739 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32740 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32741 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32742
32743 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32744 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32745
32746 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32747 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32748 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32749 the system include directory.
32750
32751 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32752 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32753 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32754
32755 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32756 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32757
32758 @findex gdb_init_reader
32759 @smallexample
32760 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32761 @end smallexample
32762
32763 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32764
32765 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32766 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32767 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32768 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32769 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32770 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32771
32772 @smallexample
32773 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32774 @{
32775 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32776 int reader_version;
32777
32778 /* For use by the reader. */
32779 void *priv_data;
32780
32781 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32782 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32783 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32784 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32785 @};
32786 @end smallexample
32787
32788 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32789 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32790
32791 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32792 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32793 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32794 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32795 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32796 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32797 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32798 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32799 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32800 target's address space.
32801
32802 @node In-Process Agent
32803 @chapter In-Process Agent
32804 @cindex debugging agent
32805 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32806 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32807 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32808 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32809 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32810 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32811 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32812 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32813 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32814 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32815 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32816 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32817 behavior without interrupting it.
32818
32819 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32820 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32821 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32822 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32823 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32824 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32825 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32826 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32827 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32828
32829 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32830 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32831 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32832 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32833
32834 @anchor{Control Agent}
32835 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32836 debugging with the following commands:
32837
32838 @table @code
32839 @kindex set agent on
32840 @item set agent on
32841 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32842 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32843 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32844 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32845 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32846 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32847
32848 @kindex set agent off
32849 @item set agent off
32850 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32851 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32852
32853 @kindex show agent
32854 @item show agent
32855 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32856 the in-process agent.
32857 @end table
32858
32859 @menu
32860 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32861 @end menu
32862
32863 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32864 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32865 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32866
32867 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32868 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32869 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32870 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32871 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32872 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32873 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32874 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32875 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32876
32877 @menu
32878 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32879 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32880 @end menu
32881
32882 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32883 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32884 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32885
32886 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32887 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32888
32889 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32890 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32891 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32892 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32893
32894 @enumerate
32895 @item
32896 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32897 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32898 @item
32899 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32900 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32901 the other one.
32902 @end enumerate
32903
32904 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32905
32906 @enumerate
32907 @item
32908 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32909 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32910 @anchor{agent expression object}
32911 @item
32912 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32913 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32914 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32915 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32916 @item
32917 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32918 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32919
32920 @end enumerate
32921
32922 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32923 object:
32924
32925 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32926 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32927 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32928 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32929 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32930 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32931 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32932 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32933 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32934 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32935 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32936 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32937 memory address for collecting.
32938 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32939 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32940 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32941 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32942 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32943 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32944 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32945 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32946 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32947 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32948 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32949 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32950 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32951 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32952 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32953 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32954 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32955 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32956 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32957 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32958 @ref{agent expression object}
32959 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32960 @ref{agent expression object}
32961 @item actions @tab variable
32962 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32963 @end multitable
32964
32965 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32966 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32967 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32968
32969 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32970 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32971
32972 @table @samp
32973
32974 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32975 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32976 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32977 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32978 in IPA finally.
32979
32980 Replies:
32981 @table @samp
32982 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32983 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32984 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32985 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32986 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32987 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32988 @item E @var{NN}
32989 for an error
32990
32991 @end table
32992
32993 @item close
32994 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32995 is about to kill inferiors.
32996
32997 @item qTfSTM
32998 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32999 @item qTsSTM
33000 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33001 @item qTSTMat
33002 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33003 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33004 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33005
33006 Replies:
33007 @table @samp
33008 @item E @var{NN}
33009 for an error
33010 @end table
33011 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33012 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33013 @end table
33014
33015 @node GDB Bugs
33016 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33017 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33018 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33019
33020 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33021
33022 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33023 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33024 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33025 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33026
33027 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33028 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33029
33030 @menu
33031 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33032 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33033 @end menu
33034
33035 @node Bug Criteria
33036 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33037 @cindex bug criteria
33038
33039 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33040
33041 @itemize @bullet
33042 @cindex fatal signal
33043 @cindex debugger crash
33044 @cindex crash of debugger
33045 @item
33046 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33047 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33048
33049 @cindex error on valid input
33050 @item
33051 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33052 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33053 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33054
33055 @cindex invalid input
33056 @item
33057 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33058 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33059 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33060 for traditional practice''.
33061
33062 @item
33063 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33064 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33065 @end itemize
33066
33067 @node Bug Reporting
33068 @section How to Report Bugs
33069 @cindex bug reports
33070 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33071
33072 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33073 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33074 contact that organization first.
33075
33076 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33077 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33078 distribution.
33079 @c should add a web page ref...
33080
33081 @ifset BUGURL
33082 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33083 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33084 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33085 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33086 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33087 be used.
33088
33089 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33090 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33091 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33092 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33093
33094 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33095 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33096 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33097 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33098 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33099 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33100 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33101 bug reports to the mailing list.
33102 @end ifset
33103 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33104 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33105 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33106 @end ifclear
33107 @end ifset
33108
33109 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33110 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33111 fact or leave it out, state it!
33112
33113 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33114 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33115 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33116 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33117 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33118 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33119 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33120 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33121 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33122
33123 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33124 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33125 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33126 self-contained.
33127
33128 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33129 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33130 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33131 bugs properly.
33132
33133 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33134
33135 @itemize @bullet
33136 @item
33137 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33138 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33139 version}.
33140
33141 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33142 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33143
33144 @item
33145 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33146 version number.
33147
33148 @item
33149 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33150 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33151 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33152 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33153
33154 @item
33155 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33156 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33157
33158 @item
33159 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33160 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33161 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33162 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33163 those compilers.
33164
33165 @item
33166 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33167 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33168 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33169 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33170
33171 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33172 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33173
33174 @item
33175 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33176 reproduce the bug.
33177
33178 @item
33179 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33180 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33181
33182 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33183 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33184 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33185 a chance to make a mistake.
33186
33187 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33188 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33189 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33190 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33191 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33192 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33193 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33194 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33195
33196 @pindex script
33197 @cindex recording a session script
33198 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33199 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33200 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33201 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33202
33203 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33204 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33205
33206 @item
33207 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33208 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33209 it by context, not by line number.
33210
33211 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33212 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33213
33214 @end itemize
33215
33216 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33217
33218 @itemize @bullet
33219 @item
33220 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33221
33222 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33223 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33224 changes will not affect it.
33225
33226 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33227 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33228 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33229 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33230
33231 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33232 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33233 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33234 less time, and so on.
33235
33236 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33237 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33238
33239 @item
33240 A patch for the bug.
33241
33242 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33243 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33244 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33245 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33246
33247 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33248 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33249 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33250 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33251
33252 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33253 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33254 help us to understand.
33255
33256 @item
33257 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33258
33259 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33260 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33261 @end itemize
33262
33263 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33264 @c and consists of the two following files:
33265 @c rluser.texi
33266 @c hsuser.texi
33267 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33268 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33269 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33270 @include rluser.texi
33271 @include hsuser.texi
33272 @end ifclear
33273
33274 @node In Memoriam
33275 @appendix In Memoriam
33276
33277 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33278 contributors:
33279
33280 @table @code
33281 @item Fred Fish
33282 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33283 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33284 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33285
33286 @item Michael Snyder
33287 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33288 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33289 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33290 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33291 @end table
33292
33293 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33294 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33295
33296 @node Formatting Documentation
33297 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33298
33299 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33300 @cindex reference card
33301 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33302 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33303 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33304 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33305 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33306 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33307
33308 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33309 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33310
33311 @smallexample
33312 make refcard.dvi
33313 @end smallexample
33314
33315 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33316 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33317 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33318 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33319 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33320
33321 @cindex documentation
33322
33323 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33324 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33325 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33326 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33327 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33328 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33329
33330 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33331 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33332 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33333 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33334 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33335 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33336 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33337 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33338
33339 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33340 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33341 @code{makeinfo}.
33342
33343 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33344 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33345 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33346
33347 @smallexample
33348 cd gdb
33349 make gdb.info
33350 @end smallexample
33351
33352 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33353 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33354 Texinfo definitions file.
33355
33356 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33357 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33358 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33359 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33360 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33361 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33362 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33363
33364 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33365 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33366 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33367 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33368 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33369 directory.
33370
33371 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33372 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33373 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33374 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33375
33376 @smallexample
33377 make gdb.dvi
33378 @end smallexample
33379
33380 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33381
33382 @node Installing GDB
33383 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33384 @cindex installation
33385
33386 @menu
33387 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33388 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33389 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33390 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33391 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33392 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33393 @end menu
33394
33395 @node Requirements
33396 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33397 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33398
33399 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33400 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33401
33402 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33403 @table @asis
33404 @item ISO C90 compiler
33405 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33406 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33407
33408 @end table
33409
33410 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33411 @table @asis
33412 @item Expat
33413 @anchor{Expat}
33414 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33415 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33416 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33417 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33418 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33419 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33420
33421 Expat is used for:
33422
33423 @itemize @bullet
33424 @item
33425 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33426 @item
33427 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33428 @item
33429 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33430 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33431 @item
33432 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33433 @item
33434 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33435 @item
33436 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33437 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33438 @end itemize
33439
33440 @item zlib
33441 @cindex compressed debug sections
33442 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33443 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33444 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33445 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33446 information in such binaries.
33447
33448 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33449 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33450 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33451
33452 @item iconv
33453 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33454 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33455 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33456 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33457
33458 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33459 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33460 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33461 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33462
33463 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33464 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33465 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33466
33467 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33468 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33469 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33470 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33471 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33472 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33473 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33474 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33475 @end table
33476
33477 @node Running Configure
33478 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33479 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33480 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33481 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33482 build the @code{gdb} program.
33483 @iftex
33484 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33485 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33486 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33487 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33488 @end iftex
33489
33490 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33491 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33492 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33493
33494 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33495 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33496
33497 @table @code
33498 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33499 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33500
33501 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33502 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33503
33504 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33505 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33506
33507 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33508 @sc{gnu} include files
33509
33510 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33511 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33512
33513 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33514 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33515
33516 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33517 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33518
33519 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33520 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33521
33522 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33523 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33524 @end table
33525
33526 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33527 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33528 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33529
33530 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33531 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33532 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33533 argument.
33534
33535 For example:
33536
33537 @smallexample
33538 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33539 ./configure @var{host}
33540 make
33541 @end smallexample
33542
33543 @noindent
33544 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33545 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33546 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33547 correct value by examining your system.)
33548
33549 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33550 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33551 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33552 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33553
33554 @need 750
33555 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33556 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33557 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33558
33559 @smallexample
33560 sh configure @var{host}
33561 @end smallexample
33562
33563 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33564 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33565 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33566 @file{configure}
33567 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33568 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33569
33570 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33571 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33572 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33573 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33574 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33575 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33576 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33577 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33578 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33579
33580 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33581 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33582 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33583 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33584 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33585
33586 @node Separate Objdir
33587 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33588
33589 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33590 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33591 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33592 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33593 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33594 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33595 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33596 program specified there.
33597
33598 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33599 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33600 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33601 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33602 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33603 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33604
33605 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33606 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33607
33608 @smallexample
33609 @group
33610 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33611 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33612 cd ../gdb-sun4
33613 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33614 make
33615 @end group
33616 @end smallexample
33617
33618 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33619 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33620 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33621 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33622 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33623 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33624
33625 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33626 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33627 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33628 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33629 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33630
33631 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33632 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33633 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33634 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33635 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33636 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33637
33638 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33639 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33640 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33641
33642 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33643 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33644 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33645 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33646 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33647
33648 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33649 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33650 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33651 with each other.
33652
33653 @node Config Names
33654 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33655
33656 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33657 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33658 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33659 of information in the following pattern:
33660
33661 @smallexample
33662 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33663 @end smallexample
33664
33665 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33666 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33667 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33668
33669 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33670 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33671 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33672 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33673 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33674 abbreviations---for example:
33675
33676 @smallexample
33677 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33678 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33679 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33680 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33681 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33682 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33683 % sh config.sub sun4
33684 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33685 % sh config.sub sun3
33686 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33687 % sh config.sub i986v
33688 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33689 @end smallexample
33690
33691 @noindent
33692 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33693 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33694
33695 @node Configure Options
33696 @section @file{configure} Options
33697
33698 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33699 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33700 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33701 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33702
33703 @smallexample
33704 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33705 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33706 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33707 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33708 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
33709 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
33710 @var{host}
33711 @end smallexample
33712
33713 @noindent
33714 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
33715 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
33716 @samp{--}.
33717
33718 @table @code
33719 @item --help
33720 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
33721
33722 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
33723 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
33724 @file{@var{dir}}.
33725
33726 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33727 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33728 @file{@var{dir}}.
33729
33730 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33731 @need 2000
33732 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33733 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33734 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33735 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33736 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33737 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33738 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33739 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33740 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33741 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33742 @var{dirname}.
33743
33744 @item --norecursion
33745 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33746 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33747
33748 @item --target=@var{target}
33749 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33750 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33751 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33752
33753 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33754
33755 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33756 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33757
33758 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
33759 @end table
33760
33761 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
33762 needed for special purposes only.
33763
33764 @node System-wide configuration
33765 @section System-wide configuration and settings
33766 @cindex system-wide init file
33767
33768 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
33769 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
33770 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
33771
33772 Here is the corresponding configure option:
33773
33774 @table @code
33775 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
33776 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
33777 @var{file}.
33778 @end table
33779
33780 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
33781 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
33782
33783 @itemize @bullet
33784 @item
33785 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
33786 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
33787 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
33788 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
33789 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
33790 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
33791
33792 @item
33793 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
33794 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
33795 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33796 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33797 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33798 @end itemize
33799
33800 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33801 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33802 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33803 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33804 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33805 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33806 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33807 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33808 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33809 reread.
33810
33811 @menu
33812 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33813 @end menu
33814
33815 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33816 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33817 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33818
33819 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33820 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33821 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33822 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33823 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33824 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33825
33826 The following scripts are currently available:
33827 @itemize @bullet
33828
33829 @item @file{elinos.py}
33830 @pindex elinos.py
33831 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33832 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33833 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33834 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33835 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33836 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33837
33838 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33839 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33840 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33841 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33842 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33843 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33844
33845 @end itemize
33846
33847 @node Maintenance Commands
33848 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33849 @cindex maintenance commands
33850 @cindex internal commands
33851
33852 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33853 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33854 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33855 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33856 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33857
33858 @table @code
33859 @kindex maint agent
33860 @kindex maint agent-eval
33861 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33862 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33863 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33864 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33865 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33866 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33867 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33868 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33869 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33870 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33871 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33872 addition and return the sum.
33873 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33874 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33875
33876 @kindex maint agent-printf
33877 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33878 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33879 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33880 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33881 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33882
33883 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33884 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33885 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33886 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33887 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33888 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33889 is shown:
33890
33891 @table @code
33892 @item breakpoint
33893 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33894
33895 @item watchpoint
33896 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33897
33898 @item longjmp
33899 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33900 @code{longjmp} calls.
33901
33902 @item longjmp resume
33903 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33904
33905 @item until
33906 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33907
33908 @item finish
33909 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33910
33911 @item shlib events
33912 Shared library events.
33913
33914 @end table
33915
33916 @kindex maint info bfds
33917 @item maint info bfds
33918 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33919 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33920
33921 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33922 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33923 @cindex displaced stepping support
33924 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33925 @item set displaced-stepping
33926 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33927 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33928 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33929 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33930 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33931 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33932
33933 @table @code
33934 @item set displaced-stepping on
33935 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33936 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33937
33938 @item set displaced-stepping off
33939 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33940 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33941
33942 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33943 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33944 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33945 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33946 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33947 @end table
33948
33949 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33950 @item maint check-psymtabs
33951 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33952 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33953
33954 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33955 @item maint check-symtabs
33956 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33957
33958 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33959 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33960 Expand symbol tables.
33961 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33962 names matching @var{regexp}.
33963
33964 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
33965 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33966 @cindex demangler crashes
33967 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
33968 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33969 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
33970 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
33971 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
33972 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
33973 option to terminate the current session.
33974
33975 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33976 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33977 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33978
33979 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33980 @item maint cplus namespace
33981 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33982
33983 @kindex maint deprecate
33984 @kindex maint undeprecate
33985 @cindex deprecated commands
33986 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33987 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33988 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33989 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33990 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33991 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33992 the replacement as part of the warning.
33993
33994 @kindex maint dump-me
33995 @item maint dump-me
33996 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33997 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33998 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33999 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34000
34001 @kindex maint internal-error
34002 @kindex maint internal-warning
34003 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34004 @cindex demangler crashes
34005 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34006 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34007 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34008
34009 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34010 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34011 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34012 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34013 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34014 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34015 @value{GDBN} session.
34016
34017 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34018 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34019
34020 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34021
34022 @smallexample
34023 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34024 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34025 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34026 debugging may prove unreliable.
34027 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34028 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34029 (@value{GDBP})
34030 @end smallexample
34031
34032 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34033 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34034 @cindex demangler crashes
34035
34036 @kindex maint set internal-error
34037 @kindex maint show internal-error
34038 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34039 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34040 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34041 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34042 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34043 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34044 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34045 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34046 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34047 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34048 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34049 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34050 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34051 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34052 described in the table below.
34053
34054 @table @samp
34055 @item quit
34056 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34057 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34058
34059 @item corefile
34060 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34061 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34062 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34063 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34064 disabled.
34065 @end table
34066
34067 @kindex maint packet
34068 @item maint packet @var{text}
34069 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34070 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34071 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34072 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34073 checksum.
34074
34075 @kindex maint print architecture
34076 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34077 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34078 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34079
34080 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34081 @item maint print c-tdesc
34082 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34083 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34084 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34085
34086 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34087 @item maint print dummy-frames
34088 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34089
34090 @smallexample
34091 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34092 @dots{}
34093 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34094 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34095 58 return (a + b);
34096 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34097 @dots{}
34098 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34099 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34100 (@value{GDBP})
34101 @end smallexample
34102
34103 Takes an optional file parameter.
34104
34105 @kindex maint print registers
34106 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34107 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34108 @kindex maint print register-groups
34109 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34110 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34111 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34112 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34113 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34114 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34115 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34116
34117 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34118 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34119 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34120 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34121 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34122 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34123 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34124 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34125
34126 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34127 write the information.
34128
34129 @kindex maint print reggroups
34130 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34131 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34132 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34133 information.
34134
34135 The register groups info looks like this:
34136
34137 @smallexample
34138 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34139 Group Type
34140 general user
34141 float user
34142 all user
34143 vector user
34144 system user
34145 save internal
34146 restore internal
34147 @end smallexample
34148
34149 @kindex flushregs
34150 @item flushregs
34151 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34152
34153 @kindex maint print objfiles
34154 @cindex info for known object files
34155 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34156 Print a dump of all known object files.
34157 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34158 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34159 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34160
34161 @kindex maint print user-registers
34162 @cindex user registers
34163 @item maint print user-registers
34164 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34165 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34166 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34167 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34168 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34169 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34170 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34171
34172 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34173 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34174 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34175 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34176 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34177 matching @var{regexp}.
34178 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34179 and the full path if known.
34180 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34181
34182 @kindex maint print statistics
34183 @cindex bcache statistics
34184 @item maint print statistics
34185 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34186 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34187 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34188 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34189 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34190 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34191 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34192 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34193 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34194 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34195 lengths.
34196
34197 @kindex maint print target-stack
34198 @cindex target stack description
34199 @item maint print target-stack
34200 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34201 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34202 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34203 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34204 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34205 address.
34206
34207 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34208 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34209
34210 @kindex maint print type
34211 @cindex type chain of a data type
34212 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34213 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34214 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34215 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34216 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34217 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34218
34219 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34220 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34221 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34222 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34223 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34224 information.
34225
34226 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34227 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34228 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34229 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34230 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34231 always see the disassembly form.
34232
34233 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34234
34235 @smallexample
34236 (gdb) info addr argc
34237 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34238 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34239 @end smallexample
34240
34241 For more information on these expressions, see
34242 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34243
34244 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34245 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34246 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34247 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34248 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34249
34250 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34251 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34252 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34253 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34254 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34255 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34256 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34257 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34258 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34259
34260 @kindex maint set profile
34261 @kindex maint show profile
34262 @cindex profiling GDB
34263 @item maint set profile
34264 @itemx maint show profile
34265 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34266
34267 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34268 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34269 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34270 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34271 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34272 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34273 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34274
34275 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34276 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34277
34278 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34279 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34280 @cindex hardware debug registers
34281 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34282 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34283 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34284 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34285 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34286 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34287 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34288
34289 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34290 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34291 @item maint set show-all-tib
34292 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34293 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34294 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34295 command.
34296
34297 @kindex maint set target-async
34298 @kindex maint show target-async
34299 @item maint set target-async
34300 @itemx maint show target-async
34301 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34302 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34303 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34304 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34305
34306 @kindex maint set per-command
34307 @kindex maint show per-command
34308 @item maint set per-command
34309 @itemx maint show per-command
34310 @cindex resources used by commands
34311
34312 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34313 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34314
34315 @table @code
34316 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34317 @itemx maint show per-command space
34318 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34319 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34320 took, following the command's own output.
34321 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34322 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34323
34324 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34325 @itemx maint show per-command time
34326 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34327 for each command.
34328 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34329 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34330 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34331 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34332 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34333 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34334 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34335 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34336 spent by the program been debugged.
34337 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34338 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34339
34340 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34341 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34342 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34343 for each command.
34344 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34345
34346 @enumerate a
34347 @item
34348 number of symbol tables
34349 @item
34350 number of primary symbol tables
34351 @item
34352 number of blocks in the blockvector
34353 @end enumerate
34354 @end table
34355
34356 @kindex maint space
34357 @cindex memory used by commands
34358 @item maint space @var{value}
34359 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34360 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34361
34362 @kindex maint time
34363 @cindex time of command execution
34364 @item maint time @var{value}
34365 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34366 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34367
34368 @kindex maint translate-address
34369 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34370 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34371 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34372 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34373 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34374 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34375 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34376
34377 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34378 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34379 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34380
34381 @end table
34382
34383 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34384 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34385
34386 @table @code
34387 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34388 @kindex set watchdog
34389 @cindex watchdog timer
34390 @cindex timeout for commands
34391 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34392 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34393 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34394
34395 @item show watchdog
34396 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34397 @end table
34398
34399 @node Remote Protocol
34400 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34401
34402 @menu
34403 * Overview::
34404 * Packets::
34405 * Stop Reply Packets::
34406 * General Query Packets::
34407 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34408 * Tracepoint Packets::
34409 * Host I/O Packets::
34410 * Interrupts::
34411 * Notification Packets::
34412 * Remote Non-Stop::
34413 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34414 * Examples::
34415 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34416 * Library List Format::
34417 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34418 * Memory Map Format::
34419 * Thread List Format::
34420 * Traceframe Info Format::
34421 * Branch Trace Format::
34422 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34423 @end menu
34424
34425 @node Overview
34426 @section Overview
34427
34428 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34429 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34430 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34431 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34432
34433 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34434 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34435
34436 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34437 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34438 @cindex remote serial protocol
34439 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34440 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34441 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34442 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34443 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34444
34445 @smallexample
34446 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34447 @end smallexample
34448 @noindent
34449
34450 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34451 @noindent
34452 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34453 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34454 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34455
34456 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34457 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34458
34459 @smallexample
34460 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34461 @end smallexample
34462
34463 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34464 @noindent
34465 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34466 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34467 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34468
34469 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34470 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34471 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34472 retransmission):
34473
34474 @smallexample
34475 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34476 <- @code{+}
34477 @end smallexample
34478 @noindent
34479
34480 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34481 once a connection is established.
34482 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34483
34484 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34485 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34486 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34487 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34488 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34489 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34490 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34491
34492 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34493 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34494 exceptions).
34495
34496 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34497 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34498 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34499 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34500
34501 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34502 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34503 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34504
34505 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34506 @anchor{Binary Data}
34507 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34508 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34509 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34510 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34511 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34512 binary data.
34513
34514 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34515 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34516 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34517 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34518 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34519 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34520 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34521 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34522 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34523 (described next).
34524
34525 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34526 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34527 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34528 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34529 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34530 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34531 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34532 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34533 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34534 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34535 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34536 3}} more times.
34537
34538 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34539 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34540 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34541 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34542 @samp{0*"00}.
34543
34544 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34545 error number. That number is not well defined.
34546
34547 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34548 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34549 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34550 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34551 on that response.
34552
34553 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34554 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34555 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34556 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34557 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34558 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34559
34560 @node Packets
34561 @section Packets
34562
34563 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34564 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34565 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34566 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34567
34568 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34569 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34570 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34571 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34572 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34573 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34574 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34575 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34576 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34577 @var{baz}.
34578
34579 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34580 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34581 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34582 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34583 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34584 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34585 pick any thread.
34586
34587 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
34588 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
34589 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
34590 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
34591 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
34592 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
34593 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
34594 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
34595 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
34596 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
34597 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
34598 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
34599 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
34600
34601 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
34602 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
34603 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
34604 more information.
34605
34606 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
34607 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
34608
34609 Here are the packet descriptions.
34610
34611 @table @samp
34612
34613 @item !
34614 @cindex @samp{!} packet
34615 @anchor{extended mode}
34616 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
34617 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
34618 debugged.
34619
34620 Reply:
34621 @table @samp
34622 @item OK
34623 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
34624 @end table
34625
34626 @item ?
34627 @cindex @samp{?} packet
34628 @anchor{? packet}
34629 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
34630 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
34631 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
34632
34633 Reply:
34634 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34635
34636 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
34637 @cindex @samp{A} packet
34638 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
34639 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
34640 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
34641
34642 Reply:
34643 @table @samp
34644 @item OK
34645 The arguments were set.
34646 @item E @var{NN}
34647 An error occurred.
34648 @end table
34649
34650 @item b @var{baud}
34651 @cindex @samp{b} packet
34652 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
34653 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
34654
34655 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
34656 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
34657 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
34658
34659 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
34660 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
34661 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
34662 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
34663 of view, nothing actually happened.}
34664
34665 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
34666 @cindex @samp{B} packet
34667 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
34668 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
34669
34670 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
34671 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
34672
34673 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
34674 @anchor{bc}
34675 @item bc
34676 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
34677 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34678
34679 Reply:
34680 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34681
34682 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
34683 @anchor{bs}
34684 @item bs
34685 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
34686 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34687
34688 Reply:
34689 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34690
34691 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34692 @cindex @samp{c} packet
34693 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
34694 is omitted, resume at current address.
34695
34696 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34697 packet}.
34698
34699 Reply:
34700 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34701
34702 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34703 @cindex @samp{C} packet
34704 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
34705 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
34706
34707 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34708 packet}.
34709
34710 Reply:
34711 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34712
34713 @item d
34714 @cindex @samp{d} packet
34715 Toggle debug flag.
34716
34717 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
34718 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
34719
34720 @item D
34721 @itemx D;@var{pid}
34722 @cindex @samp{D} packet
34723 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
34724 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
34725 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
34726
34727 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
34728 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
34729 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
34730 big-endian hex string.
34731
34732 Reply:
34733 @table @samp
34734 @item OK
34735 for success
34736 @item E @var{NN}
34737 for an error
34738 @end table
34739
34740 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
34741 @cindex @samp{F} packet
34742 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
34743 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
34744 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
34745
34746 @item g
34747 @anchor{read registers packet}
34748 @cindex @samp{g} packet
34749 Read general registers.
34750
34751 Reply:
34752 @table @samp
34753 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34754 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
34755 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
34756 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
34757 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
34758 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
34759 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
34760
34761 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
34762 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
34763 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
34764 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
34765 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
34766 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
34767 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
34768 have been collected, and both have zero value:
34769
34770 @smallexample
34771 -> @code{g}
34772 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
34773 @end smallexample
34774
34775 @item E @var{NN}
34776 for an error.
34777 @end table
34778
34779 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
34780 @cindex @samp{G} packet
34781 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
34782 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
34783
34784 Reply:
34785 @table @samp
34786 @item OK
34787 for success
34788 @item E @var{NN}
34789 for an error
34790 @end table
34791
34792 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
34793 @cindex @samp{H} packet
34794 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
34795 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
34796 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
34797 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
34798 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
34799 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
34800 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34801
34802 Reply:
34803 @table @samp
34804 @item OK
34805 for success
34806 @item E @var{NN}
34807 for an error
34808 @end table
34809
34810 @c FIXME: JTC:
34811 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
34812 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
34813 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
34814 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
34815 @c described. For example:
34816 @c
34817 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34818 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
34819 @c otherwise returns current registers.
34820 @c
34821 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34822 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
34823 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
34824
34825 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
34826 @anchor{cycle step packet}
34827 @cindex @samp{i} packet
34828 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
34829 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
34830 step starting at that address.
34831
34832 @item I
34833 @cindex @samp{I} packet
34834 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
34835 step packet}.
34836
34837 @item k
34838 @cindex @samp{k} packet
34839 Kill request.
34840
34841 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
34842
34843 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
34844 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
34845
34846 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
34847
34848 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
34849 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
34850 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
34851
34852 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
34853 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
34854 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
34855
34856 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
34857 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
34858 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
34859 (@pxref{? packet}).
34860
34861 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34862 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34863 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
34864 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
34865 any particular boundary.
34866
34867 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34868 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34869 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34870 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34871 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34872 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34873 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34874 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34875
34876 Reply:
34877 @table @samp
34878 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34879 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
34880 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
34881 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34882 @item E @var{NN}
34883 @var{NN} is errno
34884 @end table
34885
34886 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34887 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34888 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
34889 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
34890 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
34891
34892 Reply:
34893 @table @samp
34894 @item OK
34895 for success
34896 @item E @var{NN}
34897 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34898 written).
34899 @end table
34900
34901 @item p @var{n}
34902 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34903 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34904 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34905 register value is encoded.
34906
34907 Reply:
34908 @table @samp
34909 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34910 the register's value
34911 @item E @var{NN}
34912 for an error
34913 @item @w{}
34914 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34915 @end table
34916
34917 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34918 @anchor{write register packet}
34919 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34920 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34921 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34922 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34923
34924 Reply:
34925 @table @samp
34926 @item OK
34927 for success
34928 @item E @var{NN}
34929 for an error
34930 @end table
34931
34932 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34933 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34934 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34935 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34936 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34937 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34938
34939 @item r
34940 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34941 Reset the entire system.
34942
34943 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34944
34945 @item R @var{XX}
34946 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34947 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34948 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34949
34950 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34951
34952 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34953 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34954 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
34955 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34956
34957 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34958 packet}.
34959
34960 Reply:
34961 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34962
34963 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34964 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34965 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34966 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34967 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34968
34969 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34970 packet}.
34971
34972 Reply:
34973 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34974
34975 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34976 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34977 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34978 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
34979 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
34980
34981 @item T @var{thread-id}
34982 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34983 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34984
34985 Reply:
34986 @table @samp
34987 @item OK
34988 thread is still alive
34989 @item E @var{NN}
34990 thread is dead
34991 @end table
34992
34993 @item v
34994 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34995 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34996
34997 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34998 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34999 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35000 The process ID is a
35001 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35002 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35003 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35004
35005 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35006 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35007 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35008 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35009 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35010 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35011 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35012 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35013
35014 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35015
35016 Reply:
35017 @table @samp
35018 @item E @var{nn}
35019 for an error
35020 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35021 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35022 @item OK
35023 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35024 @end table
35025
35026 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35027 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35028 @anchor{vCont packet}
35029 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35030 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
35031 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
35032 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
35033 in their current state in non-stop mode.
35034 Specifying multiple
35035 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
35036 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35037
35038 Currently supported actions are:
35039
35040 @table @samp
35041 @item c
35042 Continue.
35043 @item C @var{sig}
35044 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35045 @item s
35046 Step.
35047 @item S @var{sig}
35048 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35049 @item t
35050 Stop.
35051 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35052 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35053 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35054 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35055 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35056 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35057
35058 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35059 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35060 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35061 jumps to @var{start}).
35062
35063 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35064 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35065 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35066
35067 @end table
35068
35069 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35070 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35071 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35072
35073 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35074 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35075 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35076 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35077 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35078 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35079 as an implementation detail.
35080
35081 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35082 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
35083 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
35084 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
35085 @var{thread-id}.
35086
35087 Reply:
35088 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35089
35090 @item vCont?
35091 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35092 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35093
35094 Reply:
35095 @table @samp
35096 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35097 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35098 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35099 @item @w{}
35100 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35101 @end table
35102
35103 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35104 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35105 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35106 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35107
35108 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35109 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35110 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35111 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35112 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35113 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35114 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35115 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35116 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35117 packet is received.
35118
35119 Reply:
35120 @table @samp
35121 @item OK
35122 for success
35123 @item E @var{NN}
35124 for an error
35125 @end table
35126
35127 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35128 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35129 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35130 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35131 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35132 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35133 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35134 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35135 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35136 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35137 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35138 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35139
35140
35141 Reply:
35142 @table @samp
35143 @item OK
35144 for success
35145 @item E.memtype
35146 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35147 @item E @var{NN}
35148 for an error
35149 @end table
35150
35151 @item vFlashDone
35152 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35153 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35154 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35155 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35156 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35157 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35158 request is completed.
35159
35160 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35161 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35162 @anchor{vKill packet}
35163 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35164 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35165 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35166 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35167
35168 Reply:
35169 @table @samp
35170 @item E @var{nn}
35171 for an error
35172 @item OK
35173 for success
35174 @end table
35175
35176 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35177 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35178 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35179 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35180 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35181 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35182 state.
35183
35184 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35185
35186 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35187
35188 Reply:
35189 @table @samp
35190 @item E @var{nn}
35191 for an error
35192 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35193 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35194 @end table
35195
35196 @item vStopped
35197 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35198 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35199
35200 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35201 @anchor{X packet}
35202 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35203 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35204 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35205 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35206 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35207
35208 Reply:
35209 @table @samp
35210 @item OK
35211 for success
35212 @item E @var{NN}
35213 for an error
35214 @end table
35215
35216 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35217 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35218 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35219 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35220 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35221 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35222 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35223
35224 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35225 separately.
35226
35227 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35228 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35229 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35230 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35231 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35232 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35233
35234 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35235 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35236 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35237 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35238 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35239 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35240
35241 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35242 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35243 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35244 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35245 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35246 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35247 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35248 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35249 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35250 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35251
35252 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35253 for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35254
35255 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35256 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35257
35258 @table @samp
35259
35260 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35261 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35262 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35263
35264 @end table
35265
35266 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35267 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35268 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35269 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35270 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35271 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35272 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35273
35274 @table @samp
35275
35276 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35277 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35278 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35279
35280 @end table
35281
35282 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35283
35284 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35285 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35286 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35287 target, is not defined.}
35288
35289 Reply:
35290 @table @samp
35291 @item OK
35292 success
35293 @item @w{}
35294 not supported
35295 @item E @var{NN}
35296 for an error
35297 @end table
35298
35299 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35300 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35301 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35302 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35303 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35304 address @var{addr}.
35305
35306 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35307 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35308 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35309
35310 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35311 movement.}
35312
35313 Reply:
35314 @table @samp
35315 @item OK
35316 success
35317 @item @w{}
35318 not supported
35319 @item E @var{NN}
35320 for an error
35321 @end table
35322
35323 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35324 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35325 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35326 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35327 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35328 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35329
35330 Reply:
35331 @table @samp
35332 @item OK
35333 success
35334 @item @w{}
35335 not supported
35336 @item E @var{NN}
35337 for an error
35338 @end table
35339
35340 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35341 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35342 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35343 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35344 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35345 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35346
35347 Reply:
35348 @table @samp
35349 @item OK
35350 success
35351 @item @w{}
35352 not supported
35353 @item E @var{NN}
35354 for an error
35355 @end table
35356
35357 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35358 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35359 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35360 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35361 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35362 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35363
35364 Reply:
35365 @table @samp
35366 @item OK
35367 success
35368 @item @w{}
35369 not supported
35370 @item E @var{NN}
35371 for an error
35372 @end table
35373
35374 @end table
35375
35376 @node Stop Reply Packets
35377 @section Stop Reply Packets
35378 @cindex stop reply packets
35379
35380 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35381 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35382 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35383 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35384 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35385 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35386 @value{GDBN} source code.
35387
35388 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35389 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35390 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35391 components.
35392
35393 @table @samp
35394
35395 @item S @var{AA}
35396 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35397 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35398 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35399
35400 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35401 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35402 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35403 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35404 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35405 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35406 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35407 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35408
35409 @itemize @bullet
35410 @item
35411 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35412 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35413 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35414 two-digit hex number.
35415
35416 @item
35417 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35418 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35419
35420 @item
35421 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35422 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35423
35424 @item
35425 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35426 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35427 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35428 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35429
35430 @item
35431 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35432 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35433 future.
35434 @end itemize
35435
35436 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35437
35438 @table @samp
35439 @item watch
35440 @itemx rwatch
35441 @itemx awatch
35442 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35443 hex.
35444
35445 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35446 @item library
35447 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35448 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35449 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35450
35451 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35452 @item replaylog
35453 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35454 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35455 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35456 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35457 for more information.
35458
35459 @item swbreak
35460 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35461 The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35462 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35463 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
35464 part must be left empty.
35465
35466 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35467 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35468 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
35469 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35470 address.
35471
35472 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35473 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35474 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35475 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35476 indicating support.
35477
35478 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35479
35480 @item hwbreak
35481 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35482 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35483
35484 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35485 apply.
35486
35487 @cindex fork events, remote reply
35488 @item fork
35489 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
35490 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35491 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35492 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35493 fork events.
35494
35495 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35496 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35497 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35498 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35499 indicating support.
35500
35501 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
35502 @item vfork
35503 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
35504 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35505 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35506 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35507 vfork events.
35508
35509 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35510 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35511 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35512 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35513 indicating support.
35514
35515 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
35516 @item vforkdone
35517 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
35518 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
35519 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
35520 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
35521 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
35522
35523 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35524 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35525 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35526 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35527 indicating support.
35528
35529 @end table
35530
35531 @item W @var{AA}
35532 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35533 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35534 applicable to certain targets.
35535
35536 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35537 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35538 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35539 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35540
35541 @item X @var{AA}
35542 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35543 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
35544
35545 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
35546 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
35547 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
35548 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35549
35550 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
35551 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
35552 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
35553 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
35554 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
35555
35556 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
35557 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
35558 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
35559 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
35560 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
35561 system calls.
35562
35563 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
35564 this very system call.
35565
35566 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
35567 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
35568 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
35569 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
35570 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
35571 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
35572
35573 @end table
35574
35575 @node General Query Packets
35576 @section General Query Packets
35577 @cindex remote query requests
35578
35579 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
35580 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
35581 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
35582 sending information to and from the stub.
35583
35584 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
35585 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
35586 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
35587 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
35588 conventions:
35589
35590 @itemize @bullet
35591 @item
35592 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
35593 @item
35594 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
35595 letter.
35596 @item
35597 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
35598 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
35599 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
35600 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
35601 @end itemize
35602
35603 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
35604 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
35605 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
35606 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
35607 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
35608 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
35609 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
35610 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
35611 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
35612 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
35613 packet.}.
35614
35615 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
35616 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
35617 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
35618 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
35619 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
35620
35621 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
35622
35623 @table @samp
35624
35625 @item QAgent:1
35626 @itemx QAgent:0
35627 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
35628 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
35629
35630 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
35631 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
35632 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
35633 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
35634 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
35635 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
35636 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
35637 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
35638 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
35639 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
35640 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
35641
35642 @item qC
35643 @cindex current thread, remote request
35644 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
35645 Return the current thread ID.
35646
35647 Reply:
35648 @table @samp
35649 @item QC @var{thread-id}
35650 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
35651 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35652 @item @r{(anything else)}
35653 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
35654 @end table
35655
35656 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
35657 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
35658 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
35659 @anchor{qCRC packet}
35660 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
35661 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
35662 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
35663 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
35664
35665 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
35666 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
35667 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
35668 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
35669 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
35670 detect trailing zeros.
35671
35672 Reply:
35673 @table @samp
35674 @item E @var{NN}
35675 An error (such as memory fault)
35676 @item C @var{crc32}
35677 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
35678 @end table
35679
35680 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
35681 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
35682 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
35683 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
35684 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
35685 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
35686 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
35687 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
35688 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
35689 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
35690 randomization.
35691
35692 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35693
35694 Reply:
35695 @table @samp
35696 @item OK
35697 The request succeeded.
35698
35699 @item E @var{nn}
35700 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35701
35702 @item @w{}
35703 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
35704 by the stub.
35705 @end table
35706
35707 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35708 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35709 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
35710 address space randomization.
35711
35712 @item qfThreadInfo
35713 @itemx qsThreadInfo
35714 @cindex list active threads, remote request
35715 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
35716 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
35717 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
35718 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
35719 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
35720 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
35721 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
35722 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
35723
35724 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
35725
35726 Reply:
35727 @table @samp
35728 @item m @var{thread-id}
35729 A single thread ID
35730 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
35731 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
35732 @item l
35733 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
35734 @end table
35735
35736 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
35737 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
35738 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
35739 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
35740 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
35741 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35742 fields.
35743
35744 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
35745 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
35746 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
35747 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
35748 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
35749
35750 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
35751 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
35752 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
35753 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
35754 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
35755
35756 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
35757 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35758
35759 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
35760 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
35761 information associated with the variable.)
35762
35763 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
35764 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
35765 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
35766 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
35767 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
35768 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
35769
35770 Reply:
35771 @table @samp
35772 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35773 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
35774 local storage requested.
35775
35776 @item E @var{nn}
35777 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35778
35779 @item @w{}
35780 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35781 @end table
35782
35783 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
35784 @cindex get thread information block address
35785 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
35786 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
35787
35788 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
35789
35790 Reply:
35791 @table @samp
35792 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35793 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
35794 thread information block.
35795
35796 @item E @var{nn}
35797 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
35798 address could not be retrieved.
35799
35800 @item @w{}
35801 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35802 @end table
35803
35804 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
35805 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
35806 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
35807 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
35808 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
35809 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
35810 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
35811
35812 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
35813
35814 Reply:
35815 @table @samp
35816 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
35817 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
35818 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
35819 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
35820 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
35821 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
35822 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
35823 @end table
35824
35825 @item qOffsets
35826 @cindex section offsets, remote request
35827 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
35828 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
35829 image.
35830
35831 Reply:
35832 @table @samp
35833 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
35834 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
35835 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
35836 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
35837 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
35838 segments by the supplied offsets.
35839
35840 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
35841 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
35842 to the @code{Bss} section.}
35843
35844 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
35845 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
35846 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
35847 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
35848 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
35849 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
35850 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
35851 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
35852 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
35853 @end table
35854
35855 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
35856 @cindex thread information, remote request
35857 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
35858 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
35859 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
35860 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
35861
35862 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
35863 (see below).
35864
35865 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
35866
35867 @item QNonStop:1
35868 @itemx QNonStop:0
35869 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
35870 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
35871 @anchor{QNonStop}
35872 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
35873 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
35874
35875 Reply:
35876 @table @samp
35877 @item OK
35878 The request succeeded.
35879
35880 @item E @var{nn}
35881 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35882
35883 @item @w{}
35884 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
35885 the stub.
35886 @end table
35887
35888 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35889 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35890 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
35891 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
35892
35893 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35894 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
35895 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35896 @anchor{QPassSignals}
35897 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
35898 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35899 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35900 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
35901 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
35902 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
35903 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
35904 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
35905 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
35906
35907 Reply:
35908 @table @samp
35909 @item OK
35910 The request succeeded.
35911
35912 @item E @var{nn}
35913 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35914
35915 @item @w{}
35916 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
35917 the stub.
35918 @end table
35919
35920 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
35921 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
35922 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35923 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35924
35925 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35926 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
35927 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
35928 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
35929 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
35930 Others should be silently discarded.
35931
35932 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
35933 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
35934 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
35935 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
35936 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
35937 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
35938 signals.
35939
35940 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
35941 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
35942
35943 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35944 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35945 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
35946 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
35947 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
35948
35949 Reply:
35950 @table @samp
35951 @item OK
35952 The request succeeded.
35953
35954 @item E @var{nn}
35955 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35956
35957 @item @w{}
35958 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
35959 by the stub.
35960 @end table
35961
35962 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
35963 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
35964 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35965 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35966
35967 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
35968 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
35969 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
35970 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
35971 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
35972 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
35973 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
35974 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
35975 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
35976
35977 Reply:
35978 @table @samp
35979 @item OK
35980 A command response with no output.
35981 @item @var{OUTPUT}
35982 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
35983 @item E @var{NN}
35984 Indicate a badly formed request.
35985 @item @w{}
35986 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
35987 @end table
35988
35989 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
35990 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35991 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35992 packets.)
35993
35994 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
35995 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
35996 @ifnotinfo
35997 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
35998 @end ifnotinfo
35999 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36000 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36001 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36002 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36003 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36004
36005 Reply:
36006 @table @samp
36007 @item 0
36008 The pattern was not found.
36009 @item 1,address
36010 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36011 @item E @var{NN}
36012 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36013 @item @w{}
36014 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36015 @end table
36016
36017 @item QStartNoAckMode
36018 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36019 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36020 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36021 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36022
36023 Reply:
36024 @table @samp
36025 @item OK
36026 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36027 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36028 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36029 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36030 @item @w{}
36031 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36032 @end table
36033
36034 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36035 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36036 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36037 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36038 @anchor{qSupported}
36039 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36040 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36041 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36042 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36043 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36044 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36045 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36046 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36047 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36048 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36049 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36050 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36051 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36052 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36053
36054 Reply:
36055 @table @samp
36056 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36057 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36058 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36059 possible forms).
36060 @item @w{}
36061 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36062 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36063 @end table
36064
36065 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36066 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36067 are:
36068
36069 @table @samp
36070 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36071 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36072 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36073 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36074 @item @var{name}+
36075 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36076 need an associated value.
36077 @item @var{name}-
36078 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36079 @item @var{name}?
36080 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36081 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36082 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36083 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36084 @end table
36085
36086 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36087 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36088 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36089 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36090 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36091
36092 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36093 are defined:
36094
36095 @table @samp
36096 @item multiprocess
36097 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36098 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36099 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36100 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36101 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36102
36103 @item xmlRegisters
36104 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36105 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36106 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36107 description.
36108
36109 @item qRelocInsn
36110 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36111 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36112 instruction reply packet}).
36113
36114 @item swbreak
36115 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36116 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36117
36118 @item hwbreak
36119 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36120 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36121
36122 @item fork-events
36123 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36124 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36125 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36126 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36127
36128 @item vfork-events
36129 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36130 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36131 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36132 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36133 @end table
36134
36135 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36136 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36137 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36138 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36139 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36140 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36141 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36142 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36143 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36144 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36145 all the features it supports.
36146
36147 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36148 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36149
36150 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36151 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36152 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36153 form response.
36154
36155 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36156 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36157 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36158 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36159
36160 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36161 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36162 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36163 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36164 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36165
36166 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36167
36168 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36169 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36170 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36171 @item Feature Name
36172 @tab Value Required
36173 @tab Default
36174 @tab Probe Allowed
36175
36176 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36177 @tab Yes
36178 @tab @samp{-}
36179 @tab No
36180
36181 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36182 @tab No
36183 @tab @samp{-}
36184 @tab Yes
36185
36186 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36187 @tab No
36188 @tab @samp{-}
36189 @tab Yes
36190
36191 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36192 @tab No
36193 @tab @samp{-}
36194 @tab Yes
36195
36196 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36197 @tab No
36198 @tab @samp{-}
36199 @tab Yes
36200
36201 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36202 @tab No
36203 @tab @samp{-}
36204 @tab Yes
36205
36206 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36207 @tab No
36208 @tab @samp{-}
36209 @tab Yes
36210
36211 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36212 @tab No
36213 @tab @samp{-}
36214 @tab Yes
36215
36216 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36217 @tab No
36218 @tab @samp{-}
36219 @tab No
36220
36221 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36222 @tab No
36223 @tab @samp{-}
36224 @tab Yes
36225
36226 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36227 @tab No
36228 @tab @samp{-}
36229 @tab Yes
36230
36231 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36232 @tab No
36233 @tab @samp{-}
36234 @tab Yes
36235
36236 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36237 @tab No
36238 @tab @samp{-}
36239 @tab Yes
36240
36241 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36242 @tab No
36243 @tab @samp{-}
36244 @tab Yes
36245
36246 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36247 @tab No
36248 @tab @samp{-}
36249 @tab Yes
36250
36251 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36252 @tab No
36253 @tab @samp{-}
36254 @tab Yes
36255
36256 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36257 @tab No
36258 @tab @samp{-}
36259 @tab Yes
36260
36261 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36262 @tab No
36263 @tab @samp{-}
36264 @tab Yes
36265
36266 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36267 @tab No
36268 @tab @samp{-}
36269 @tab Yes
36270
36271 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36272 @tab Yes
36273 @tab @samp{-}
36274 @tab Yes
36275
36276 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36277 @tab Yes
36278 @tab @samp{-}
36279 @tab Yes
36280
36281 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36282 @tab Yes
36283 @tab @samp{-}
36284 @tab Yes
36285
36286 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36287 @tab No
36288 @tab @samp{-}
36289 @tab Yes
36290
36291 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36292 @tab No
36293 @tab @samp{-}
36294 @tab Yes
36295
36296 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36297 @tab No
36298 @tab @samp{-}
36299 @tab Yes
36300
36301 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36302 @tab No
36303 @tab @samp{-}
36304 @tab No
36305
36306 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36307 @tab No
36308 @tab @samp{-}
36309 @tab No
36310
36311 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36312 @tab No
36313 @tab @samp{-}
36314 @tab No
36315
36316 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36317 @tab No
36318 @tab @samp{-}
36319 @tab No
36320
36321 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36322 @tab No
36323 @tab @samp{-}
36324 @tab No
36325
36326 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36327 @tab No
36328 @tab @samp{-}
36329 @tab No
36330
36331 @item @samp{QAgent}
36332 @tab No
36333 @tab @samp{-}
36334 @tab No
36335
36336 @item @samp{QAllow}
36337 @tab No
36338 @tab @samp{-}
36339 @tab No
36340
36341 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36342 @tab No
36343 @tab @samp{-}
36344 @tab No
36345
36346 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36347 @tab No
36348 @tab @samp{-}
36349 @tab No
36350
36351 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36352 @tab No
36353 @tab @samp{-}
36354 @tab No
36355
36356 @item @samp{tracenz}
36357 @tab No
36358 @tab @samp{-}
36359 @tab No
36360
36361 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36362 @tab No
36363 @tab @samp{-}
36364 @tab No
36365
36366 @item @samp{swbreak}
36367 @tab No
36368 @tab @samp{-}
36369 @tab No
36370
36371 @item @samp{hwbreak}
36372 @tab No
36373 @tab @samp{-}
36374 @tab No
36375
36376 @item @samp{fork-events}
36377 @tab No
36378 @tab @samp{-}
36379 @tab No
36380
36381 @item @samp{vfork-events}
36382 @tab No
36383 @tab @samp{-}
36384 @tab No
36385
36386 @end multitable
36387
36388 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
36389
36390 @table @samp
36391 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
36392 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
36393 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
36394 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
36395 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
36396 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
36397 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
36398 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
36399 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
36400 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
36401
36402 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36403 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36404 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
36405
36406 @item qXfer:btrace:read
36407 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36408 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
36409
36410 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
36411 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36412 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
36413
36414 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
36415 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
36416 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
36417
36418 @item qXfer:features:read
36419 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
36420 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
36421
36422 @item qXfer:libraries:read
36423 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
36424 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
36425
36426 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
36427 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36428 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36429
36430 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
36431 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
36432 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36433 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36434
36435 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36436 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36437 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36438
36439 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36440 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36441 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
36442
36443 @item qXfer:spu:read
36444 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
36445 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
36446
36447 @item qXfer:spu:write
36448 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
36449 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
36450
36451 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
36452 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
36453 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
36454
36455 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
36456 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
36457 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
36458
36459 @item qXfer:threads:read
36460 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36461 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
36462
36463 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
36464 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36465 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
36466
36467 @item qXfer:uib:read
36468 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36469 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
36470
36471 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
36472 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36473 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
36474
36475 @item QNonStop
36476 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
36477 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
36478
36479 @item QPassSignals
36480 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36481 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
36482
36483 @item QStartNoAckMode
36484 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
36485 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
36486
36487 @item multiprocess
36488 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
36489 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
36490 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
36491 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
36492 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
36493 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
36494 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
36495 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
36496 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
36497 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
36498 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
36499
36500 @item qXfer:osdata:read
36501 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
36502 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
36503
36504 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
36505 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
36506 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
36507 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
36508
36509 @item ConditionalTracepoints
36510 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
36511 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
36512
36513 @item ReverseContinue
36514 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
36515 (@pxref{bc}).
36516
36517 @item ReverseStep
36518 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
36519 (@pxref{bs}).
36520
36521 @item TracepointSource
36522 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
36523 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
36524
36525 @item QAgent
36526 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
36527
36528 @item QAllow
36529 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
36530
36531 @item QDisableRandomization
36532 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
36533
36534 @item StaticTracepoint
36535 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
36536 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
36537
36538 @item InstallInTrace
36539 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
36540 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
36541
36542 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
36543 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
36544 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
36545 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
36546
36547 @item QTBuffer:size
36548 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
36549 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
36550
36551 @item tracenz
36552 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
36553 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
36554 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
36555
36556 @item BreakpointCommands
36557 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
36558 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
36559 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
36560
36561 @item Qbtrace:off
36562 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
36563
36564 @item Qbtrace:bts
36565 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
36566
36567 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
36568 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
36569
36570 @item swbreak
36571 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
36572 breakpoints.
36573
36574 @item hwbreak
36575 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
36576 breakpoints.
36577
36578 @item fork-events
36579 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
36580
36581 @item vfork-events
36582 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
36583 and vforkdone events.
36584
36585 @end table
36586
36587 @item qSymbol::
36588 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
36589 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
36590 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
36591 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
36592
36593 Reply:
36594 @table @samp
36595 @item OK
36596 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36597 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36598 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
36599 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
36600 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
36601 below.
36602 @end table
36603
36604 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
36605 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
36606
36607 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
36608 target has previously requested.
36609
36610 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
36611 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
36612 will be empty.
36613
36614 Reply:
36615 @table @samp
36616 @item OK
36617 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36618 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36619 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
36620 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
36621 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
36622 @end table
36623
36624 @item qTBuffer
36625 @itemx QTBuffer
36626 @itemx QTDisconnected
36627 @itemx QTDP
36628 @itemx QTDPsrc
36629 @itemx QTDV
36630 @itemx qTfP
36631 @itemx qTfV
36632 @itemx QTFrame
36633 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
36634
36635 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36636
36637 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
36638 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
36639 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
36640 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
36641 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
36642 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
36643 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
36644 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
36645 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
36646 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
36647 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
36648
36649 Reply:
36650 @table @samp
36651 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36652 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
36653 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
36654 the thread's attributes.
36655 @end table
36656
36657 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
36658 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36659 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36660 packets.)
36661
36662 @item QTNotes
36663 @itemx qTP
36664 @itemx QTSave
36665 @itemx qTsP
36666 @itemx qTsV
36667 @itemx QTStart
36668 @itemx QTStop
36669 @itemx QTEnable
36670 @itemx QTDisable
36671 @itemx QTinit
36672 @itemx QTro
36673 @itemx qTStatus
36674 @itemx qTV
36675 @itemx qTfSTM
36676 @itemx qTsSTM
36677 @itemx qTSTMat
36678 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36679
36680 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36681 @cindex read special object, remote request
36682 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
36683 @anchor{qXfer read}
36684 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
36685 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
36686 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
36687 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
36688 additional details about what data to access.
36689
36690 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36691 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36692 formats, listed below.
36693
36694 @table @samp
36695 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36696 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
36697 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
36698 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
36699
36700 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36701 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36702
36703 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36704 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
36705
36706 Return a description of the current branch trace.
36707 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
36708 packet may have one of the following values:
36709
36710 @table @code
36711 @item all
36712 Returns all available branch trace.
36713
36714 @item new
36715 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
36716 the last read request.
36717
36718 @item delta
36719 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
36720 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
36721 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
36722 used to stitch traces together.
36723
36724 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
36725 @end table
36726
36727 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36728 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36729
36730 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36731 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
36732
36733 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
36734 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
36735
36736 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36737 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36738
36739 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36740 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
36741 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
36742 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
36743 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
36744 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
36745 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
36746
36747 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36748 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36749
36750 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36751 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
36752 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
36753 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
36754 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
36755
36756 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36757 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36758
36759 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36760 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
36761 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
36762 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36763 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36764
36765 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
36766 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
36767 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
36768
36769 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36770 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36771
36772 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36773 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
36774 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
36775 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
36776 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
36777 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
36778 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36779 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
36780
36781 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
36782 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
36783
36784 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36785 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36786
36787 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
36788 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
36789 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
36790 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
36791
36792 @table @code
36793 @item start=@var{address}
36794 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36795 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
36796 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
36797 chosen as the starting point.
36798
36799 @item prev=@var{address}
36800 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36801 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
36802 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
36803 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
36804 exists prior to the starting point.
36805
36806 @end table
36807
36808 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
36809 ignored.
36810
36811 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36812 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
36813 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
36814 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36815 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36816
36817 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36818 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36819
36820 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36821 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
36822
36823 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
36824 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
36825 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
36826 Action Lists}.
36827
36828 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36829 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36830 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36831
36832 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36833 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
36834 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
36835 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36836 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36837
36838 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36839 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36840 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36841
36842 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36843 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
36844 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36845 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
36846 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36847 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36848 in that context to be accessed.
36849
36850 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36851 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36852 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36853
36854 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36855 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
36856 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
36857 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36858 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36859
36860 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36861 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36862
36863 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36864 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
36865
36866 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
36867 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
36868 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36869
36870 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36871 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36872
36873 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36874 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
36875
36876 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
36877 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
36878
36879 This packet is not probed by default.
36880
36881 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36882 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
36883 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
36884 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
36885 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
36886
36887 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36888 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36889
36890 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36891 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
36892 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
36893 @xref{Operating System Information}.
36894
36895 @end table
36896
36897 Reply:
36898 @table @samp
36899 @item m @var{data}
36900 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
36901 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
36902 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
36903 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
36904 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
36905 request.
36906
36907 @item l @var{data}
36908 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
36909 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
36910 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
36911
36912 @item l
36913 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
36914 There is no more data to be read.
36915
36916 @item E00
36917 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36918
36919 @item E @var{nn}
36920 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
36921 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36922
36923 @item @w{}
36924 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
36925 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
36926 @end table
36927
36928 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36929 @cindex write data into object, remote request
36930 @anchor{qXfer write}
36931 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
36932 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
36933 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
36934 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
36935 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
36936 to access.
36937
36938 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36939 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36940 formats, listed below.
36941
36942 @table @samp
36943 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36944 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
36945 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
36946 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36947 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
36948
36949 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36950 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36951 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36952
36953 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36954 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
36955 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36956 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
36957 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36958 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36959 in that context to be accessed.
36960
36961 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36962 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36963 @end table
36964
36965 Reply:
36966 @table @samp
36967 @item @var{nn}
36968 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
36969 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
36970
36971 @item E00
36972 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36973
36974 @item E @var{nn}
36975 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
36976 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36977
36978 @item @w{}
36979 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
36980 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
36981 @end table
36982
36983 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
36984 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
36985 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
36986 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
36987 must respond with an empty packet.
36988
36989 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
36990 @cindex query attached, remote request
36991 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
36992 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
36993 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
36994 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
36995 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
36996 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
36997 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
36998
36999 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37000 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37001 the @code{quit} command.
37002
37003 Reply:
37004 @table @samp
37005 @item 1
37006 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37007 @item 0
37008 The remote server created a new process.
37009 @item E @var{NN}
37010 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37011 @end table
37012
37013 @item Qbtrace:bts
37014 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
37015
37016 Reply:
37017 @table @samp
37018 @item OK
37019 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37020 @item E.errtext
37021 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37022 @end table
37023
37024 @item Qbtrace:off
37025 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37026
37027 Reply:
37028 @table @samp
37029 @item OK
37030 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37031 @item E.errtext
37032 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37033 @end table
37034
37035 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37036 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37037 btrace recording method in bts format.
37038
37039 Reply:
37040 @table @samp
37041 @item OK
37042 The ring buffer size has been set.
37043 @item E.errtext
37044 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37045 @end table
37046
37047 @end table
37048
37049 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37050 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37051
37052 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37053 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37054 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37055
37056 @menu
37057 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37058 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37059 @end menu
37060
37061 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37062 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37063
37064 @menu
37065 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37066 @end menu
37067
37068 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37069 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37070 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37071
37072 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37073
37074 @table @r
37075
37076 @item 2
37077 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37078
37079 @item 3
37080 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37081
37082 @item 4
37083 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37084
37085 @end table
37086
37087 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37088 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37089
37090 @menu
37091 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37092 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37093 @end menu
37094
37095 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37096 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37097 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37098
37099 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37100 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37101 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37102 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37103 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37104 most-significant -- least-significant.
37105
37106 @table @r
37107
37108 @item MIPS32
37109 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37110 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37111 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37112
37113 @item MIPS64
37114 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37115 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37116 as @code{MIPS32}.
37117
37118 @end table
37119
37120 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37121 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37122 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37123
37124 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37125
37126 @table @r
37127
37128 @item 2
37129 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37130
37131 @item 3
37132 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37133
37134 @item 4
37135 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37136
37137 @item 5
37138 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37139
37140 @end table
37141
37142 @node Tracepoint Packets
37143 @section Tracepoint Packets
37144 @cindex tracepoint packets
37145 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37146
37147 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37148 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37149
37150 @table @samp
37151
37152 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37153 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37154 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37155 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37156 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37157 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37158 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37159 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37160 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37161 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37162 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37163 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37164 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37165 actions.
37166
37167 Replies:
37168 @table @samp
37169 @item OK
37170 The packet was understood and carried out.
37171 @item qRelocInsn
37172 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37173 @item @w{}
37174 The packet was not recognized.
37175 @end table
37176
37177 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37178 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
37179 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37180 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
37181 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
37182 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37183 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37184
37185 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37186 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37187 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37188 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37189 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37190 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37191 tracepoint actions.
37192
37193 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37194 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37195 following forms:
37196
37197 @table @samp
37198
37199 @item R @var{mask}
37200 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37201 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37202 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37203 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37204 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37205
37206 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37207 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37208 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37209 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37210 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37211 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37212 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37213
37214 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37215 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37216 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37217 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37218 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37219 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37220 packet).
37221
37222 @end table
37223
37224 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37225 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37226 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37227 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37228 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37229 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37230 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37231 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37232
37233 Replies:
37234 @table @samp
37235 @item OK
37236 The packet was understood and carried out.
37237 @item qRelocInsn
37238 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37239 @item @w{}
37240 The packet was not recognized.
37241 @end table
37242
37243 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37244 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37245 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37246 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37247 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37248 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37249 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37250 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37251
37252 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37253 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37254 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37255 fit in a single packet.
37256 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37257 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37258
37259 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37260 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37261 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37262 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37263
37264 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37265 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37266 query packets.
37267
37268 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37269 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37270 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37271 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37272 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37273 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37274 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37275 be found.
37276
37277 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37278 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37279 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37280 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37281 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37282 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37283 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37284 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37285 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37286 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37287 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37288 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
37289 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37290 variable.
37291
37292 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37293 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37294 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37295 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37296 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37297
37298 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37299 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37300 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37301 one of the following forms:
37302
37303 @table @samp
37304 @item F @var{f}
37305 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
37306 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
37307 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
37308
37309 @item T @var{t}
37310 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
37311 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
37312
37313 @end table
37314
37315 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
37316 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37317 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
37318 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
37319
37320 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
37321 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37322 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
37323 is a hexadecimal number.
37324
37325 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
37326 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37327 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
37328 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
37329 numbers.
37330
37331 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
37332 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
37333 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
37334
37335 @item qTMinFTPILen
37336 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
37337 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
37338 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
37339 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
37340 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
37341 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
37342 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
37343 arrange for that.
37344
37345 Replies:
37346
37347 @table @samp
37348 @item 0
37349 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
37350 @item @var{length}
37351 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
37352 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
37353 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
37354 regardless of size.
37355 @item E
37356 An error has occurred.
37357 @item @w{}
37358 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
37359 @end table
37360
37361 @item QTStart
37362 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
37363 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
37364 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
37365 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37366 instruction reply packet}).
37367
37368 @item QTStop
37369 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
37370 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
37371
37372 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37373 @anchor{QTEnable}
37374 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
37375 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37376 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
37377 of data from it will resume.
37378
37379 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37380 @anchor{QTDisable}
37381 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
37382 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37383 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
37384 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
37385
37386 @item QTinit
37387 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
37388 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
37389
37390 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
37391 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
37392 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
37393 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
37394 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
37395
37396 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
37397 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
37398 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
37399 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
37400
37401 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
37402 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
37403 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
37404 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
37405 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
37406 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
37407
37408 @item qTStatus
37409 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
37410 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
37411
37412 The reply has the form:
37413
37414 @table @samp
37415
37416 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
37417 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
37418 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
37419 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
37420
37421 @end table
37422
37423 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
37424 explanations as one of the optional fields:
37425
37426 @table @samp
37427
37428 @item tnotrun:0
37429 No trace has been run yet.
37430
37431 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
37432 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
37433 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
37434 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
37435 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
37436
37437 @item tfull:0
37438 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
37439
37440 @item tdisconnected:0
37441 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
37442
37443 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
37444 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
37445
37446 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
37447 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
37448 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
37449 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
37450 is hex encoded.
37451
37452 @item tunknown:0
37453 The trace stopped for some other reason.
37454
37455 @end table
37456
37457 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
37458 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
37459 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
37460 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
37461 trace.
37462
37463 @table @samp
37464
37465 @item tframes:@var{n}
37466 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
37467
37468 @item tcreated:@var{n}
37469 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
37470 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
37471
37472 @item tsize:@var{n}
37473 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
37474
37475 @item tfree:@var{n}
37476 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
37477
37478 @item circular:@var{n}
37479 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
37480 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
37481 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
37482 and may fill up.
37483
37484 @item disconn:@var{n}
37485 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
37486 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
37487 that the trace run will stop.
37488
37489 @end table
37490
37491 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
37492 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
37493 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
37494 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
37495 address @var{addr}.
37496
37497 Replies:
37498 @table @samp
37499 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
37500 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
37501 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
37502 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
37503 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
37504
37505 @end table
37506
37507 @item qTV:@var{var}
37508 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
37509 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
37510 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
37511
37512 Replies:
37513 @table @samp
37514 @item V@var{value}
37515 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
37516 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
37517 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
37518 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
37519 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
37520 program is running.
37521
37522 @item U
37523 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
37524 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
37525 was not collected.
37526 @end table
37527
37528 @item qTfP
37529 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
37530 @itemx qTsP
37531 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
37532 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
37533 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
37534 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
37535 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
37536 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
37537
37538 @item qTfV
37539 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
37540 @itemx qTsV
37541 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
37542 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
37543 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
37544 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
37545 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
37546 trace state variables.
37547
37548 @item qTfSTM
37549 @itemx qTsSTM
37550 @anchor{qTfSTM}
37551 @anchor{qTsSTM}
37552 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
37553 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
37554 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
37555 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
37556 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
37557 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
37558
37559 Reply:
37560 @table @samp
37561 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
37562 A single marker
37563 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
37564 a comma-separated list of markers
37565 @item l
37566 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37567 @item E @var{nn}
37568 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37569 @item @w{}
37570 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
37571 stub.
37572 @end table
37573
37574 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
37575 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
37576
37577 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37578 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
37579 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
37580 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
37581 @dfn{last}).
37582
37583 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
37584 @anchor{qTSTMat}
37585 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
37586 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
37587 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
37588 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
37589 tracepoint markers.
37590
37591 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
37592 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
37593 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
37594 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
37595 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
37596 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
37597
37598 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
37599 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
37600 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
37601 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
37602 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
37603 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
37604 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
37605 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
37606 available.
37607
37608 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
37609 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
37610 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
37611
37612 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
37613 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
37614 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
37615 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
37616 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
37617 use whatever size it prefers.
37618
37619 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
37620 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
37621 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
37622 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
37623 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
37624
37625 @end table
37626
37627 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
37628 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
37629 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
37630 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
37631 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
37632 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
37633 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
37634 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
37635 it had executed in the original location.
37636
37637 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
37638 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
37639 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
37640 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
37641 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
37642 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
37643 format of the request is:
37644
37645 @table @samp
37646 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
37647
37648 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
37649 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
37650 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
37651 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
37652 memory starting at @var{to}.
37653 @end table
37654
37655 Replies:
37656 @table @samp
37657 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
37658 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
37659 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
37660 @item E @var{NN}
37661 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
37662 relocating the instruction.
37663 @end table
37664
37665 @node Host I/O Packets
37666 @section Host I/O Packets
37667 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
37668 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
37669
37670 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
37671 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
37672 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
37673 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
37674 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
37675 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
37676 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
37677 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
37678 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
37679 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
37680
37681 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
37682 its arguments. They have this format:
37683
37684 @table @samp
37685
37686 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
37687 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
37688 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
37689 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
37690 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
37691 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
37692 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
37693 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
37694 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37695
37696 @end table
37697
37698 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
37699
37700 @table @samp
37701
37702 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
37703 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
37704 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
37705 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
37706 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
37707 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
37708 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
37709 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
37710 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
37711 @var{attachment}.
37712
37713 @item @w{}
37714 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
37715
37716 @end table
37717
37718 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
37719
37720 @table @samp
37721 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
37722 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
37723 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
37724 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
37725 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
37726 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
37727 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
37728
37729 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
37730 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
37731 -1 if an error occurs.
37732
37733 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
37734 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
37735 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
37736 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
37737 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
37738 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
37739 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
37740 @var{count} was zero.
37741
37742 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37743 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37744 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37745 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37746 some characters were escaped.
37747
37748 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
37749 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
37750 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
37751 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
37752 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
37753 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
37754 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
37755 error occurred.
37756
37757 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
37758 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
37759 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
37760 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
37761 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
37762 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
37763
37764 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
37765 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
37766 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
37767
37768 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
37769 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
37770 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
37771
37772 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37773 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37774 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37775 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37776 some characters were escaped.
37777
37778 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
37779 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
37780 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
37781 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
37782 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
37783 inferior(s).
37784
37785 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
37786 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
37787 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
37788 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
37789 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
37790 operation.
37791
37792 @end table
37793
37794 @node Interrupts
37795 @section Interrupts
37796 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
37797
37798 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
37799 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
37800 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
37801 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
37802
37803 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
37804 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
37805 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
37806 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
37807 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
37808
37809 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
37810 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
37811 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
37812 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
37813 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
37814 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
37815 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
37816 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
37817
37818 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
37819 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
37820 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
37821
37822 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
37823 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
37824 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
37825 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
37826 currently-executing threads and processes.
37827 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
37828 running program, it should send one of the stop
37829 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
37830 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
37831 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
37832 Interrupts received while the
37833 program is stopped are discarded.
37834
37835 @node Notification Packets
37836 @section Notification Packets
37837 @cindex notification packets
37838 @cindex packets, notification
37839
37840 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
37841 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
37842 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
37843 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
37844 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
37845 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
37846 is not a problem.
37847
37848 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
37849 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
37850 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
37851 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
37852 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
37853 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
37854 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
37855
37856 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
37857 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
37858
37859 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
37860 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
37861 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
37862 not they understand it.
37863
37864 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
37865 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
37866 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
37867 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
37868 recipients.
37869
37870 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
37871 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
37872 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
37873 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
37874 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
37875
37876 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
37877 @table @samp
37878 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
37879 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
37880 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
37881 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
37882 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
37883 @item @var{ack}
37884 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
37885 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
37886 @end table
37887
37888 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
37889 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
37890
37891 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
37892 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
37893 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
37894 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
37895 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
37896 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
37897 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
37898 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
37899 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
37900 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
37901
37902 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
37903 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
37904 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
37905 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
37906 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
37907 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
37908
37909 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
37910 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
37911 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
37912 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
37913 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
37914
37915 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
37916 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
37917 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
37918 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
37919 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
37920 normally.
37921
37922 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
37923 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
37924 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
37925 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
37926 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
37927 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
37928 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
37929 the process shall be repeated.
37930
37931 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
37932 following example:
37933 @smallexample
37934 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
37935 @code{...}
37936 -> @code{vStopped}
37937 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
37938 -> @code{vStopped}
37939 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
37940 -> @code{vStopped}
37941 <- @code{OK}
37942 @end smallexample
37943
37944 The following notifications are defined:
37945 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
37946
37947 @item Notification
37948 @tab Ack
37949 @tab Event
37950 @tab Description
37951
37952 @item Stop
37953 @tab vStopped
37954 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
37955 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
37956 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
37957 @value{GDBN}.
37958 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
37959
37960 @end multitable
37961
37962 @node Remote Non-Stop
37963 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
37964
37965 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
37966 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
37967 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
37968 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37969
37970 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
37971 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
37972 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
37973 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
37974 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
37975 probe the target state after a mode change.
37976
37977 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
37978 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
37979 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
37980 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
37981 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
37982 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
37983 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
37984 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
37985 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
37986 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
37987 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
37988
37989 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
37990 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
37991 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
37992 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
37993 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
37994 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
37995 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
37996 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
37997 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
37998 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
37999 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38000 @samp{OK}.
38001
38002 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38003 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38004 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38005 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38006 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38007 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38008 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38009 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38010 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38011 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38012 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38013 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38014 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38015
38016 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38017 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38018
38019 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38020 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38021 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38022 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38023 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38024 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38025 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38026
38027 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38028 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38029 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38030 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38031 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38032
38033 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38034 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38035 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38036 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38037
38038 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38039 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38040 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38041 @pxref{qSupported}.
38042 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38043 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38044 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38045 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38046 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38047 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38048 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38049
38050 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38051 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38052 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38053 connection.
38054 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38055 new connection is established,
38056 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38057 for the current connection, once disabled.
38058
38059 @node Examples
38060 @section Examples
38061
38062 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38063 does not get any direct output:
38064
38065 @smallexample
38066 -> @code{R00}
38067 <- @code{+}
38068 @emph{target restarts}
38069 -> @code{?}
38070 <- @code{+}
38071 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38072 -> @code{+}
38073 @end smallexample
38074
38075 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38076
38077 @smallexample
38078 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38079 <- @code{+}
38080 -> @code{s}
38081 <- @code{+}
38082 @emph{time passes}
38083 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38084 -> @code{+}
38085 -> @code{g}
38086 <- @code{+}
38087 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38088 -> @code{+}
38089 @end smallexample
38090
38091 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38092 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38093 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38094
38095 @menu
38096 * File-I/O Overview::
38097 * Protocol Basics::
38098 * The F Request Packet::
38099 * The F Reply Packet::
38100 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38101 * Console I/O::
38102 * List of Supported Calls::
38103 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38104 * Constants::
38105 * File-I/O Examples::
38106 @end menu
38107
38108 @node File-I/O Overview
38109 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38110 @cindex file-i/o overview
38111
38112 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38113 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38114 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38115 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38116 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38117 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38118
38119 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38120 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38121 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38122 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38123 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38124
38125 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38126 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38127 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38128 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38129 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38130 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38131 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38132
38133 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38134 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38135 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38136 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38137 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38138
38139 @smallexample
38140 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38141 <- target requests 'system call X'
38142 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38143 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38144 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38145 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38146 @end smallexample
38147
38148 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38149 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38150 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38151 system are not supported by this protocol.
38152
38153 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38154
38155 @node Protocol Basics
38156 @subsection Protocol Basics
38157 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38158
38159 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38160 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38161 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38162 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38163 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38164 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38165 to call the appropriate host system call:
38166
38167 @itemize @bullet
38168 @item
38169 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38170
38171 @item
38172 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
38173 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
38174 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
38175 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38176
38177 @end itemize
38178
38179 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38180
38181 @itemize @bullet
38182 @item
38183 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38184 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38185 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
38186 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38187 packet.
38188
38189 @item
38190 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38191 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38192
38193 @item
38194 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38195
38196 @item
38197 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38198
38199 @item
38200 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38201 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38202 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38203 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38204 packet.
38205
38206 @end itemize
38207
38208 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38209 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38210
38211 @itemize @bullet
38212 @item
38213 Return value.
38214
38215 @item
38216 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38217
38218 @item
38219 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38220
38221 @end itemize
38222
38223 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38224 the latest continue or step action.
38225
38226 @node The F Request Packet
38227 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38228 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38229 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38230
38231 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38232
38233 @table @samp
38234 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38235
38236 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38237 This is just the name of the function.
38238
38239 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38240 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38241 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38242 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38243 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38244 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38245 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38246
38247 @end table
38248
38249
38250
38251 @node The F Reply Packet
38252 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38253 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38254 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38255
38256 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38257
38258 @table @samp
38259
38260 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38261
38262 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38263
38264 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38265 representation.
38266 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38267
38268 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38269 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38270 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38271
38272 @smallexample
38273 F0,0,C
38274 @end smallexample
38275
38276 @noindent
38277 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38278
38279 @smallexample
38280 F-1,4,C
38281 @end smallexample
38282
38283 @noindent
38284 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38285
38286 @end table
38287
38288
38289 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38290 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38291 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38292
38293 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38294 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38295 the target should behave as if it had
38296 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
38297 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
38298 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
38299 packet.
38300
38301 It's important for the target to know in which
38302 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
38303
38304 @itemize @bullet
38305 @item
38306 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
38307
38308 @item
38309 The system call on the host has been finished.
38310
38311 @end itemize
38312
38313 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
38314 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
38315 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
38316 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
38317 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
38318 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
38319
38320 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
38321 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
38322 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
38323 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
38324 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
38325 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
38326 or the full action has been completed.
38327
38328 @node Console I/O
38329 @subsection Console I/O
38330 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
38331
38332 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
38333 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
38334 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
38335 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
38336 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
38337 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
38338 conditions is met:
38339
38340 @itemize @bullet
38341 @item
38342 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
38343 @code{read}
38344 system call is treated as finished.
38345
38346 @item
38347 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
38348 newline.
38349
38350 @item
38351 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
38352 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
38353
38354 @end itemize
38355
38356 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
38357 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
38358 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
38359 is stopped at the user's request.
38360
38361
38362 @node List of Supported Calls
38363 @subsection List of Supported Calls
38364 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
38365
38366 @menu
38367 * open::
38368 * close::
38369 * read::
38370 * write::
38371 * lseek::
38372 * rename::
38373 * unlink::
38374 * stat/fstat::
38375 * gettimeofday::
38376 * isatty::
38377 * system::
38378 @end menu
38379
38380 @node open
38381 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
38382 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
38383
38384 @table @asis
38385 @item Synopsis:
38386 @smallexample
38387 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
38388 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
38389 @end smallexample
38390
38391 @item Request:
38392 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
38393
38394 @noindent
38395 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38396
38397 @table @code
38398 @item O_CREAT
38399 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
38400 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
38401 are concerned.
38402
38403 @item O_EXCL
38404 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
38405 an error and open() fails.
38406
38407 @item O_TRUNC
38408 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
38409 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
38410 truncated to zero length.
38411
38412 @item O_APPEND
38413 The file is opened in append mode.
38414
38415 @item O_RDONLY
38416 The file is opened for reading only.
38417
38418 @item O_WRONLY
38419 The file is opened for writing only.
38420
38421 @item O_RDWR
38422 The file is opened for reading and writing.
38423 @end table
38424
38425 @noindent
38426 Other bits are silently ignored.
38427
38428
38429 @noindent
38430 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38431
38432 @table @code
38433 @item S_IRUSR
38434 User has read permission.
38435
38436 @item S_IWUSR
38437 User has write permission.
38438
38439 @item S_IRGRP
38440 Group has read permission.
38441
38442 @item S_IWGRP
38443 Group has write permission.
38444
38445 @item S_IROTH
38446 Others have read permission.
38447
38448 @item S_IWOTH
38449 Others have write permission.
38450 @end table
38451
38452 @noindent
38453 Other bits are silently ignored.
38454
38455
38456 @item Return value:
38457 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
38458 occurred.
38459
38460 @item Errors:
38461
38462 @table @code
38463 @item EEXIST
38464 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
38465
38466 @item EISDIR
38467 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
38468
38469 @item EACCES
38470 The requested access is not allowed.
38471
38472 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38473 @var{pathname} was too long.
38474
38475 @item ENOENT
38476 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38477
38478 @item ENODEV
38479 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
38480
38481 @item EROFS
38482 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
38483 write access was requested.
38484
38485 @item EFAULT
38486 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
38487
38488 @item ENOSPC
38489 No space on device to create the file.
38490
38491 @item EMFILE
38492 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
38493
38494 @item ENFILE
38495 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
38496 has been reached.
38497
38498 @item EINTR
38499 The call was interrupted by the user.
38500 @end table
38501
38502 @end table
38503
38504 @node close
38505 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
38506 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
38507
38508 @table @asis
38509 @item Synopsis:
38510 @smallexample
38511 int close(int fd);
38512 @end smallexample
38513
38514 @item Request:
38515 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
38516
38517 @item Return value:
38518 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
38519
38520 @item Errors:
38521
38522 @table @code
38523 @item EBADF
38524 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
38525
38526 @item EINTR
38527 The call was interrupted by the user.
38528 @end table
38529
38530 @end table
38531
38532 @node read
38533 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
38534 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
38535
38536 @table @asis
38537 @item Synopsis:
38538 @smallexample
38539 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
38540 @end smallexample
38541
38542 @item Request:
38543 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38544
38545 @item Return value:
38546 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
38547 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
38548 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
38549
38550 @item Errors:
38551
38552 @table @code
38553 @item EBADF
38554 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38555 reading.
38556
38557 @item EFAULT
38558 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38559
38560 @item EINTR
38561 The call was interrupted by the user.
38562 @end table
38563
38564 @end table
38565
38566 @node write
38567 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
38568 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
38569
38570 @table @asis
38571 @item Synopsis:
38572 @smallexample
38573 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
38574 @end smallexample
38575
38576 @item Request:
38577 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38578
38579 @item Return value:
38580 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
38581 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
38582 is returned.
38583
38584 @item Errors:
38585
38586 @table @code
38587 @item EBADF
38588 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38589 writing.
38590
38591 @item EFAULT
38592 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38593
38594 @item EFBIG
38595 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
38596 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
38597
38598 @item ENOSPC
38599 No space on device to write the data.
38600
38601 @item EINTR
38602 The call was interrupted by the user.
38603 @end table
38604
38605 @end table
38606
38607 @node lseek
38608 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
38609 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
38610
38611 @table @asis
38612 @item Synopsis:
38613 @smallexample
38614 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
38615 @end smallexample
38616
38617 @item Request:
38618 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
38619
38620 @var{flag} is one of:
38621
38622 @table @code
38623 @item SEEK_SET
38624 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
38625
38626 @item SEEK_CUR
38627 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
38628 bytes.
38629
38630 @item SEEK_END
38631 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
38632 bytes.
38633 @end table
38634
38635 @item Return value:
38636 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
38637 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
38638 value of -1 is returned.
38639
38640 @item Errors:
38641
38642 @table @code
38643 @item EBADF
38644 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
38645
38646 @item ESPIPE
38647 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
38648
38649 @item EINVAL
38650 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
38651
38652 @item EINTR
38653 The call was interrupted by the user.
38654 @end table
38655
38656 @end table
38657
38658 @node rename
38659 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
38660 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
38661
38662 @table @asis
38663 @item Synopsis:
38664 @smallexample
38665 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
38666 @end smallexample
38667
38668 @item Request:
38669 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
38670
38671 @item Return value:
38672 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38673
38674 @item Errors:
38675
38676 @table @code
38677 @item EISDIR
38678 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
38679 directory.
38680
38681 @item EEXIST
38682 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
38683
38684 @item EBUSY
38685 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
38686 process.
38687
38688 @item EINVAL
38689 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
38690 of itself.
38691
38692 @item ENOTDIR
38693 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
38694 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
38695 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
38696
38697 @item EFAULT
38698 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
38699
38700 @item EACCES
38701 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38702
38703 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38704
38705 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
38706
38707 @item ENOENT
38708 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
38709
38710 @item EROFS
38711 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38712
38713 @item ENOSPC
38714 The device containing the file has no room for the new
38715 directory entry.
38716
38717 @item EINTR
38718 The call was interrupted by the user.
38719 @end table
38720
38721 @end table
38722
38723 @node unlink
38724 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
38725 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
38726
38727 @table @asis
38728 @item Synopsis:
38729 @smallexample
38730 int unlink(const char *pathname);
38731 @end smallexample
38732
38733 @item Request:
38734 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
38735
38736 @item Return value:
38737 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38738
38739 @item Errors:
38740
38741 @table @code
38742 @item EACCES
38743 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38744
38745 @item EPERM
38746 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
38747
38748 @item EBUSY
38749 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
38750 being used by another process.
38751
38752 @item EFAULT
38753 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38754
38755 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38756 @var{pathname} was too long.
38757
38758 @item ENOENT
38759 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38760
38761 @item ENOTDIR
38762 A component of the path is not a directory.
38763
38764 @item EROFS
38765 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38766
38767 @item EINTR
38768 The call was interrupted by the user.
38769 @end table
38770
38771 @end table
38772
38773 @node stat/fstat
38774 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
38775 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
38776 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
38777
38778 @table @asis
38779 @item Synopsis:
38780 @smallexample
38781 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
38782 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
38783 @end smallexample
38784
38785 @item Request:
38786 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
38787 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
38788
38789 @item Return value:
38790 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38791
38792 @item Errors:
38793
38794 @table @code
38795 @item EBADF
38796 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
38797
38798 @item ENOENT
38799 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
38800 path is an empty string.
38801
38802 @item ENOTDIR
38803 A component of the path is not a directory.
38804
38805 @item EFAULT
38806 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38807
38808 @item EACCES
38809 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38810
38811 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38812 @var{pathname} was too long.
38813
38814 @item EINTR
38815 The call was interrupted by the user.
38816 @end table
38817
38818 @end table
38819
38820 @node gettimeofday
38821 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
38822 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
38823
38824 @table @asis
38825 @item Synopsis:
38826 @smallexample
38827 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
38828 @end smallexample
38829
38830 @item Request:
38831 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
38832
38833 @item Return value:
38834 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
38835
38836 @item Errors:
38837
38838 @table @code
38839 @item EINVAL
38840 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
38841
38842 @item EFAULT
38843 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38844 @end table
38845
38846 @end table
38847
38848 @node isatty
38849 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
38850 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
38851
38852 @table @asis
38853 @item Synopsis:
38854 @smallexample
38855 int isatty(int fd);
38856 @end smallexample
38857
38858 @item Request:
38859 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
38860
38861 @item Return value:
38862 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
38863
38864 @item Errors:
38865
38866 @table @code
38867 @item EINTR
38868 The call was interrupted by the user.
38869 @end table
38870
38871 @end table
38872
38873 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
38874 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
38875 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
38876 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
38877 needed.
38878
38879
38880 @node system
38881 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
38882 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
38883
38884 @table @asis
38885 @item Synopsis:
38886 @smallexample
38887 int system(const char *command);
38888 @end smallexample
38889
38890 @item Request:
38891 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
38892
38893 @item Return value:
38894 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
38895 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
38896 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
38897 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
38898 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
38899 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
38900 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
38901
38902 @item Errors:
38903
38904 @table @code
38905 @item EINTR
38906 The call was interrupted by the user.
38907 @end table
38908
38909 @end table
38910
38911 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
38912 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
38913 the host is simplified before it's returned
38914 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
38915 is discarded, and the return value consists
38916 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
38917
38918 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
38919 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
38920 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
38921
38922 @table @code
38923 @item set remote system-call-allowed
38924 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
38925 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
38926 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
38927
38928 @item show remote system-call-allowed
38929 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
38930 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
38931 protocol.
38932 @end table
38933
38934 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
38935 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
38936 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
38937
38938 @menu
38939 * Integral Datatypes::
38940 * Pointer Values::
38941 * Memory Transfer::
38942 * struct stat::
38943 * struct timeval::
38944 @end menu
38945
38946 @node Integral Datatypes
38947 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
38948 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
38949
38950 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
38951 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
38952 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
38953
38954 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
38955 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
38956
38957 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
38958
38959 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
38960 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
38961
38962 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
38963
38964 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
38965 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
38966 byte order.
38967
38968 @node Pointer Values
38969 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
38970 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
38971
38972 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
38973 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
38974 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
38975 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
38976
38977 @smallexample
38978 @code{1aaf/12}
38979 @end smallexample
38980
38981 @noindent
38982 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
38983 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
38984 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
38985 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
38986
38987 @smallexample
38988 @code{123456/d}
38989 @end smallexample
38990
38991 @node Memory Transfer
38992 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
38993 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
38994
38995 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
38996 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
38997 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
38998 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
38999 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39000 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39001 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39002
39003
39004 @node struct stat
39005 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39006 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39007
39008 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39009 is defined as follows:
39010
39011 @smallexample
39012 struct stat @{
39013 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39014 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39015 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39016 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39017 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39018 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39019 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39020 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39021 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39022 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39023 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39024 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39025 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39026 @};
39027 @end smallexample
39028
39029 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39030 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39031 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39032
39033 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39034 range of values.
39035
39036 @table @code
39037
39038 @item st_dev
39039 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39040
39041 @item st_ino
39042 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39043
39044 @item st_mode
39045 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39046 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39047
39048 @item st_uid
39049 @itemx st_gid
39050 @itemx st_rdev
39051 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39052
39053 @item st_atime
39054 @itemx st_mtime
39055 @itemx st_ctime
39056 These values have a host and file system dependent
39057 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39058 support exact timing values.
39059 @end table
39060
39061 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39062 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39063 continuing.
39064
39065 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39066 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39067 get truncated on the target.
39068
39069 @node struct timeval
39070 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39071 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39072
39073 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39074 is defined as follows:
39075
39076 @smallexample
39077 struct timeval @{
39078 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39079 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39080 @};
39081 @end smallexample
39082
39083 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39084 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39085 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39086
39087 @node Constants
39088 @subsection Constants
39089 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39090
39091 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39092 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39093 values before and after the call as needed.
39094
39095 @menu
39096 * Open Flags::
39097 * mode_t Values::
39098 * Errno Values::
39099 * Lseek Flags::
39100 * Limits::
39101 @end menu
39102
39103 @node Open Flags
39104 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39105 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39106
39107 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39108
39109 @smallexample
39110 O_RDONLY 0x0
39111 O_WRONLY 0x1
39112 O_RDWR 0x2
39113 O_APPEND 0x8
39114 O_CREAT 0x200
39115 O_TRUNC 0x400
39116 O_EXCL 0x800
39117 @end smallexample
39118
39119 @node mode_t Values
39120 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39121 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39122
39123 All values are given in octal representation.
39124
39125 @smallexample
39126 S_IFREG 0100000
39127 S_IFDIR 040000
39128 S_IRUSR 0400
39129 S_IWUSR 0200
39130 S_IXUSR 0100
39131 S_IRGRP 040
39132 S_IWGRP 020
39133 S_IXGRP 010
39134 S_IROTH 04
39135 S_IWOTH 02
39136 S_IXOTH 01
39137 @end smallexample
39138
39139 @node Errno Values
39140 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39141 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39142
39143 All values are given in decimal representation.
39144
39145 @smallexample
39146 EPERM 1
39147 ENOENT 2
39148 EINTR 4
39149 EBADF 9
39150 EACCES 13
39151 EFAULT 14
39152 EBUSY 16
39153 EEXIST 17
39154 ENODEV 19
39155 ENOTDIR 20
39156 EISDIR 21
39157 EINVAL 22
39158 ENFILE 23
39159 EMFILE 24
39160 EFBIG 27
39161 ENOSPC 28
39162 ESPIPE 29
39163 EROFS 30
39164 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39165 EUNKNOWN 9999
39166 @end smallexample
39167
39168 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39169 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39170
39171 @node Lseek Flags
39172 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39173 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39174
39175 @smallexample
39176 SEEK_SET 0
39177 SEEK_CUR 1
39178 SEEK_END 2
39179 @end smallexample
39180
39181 @node Limits
39182 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39183 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39184
39185 All values are given in decimal representation.
39186
39187 @smallexample
39188 INT_MIN -2147483648
39189 INT_MAX 2147483647
39190 UINT_MAX 4294967295
39191 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
39192 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
39193 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
39194 @end smallexample
39195
39196 @node File-I/O Examples
39197 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39198 @cindex file-i/o examples
39199
39200 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39201 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39202
39203 @smallexample
39204 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39205 @emph{request memory read from target}
39206 -> @code{m1234,6}
39207 <- XXXXXX
39208 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39209 -> @code{F6}
39210 @end smallexample
39211
39212 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39213 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39214
39215 @smallexample
39216 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39217 @emph{request memory write to target}
39218 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39219 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39220 -> @code{F6}
39221 @end smallexample
39222
39223 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39224 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39225
39226 @smallexample
39227 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39228 -> @code{F-1,9}
39229 @end smallexample
39230
39231 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39232 host is called:
39233
39234 @smallexample
39235 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39236 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39237 <- @code{T02}
39238 @end smallexample
39239
39240 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39241 host is called:
39242
39243 @smallexample
39244 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39245 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39246 <- @code{T02}
39247 @end smallexample
39248
39249 @node Library List Format
39250 @section Library List Format
39251 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39252
39253 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39254 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39255 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39256 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39257 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39258 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39259 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39260 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39261 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39262 are loaded.
39263
39264 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39265 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39266 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39267 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39268
39269 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39270 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39271 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39272 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39273 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39274 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39275
39276 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39277 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39278
39279 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39280 offset, looks like this:
39281
39282 @smallexample
39283 <library-list>
39284 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39285 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39286 </library>
39287 </library-list>
39288 @end smallexample
39289
39290 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39291 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39292
39293 @smallexample
39294 <library-list>
39295 <library name="sharedlib.o">
39296 <section address="0x10000000"/>
39297 <section address="0x20000000"/>
39298 <section address="0x30000000"/>
39299 </library>
39300 </library-list>
39301 @end smallexample
39302
39303 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
39304
39305 @smallexample
39306 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
39307 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
39308 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39309 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
39310 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39311 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
39312 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39313 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
39314 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39315 @end smallexample
39316
39317 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
39318 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
39319 section for each library.
39320
39321 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39322 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39323 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39324
39325 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
39326 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
39327 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
39328 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
39329
39330 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
39331 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
39332 target, the following parameters are reported:
39333
39334 @itemize @minus
39335 @item
39336 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
39337 @code{struct link_map}.
39338 @item
39339 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
39340 (Thread Local Storage) access.
39341 @item
39342 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
39343 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
39344 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
39345 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
39346 @item
39347 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
39348 @end itemize
39349
39350 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
39351 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
39352 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
39353
39354 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39355 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39356
39357 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
39358 looks like this:
39359
39360 @smallexample
39361 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
39362 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
39363 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
39364 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
39365 l_ld="0x152350"/>
39366 </library-list-svr>
39367 @end smallexample
39368
39369 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
39370
39371 @smallexample
39372 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
39373 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
39374 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39375 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
39376 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
39377 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39378 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
39379 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
39380 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
39381 @end smallexample
39382
39383 @node Memory Map Format
39384 @section Memory Map Format
39385 @cindex memory map format
39386
39387 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
39388 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
39389 memory map.
39390
39391 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39392 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
39393 lists memory regions.
39394
39395 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39396 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
39397
39398 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39399
39400 @smallexample
39401 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39402 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
39403 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39404 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
39405 <memory-map>
39406 region...
39407 </memory-map>
39408 @end smallexample
39409
39410 Each region can be either:
39411
39412 @itemize
39413
39414 @item
39415 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
39416 bytes from there:
39417
39418 @smallexample
39419 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39420 @end smallexample
39421
39422
39423 @item
39424 A region of read-only memory:
39425
39426 @smallexample
39427 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39428 @end smallexample
39429
39430
39431 @item
39432 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
39433 bytes in length:
39434
39435 @smallexample
39436 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
39437 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
39438 </memory>
39439 @end smallexample
39440
39441 @end itemize
39442
39443 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
39444 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
39445 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
39446
39447 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
39448
39449 @smallexample
39450 <!-- ................................................... -->
39451 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
39452 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
39453 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
39454 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
39455 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
39456 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
39457 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
39458 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
39459 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
39460 and its type, or device. -->
39461 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
39462 start CDATA #REQUIRED
39463 length CDATA #REQUIRED
39464 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
39465 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
39466 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
39467 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39468 @end smallexample
39469
39470 @node Thread List Format
39471 @section Thread List Format
39472 @cindex thread list format
39473
39474 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
39475 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39476 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
39477 the following structure:
39478
39479 @smallexample
39480 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39481 <threads>
39482 <thread id="id" core="0">
39483 ... description ...
39484 </thread>
39485 </threads>
39486 @end smallexample
39487
39488 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
39489 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
39490 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
39491 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
39492 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
39493
39494 @node Traceframe Info Format
39495 @section Traceframe Info Format
39496 @cindex traceframe info format
39497
39498 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
39499 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
39500 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
39501 collected in a traceframe.
39502
39503 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39504 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
39505
39506 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39507 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39508
39509 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39510
39511 @smallexample
39512 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39513 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
39514 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39515 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
39516 <traceframe-info>
39517 block...
39518 </traceframe-info>
39519 @end smallexample
39520
39521 Each traceframe block can be either:
39522
39523 @itemize
39524
39525 @item
39526 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
39527 @var{length} bytes from there:
39528
39529 @smallexample
39530 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39531 @end smallexample
39532
39533 @item
39534 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
39535 collected:
39536
39537 @smallexample
39538 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
39539 @end smallexample
39540
39541 @end itemize
39542
39543 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
39544
39545 @smallexample
39546 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
39547 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39548
39549 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
39550 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
39551 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
39552 <!ELEMENT tvar>
39553 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
39554 @end smallexample
39555
39556 @node Branch Trace Format
39557 @section Branch Trace Format
39558 @cindex branch trace format
39559
39560 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
39561 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
39562 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
39563 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
39564
39565 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39566 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
39567
39568 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39569 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39570
39571 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39572
39573 @smallexample
39574 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39575 <!DOCTYPE btrace
39576 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
39577 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
39578 <btrace>
39579 block...
39580 </btrace>
39581 @end smallexample
39582
39583 @itemize
39584
39585 @item
39586 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
39587 and ending at @var{end}:
39588
39589 @smallexample
39590 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
39591 @end smallexample
39592
39593 @end itemize
39594
39595 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
39596
39597 @smallexample
39598 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
39599 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39600
39601 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
39602 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
39603 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
39604 @end smallexample
39605
39606 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
39607 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
39608 @cindex branch trace configuration format
39609
39610 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
39611 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39612 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
39613
39614 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
39615 settings for that format. The following information is described:
39616
39617 @table @code
39618 @item bts
39619 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
39620 @table @code
39621 @item size
39622 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
39623 @end table
39624 @end table
39625
39626 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39627 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39628
39629 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
39630
39631 @smallexample
39632 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?)>
39633 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39634
39635 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
39636 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
39637 @end smallexample
39638
39639 @include agentexpr.texi
39640
39641 @node Target Descriptions
39642 @appendix Target Descriptions
39643 @cindex target descriptions
39644
39645 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
39646 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
39647 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
39648 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
39649 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
39650 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
39651 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
39652
39653 @itemize @bullet
39654 @item
39655 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
39656 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
39657 @item
39658 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
39659 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
39660 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
39661 @item
39662 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
39663 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
39664 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
39665 @end itemize
39666
39667 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
39668 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
39669 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
39670 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
39671 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
39672
39673 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39674 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
39675
39676 @menu
39677 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
39678 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
39679 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
39680 descriptions.
39681 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
39682 @end menu
39683
39684 @node Retrieving Descriptions
39685 @section Retrieving Descriptions
39686
39687 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
39688 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
39689 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
39690 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
39691 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
39692 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
39693 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
39694 Format}.
39695
39696 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
39697 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
39698 specify a file are:
39699
39700 @table @code
39701 @cindex set tdesc filename
39702 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
39703 Read the target description from @var{path}.
39704
39705 @cindex unset tdesc filename
39706 @item unset tdesc filename
39707 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
39708 will use the description supplied by the current target.
39709
39710 @cindex show tdesc filename
39711 @item show tdesc filename
39712 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
39713 @end table
39714
39715
39716 @node Target Description Format
39717 @section Target Description Format
39718 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
39719
39720 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
39721 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
39722 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
39723 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
39724 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
39725 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
39726 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
39727
39728 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
39729 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
39730 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
39731 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
39732 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
39733
39734 Here is a simple target description:
39735
39736 @smallexample
39737 <target version="1.0">
39738 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
39739 </target>
39740 @end smallexample
39741
39742 @noindent
39743 This minimal description only says that the target uses
39744 the x86-64 architecture.
39745
39746 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
39747 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
39748 are explained further below.
39749
39750 @smallexample
39751 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39752 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
39753 <target version="1.0">
39754 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
39755 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
39756 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
39757 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
39758 </target>
39759 @end smallexample
39760
39761 @noindent
39762 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
39763 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
39764 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
39765 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
39766 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
39767 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
39768 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
39769 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
39770 the version mismatch.
39771
39772 @subsection Inclusion
39773 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
39774 @cindex XInclude
39775 @ifnotinfo
39776 @cindex <xi:include>
39777 @end ifnotinfo
39778
39779 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
39780 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
39781 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
39782 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
39783 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
39784
39785 @smallexample
39786 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
39787 @end smallexample
39788
39789 @noindent
39790 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
39791 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
39792 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
39793 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
39794 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
39795 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
39796 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
39797 original description.
39798
39799 @subsection Architecture
39800 @cindex <architecture>
39801
39802 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
39803
39804 @smallexample
39805 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
39806 @end smallexample
39807
39808 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
39809 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
39810
39811 @subsection OS ABI
39812 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
39813
39814 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
39815 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
39816
39817 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
39818
39819 @smallexample
39820 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
39821 @end smallexample
39822
39823 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
39824 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
39825
39826 @subsection Compatible Architecture
39827 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
39828
39829 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
39830 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
39831
39832 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
39833
39834 @smallexample
39835 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
39836 @end smallexample
39837
39838 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
39839 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
39840
39841 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
39842 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
39843 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
39844 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
39845 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
39846 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
39847 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
39848
39849 @smallexample
39850 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
39851 <compatible>spu</compatible>
39852 @end smallexample
39853
39854 @subsection Features
39855 @cindex <feature>
39856
39857 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
39858 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
39859 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
39860 has this form:
39861
39862 @smallexample
39863 <feature name="@var{name}">
39864 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
39865 @var{reg}@dots{}
39866 </feature>
39867 @end smallexample
39868
39869 @noindent
39870 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
39871 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
39872 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
39873 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
39874
39875 @subsection Types
39876
39877 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
39878 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
39879 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
39880 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
39881 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
39882
39883 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
39884 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
39885 Types must be defined before they are used.
39886
39887 @cindex <vector>
39888 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
39889 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
39890 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
39891 @var{count}:
39892
39893 @smallexample
39894 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
39895 @end smallexample
39896
39897 @cindex <union>
39898 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
39899 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
39900 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
39901 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
39902
39903 @smallexample
39904 <union id="@var{id}">
39905 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
39906 @dots{}
39907 </union>
39908 @end smallexample
39909
39910 @cindex <struct>
39911 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
39912 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
39913 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
39914 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
39915 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
39916 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
39917 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
39918 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
39919
39920 @smallexample
39921 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
39922 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
39923 @dots{}
39924 </struct>
39925 @end smallexample
39926
39927 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
39928 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
39929
39930 @smallexample
39931 <struct id="@var{id}">
39932 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
39933 @dots{}
39934 </struct>
39935 @end smallexample
39936
39937 @cindex <flags>
39938 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
39939 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
39940 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
39941 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
39942 are supported.
39943
39944 @smallexample
39945 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
39946 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
39947 @dots{}
39948 </flags>
39949 @end smallexample
39950
39951 @subsection Registers
39952 @cindex <reg>
39953
39954 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
39955
39956 @smallexample
39957 <reg name="@var{name}"
39958 bitsize="@var{size}"
39959 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
39960 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
39961 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
39962 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
39963 @end smallexample
39964
39965 @noindent
39966 The components are as follows:
39967
39968 @table @var
39969
39970 @item name
39971 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
39972
39973 @item bitsize
39974 The register's size, in bits.
39975
39976 @item regnum
39977 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
39978 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
39979 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
39980 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
39981 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
39982 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
39983 in order of increasing register number.
39984
39985 @item save-restore
39986 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
39987 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
39988 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
39989 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
39990 ABI.
39991
39992 @item type
39993 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
39994 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
39995 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
39996 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
39997 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
39998 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
39999
40000 @item group
40001 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40002 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40003 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40004 in @code{info registers}.
40005
40006 @end table
40007
40008 @node Predefined Target Types
40009 @section Predefined Target Types
40010 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40011
40012 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40013 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40014 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40015 types. The currently supported types are:
40016
40017 @table @code
40018
40019 @item int8
40020 @itemx int16
40021 @itemx int32
40022 @itemx int64
40023 @itemx int128
40024 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40025
40026 @item uint8
40027 @itemx uint16
40028 @itemx uint32
40029 @itemx uint64
40030 @itemx uint128
40031 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40032
40033 @item code_ptr
40034 @itemx data_ptr
40035 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40036 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40037 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40038 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40039 may be marked as data pointers.
40040
40041 @item ieee_single
40042 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40043
40044 @item ieee_double
40045 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40046
40047 @item arm_fpa_ext
40048 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40049
40050 @item i387_ext
40051 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40052
40053 @item i386_eflags
40054 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40055
40056 @item i386_mxcsr
40057 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40058
40059 @end table
40060
40061 @node Standard Target Features
40062 @section Standard Target Features
40063 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40064
40065 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40066 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
40067 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40068 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
40069 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40070 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40071 can recognize them.
40072
40073 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40074 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
40075 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40076 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40077 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40078 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
40079 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40080 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40081
40082 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40083 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40084 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40085
40086 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40087 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40088 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40089 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40090
40091 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40092 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40093 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40094
40095 @menu
40096 * AArch64 Features::
40097 * ARM Features::
40098 * i386 Features::
40099 * MicroBlaze Features::
40100 * MIPS Features::
40101 * M68K Features::
40102 * Nios II Features::
40103 * PowerPC Features::
40104 * S/390 and System z Features::
40105 * TIC6x Features::
40106 @end menu
40107
40108
40109 @node AArch64 Features
40110 @subsection AArch64 Features
40111 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
40112
40113 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
40114 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
40115 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40116
40117 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
40118 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
40119 and @samp{fpcr}.
40120
40121 @node ARM Features
40122 @subsection ARM Features
40123 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
40124
40125 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
40126 ARM targets.
40127 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
40128 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40129
40130 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
40131 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
40132 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
40133 and @samp{xpsr}.
40134
40135 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
40136 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
40137
40138 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
40139 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
40140 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
40141 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
40142
40143 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
40144 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
40145 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
40146 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
40147 halves of the double-precision registers.
40148
40149 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
40150 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
40151 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
40152 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
40153 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
40154 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
40155
40156 @node i386 Features
40157 @subsection i386 Features
40158 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
40159
40160 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
40161 targets. It should describe the following registers:
40162
40163 @itemize @minus
40164 @item
40165 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
40166 @item
40167 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
40168 @item
40169 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
40170 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
40171 @item
40172 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
40173 @item
40174 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
40175 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
40176 @end itemize
40177
40178 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
40179
40180 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
40181 describe registers:
40182
40183 @itemize @minus
40184 @item
40185 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
40186 @item
40187 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
40188 @item
40189 @samp{mxcsr}
40190 @end itemize
40191
40192 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
40193 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
40194 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
40195
40196 @itemize @minus
40197 @item
40198 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
40199 @item
40200 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
40201 @end itemize
40202
40203 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
40204 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
40205
40206 @itemize @minus
40207 @item
40208 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
40209 @item
40210 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
40211 @end itemize
40212
40213 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
40214 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
40215
40216 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
40217 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
40218 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
40219
40220 @itemize @minus
40221 @item
40222 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40223 @end itemize
40224
40225 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
40226
40227 @itemize @minus
40228 @item
40229 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40230 @end itemize
40231
40232 It should
40233 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
40234
40235 @itemize @minus
40236 @item
40237 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
40238 @item
40239 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
40240 @end itemize
40241
40242 It should
40243 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
40244
40245 @itemize @minus
40246 @item
40247 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40248 @end itemize
40249
40250 @node MicroBlaze Features
40251 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
40252 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
40253
40254 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
40255 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40256 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
40257 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
40258 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
40259
40260 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
40261 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
40262
40263 @node MIPS Features
40264 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
40265 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
40266
40267 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
40268 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
40269 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
40270 on the target.
40271
40272 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
40273 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
40274 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40275
40276 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
40277 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
40278 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
40279 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40280
40281 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
40282 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
40283 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
40284 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40285
40286 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
40287 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
40288 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
40289
40290 @node M68K Features
40291 @subsection M68K Features
40292 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
40293
40294 @table @code
40295 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
40296 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
40297 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
40298 One of those features must be always present.
40299 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
40300 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
40301 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
40302 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
40303
40304 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
40305 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
40306 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
40307 @samp{fpiaddr}.
40308 @end table
40309
40310 @node Nios II Features
40311 @subsection Nios II Features
40312 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
40313
40314 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
40315 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
40316 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
40317 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
40318 @samp{mpuacc}).
40319
40320 @node PowerPC Features
40321 @subsection PowerPC Features
40322 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
40323
40324 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
40325 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40326 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
40327 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40328
40329 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
40330 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
40331
40332 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
40333 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
40334 and @samp{vrsave}.
40335
40336 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
40337 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
40338 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
40339 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
40340 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
40341 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
40342
40343 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
40344 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
40345 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
40346 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
40347 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
40348 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
40349 user.
40350
40351 @node S/390 and System z Features
40352 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
40353 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
40354 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
40355
40356 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
40357 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
40358 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
40359 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
40360 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
40361 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
40362 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
40363 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
40364 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
40365
40366 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
40367 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
40368 @samp{fpc}.
40369
40370 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
40371 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
40372
40373 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
40374 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
40375 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
40376 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
40377 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
40378 32-bit wide.
40379
40380 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
40381 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
40382 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
40383
40384 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
40385 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
40386 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
40387 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
40388 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
40389 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
40390 @samp{v31}.
40391
40392 @node TIC6x Features
40393 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
40394 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
40395 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
40396 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
40397 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
40398 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
40399
40400 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
40401 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
40402 through @samp{B31}.
40403
40404 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
40405 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
40406
40407 @node Operating System Information
40408 @appendix Operating System Information
40409 @cindex operating system information
40410
40411 @menu
40412 * Process list::
40413 @end menu
40414
40415 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
40416 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
40417 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
40418 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
40419 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
40420 on a different aspect of target.
40421
40422 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
40423 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
40424 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
40425 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
40426
40427 @node Process list
40428 @appendixsection Process list
40429 @cindex operating system information, process list
40430
40431 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
40432 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
40433 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
40434 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
40435
40436 An example document is:
40437
40438 @smallexample
40439 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40440 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
40441 <osdata type="processes">
40442 <item>
40443 <column name="pid">1</column>
40444 <column name="user">root</column>
40445 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
40446 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
40447 </item>
40448 </osdata>
40449 @end smallexample
40450
40451 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
40452 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
40453 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
40454 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
40455 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
40456 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
40457 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
40458
40459 @node Trace File Format
40460 @appendix Trace File Format
40461 @cindex trace file format
40462
40463 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
40464 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
40465
40466 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
40467 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
40468 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
40469 in the future.
40470
40471 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
40472 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
40473 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
40474 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
40475 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
40476 of this section.
40477
40478 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
40479
40480 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
40481 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
40482 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
40483 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
40484 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
40485 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
40486 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
40487 endianness.
40488
40489 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
40490
40491 @table @code
40492 @item R @var{bytes}
40493 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
40494 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
40495 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
40496 hexadecimal encoding.
40497
40498 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
40499 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
40500 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
40501 @var{length} bytes.
40502
40503 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
40504 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
40505 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
40506
40507 @end table
40508
40509 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
40510 of blocks.
40511
40512 @node Index Section Format
40513 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
40514 @cindex .gdb_index section format
40515 @cindex index section format
40516
40517 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
40518 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
40519 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
40520 description.
40521
40522 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
40523 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
40524 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
40525 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
40526 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
40527 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
40528
40529 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
40530
40531 @enumerate
40532 @item
40533 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
40534 unless otherwise noted:
40535
40536 @enumerate
40537 @item
40538 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
40539 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
40540 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
40541 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
40542 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
40543 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
40544 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
40545
40546 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
40547 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
40548 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
40549 currently not flagged as deprecated.
40550
40551 @item
40552 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
40553
40554 @item
40555 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
40556 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
40557 to the next offset.
40558
40559 @item
40560 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
40561
40562 @item
40563 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
40564
40565 @item
40566 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
40567 @end enumerate
40568
40569 @item
40570 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
40571 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
40572 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
40573 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
40574 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
40575 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
40576 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
40577 CU indices.
40578
40579 @item
40580 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
40581 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
40582 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
40583 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
40584
40585 @item
40586 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
40587 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
40588
40589 @enumerate
40590 @item
40591 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
40592
40593 @item
40594 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
40595 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
40596
40597 @item
40598 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
40599 @end enumerate
40600
40601 @item
40602 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
40603 the hash table is always a power of 2.
40604
40605 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
40606 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
40607 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
40608 constant pool.
40609
40610 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
40611 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
40612 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
40613
40614 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
40615 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
40616 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
40617 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
40618 index version:
40619
40620 @table @asis
40621 @item Version 4
40622 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
40623
40624 @item Versions 5 to 7
40625 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
40626 @end table
40627
40628 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
40629
40630 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
40631 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
40632 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
40633 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
40634 collision.
40635
40636 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
40637 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
40638 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
40639 the code.
40640
40641 @item
40642 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
40643 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
40644 strings.
40645
40646 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
40647 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
40648 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
40649 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
40650 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
40651 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
40652
40653 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
40654 @end enumerate
40655
40656 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
40657 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
40658 CU index+attributes value for each use.
40659
40660 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
40661 (bit 0 = LSB):
40662
40663 @table @asis
40664
40665 @item Bits 0-23
40666 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
40667 @item Bits 24-27
40668 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
40669 @item Bits 28-30
40670 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
40671
40672 @table @asis
40673 @item 0
40674 This value is reserved and should not be used.
40675 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
40676 with previous versions of the index.
40677 @item 1
40678 The symbol is a type.
40679 @item 2
40680 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
40681 @item 3
40682 The symbol is a function.
40683 @item 4
40684 Any other kind of symbol.
40685 @item 5,6,7
40686 These values are reserved.
40687 @end table
40688
40689 @item Bit 31
40690 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
40691
40692 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
40693 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
40694 @value{GDBN} sources.
40695
40696 @end table
40697
40698 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
40699 global/static attributes in the index.
40700
40701 @smallexample
40702 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
40703 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
40704 switch (die->tag)
40705 @{
40706 case DW_TAG_typedef:
40707 case DW_TAG_base_type:
40708 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
40709 kind = TYPE;
40710 is_static = 1;
40711 break;
40712 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
40713 kind = VARIABLE;
40714 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40715 break;
40716 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
40717 kind = FUNCTION;
40718 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
40719 break;
40720 case DW_TAG_constant:
40721 kind = VARIABLE;
40722 is_static = ! is_external;
40723 break;
40724 case DW_TAG_variable:
40725 kind = VARIABLE;
40726 is_static = ! is_external;
40727 break;
40728 case DW_TAG_namespace:
40729 kind = TYPE;
40730 is_static = 0;
40731 break;
40732 case DW_TAG_class_type:
40733 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
40734 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
40735 case DW_TAG_union_type:
40736 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
40737 kind = TYPE;
40738 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40739 break;
40740 default:
40741 assert (0);
40742 @}
40743 @end smallexample
40744
40745 @node Man Pages
40746 @appendix Manual pages
40747 @cindex Man pages
40748
40749 @menu
40750 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
40751 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
40752 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
40753 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
40754 @end menu
40755
40756 @node gdb man
40757 @heading gdb man
40758
40759 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
40760
40761 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
40762 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
40763 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
40764 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
40765 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
40766 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
40767 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
40768 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
40769 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
40770 @c man end
40771
40772 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
40773 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
40774 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
40775 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
40776
40777 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
40778 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
40779
40780 @itemize @bullet
40781 @item
40782 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
40783
40784 @item
40785 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
40786
40787 @item
40788 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
40789
40790 @item
40791 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
40792 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
40793 @end itemize
40794
40795 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
40796 Modula-2.
40797
40798 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
40799 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
40800 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
40801 by using the command @code{help}.
40802
40803 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
40804 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
40805 executable program as the argument:
40806
40807 @smallexample
40808 gdb program
40809 @end smallexample
40810
40811 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
40812
40813 @smallexample
40814 gdb program core
40815 @end smallexample
40816
40817 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
40818 to debug a running process:
40819
40820 @smallexample
40821 gdb program 1234
40822 gdb -p 1234
40823 @end smallexample
40824
40825 @noindent
40826 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
40827 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
40828 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
40829
40830 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
40831
40832 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
40833 @table @env
40834 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
40835 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
40836
40837 @item run [@var{arglist}]
40838 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
40839
40840 @item bt
40841 Backtrace: display the program stack.
40842
40843 @item print @var{expr}
40844 Display the value of an expression.
40845
40846 @item c
40847 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
40848
40849 @item next
40850 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
40851 function calls in the line.
40852
40853 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
40854 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
40855
40856 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
40857 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
40858
40859 @item step
40860 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
40861 function calls in the line.
40862
40863 @item help [@var{name}]
40864 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
40865 about using @value{GDBN}.
40866
40867 @item quit
40868 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
40869 @end table
40870
40871 @ifset man
40872 For full details on @value{GDBN},
40873 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40874 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
40875 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
40876 @end ifset
40877 @c man end
40878
40879 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
40880 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
40881 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
40882 encountered with no
40883 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
40884 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
40885 Many options have
40886 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
40887 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
40888 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
40889 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
40890 more usual convention.)
40891
40892 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
40893 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
40894 option is used.
40895
40896 @table @env
40897 @item -help
40898 @itemx -h
40899 List all options, with brief explanations.
40900
40901 @item -symbols=@var{file}
40902 @itemx -s @var{file}
40903 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
40904
40905 @item -write
40906 Enable writing into executable and core files.
40907
40908 @item -exec=@var{file}
40909 @itemx -e @var{file}
40910 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
40911 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
40912 dump.
40913
40914 @item -se=@var{file}
40915 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
40916 file.
40917
40918 @item -core=@var{file}
40919 @itemx -c @var{file}
40920 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
40921
40922 @item -command=@var{file}
40923 @itemx -x @var{file}
40924 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
40925
40926 @item -ex @var{command}
40927 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
40928
40929 @item -directory=@var{directory}
40930 @itemx -d @var{directory}
40931 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
40932
40933 @item -nh
40934 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
40935
40936 @item -nx
40937 @itemx -n
40938 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
40939
40940 @item -quiet
40941 @itemx -q
40942 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
40943 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
40944
40945 @item -batch
40946 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
40947 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
40948 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
40949 commands in the command files.
40950
40951 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
40952 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
40953 more useful, the message
40954
40955 @smallexample
40956 Program exited normally.
40957 @end smallexample
40958
40959 @noindent
40960 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
40961 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
40962
40963 @item -cd=@var{directory}
40964 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
40965 instead of the current directory.
40966
40967 @item -fullname
40968 @itemx -f
40969 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
40970 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
40971 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
40972 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
40973 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
40974 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
40975 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
40976 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
40977
40978 @item -b @var{bps}
40979 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
40980 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
40981
40982 @item -tty=@var{device}
40983 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
40984 @end table
40985 @c man end
40986
40987 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
40988 @ifset man
40989 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40990 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40991 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40992
40993 @smallexample
40994 info gdb
40995 @end smallexample
40996
40997 @noindent
40998 should give you access to the complete manual.
40999
41000 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41001 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41002 @end ifset
41003 @c man end
41004
41005 @node gdbserver man
41006 @heading gdbserver man
41007
41008 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
41009 @format
41010 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
41011 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41012
41013 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41014
41015 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41016 @c man end
41017 @end format
41018
41019 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
41020 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
41021 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
41022
41023 @ifclear man
41024 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
41025 @end ifclear
41026 @ifset man
41027 Usage (server (target) side):
41028 @end ifset
41029
41030 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
41031 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
41032 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
41033 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
41034
41035 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
41036 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
41037 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
41038
41039 @smallexample
41040 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
41041 @end smallexample
41042
41043 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
41044
41045 @smallexample
41046 @ifset man
41047 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
41048 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
41049 @end ifset
41050 @ifclear man
41051 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
41052 @end ifclear
41053 @end smallexample
41054
41055 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
41056 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
41057 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
41058
41059 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
41060
41061 @smallexample
41062 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
41063 @end smallexample
41064
41065 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
41066 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
41067 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
41068 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
41069 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
41070 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
41071 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
41072 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
41073 print an error message and exit.
41074
41075 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
41076 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
41077
41078 @smallexample
41079 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41080 @end smallexample
41081
41082 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41083 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41084
41085 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41086 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
41087 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
41088 the program you want to debug.
41089
41090 @smallexample
41091 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41092 @end smallexample
41093
41094 @ifclear man
41095 @subheading Usage (host side)
41096 @end ifclear
41097 @ifset man
41098 Usage (host side):
41099 @end ifset
41100
41101 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
41102 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
41103 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
41104 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
41105 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
41106 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
41107 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
41108 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
41109 descriptor. For example:
41110
41111 @smallexample
41112 @ifset man
41113 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
41114 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
41115 @end ifset
41116 @ifclear man
41117 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
41118 @end ifclear
41119 @end smallexample
41120
41121 @noindent
41122 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
41123
41124 @smallexample
41125 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
41126 @end smallexample
41127
41128 @noindent
41129 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
41130 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
41131 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
41132 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
41133 `Connection refused'.
41134
41135 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
41136 described in
41137 @ifset man
41138 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
41139 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
41140 @end ifset
41141 @ifclear man
41142 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
41143 @end ifclear
41144 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
41145
41146 @smallexample
41147 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
41148 @end smallexample
41149
41150 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
41151 case.
41152 @c man end
41153
41154 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
41155 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
41156
41157 @itemize @bullet
41158
41159 @item
41160 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
41161
41162 @smallexample
41163 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41164 @end smallexample
41165
41166 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
41167 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
41168 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
41169 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
41170 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
41171 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
41172 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41173
41174 @item
41175 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
41176 program:
41177
41178 @smallexample
41179 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41180 @end smallexample
41181
41182 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
41183 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
41184 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
41185 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41186
41187 @item
41188 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
41189
41190 @smallexample
41191 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41192 @end smallexample
41193
41194 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
41195 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
41196 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
41197 debug several processes in the same session.
41198 @end itemize
41199
41200 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
41201
41202 @table @env
41203
41204 @item --help
41205 List all options, with brief explanations.
41206
41207 @item --version
41208 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
41209
41210 @item --attach
41211 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
41212
41213 @smallexample
41214 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41215 @end smallexample
41216
41217 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41218 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41219
41220 @item --multi
41221 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41222 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
41223 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
41224 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
41225
41226 @smallexample
41227 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41228 @end smallexample
41229
41230 @item --debug
41231 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
41232 process.
41233 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41234 the developers.
41235
41236 @item --remote-debug
41237 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
41238 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41239 the developers.
41240
41241 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
41242 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
41243 of debugging output.
41244 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
41245
41246 @item --wrapper
41247 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
41248 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
41249 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
41250 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
41251
41252 @item --once
41253 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
41254 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
41255 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
41256 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
41257
41258 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
41259
41260 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
41261 @c QDisableRandomization.
41262
41263 @end table
41264 @c man end
41265
41266 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
41267 @ifset man
41268 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41269 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41270 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41271
41272 @smallexample
41273 info gdb
41274 @end smallexample
41275
41276 should give you access to the complete manual.
41277
41278 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41279 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41280 @end ifset
41281 @c man end
41282
41283 @node gcore man
41284 @heading gcore
41285
41286 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
41287
41288 @format
41289 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
41290 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
41291 @c man end
41292 @end format
41293
41294 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
41295 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
41296 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
41297 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
41298 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
41299 running without any change.
41300 @c man end
41301
41302 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
41303 @table @env
41304 @item -o @var{filename}
41305 The optional argument
41306 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
41307 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
41308 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
41309 @end table
41310 @c man end
41311
41312 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
41313 @ifset man
41314 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41315 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41316 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41317
41318 @smallexample
41319 info gdb
41320 @end smallexample
41321
41322 @noindent
41323 should give you access to the complete manual.
41324
41325 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41326 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41327 @end ifset
41328 @c man end
41329
41330 @node gdbinit man
41331 @heading gdbinit
41332
41333 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
41334
41335 @format
41336 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
41337 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41338 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41339 @end ifset
41340
41341 ~/.gdbinit
41342
41343 ./.gdbinit
41344 @c man end
41345 @end format
41346
41347 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
41348 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
41349 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
41350 described in
41351 @ifset man
41352 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
41353 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
41354 @end ifset
41355 @ifclear man
41356 @ref{Sequences}.
41357 @end ifclear
41358
41359 Please read more in
41360 @ifset man
41361 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
41362 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
41363 @end ifset
41364 @ifclear man
41365 @ref{Startup}.
41366 @end ifclear
41367
41368 @table @env
41369 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41370 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41371 @end ifset
41372 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41373 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
41374 @end ifclear
41375 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41376 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
41377 See more in
41378 @ifset man
41379 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
41380 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
41381 @end ifset
41382 @ifclear man
41383 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
41384 @end ifclear
41385
41386 @item ~/.gdbinit
41387 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41388 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
41389
41390 @item ./.gdbinit
41391 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
41392 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
41393 See more in
41394 @ifset man
41395 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
41396 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
41397 @end ifset
41398 @ifclear man
41399 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
41400 @end ifclear
41401 @end table
41402 @c man end
41403
41404 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
41405 @ifset man
41406 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
41407
41408 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41409 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41410 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41411
41412 @smallexample
41413 info gdb
41414 @end smallexample
41415
41416 should give you access to the complete manual.
41417
41418 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41419 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41420 @end ifset
41421 @c man end
41422
41423 @include gpl.texi
41424
41425 @node GNU Free Documentation License
41426 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
41427 @include fdl.texi
41428
41429 @node Concept Index
41430 @unnumbered Concept Index
41431
41432 @printindex cp
41433
41434 @node Command and Variable Index
41435 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
41436
41437 @printindex fn
41438
41439 @tex
41440 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
41441 % meantime:
41442 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
41443 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
41444 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
41445 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
41446 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
41447 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
41448 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
41449 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
41450 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
41451 \page\colophon
41452 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
41453 @end tex
41454
41455 @bye
This page took 1.098499 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.